CBSE XI Text Books
CBSE XI Text Books
CBSE XI Text Books
Foreword 1. Sets 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 1.8 1.9 1.10 1.11 1.12 Introduction Sets and their Representations The Empty Set Finite and Infinite Sets Equal Sets Subsets Power Set Universal Set Venn Diagrams Operations on Sets Complement of a Set Practical Problems on Union and Intersection of Two Sets iii 1 1 1 5 6 7 9 12 12 13 14 18 21 30 30 30 34 36 49 49 49 55 63 74 86 86 87 88
2.
Relations and Functions 2.1 Introduction 2.2 Cartesian Product of Sets 2.3 Relations 2.4 Functions Trigonometric Functions 3.1 Introduction 3.2 Angles 3.3 Trigonometric Functions 3.4 Trigonometric Functions of Sum and Difference of Two Angles 3.5 Trigonometric Equations Principle of Mathematical Induction 4.1 Introduction 4.2 Motivation 4.3 The Principle of Mathematical Induction
3.
4.
5.
Complex Numbers and Quadratic Equations 5.1 Introduction 5.2 Complex Numbers 5.3 Algebra of Complex Numbers 5.4 The Modulus and the Conjugate of a Complex Number 5.5 Argand Plane and Polar Representation 5.6 Quadratic Equations Linear Inequalities 6.1 Introduction 6.2 Inequalities 6.3 Algebraic Solutions of Linear Inequalities in One Variable and their Graphical Representation 6.4 Graphical Solution of Linear Inequalities in Two Variables 6.5 Solution of System of Linear Inequalities in Two Variables Permutations and Combinations 7.1 Introduction 7.2 Fundamental Principle of Counting 7.3 Permutations 7.4 Combinations Binomial Theorem 8.1 Introduction 8.2 Binomial Theorem for Positive Integral Indices 8.3 General and Middle Terms Sequences and Series 9.1 Introduction 9.2 Sequences 9.3 Series 9.4 Arithmetic Progression (A.P.) 9.5 Geometric Progression (G.P.) 9.6 Relationship Between A.M. and G.M. 9.7 Sum to n terms of Special Series
97 97 97 98 102 104 108 116 116 116 118 123 127 134 134 134 138 148 160 160 160 167 177 177 177 179 181 186 191 194 203 203 204 212 220 225
6.
7.
8.
9.
10. Straight Lines 10.1 Introduction 10.2 Slope of a Line 10.3 Various Forms of the Equation of a Line 10.4 General Equation of a Line 10.5 Distance of a Point From a Line
viii
11. Conic Sections 11.1 Introduction 11.2 Sections of a Cone 11.3 Circle 11.4 Parabola 11.5 Ellipse 11.6 Hyperbola 12. Introduction to Three Dimensional Geometry 12.1 Introduction 12.2 Coordinate Axes and Coordinate Planes in Three Dimensional Space 12.3 Coordinates of a Point in Space 12.4 Distance between Two Points 12.5 Section Formula 13. Limits and Derivatives 13.1 Introduction 13.2 Intuitive Idea of Derivatives 13.3 Limits 13.4 Limits of Trigonometric Functions 13.5 Derivatives 14. Mathematical Reasoning 14.1 Introduction 14.2 Statements 14.3 New Statements from Old 14.4 Special Words/Phrases 14.5 Implications 14.6 Validating Statements 15. Statistics 15.1 Introduction 15.2 Measures of Dispersion 15.3 Range 15.4 Mean Deviation 15.5 Variance and Standard Deviation 15.6 Analysis of Frequency Distributions
ix
236 236 236 239 242 247 255 268 268 269 269 271 273 281 281 281 284 298 303 321 321 321 324 329 335 339 347 347 349 349 349 361 372
16. Probability 16.1 Introduction 16.2 Random Experiments 16.3 Event 16.4 Axiomatic Approach to Probability Appendix 1: Infinite Series A.1.1 Introduction A.1.2 Binomial Theorem for any Index A.1.3 Infinite Geometric Series A.1.4 Exponential Series A.1.5 Logarithmic Series Appendix 2: Mathematical Modelling A.2.1 Introduction A.2.2 Preliminaries A.2.3 What is Mathematical Modelling Answers
383 383 384 387 394 412 412 412 414 416 419 421 421 421 425 433
Chapter
SETS
In these days of conflict between ancient and modern studies; there must surely be something to be said for a study which did not begin with Pythagoras and will not end with Einstein; but is the oldest and the youngest. G.H. HARDY
1.1 Introduction
The concept of set serves as a fundamental part of the present day mathematics. Today this concept is being used in almost every branch of mathematics. Sets are used to define the concepts of relations and functions. The study of geometry, sequences, probability, etc. requires the knowledge of sets. The theory of sets was developed by German mathematician Georg Cantor (1845-1918). He first encountered sets while working on problems on trigonometric series. In this Chapter, we discuss some basic definitions and operations involving sets.
MATHEMATICS
the sense that we can definitely decide whether a given particular object belongs to a given collection or not. For example, we can say that the river Nile does not belong to the collection of rivers of India. On the other hand, the river Ganga does belong to this colleciton. We give below a few more examples of sets used particularly in mathematics, viz. N Z Q R Z+ Q+ : : : : : : the set of all natural numbers the set of all integers the set of all rational numbers the set of real numbers the set of positive integers the set of positive rational numbers, and
R + : the set of positive real numbers. The symbols for the special sets given above will be referred to throughout this text. Again the collection of five most renowned mathematicians of the world is not well-defined, because the criterion for determining a mathematician as most renowned may vary from person to person. Thus, it is not a well-defined collection. We shall say that a set is a well-defined collection of objects. The following points may be noted : (i) Objects, elements and members of a set are synonymous terms. (ii) Sets are usually denoted by capital letters A, B, C, X, Y, Z, etc. (iii) The elements of a set are represented by small letters a, b, c, x, y, z, etc. If a is an element of a set A, we say that a belongs to A the Greek symbol (epsilon) is used to denote the phrase belongs to. Thus, we write a A. If b is not an element of a set A, we write b A and read b does not belong to A. Thus, in the set V of vowels in the English alphabet, a V but b V. In the set P of prime factors of 30, 3 P but 15 P. There are two methods of representing a set : (i) Roster or tabular form (ii) Set-builder form. (i) In roster form, all the elements of a set are listed, the elements are being separated by commas and are enclosed within braces { }. For example, the set of all even positive integers less than 7 is described in roster form as {2, 4, 6}. Some more examples of representing a set in roster form are given below : (a) The set of all natural numbers which divide 42 is {1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 14, 21, 42}.
SETS
Note In roster form, the order in which the elements are listed is immaterial. Thus, the above set can also be represented as {1, 3, 7, 21, 2, 6, 14, 42}. (b) (c) The set of all vowels in the English alphabet is {a, e, i, o, u}. The set of odd natural numbers is represented by {1, 3, 5, . . .}. The dots tell us that the list of odd numbers continue indefinitely.
Note It may be noted that while writing the set in roster form an element is not generally repeated, i.e., all the elements are taken as distinct. For example, the set of letters forming the word SCHOOL is { S, C, H, O, L} or {H, O, L, C, S}. Here, the order of listing elements has no relevance. (ii) In set-builder form, all the elements of a set possess a single common property which is not possessed by any element outside the set. For example, in the set {a, e, i, o, u}, all the elements possess a common property, namely, each of them is a vowel in the English alphabet, and no other letter possess this property. Denoting this set by V, we write V = {x : x is a vowel in English alphabet} It may be observed that we describe the element of the set by using a symbol x (any other symbol like the letters y, z, etc. could be used) which is followed by a colon : . After the sign of colon, we write the characteristic property possessed by the elements of the set and then enclose the whole description within braces. The above description of the set V is read as the set of all x such that x is a vowel of the English alphabet. In this description the braces stand for the set of all, the colon stands for such that. For example, the set A = {x : x is a natural number and 3 < x < 10} is read as the set of all x such that x is a natural number and x lies between 3 and 10. Hence, the numbers 4, 5, 6, 7, 8 and 9 are the elements of the set A. If we denote the sets described in (a), (b) and (c) above in roster form by A, B, C, respectively, then A, B, C can also be represented in set-builder form as follows: A= {x : x is a natural number which divides 42} B= {y : y is a vowel in the English alphabet} C= {z : z is an odd natural number} Example 1 Write the solution set of the equation x2 + x 2 = 0 in roster form. Solution The given equation can be written as (x 1) (x + 2) = 0, i. e., x = 1, 2 Therefore, the solution set of the given equation can be written in roster form as {1, 2}. Example 2 Write the set {x : x is a positive integer and x2 < 40} in the roster form.
MATHEMATICS
Solution The required numbers are 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6. So, the given set in the roster form is {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}. Example 3 Write the set A = {1, 4, 9, 16, 25, . . . }in set-builder form. Solution We may write the set A as A = {x : x is the square of a natural number} Alternatively, we can write A = {x : x = n2, where n N}
EXERCISE 1.1
1. Which of the following are sets ? Justify your asnwer. (i) The collection of all the months of a year beginning with the letter J. (ii) The collection of ten most talented writers of India. (iii) A team of eleven best-cricket batsmen of the world. (iv) The collection of all boys in your class. (v) The collection of all natural numbers less than 100. (vi) A collection of novels written by the writer Munshi Prem Chand. (vii) The collection of all even integers.
SETS
2.
3.
4.
5.
(viii) The collection of questions in this Chapter. (ix) A collection of most dangerous animals of the world. Let A = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}. Insert the appropriate symbol or in the blank spaces: (i) 5. . .A (ii) 8 . . . A (iii) 0. . .A (iv) 4. . . A (v) 2. . .A (vi) 10. . .A Write the following sets in roster form: (i) A = {x : x is an integer and 3 < x < 7} (ii) B = {x : x is a natural number less than 6} (iii) C = {x : x is a two-digit natural number such that the sum of its digits is 8} (iv) D = {x : x is a prime number which is divisor of 60} (v) E = The set of all letters in the word TRIGONOMETRY (vi) F = The set of all letters in the word BETTER Write the following sets in the set-builder form : (i) (3, 6, 9, 12} (ii) {2,4,8,16,32} (iii) {5, 25, 125, 625} (iv) {2, 4, 6, . . .} (v) {1,4,9, . . .,100} List all the elements of the following sets : (i) A = {x : x is an odd natural number} (ii) B = {x : x is an integer,
1 9 <x< } 2 2
6.
(iii) C = {x : x is an integer, x2 4} (iv) D = {x : x is a letter in the word LOYAL} (v) E = {x : x is a month of a year not having 31 days} (vi) F = {x : x is a consonant in the English alphabet which precedes k }. Match each of the set on the left in the roster form with the same set on the right described in set-builder form: (i) {1, 2, 3, 6} (a) {x : x is a prime number and a divisor of 6} (ii) {2, 3} (b) {x : x is an odd natural number less than 10} (iii) {M,A,T,H,E,I,C,S} (c) {x : x is natural number and divisor of 6} (iv) {1, 3, 5, 7, 9} (d) {x : x is a letter of the word MATHEMATICS}.
MATHEMATICS
B = { x : x is a student presently studying in both Classes X and XI } We observe that a student cannot study simultaneously in both Classes X and XI. Thus, the set B contains no element at all. Definition 1 A set which does not contain any element is called the empty set or the null set or the void set. According to this definition, B is an empty set while A is not an empty set. The empty set is denoted by the symbol or { }. We give below a few examples of empty sets. (i) Let A = {x : 1 < x < 2, x is a natural number}. Then A is the empty set, because there is no natural number between 1 and 2. (ii) B = {x : x2 2 = 0 and x is rational number}. Then B is the empty set because the equation x2 2 = 0 is not satisfied by any rational value of x. (iii) C = {x : x is an even prime number greater than 2}.Then C is the empty set, because 2 is the only even prime number. (iv) D = { x : x2 = 4, x is odd }. Then D is the empty set, because the equation x2 = 4 is not satisfied by any odd value of x.
SETS
some infinite set in the roster form by writing a few elements which clearly indicate the structure of the set followed ( or preceded ) by three dots. For example, {1, 2, 3 . . .} is the set of natural numbers, {1, 3, 5, 7, . . .} is the set of odd natural numbers, {. . .,3, 2, 1, 0,1, 2 ,3, . . .} is the set of integers. All these sets are infinite. Note All infinite sets cannot be described in the roster form. For example, the set of real numbers cannot be described in this form, because the elements of this set do not follow any particular pattern. Example 6 State which of the following sets are finite or infinite : (i) {x : x N and (x 1) (x 2) = 0} (ii) {x : x N and x2 = 4} (iii) {x : x N and 2x 1 = 0} (iv) {x : x N and x is prime} (v) {x : x N and x is odd} Solution (i) Given set = {1, 2}. Hence, it is finite. (ii) Given set = {2}. Hence, it is finite. (iii) Given set = . Hence, it is finite. (iv) The given set is the set of all prime numbers and since set of prime numbers is infinite. Hence the given set is infinite (v) Since there are infinite number of odd numbers, hence, the given set is infinite.
MATHEMATICS
element of A is in B and vice-versa. That is why we generally do not repeat any element in describing a set. Example 7 Find the pairs of equal sets, if any, give reasons: A = {0}, B = {x : x > 15 and x < 5}, C = {x : x 5 = 0 }, D = {x: x2 = 25}, E = {x : x is an integral positive root of the equation x2 2x 15 = 0}. Solution Since 0 A and 0 does not belong to any of the sets B, C, D and E, it follows that, A B, A C, A D, A E. Since B = but none of the other sets are empty. Therefore B C, B D and B E. Also C = {5} but 5 D, hence C D. Since E = {5}, C = E. Further, D = {5, 5} and E = {5}, we find that, D E. Thus, the only pair of equal sets is C and E. Example 8 Which of the following pairs of sets are equal? Justify your answer. (i) X, the set of letters in ALLOY and B, the set of letters in LOYAL. (ii) A = {n : n Z and n2 4} and B = {x : x R and x2 3x + 2 = 0}. Solution (i) We have, X = {A, L, L, O, Y}, B = {L, O, Y, A, L}. Then X and B are equal sets as repetition of elements in a set do not change a set. Thus, X = {A, L, O, Y} = B (ii) A = {2, 1, 0, 1, 2}, B = {1, 2}. Since 0 A and 0 B, A and B are not equal sets.
EXERCISE 1.2
1. Which of the following are examples of the null set (i) Set of odd natural numbers divisible by 2 (ii) Set of even prime numbers (iii) { x : x is a natural numbers, x < 5 and x > 7 } (iv) { y : y is a point common to any two parallel lines} Which of the following sets are finite or infinite (i) The set of months of a year (ii) {1, 2, 3, . . .} (iii) {1, 2, 3, . . .99, 100} (iv) The set of positive integers greater than 100 (v) The set of prime numbers less than 99 State whether each of the following set is finite or infinite: (i) The set of lines which are parallel to the x-axis (ii) The set of letters in the English alphabet (iii) The set of numbers which are multiple of 5
2.
3.
SETS
4.
5.
6.
(iv) The set of animals living on the earth (v) The set of circles passing through the origin (0,0) In the following, state whether A = B or not: (i) A = { a, b, c, d } B = { d, c, b, a } (ii) A = { 4, 8, 12, 16 } B = { 8, 4, 16, 18} (iii) A = {2, 4, 6, 8, 10} B = { x : x is positive even integer and x 10} (iv) A = { x : x is a multiple of 10}, B = { 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, . . . } Are the following pair of sets equal ? Give reasons. (i) A = {2, 3}, B = {x : x is solution of x2 + 5x + 6 = 0} (ii) A = { x : x is a letter in the word FOLLOW} B = { y : y is a letter in the word WOLF} From the sets given below, select equal sets : A = { 2, 4, 8, 12}, B = { 1, 2, 3, 4}, C = { 4, 8, 12, 14}, D = { 3, 1, 4, 2} E = {1, 1}, F = { 0, a}, G = {1, 1}, H = { 0, 1}
1.6 Subsets
Consider the sets : X = set of all students in your school, Y = set of all students in your class. We note that every element of Y is also an element of X; we say that Y is a subset of X. The fact that Y is subset of X is expressed in symbols as Y X. The symbol stands for is a subset of or is contained in. Definition 4 A set A is said to be a subset of a set B if every element of A is also an element of B. In other words, A B if whenever a A, then a B. It is often convenient to use the symbol which means implies. Using this symbol, we can write the definiton of subset as follows: A B if a A a B We read the above statement as A is a subset of B if a is an element of A implies that a is also an element of B. If A is not a subset of B, we write A B. We may note that for A to be a subset of B, all that is needed is that every element of A is in B. It is possible that every element of B may or may not be in A. If it so happens that every element of B is also in A, then we shall also have B A. In this case, A and B are the same sets so that we have A B and B A A = B, where is a symbol for two way implications, and is usually read as if and only if (briefly written as iff). It follows from the above definition that every set A is a subset of itself, i.e., A A. Since the empty set has no elements, we agree to say that is a subset of every set. We now consider some examples :
10
MATHEMATICS
(i) The set Q of rational numbers is a subset of the set R of real numbes, and we write Q R. (ii) If A is the set of all divisors of 56 and B the set of all prime divisors of 56, then B is a subset of A and we write B A. (iii) Let A = {1, 3, 5} and B = {x : x is an odd natural number less than 6}. Then A B and B A and hence A = B. (iv) Let A = { a, e, i, o, u} and B = { a, b, c, d}. Then A is not a subset of B, also B is not a subset of A. Let A and B be two sets. If A B and A B , then A is called a proper subset of B and B is called superset of A. For example, A = {1, 2, 3} is a proper subset of B = {1, 2, 3, 4}. If a set A has only one element, we call it a singleton set. Thus,{ a } is a singleton set. Example 9 Consider the sets , A = { 1, 3 }, B = {1, 5, 9}, C = {1, 3, 5, 7, 9}. Insert the symbol or between each of the following pair of sets: (i) . . . B Solution (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (ii) A . . . B (iii) A . . . C (iv) B . . . C B as is a subset of every set. A B as 3 A and 3 B A C as 1, 3 A also belongs to C B C as each element of B is also an element of C.
Example 10 Let A = { a, e, i, o, u} and B = { a, b, c, d}. Is A a subset of B ? No. (Why?). Is B a subset of A? No. (Why?) Example 11 Let A, B and C be three sets. If A B and B C, is it true that A C?. If not, give an example. Solution No. Let A = {1}, B = {{1}, 2} and C = {{1}, 2, 3}. Here A B as A = {1} and B C. But A C as 1 A and 1 C. Note that an element of a set can never be a subset of itself. 1.6.1 Subsets of set of real numbers As noted in Section 1.6, there are many important subsets of R. We give below the names of some of these subsets. The set of natural numbers N = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, . . .} The set of integers Z = {. . ., 3, 2, 1, 0, 1, 2, 3, . . .} The set of rational numbers Q = { x : x =
p , p, q Z and q 0} q
SETS
11
which is read Q is the set of all numbers x such that x equals the quotient
p q , where
p and q are integers and q is not zero. Members of Q include 5 (which can be
1 7 11 5 , 3 (which can be expressed as ) and . 2 2 3 7 The set of irrational numbers, denoted by T, is composed of all other real numbers. Thus T = {x : x R and x Q} = R Q., i.e., all real numbers that are not
expressed as ) ,
5 1
rational. Members of T include 2 , 5 and . Some of the obvious relations among these subsets are: N Z Q, Q R, T R, N T. 1.6.2 Intervals as subsets of R Let a, b R and a < b. Then the set of real numbers { y : a < y < b} is called an open interval and is denoted by (a, b). All the points between a and b belong to the open interval (a, b) but a, b themselves do not belong to this interval. The interval which contains the end points also is called closed interval and is denoted by [ a, b ]. Thus [ a, b ] = {x : a x b} We can also have intervals closed at one end and open at the other, i.e., [ a, b ) = {x : a x < b} is an open interval from a to b, including a but excluding b. ( a, b ] = { x : a < x b } is an open interval from a to b including b but excluding a. These notations provide an alternative way of designating the subsets of set of real numbers. For example , if A = (3, 5) and B = [7, 9], then A B. The set [ 0, ) defines the set of non-negative real numbers, while set ( , 0 ) defines the set of negative real numbers. The set ( , ) describes the set of real numbers in relation to a line extending from to . On real number line, various types of intervals described above as subsets of R, are shown in the Fig 1.1.
Fig 1.1
Here, we note that an interval contains infinitely many points. For example, the set {x : x R, 5 < x 7}, written in set-builder form, can be written in the form of interval as (5, 7] and the interval [3, 5) can be written in setbuilder form as {x : 3 x < 5}.
12
MATHEMATICS
The number (b a) is called the length of any of the intervals (a, b), [a, b], [a, b) or (a, b].
EXERCISE 1.3
1. Make correct statements by filling in the symbols or in the blank spaces : (i) { 2, 3, 4 } . . . { 1, 2, 3, 4,5 } (ii) { a, b, c } . . . { b, c, d } (iii) {x : x is a student of Class XI of your school}. . .{x : x student of your school} (iv) {x : x is a circle in the plane} . . .{x : x is a circle in the same plane with radius 1 unit} (v) {x : x is a triangle in a plane} . . . {x : x is a rectangle in the plane} (vi) {x : x is an equilateral triangle in a plane} . . . {x : x is a triangle in the same plane} (vii) {x : x is an even natural number} . . . {x : x is an integer}
SETS
13
2.
3.
4. 5. 6.
7. 8. 9.
Examine whether the following statements are true or false: (i) { a, b } { b, c, a } (ii) { a, e } { x : x is a vowel in the English alphabet} (iii) { 1, 2, 3 } { 1, 3, 5 } (iv) { a } { a, b, c } (v) { a } { a, b, c } (vi) { x : x is an even natural number less than 6} { x : x is a natural number which divides 36} Let A = { 1, 2, { 3, 4 }, 5 }. Which of the following statements are incorrect and why? (i) {3, 4} A (ii) {3, 4} A (iii) {{3, 4}} A (iv) 1 A (v) 1 A (vi) {1, 2, 5} A (vii) {1, 2, 5} A (viii) {1, 2, 3} A (ix) A (x) A (xi) {} A Write down all the subsets of the following sets (i) {a} (ii) {a, b} (iii) {1, 2, 3} (iv) How many elements has P(A), if A = ? Write the following as intervals : (i) {x : x R, 4 < x 6} (ii) {x : x R, 12 < x < 10} (iii) {x : x R, 0 x < 7} (iv) {x : x R, 3 x 4} Write the following intervals in set-builder form : (i) ( 3, 0) (ii) [6 , 12] (iii) (6, 12] (iv) [23, 5) What universal set(s) would you propose for each of the following : (i) The set of right triangles. (ii) The set of isosceles triangles. Given the sets A = {1, 3, 5}, B = {2, 4, 6} and C = {0, 2, 4, 6, 8}, which of the following may be considered as universal set (s) for all the three sets A, B and C (i) {0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6} (ii) (iii) {0,1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8,9,10} (iv) {1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8}
Fig 1.2
14
MATHEMATICS
Illustration 1 In Fig 1.2, U = {1,2,3, ..., 10} is the universal set of which A = {2,4,6,8,10} is a subset. Illustration 2 In Fig 1.3, U = {1,2,3, ..., 10} is the universal set of which A = {2,4,6,8,10} and B = {4, 6} are subsets, and also B A. Fig 1.3 The reader will see an extensive use of the Venn diagrams when we discuss the union, intersection and difference of sets.
SETS
15
Thus, we can define the union of two sets as follows: Definition 6 The union of two sets A and B is the set C which consists of all those elements which are either in A or in B (including those which are in both). In symbols, we write. A B = { x : x A or x B } The union of two sets can be represented by a Venn diagram as shown in Fig 1.4. The shaded portion in Fig 1.4 represents A B. Some Properties of the Operation of Union (i) A B = B A (Commutative law) Fig 1.4 (ii) ( A B ) C = A ( B C) (Associative law ) (iii) A = A (iv) A A = A (v) U A = U (Law of identity element, is the identity of ) (Idempotent law) (Law of U)
1.10.2 Intersection of sets The intersection of sets A and B is the set of all elements which are common to both A and B. The symbol is used to denote the intersection. The intersection of two sets A and B is the set of all those elements which belong to both A and B. Symbolically, we write A B = {x : x A and x B}. Example 15 Consider the sets A and B of Example 12. Find A B. Solution We see that 6, 8 are the only elements which are common to both A and B. Hence A B = { 6, 8 }. Example 16 Consider the sets X and Y of Example 14. Find X Y. Solution We see that element Geeta is the only element common to both. Hence, X Y = {Geeta}. Example 17 Let A = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10} and B = { 2, 3, 5, 7 }. Find A B and hence show that A B = B. Solution We have A B = { 2, 3, 5, 7 } = B. We note that B A and that A B = B. Definition 7 The intersection of two sets A and B is the set of all those elements which belong to both A and B. Symbolically, we write A B = {x : x A and x B} The shaded portion in Fig 1.5 indicates the Fig 1.5 interseciton of A and B.
16
MATHEMATICS
If A and B are two sets such that A B = , then U A and B are called disjoint sets. For example, let A = { 2, 4, 6, 8 } and B = { 1, 3, 5, 7 }. Then A and B are disjoint sets, A B because there are no elements which are common to A and B. The disjoint sets can be represented by means of Venn diagram as shown in the Fig 1.6 In the above diagram, A and B are disjoint sets. Fig 1.6 Some Properties of Operation of Intersection (i) A B = B A (Commutative law). (ii) ( A B ) C = A ( B C ) (Associative law). (iii) A = , U A = A (Law of and U). (iv) A A = A (Idempotent law) (v) A ( B C ) = ( A B ) ( A C ) (Distributive law ) i. e., distributes over This can be seen easily from the following Venn diagrams [Figs 1.7 (i) to (v)].
(i)
(iii)
(ii)
(iv)
(v)
Figs 1.7 (i) to (v)
SETS
17
1.10.3 Difference of sets The difference of the sets A and B in this order is the set of elements which belong to A but not to B. Symbolically, we write A B and read as A minus B. Example 18 Let A = { 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}, B = { 2, 4, 6, 8 }. Find A B and B A. Solution We have, A B = { 1, 3, 5 }, since the elements 1, 3, 5 belong to A but not to B and B A = { 8 }, since the element 8 belongs to B and not to A. We note that A B B A. Example 19 Let V = { a, e, i, o, u } and B = { a, i, k, u}. Find V B and B V Solution We have, V B = { e, o }, since the elements e, o belong to V but not to B and B V = { k }, since the element k belongs to B but not to V. We note that V B B V. Using the setbuilder notation, we can rewrite the definition of difference as A B = { x : x A and x B } The difference of two sets A and B can be represented by Venn diagram as shown in Fig 1.8. The shaded portion represents the difference of the two sets A and B. Remark The sets A B, A B and B A are mutually disjoint sets, i.e., the intersection of any of these two sets is the null set as shown in Fig 1.9.
Fig 1.8
Fig 1.9
EXERCISE 1.4
1. Find the union of each of the following pairs of sets : (i) X = {1, 3, 5} Y = {1, 2, 3} (ii) A = [ a, e, i, o, u} B = {a, b, c} (iii) A = {x : x is a natural number and multiple of 3} B = {x : x is a natural number less than 6} (iv) A = {x : x is a natural number and 1 < x 6 } B = {x : x is a natural number and 6 < x < 10 } (v) A = {1, 2, 3}, B = 2. Let A = { a, b }, B = {a, b, c}. Is A B ? What is A B ? 3. If A and B are two sets such that A B, then what is A B ? 4. If A = {1, 2, 3, 4}, B = {3, 4, 5, 6}, C = {5, 6, 7, 8 }and D = { 7, 8, 9, 10 }; find
18
MATHEMATICS
5. 6.
7.
8.
9.
(i) A B (ii) A C (iii) B C (iv) B D (v) A B C (vi) A B D (vii) B C D Find the intersection of each pair of sets of question 1 above. If A = { 3, 5, 7, 9, 11 }, B = {7, 9, 11, 13}, C = {11, 13, 15}and D = {15, 17}; find (i) A B (ii) B C (iii) A C D (iv) A C (v) B D (vi) A (B C) (vii) A D (viii) A (B D) (ix) ( A B ) ( B C ) (x) ( A D) ( B C) If A = {x : x is a natural number }, B = {x : x is an even natural number} C = {x : x is an odd natural number}andD = {x : x is a prime number }, find (i) A B (ii) A C (iii) A D (iv) B C (v) B D (vi) C D Which of the following pairs of sets are disjoint (i) {1, 2, 3, 4} and {x : x is a natural number and 4 x 6 } (ii) { a, e, i, o, u } and { c, d, e, f } (iii) {x : x is an even integer } and {x : x is an odd integer} If A = {3, 6, 9, 12, 15, 18, 21}, B = { 4, 8, 12, 16, 20 }, C = { 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16 }, D = {5, 10, 15, 20 }; find (i) A B (ii) A C (iii) A D (iv) B A (v) C A (vi) D A (vii) B C (viii) B D (ix) C B (x) D B (xi) C D (xii) D C If X= { a, b, c, d } and Y = { f, b, d, g}, find (i) X Y (ii) Y X (iii) X Y If R is the set of real numbers and Q is the set of rational numbers, then what is R Q? State whether each of the following statement is true or false. Justify your answer. (i) { 2, 3, 4, 5 } and { 3, 6} are disjoint sets. (ii) { a, e, i, o, u } and { a, b, c, d }are disjoint sets. (iii) { 2, 6, 10, 14 } and { 3, 7, 11, 15} are disjoint sets. (iv) { 2, 6, 10 } and { 3, 7, 11} are disjoint sets.
SETS
19
A. So we have A = {2, 3, 7}. Thus, we see that A = {x : x U and x A }. This leads to the following definition. Definition 8 Let U be the universal set and A a subset of U. Then the complement of A is the set of all elements of U which are not the elements of A. Symbolically, we write A to denote the complement of A with respect to U. Thus, A = {x : x U and x A }. Obviously A = U A We note that the complement of a set A can be looked upon, alternatively, as the difference between a universal set U and the set A. Example 20 Let U = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10} and A = {1, 3, 5, 7, 9}. Find A. Solution We note that 2, 4, 6, 8, 10 are the only elements of U which do not belong to A. Hence A = { 2, 4, 6, 8,10 }. Example 21 Let U be universal set of all the students of Class XI of a coeducational school and A be the set of all girls in Class XI. Find A. Solution Since A is the set of all girls, A is clearly the set of all boys in the class. Note If A is a subset of the universal set U, then its complement A is also a subset of U. Again in Example 20 above, we have A = { 2, 4, 6, 8, 10 } (A ) = {x : x U and x A} = {1, 3, 5, 7, 9} = A It is clear from the definition of the complement that for any subset of the universal Hence set U, we have ( A ) = A Now, we want to find the results for ( A B ) and A B in the followng example. Example 22 Let U = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}, A = {2, 3} and B = {3, 4, 5}. Find A, B , A B, A B and hence show that ( A B ) = A B. Solution Clearly A = {1, 4, 5, 6}, B = { 1, 2, 6 }. Hence A B = { 1, 6 } Also A B = { 2, 3, 4, 5 }, so that (A B ) = { 1, 6 } ( A B ) = { 1, 6 } = A B It can be shown that the above result is true in general. If A and B are any two subsets of the universal set U, then ( A B ) = A B. Similarly, ( A B ) = A B . These two results are stated in words as follows :
20
MATHEMATICS
The complement of the union of two sets is the intersection of their complements and the complement of the intersection of two sets is the union of their complements. These are called De Morgans laws. These are named after the mathematician De Morgan. The complement A of a set A can be represented by a Venn diagram as shown in Fig 1.10. The shaded portion represents the complement of the set A. Some Properties of Complement Sets 1. Complement laws: (i) A A = U 2. De Morgans law:
Fig 1.10
(ii) A A =
(i) (A B) = A B (ii) (A B ) = A B
3. Law of double complementation : (A ) = A 4. Laws of empty set and universal set = U and U = . These laws can be verified by using Venn diagrams.
EXERCISE 1.5
1. Let U = { 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 }, A = { 1, 2, 3, 4}, B = { 2, 4, 6, 8 } and C = { 3, 4, 5, 6 }. Find (i) A (ii) B (iii) (A C) (iv) (A B) (v) (A) (vi) (B C) If U = { a, b, c, d, e, f, g, h}, find the complements of the following sets : (i) A = {a, b, c} (ii) B = {d, e, f, g} (iii) C = {a, c, e, g} (iv) D = { f, g, h, a} Taking the set of natural numbers as the universal set, write down the complements of the following sets: (i) {x : x is an even natural number} (ii) { x : x is an odd natural number } (iii) {x : x is a positive multiple of 3} (iv) { x : x is a prime number } (v) {x : x is a natural number divisible by 3 and 5} (vi) { x : x is a perfect square } (vii) { x : x is a perfect cube} (viii) { x : x + 5 = 8 } (ix) { x : 2x + 5 = 9} (x) { x : x 7 } (xi) { x : x N and 2x + 1 > 10 } If U = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 }, A = {2, 4, 6, 8} and B = { 2, 3, 5, 7}. Verify that (i) (A B) = A B (ii) (A B) = A B Draw appropriate Venn diagram for each of the following : (i) (A B), (ii) A B, (iii) (A B), (iv) A B Let U be the set of all triangles in a plane. If A is the set of all triangles with at least one angle different from 60, what is A?
2.
3.
4. 5. 6.
SETS
21
7.
Fill in the blanks to make each of the following a true statement : (i) A A = . . . (ii) A = . . . (iii) A A = . . . (iv) U A = . . .
Fig 1.11
Let A and B be finite sets. If A B = , then (i) n ( A B ) = n ( A ) + n ( B ) ... (1) The elements in A B are either in A or in B but not in both as A B = . So, (1) follows immediately. In general, if A and B are finite sets, then (ii) n ( A B ) = n ( A ) + n ( B ) n ( A B ) ... (2) Note that the sets A B, A B and B A are disjoint and their union is A B (Fig 1.11). Therefore n ( A B) = n ( A B) + n ( A B ) + n ( B A ) = n ( A B) + n ( A B ) + n ( B A ) + n ( A B ) n ( A B) = n ( A ) + n ( B ) n ( A B), which verifies (2) (iii) If A, B and C are finite sets, then n ( A B C ) = n ( A ) + n ( B ) + n ( C ) n ( A B ) n ( B C) n (A C)+n (A B C) ... (3) In fact, we have n ( A B C ) = n (A) + n ( B C ) n [ A ( B C ) ] [ by (2) ] = n (A) + n ( B ) + n ( C ) n ( B C ) n [ A ( B C ) ] [ by (2) ] Since A ( B C ) = ( A B ) ( A C ), we get n [ A ( B C ) ] = n ( A B ) + n ( A C ) n [ ( A B ) (A C)] = n ( A B ) + n ( A C ) n (A B C) Therefore n ( A B C ) = n (A) + n ( B ) + n ( C ) n ( A B ) n ( B C) n(A C)+n (A B C) This proves (3). Example 23 If X and Y are two sets such that X Y has 50 elements, X has 28 elements and Y has 32 elements, how many elements does X Y have ?
22
MATHEMATICS
Solution Given that n ( X Y ) = 50, n ( X ) = 28, n ( Y ) = 32, n (X Y) = ? By using the formula n ( X Y ) = n ( X ) + n ( Y ) n ( X Y ), we find that n(XY) = n ( X ) + n(Y) n ( XY) Fig 1.12 = 28 + 32 50 = 10 Alternatively, suppose n ( X Y ) = k, then n ( X Y ) = 28 k , n ( Y X ) = 32 k (by Venn diagram in Fig 1.12 ) This gives 50 = n ( X Y ) = n (X Y) + n (X Y) + n ( Y X) = ( 28 k ) + k + (32 k ) Hence k = 10. Example 24 In a school there are 20 teachers who teach mathematics or physics. Of these, 12 teach mathematics and 4 teach both physics and mathematics. How many teach physics ? Solution Let M denote the set of teachers who teach mathematics and P denote the set of teachers who teach physics. In the statement of the problem, the word or gives us a clue of union and the word and gives us a clue of intersection. We, therefore, have n ( M P ) = 20 , n ( M ) = 12 and n ( M P ) = 4 We wish to determine n ( P ). Using the result n ( M P ) = n ( M ) + n ( P ) n ( M P ), we obtain 20 = 12 + n ( P ) 4 Thus n ( P ) = 12 Hence 12 teachers teach physics. Example 25 In a class of 35 students, 24 like to play cricket and 16 like to play football. Also, each student likes to play at least one of the two games. How many students like to play both cricket and football ? Solution Let X be the set of students who like to play cricket and Y be the set of students who like to play football. Then X Y is the set of students who like to play at least one game, and X Y is the set of students who like to play both games. Given n ( X) = 24, n ( Y ) = 16, n ( X Y ) = 35, n (X Y) = ? Using the formula n ( X Y ) = n ( X ) + n ( Y ) n ( X Y ), we get 35 = 24 + 16 n (X Y)
SETS
23
Thus, i.e.,
Example 26 In a survey of 400 students in a school, 100 were listed as taking apple juice, 150 as taking orange juice and 75 were listed as taking both apple as well as orange juice. Find how many students were taking neither apple juice nor orange juice. Solution Let U denote the set of surveyed students and A denote the set of students taking apple juice and B denote the set of students taking orange juice. Then n (U) = 400, n (A) = 100, n (B) = 150 and n (A B) = 75. n (A B) = n (A B ) = n (U) n (A B) = n (U) n (A) n (B) + n (A B) = 400 100 150 + 75 = 225 Hence 225 students were taking neither apple juice nor orange juice. Now Example 27 There are 200 individuals with a skin disorder, 120 had been exposed to the chemical C1, 50 to chemical C2, and 30 to both the chemicals C1 and C2. Find the number of individuals exposed to (i) Chemical C1 but not chemical C2 (ii) Chemical C2 but not chemical C1 (iii) Chemical C1 or chemical C2 Solution Let U denote the universal set consisting of individuals suffering from the skin disorder, A denote the set of individuals exposed to the chemical C1 and B denote the set of individuals exposed to the chemical C2. Here n ( U) = 200, n ( A ) = 120, n ( B ) = 50 and n ( A B ) = 30 (i) From the Venn diagram given in Fig 1.13, we have A = ( A B ) ( A B ). n (A) = n( A B ) + n( A B ) (Since A B) and A B are disjoint.) or n ( A B ) = n ( A ) n ( A B ) = 120 30 = 90 Hence, the number of individuals exposed to chemical C1 but not to chemical C2 is 90. (ii) From the Fig 1.13, we have B = ( B A) ( A B). and so, n (B) = n (B A) + n ( A B) (Since B A and A B are disjoint.) or n ( B A ) = n ( B ) n ( A B ) = 50 30 = 20
Fig 1.13
24
MATHEMATICS
Thus, the number of individuals exposed to chemical C2 and not to chemical C1 is 20. (iii) The number of individuals exposed either to chemical C1 or to chemical C2, i.e., n (AB ) = n (A) + n ( B ) n (A B ) = 120 + 50 30 = 140.
EXERCISE 1.6
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. If X and Y are two sets such that n ( X ) = 17, n ( Y ) = 23 and n ( X Y ) = 38, find n ( X Y ). If X and Y are two sets such that X Y has 18 elements, X has 8 elements and Y has 15 elements ; how many elements does X Y have? In a group of 400 people, 250 can speak Hindi and 200 can speak English. How many people can speak both Hindi and English? If S and T are two sets such that S has 21 elements, T has 32 elements, and S T has 11 elements, how many elements does S T have? If X and Y are two sets such that X has 40 elements, X Y has 60 elements and X Y has 10 elements, how many elements does Y have? In a group of 70 people, 37 like coffee, 52 like tea and each person likes at least one of the two drinks. How many people like both coffee and tea? In a group of 65 people, 40 like cricket, 10 like both cricket and tennis. How many like tennis only and not cricket? How many like tennis? In a committee, 50 people speak French, 20 speak Spanish and 10 speak both Spanish and French. How many speak at least one of these two languages?
Miscellaneous Examples
Example 28 Show that the set of letters needed to spell CATARACT and the set of letters needed to spell TRACT are equal. Solution Let X be the set of letters in CATARACT. Then X = { C, A, T, R } Let Y be the set of letters in TRACT. Then Y = { T, R, A, C, T } = { T, R, A, C } Since every element in X is in Y and every element in Y is in X. It follows that X = Y. Example 29 List all the subsets of the set { 1, 0, 1 }. Solution Let A = { 1, 0, 1 }. The subset of A having no element is the empty set . The subsets of A having one element are { 1 }, { 0 }, { 1 }. The subsets of A having two elements are {1, 0}, {1, 1} ,{0, 1}. The subset of A having three elements of A is A itself. So, all the subsets of A are , {1}, {0}, {1}, {1, 0}, {1, 1}, {0, 1} and {1, 0, 1}.
SETS
25
Example 30 Show that A B = A B implies A = B Solution Let a A. Then a A B. Since A B = A B , a A B. So a B. Therefore, A B. Similarly, if b B, then b A B. Since A B = A B, b A B. So, b A. Therefore, B A. Thus, A = B Example 31 For any sets A and B, show that P ( A B ) = P ( A ) P ( B ). Solution Let X P ( A B ). Then X A B. So, X A and X B. Therefore, X P ( A ) and X P ( B ) which implies X P ( A ) P ( B). This gives P ( A B ) P ( A ) P ( B ). Let Y P ( A ) P ( B ). Then Y P ( A) and Y P ( B ). So, Y A and Y B. Therefore, Y A B, which implies Y P ( A B ). This gives P ( A ) P ( B ) P ( A B) Hence P ( A B ) = P ( A ) P ( B ). Example 32 A market research group conducted a survey of 1000 consumers and reported that 720 consumers like product A and 450 consumers like product B, what is the least number that must have liked both products? Solution Let U be the set of consumers questioned, S be the set of consumers who liked the product A and T be the set of consumers who like the product B. Given that n ( U ) = 1000, n ( S ) = 720, n ( T ) = 450 So n(ST)=n(S)+n(T)n(ST) = 720 + 450 n (S T) = 1170 n ( S T ) Therefore, n ( S T ) is maximum when n ( S T ) is least. But S T U implies n ( S T ) n ( U ) = 1000. So, maximum values of n ( S T ) is 1000. Thus, the least value of n ( S T ) is 170. Hence, the least number of consumers who liked both products is 170. Example 33 Out of 500 car owners investigated, 400 owned car A and 200 owned car B, 50 owned both A and B cars. Is this data correct? Solution Let U be the set of car owners investigated, M be the set of persons who owned car A and S be the set of persons who owned car B. Given that n ( U ) = 500, n (M ) = 400, n ( S ) = 200 and n ( S M ) = 50. Then n ( S M ) = n ( S ) + n ( M ) n ( S M ) = 200 + 400 50 = 550 But S M U implies n ( S M ) n ( U ). This is a contradiction. So, the given data is incorrect. Example 34 A college warded 38 medals in football, 15 in basketball and 20 in cricket. If these medals went to a total of 58 men and only three men got medals in all the three sports, how many received medals in exactly two of the three sports ?
26
MATHEMATICS
Solution Let F, B and C denote the set of men who received medals in football, basketball and cricket, respectively. Then n ( F ) = 38, n ( B ) = 15, n ( C ) = 20 n (F B C ) = 58 and n (F B C ) = 3 Therefore, n (F B C ) = n ( F ) + n ( B ) + n ( C ) n (F B ) n (F C ) n (B C ) + Fig 1.14 n ( F B C ), gives n ( F B ) + n ( F C ) + n ( B C ) = 18 Consider the Venn diagram as given in Fig 1.14 Here, a denotes the number of men who got medals in football and basketball only, b denotes the number of men who got medals in football and cricket only, c denotes the number of men who got medals in basket ball and cricket only and d denotes the number of men who got medal in all the three. Thus, d = n ( F B C ) = 3 and a + d + b + d + c + d = 18 Therefore a + b + c = 9, which is the number of people who got medals in exactly two of the three sports.
2.
3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
SETS
27
8. 9. 10. 11.
12. 13.
14.
15.
16.
Show that for any sets A and B, A = ( A B ) ( A B ) and A ( B A ) = ( A B ) Using properties of sets, show that (i) A ( A B ) = A (ii) A ( A B ) = A. Show that A B = A C need not imply B = C. Let A and B be sets. If A X = B X = and A X = B X for some set X, show that A = B. (Hints A = A ( A X ) , B = B ( B X ) and use Distributive law ) Find sets A, B and C such that A B, B C and A C are non-empty sets and A B C = . In a survey of 600 students in a school, 150 students were found to be taking tea and 225 taking coffee, 100 were taking both tea and coffee. Find how many students were taking neither tea nor coffee? In a group of students, 100 students know Hindi, 50 know English and 25 know both. Each of the students knows either Hindi or English. How many students are there in the group? In a survey of 60 people, it was found that 25 people read newspaper H, 26 read newspaper T, 26 read newspaper I, 9 read both H and I, 11 read both H and T, 8 read both T and I, 3 read all three newspapers. Find: (i) the number of people who read at least one of the newspapers. (ii) the number of people who read exactly one newspaper. In a survey it was found that 21 people liked product A, 26 liked product B and 29 liked product C. If 14 people liked products A and B, 12 people liked products C and A, 14 people liked products B and C and 8 liked all the three products. Find how many liked product C only.
Summary
This chapter deals with some basic definitions and operations involving sets. These are summarised below: A set is a well-defined collection of objects. A set which does not contain any element is called empty set. A set which consists of a definite number of elements is called finite set, otherwise, the set is called infinite set. Two sets A and B are said to be equal if they have exactly the same elements. A set A is said to be subset of a set B, if every element of A is also an element of B. Intervals are subsets of R. A power set of a set A is collection of all subsets of A. It is denoted by P(A).
28
MATHEMATICS
The union of two sets A and B is the set of all those elements which are either in A or in B. The intersection of two sets A and B is the set of all elements which are common. The difference of two sets A and B in this order is the set of elements which belong to A but not to B. The complement of a subset A of universal set U is the set of all elements of U which are not the elements of A. For any two sets A and B, (A B) = A B and ( A B ) = A B If A and B are finite sets such that A B = , then n (A B) = n (A) + n (B). If A B , then n (A B) = n (A) + n (B) n (A B)
Historical Note
The modern theory of sets is considered to have been originated largely by the German mathematician Georg Cantor (1845-1918 A.D.). His papers on set theory appeared sometimes during 1874 A.D. to 1897 A.D. His study of set theory came when he was studying trigonometric series of the form a1 sin x + a2 sin 2x + a3 sin 3x + ... He published in a paper in 1874 A.D. that the set of real numbers could not be put into one-to-one correspondence wih the integers. From 1879 onwards, he publishd several papers showing various properties of abstract sets. Cantors work was well received by another famous mathematician Richard Dedekind (1831-1916 A.D.). But Kronecker (1810-1893 A.D.) castigated him for regarding infinite set the same way as finite sets. Another German mathematician Gottlob Frege, at the turn of the century, presented the set theory as principles of logic. Till then the entire set theory was based on the assumption of the existence of the set of all sets. It was the famous Englih Philosopher Bertand Russell (1872-1970 A.D.) who showed in 1902 A.D. that the assumption of existence of a set of all sets leads to a contradiction. This led to the famous Russells Paradox. Paul R.Halmos writes about it in his book Nave Set Theory that nothing contains everything. The Russells Paradox was not the only one which arose in set theory. Many paradoxes were produced later by several mathematicians and logicians.
SETS
29
As a consequence of all these paradoxes, the first axiomatisation of set theory was published in 1908 A.D. by Ernst Zermelo. Another one was proposed by Abraham Fraenkel in 1922 A.D. John Von Neumann in 1925 A.D. introduced explicitly the axiom of regularity. Later in 1937 A.D. Paul Bernays gave a set of more satisfactory axiomatisation. A modification of these axioms was done by Kurt Gdel in his monograph in 1940 A.D. This was known as Von NeumannBernays (VNB) or Gdel-Bernays (GB) set theory. Despite all these difficulties, Cantors set theory is used in present day mathematics. In fact, these days most of the concepts and results in mathematics are expressed in the set theoretic language.
Chapter
2.1 Introduction
Much of mathematics is about finding a pattern a recognisable link between quantities that change. In our daily life, we come across many patterns that characterise relations such as brother and sister, father and son, teacher and student. In mathematics also, we come across many relations such as number m is less than number n, line l is parallel to line m, set A is a subset of set B. In all these, we notice that a relation involves pairs of objects in certain order. In this Chapter, we will learn how to link pairs of objects from two sets and then introduce relations between the two objects in the pair. Finally, we will learn about G . W. Leibnitz (16461716) special relations which will qualify to be functions. The concept of function is very important in mathematics since it captures the idea of a mathematically precise correspondence between one quantity with the other.
Fig 2.1
31
brackets and grouped together in a particular order, i.e., (p,q), p P and q Q . This leads to the following definition: Definition 1 Given two non-empty sets P and Q. The cartesian product P Q is the set of all ordered pairs of elements from P and Q, i.e., P Q = { (p,q) : p P, q Q } If either P or Q is the null set, then P Q will also be empty set, i.e., P Q = From the illustration given above we note that A B = {(red,b), (red,c), (red,s), (blue,b), (blue,c), (blue,s)}. Again, consider the two sets: A = {DL, MP, KA}, where DL, MP, KA represent Delhi, Madhya Pradesh and Karnataka, respectively and B = {01,02, 03 03}representing codes for the licence plates of vehicles issued 02 by DL, MP and KA . 01 If the three states, Delhi, Madhya Pradesh and Karnataka were making codes for the licence plates of vehicles, with the DL MP KA restriction that the code begins with an element from set A, Fig 2.2 which are the pairs available from these sets and how many such pairs will there be (Fig 2.2)? The available pairs are:(DL,01), (DL,02), (DL,03), (MP,01), (MP,02), (MP,03), (KA,01), (KA,02), (KA,03) and the product of set A and set B is given by A B = {(DL,01), (DL,02), (DL,03), (MP,01), (MP,02), (MP,03), (KA,01), (KA,02), (KA,03)}. It can easily be seen that there will be 9 such pairs in the Cartesian product, since there are 3 elements in each of the sets A and B. This gives us 9 possible codes. Also note that the order in which these elements are paired is crucial. For example, the code (DL, 01) will not be the same as the code (01, DL). As a final illustration, consider the two sets A= {a1, a2} and B = {b1, b2, b3, b4} (Fig 2.3). A B = {( a1, b1), (a1, b2), (a1, b3), (a1, b4), (a2, b1), (a2, b2), (a2, b3), (a2, b4)}. The 8 ordered pairs thus formed can represent the position of points in the plane if A and B are subsets of the set of real numbers and it is obvious that the point in the position (a1, b2) will be distinct from the point in the position (b2, a1).
Fig 2.3
Remarks (i) Two ordered pairs are equal, if and only if the corresponding first elements are equal and the second elements are also equal.
32
MATHEMATICS
(ii) If there are p elements in A and q elements in B, then there will be pq elements in A B, i.e., if n(A) = p and n(B) = q, then n(A B) = pq. (iii) If A and B are non-empty sets and either A or B is an infinite set, then so is A B. (iv) A A A = {(a, b, c) : a, b, c A}. Here (a, b, c) is called an ordered triplet. Example 1 If (x + 1, y 2) = (3,1), find the values of x and y. Solution Since the ordered pairs are equal, the corresponding elements are equal. Therefore x + 1 = 3 and y 2 = 1. Solving we get x = 2 and y = 3. Example 2 If P = {a, b, c} and Q = {r}, form the sets P Q and Q P. Are these two products equal? Solution By the definition of the cartesian product, P Q = {(a, r), (b, r), (c, r)} and Q P = {(r, a), (r, b), (r, c)} Since, by the definition of equality of ordered pairs, the pair (a, r) is not equal to the pair (r, a), we conclude that P Q Q P. However, the number of elements in each set will be the same. Example 3 Let A = {1,2,3}, B = {3,4} and C = {4,5,6}. Find (ii) (A B) (A C) (i) A (B C) (iv) (A B) (A C) (iii) A (B C) Solution (i) By the definition of the intersection of two sets, (B C) = {4}. Therefore, A (B C) = {(1,4), (2,4), (3,4)}. Now (A B) = {(1,3), (1,4), (2,3), (2,4), (3,3), (3,4)} and (A C) = {(1,4), (1,5), (1,6), (2,4), (2,5), (2,6), (3,4), (3,5), (3,6)} Therefore, (A B) (A C) = {(1, 4), (2, 4), (3, 4)}. (iii) Since, (B C) = {3, 4, 5, 6}, we have A (B C) = {(1,3), (1,4), (1,5), (1,6), (2,3), (2,4), (2,5), (2,6), (3,3), (3,4), (3,5), (3,6)}. (ii)
(iv) Using the sets A B and A C from part (ii) above, we obtain (A B) (A C) = {(1,3), (1,4), (1,5), (1,6), (2,3), (2,4), (2,5), (2,6), (3,3), (3,4), (3,5), (3,6)}.
33
Example 4 If P = {1, 2}, form the set P P P. Solution We have, P P P = {(1,1,1), (1,1,2), (1,2,1), (1,2,2), (2,1,1), (2,1,2), (2,2,1), (2,2,2)}. Example 5 If R is the set of all real numbers, what do the cartesian products R R and R R R represent? Solution The Cartesian product R R represents the set R R={(x, y) : x, y R} which represents the coordinates of all the points in two dimensional space and the cartisian product R R R represents the set R R R ={(x, y, z) : x, y, z R} which represents the coordinates of all the points in three-dimensional space. Example 6 If A B ={(p, q),(p, r), (m, q), (m, r)}, find A and B. Solution A = set of first elements = {p, m} B = set of second elements = {q, r}.
EXERCISE 2.1
2 5 1 x 1. If + 1, y = , , find the values of x and y. 3 3 3 3 2. If the set A has 3 elements and the set B = {3, 4, 5}, then find the number of elements in (AB). 3. If G = {7, 8} and H = {5, 4, 2}, find G H and H G. 4. State whether each of the following statements are true or false. If the statement is false, rewrite the given statement correctly. (i) If P = {m, n} and Q = { n, m}, then P Q = {(m, n),(n, m)}. (ii) If A and B are non-empty sets, then A B is a non-empty set of ordered
pairs (x, y) such that x A and y B. (iii) If A = {1, 2}, B = {3, 4}, then A (B ) = . If A = {1, 1}, find A A A. If A B = {(a, x),(a , y), (b, x), (b, y)}. Find A and B. Let A = {1, 2}, B = {1, 2, 3, 4}, C = {5, 6} and D = {5, 6, 7, 8}. Verify that (i) A (B C) = (A B) (A C). (ii) A C is a subset of B D. Let A = {1, 2} and B = {3, 4}. Write A B. How many subsets will A B have? List them. Let A and B be two sets such that n(A) = 3 and n(B) = 2. If (x, 1), (y, 2), (z, 1) are in A B, find A and B, where x, y and z are distinct elements.
5. 6. 7. 8. 9.
34
MATHEMATICS
10. The Cartesian product A A has 9 elements among which are found (1, 0) and (0,1). Find the set A and the remaining elements of A A.
2.3 Relations
Consider the two sets P = {a, b, c} and Q = {Ali, Bhanu, Binoy, Chandra, Divya}. The cartesian product of P and Q has 15 ordered pairs which can be listed as P Q = {(a, Ali), (a,Bhanu), (a, Binoy), ..., (c, Divya)}. We can now obtain a subset of P Q by introducing a relation R between the first element x and the Fig 2.4 second element y of each ordered pair (x, y) as R= { (x,y): x is the first letter of the name y, x P, y Q}. Then R = {(a, Ali), (b, Bhanu), (b, Binoy), (c, Chandra)} A visual representation of this relation R (called an arrow diagram) is shown in Fig 2.4. Definition 2 A relation R from a non-empty set A to a non-empty set B is a subset of the cartesian product A B. The subset is derived by describing a relationship between the first element and the second element of the ordered pairs in A B. The second element is called the image of the first element. Definition 3 The set of all first elements of the ordered pairs in a relation R from a set A to a set B is called the domain of the relation R. Definition 4 The set of all second elements in a relation R from a set A to a set B is called the range of the relation R. The whole set B is called the codomain of the relation R. Note that range codomain. Remarks (i) A relation may be represented algebraically either by the Roster method or by the Set-builder method. (ii) An arrow diagram is a visual representation of a relation.
Example 7 Let A = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}. Define a relation R from A to A by R = {(x, y) : y = x + 1 } (i) Depict this relation using an arrow diagram. (ii) Write down the domain, codomain and range of R. Solution (i) By the definition of the relation, R = {(1,2), (2,3), (3,4), (4,5), (5,6)}.
35
The corresponding arrow diagram is shown in Fig 2.5. (ii) We can see that the domain ={1, 2, 3, 4, 5,} Similarly, the range = {2, 3, 4, 5, 6} and the codomain = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}.
Fig 2.5
Example 8 The Fig 2.6 shows a relation between the sets P and Q. Write this relation (i) in set-builder form, (ii) in roster form.
EXERCISE 2.2
1. Let A = {1, 2, 3,...,14}. Define a relation R from A to A by R = {(x, y) : 3x y = 0, where x, y A}. Write down its domain, codomain and range.
36
MATHEMATICS
2.
Define a relation R on the set N of natural numbers by R = {(x, y) : y = x + 5, x is a natural number less than 4; x, y N}. Depict this relationship using roster form. Write down the domain and the range.
3.
A = {1, 2, 3, 5} and B = {4, 6, 9}. Define a relation R from A to B by R = {(x, y): the difference between x and y is odd; x A, y B}. Write R in roster form. The Fig2.7 shows a relationship between the sets P and Q. Write this relation (i) in set-builder form (ii) roster form. What is its domain and range? Let A = {1, 2, 3, 4, 6}. Let R be the relation on A defined by {(a, b): a , b A, b is exactly divisible by a}. (i) Write R in roster form (ii) Find the domain of R (iii) Find the range of R. Determine the domain and range of the relation R defined by R = {(x, x + 5) : x {0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5}}. Write the relation R = {(x, x3) : x is a prime number less than 10} in roster form. Let A = {x, y, z} and B = {1, 2}. Find the number of relations from A to B. Let R be the relation on Z defined by R = {(a,b): a, b Z, a b is an integer}. Find the domain and range of R.
4.
5.
Fig 2.7
6. 7. 8. 9.
2.4 Functions In this Section, we study a special type of relation called function. It is one of the most important concepts in mathematics. We can, visualise a function as a rule, which produces new elements out of some given elements. There are many terms such as map or mapping used to denote a function. Definition 5 A relation f from a set A to a set B is said to be a function if every element of set A has one and only one image in set B. In other words, a function f is a relation from a non-empty set A to a non-empty set B such that the domain of f is A and no two distinct ordered pairs in f have the same first element. If f is a function from A to B and (a, b) f, then f (a) = b, where b is called the image of a under f and a is called the preimage of b under f.
37
The function f from A to B is denoted by f: A B. Looking at the previous examples, we can easily see that the relation in Example 7 is not a function because the element 6 has no image. Again, the relation in Example 8 is not a function because the elements in the domain are connected to more than one images. Similarly, the relation in Example 9 is also not a function. (Why?) In the examples given below, we will see many more relations some of which are functions and others are not. Example 10 Let N be the set of natural numbers and the relation R be defined on N such that R = {(x, y) : y = 2x, x, y N}. What is the domain, codomain and range of R? Is this relation a function? Solution The domain of R is the set of natural numbers N. The codomain is also N. The range is the set of even natural numbers. Since every natural number n has one and only one image, this relation is a function. Example 11 Examine each of the following relations given below and state in each case, giving reasons whether it is a function or not? (i) R = {(2,1),(3,1), (4,2)}, (ii) R = {(2,2),(2,4),(3,3), (4,4)} (iii) R = {(1,2),(2,3),(3,4), (4,5), (5,6), (6,7)} Solution (i) (ii) (iii) Since 2, 3, 4 are the elements of domain of R having their unique images, this relation R is a function. Since the same first element 2 corresponds to two different images 2 and 4, this relation is not a function. Since every element has one and only one image, this relation is a function.
Definition 6 A function which has either R or one of its subsets as its range is called a real valued function. Further, if its domain is also either R or a subset of R, it is called a real function. Example 12 Let N be the set of natural numbers. Define a real valued function f:N x N by f (x) = 2x + 1. Using this definition, complete the table given below. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
y f (1) = ... f (2) = ... f (3) = ... f (4) = ... f (5) = ... f (6) = ... f (7) = ... Solution The completed table is given by x 1 2 3 4 y f (1) = 3 f (2) = 5 f (3) = 7 5 6 7
38
MATHEMATICS
2.4.1 Some functions and their graphs (i) Identity function Let R be the set of real numbers. Define the real valued function f : R R by y = f(x) = x for each x R. Such a function is called the identity function. Here the domain and range of f are R. The graph is a straight line as shown in Fig 2.8. It passes through the origin.
Fig 2.8
(ii)
Constant function Define the function f: R R by y = f (x) = c, x R where c is a constant and each x R. Here domain of f is R and its range is {c}.
Fig 2.9
39
The graph is a line parallel to x-axis. For example, if f(x)=3 for each xR, then its graph will be a line as shown in the Fig 2.9. (iii) Polynomial function A function f : R R is said to be polynomial function if for each x in R, y = f (x) = a0 + a1x + a2x2 + ...+ an xn, where n is a non-negative integer and a0, a1, a2,...,anR.
2 x are some examples
2
of polynomial functions, whereas the function h defined by h(x) = x 3 + 2x is not a polynomial function.(Why?) Example 13 Define the function f: R R by y = f(x) = x2, x R. Complete the Table given below by using this definition. What is the domain and range of this function? Draw the graph of f. x y = f(x) = x2 Solution The completed Table is given below: x y = f (x) = x
2
4 16
3 9
2 4
1 1
0 0
1 1
2 4
3 9
4 16
Fig 2.10
40
MATHEMATICS
Example 14 Draw the graph of the function f :R R defined by f (x) = x3, xR. Solution We have f(0) = 0, f(1) = 1, f(1) = 1, f(2) = 8, f(2) = 8, f(3) = 27; f(3) = 27, etc. Therefore, f = {(x,x3): xR}. The graph of f is given in Fig 2.11.
Fig 2.11
1 , x x R {0}. Complete the Table given below using this definition. What is the domain and range of this function?
Example 15 Define the real valued function f : R {0} R defined by f (x) = x y = 2 1.5 ... 1 ... 0.5 ... 0.25 0.5 ... ... 1 ... 1.5 ... 2 ...
1 x
...
Solution The completed Table is given by x y= 2 1.5 1 0.5 0.25 4 0.5 2 1 1 1.5 0.67 2 0.5
1 x
0.5 0.67 1 2
41
The domain is all real numbers except 0 and its range is also all real numbers except 0. The graph of f is given in Fig 2.12.
(v) The Modulus function The function f: RR defined by f(x) = |x| for each x R is called modulus function. For each non-negative value of x, f(x) is equal to x. But for negative values of x, the value of f(x) is the negative of the value of x, i.e.,
x,x 0 f (x) = x,x < 0
The graph of the modulus function is given in Fig 2.13. (vi) Signum function The function f:RR defined by
Fig 2.13
42
MATHEMATICS
the set {1, 0, 1}. The graph of the signum function is given by the Fig 2.14.
Fig 2.14
(vii) Greatest integer function The function f: R R defined by f(x) = [x], x R assumes the value of the greatest integer, less than or equal to x. Such a function is called the greatest integer function. From the definition of [x], we can see that [x] = 1 for 1 x < 0 [x] = 0 for 0 x < 1 [x] = 1 for 1 x < 2 [x] = 2 for 2 x < 3 and so on. The graph of the function is shown in Fig 2.15.
Fig 2.15
2.4.2 Algebra of real functions In this Section, we shall learn how to add two real functions, subtract a real function from another, multiply a real function by a scalar (here by a scalar we mean a real number), multiply two real functions and divide one real function by another. (i) Addition of two real functions Let f : X R and g : X R be any two real functions, where X R. Then, we define (f + g): X R by (f + g) (x) = f (x) + g (x), for all x X.
43
(ii) Subtraction of a real function from another Let f : X R and g: X R be any two real functions, where X R. Then, we define (f g) : X R by (fg) (x) = f(x) g(x), for all x X. (iii) Multiplication by a scalar Let f : XR be a real valued function and be a scalar. Here by scalar, we mean a real number. Then the product f is a function from X to R defined by ( f ) (x) = f (x), x X. (iv) Multiplication of two real functions The product (or multiplication) of two real functions f:X R and g:X R is a function fg:X R defined by (fg) (x) = f(x) g(x), for all x X. This is also called pointwise multiplication. (v) Quotient of two real functions Let f and g be two real functions defined from XR where X R. The quotient of f by g denoted by
f f ( x) ( x) = , provided g(x) 0, x X g ( x) g
f g is a function defined by ,
f negative real numbers. Find (f + g) (x), (f g) (x), (fg) (x) and (x). g Solution We have
(f + g) (x) = (fg) x =
x + x, (f g) (x) =
x( x ) =
3 x2
x x,
1 f ( x) = x = x 2 , x 0 and g x
44
MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 2.3
1. Which of the following relations are functions? Give reasons. If it is a function, determine its domain and range. (i) {(2,1), (5,1), (8,1), (11,1), (14,1), (17,1)} (ii) {(2,1), (4,2), (6,3), (8,4), (10,5), (12,6), (14,7)} (iii) {(1,3), (1,5), (2,5)}. Find the domain and range of the following real functions: (i) f(x) = x 3. 4.
2.
(ii) f(x) =
9 x2 .
A function f is defined by f(x) = 2x 5. Write down the values of (i) f (0), (ii) f (7), (iii) f (3). The function t which maps temperature in degree Celsius into temperature in degree Fahrenheit is defined by t(C) =
(ii) t(28)
(iii)
Find the range of each of the following functions. (i) f (x) = 2 3x, x R, x > 0. (ii) f (x) = x2 + 2, x is a real number. (iii) f (x) = x, x is a real number.
Miscellaneous Examples
Example 18 Let R be the set of real numbers. Define the real function f: RR by f(x) = x + 10 and sketch the graph of this function. Solution Here f(0) = 10, f(1) = 11, f(2) = 12, ..., f(10) = 20, etc., and f(1) = 9, f(2) = 8, ..., f(10) = 0 and so on. Therefore, shape of the graph of the given function assumes the form as shown in Fig 2.16. Remark The function f defined by f(x) = mx + c , x R, is called linear function, where m and c are constants. Above function is an example of a linear function.
Fig 2.16
45
Example 19 Let R be a relation from Q to Q defined by R = {(a,b): a,b Q and a b Z}. Show that (i) (a,a) R for all a Q (ii) (a,b) R implies that (b, a) R (iii) (a,b) R and (b,c) R implies that (a,c) R Solution (i) Since, a a = 0 Z, if follows that (a, a) R. (ii) (a,b) R implies that a b Z. So, b a Z. Therefore, (b, a) R (iii) (a, b) and (b, c) R implies that a b Z. b c Z. So, a c = (a b) + (b c) Z. Therefore, (a,c) R
Example 20 Let f = {(1,1), (2,3), (0, 1), (1, 3)} be a linear function from Z into Z. Find f(x). Solution Since f is a linear function, f (x) = mx + c. Also, since (1, 1), (0, 1) R, f (1) = m + c = 1 and f (0) = c = 1. This gives m = 2 and f(x) = 2x 1. Example 21 Find the domain of the function f (x) =
2
x 2 + 3x + 5 x2 5x + 4
Solution Since x 5x + 4 = (x 4) (x 1), the function f (x) is defined for all real numbers except at x = 4 and x = 1. Hence the domain of f is R {1, 4}. Example 22 The function f is defined by
1 x, x < 0 1 , x=0 f (x) = x + 1, x > 0
Draw the graph of f (x). Solution Here, f(x) = 1 x, x < 0, this gives f( 4) = 1 ( 4) = 5; f( 3) =1 ( 3) = 4, f( 2) = 1 ( 2) = 3 f(1) = 1 (1) = 2; etc, and f(1) = 2, f (2) = 3, f (3) = 4 f(4) = 5 and so on for f(x) = x + 1, x > 0. Thus, the graph of f is as shown in Fig 2.17
Fig 2.17
46
MATHEMATICS
2. If f (x) = x , find
x2 + 2 x + 1 . x 2 8 x + 12
( x 1) .
4. Find the domain and the range of the real function f defined by f (x) =
5. Find the domain and the range of the real function f defined by f (x) = x 1 .
x2 f = x, : x R be a function from R into R. Determine the range 6. Let 2 1 + x of f. 7. Let f, g : RR be defined, respectively by f(x) = x + 1, g(x) = 2x 3. Find
f + g, f g and
f g.
8. Let f = {(1,1), (2,3), (0,1), (1, 3)} be a function from Z to Z defined by f(x) = ax + b, for some integers a, b. Determine a, b. 9. Let R be a relation from N to N defined by R = {(a, b) : a, b N and a = b }. Are the following true? (i) (a,a) R, for all a N (ii) (a,b) R, implies (b,a) R (iii) (a,b) R, (b,c) R implies (a,c) R. Justify your answer in each case. 10. Let A ={1,2,3,4}, B = {1,5,9,11,15,16} and f = {(1,5), (2,9), (3,1), (4,5), (2,11)} Are the following true? (i) f is a relation from A to B (ii) f is a function from A to B. Justify your answer in each case.
2
47
11. Let f be the subset of Z Z defined by f = {(ab, a + b) : a, b Z}. Is f a function from Z to Z? Justify your answer. 12. Let A = {9,10,11,12,13} and let f : AN be defined by f (n) = the highest prime factor of n. Find the range of f.
Summary
In this Chapter, we studied about relations and functions.The main features of this Chapter are as follows: Ordered pair A pair of elements grouped together in a particular order. Cartesian product A B of two sets A and B is given by A B = {(a, b): a A, b B} In particular R R = {(x, y): x, y R} and R R R = (x, y, z): x, y, z R} If (a, b) = (x, y), then a = x and b = y. If n(A) = p and n(B) = q, then n(A B) = pq. A= In general, A B B A. Relation A relation R from a set A to a set B is a subset of the cartesian product A B obtained by describing a relationship between the first element x and the second element y of the ordered pairs in A B. The image of an element x under a relation R is given by y, where (x, y) R, The domain of R is the set of all first elements of the ordered pairs in a relation R. The range of the relation R is the set of all second elements of the ordered pairs in a relation R. Function A function f from a set A to a set B is a specific type of relation for which every element x of set A has one and only one image y in set B. We write f: AB, where f(x) = y. A is the domain and B is the codomain of f. The range of the function is the set of images.
48
MATHEMATICS
A real function has the set of real numbers or one of its subsets both as its domain and as its range. Algebra of functions For functions f : X R and g : X R, we have (f + g) (x) = f(x) + g(x), x X. (f g) (x) = f (x) g(x), x X. (f.g) (x) (kf) (x) = f (x) .g (x), x X. = k f (x) ), x X.
f f ( x) ( x) = g ( x) , x X, g(x) 0. g
Historical Note
The word FUNCTION first appears in a Latin manuscript Methodus tangentium inversa, seu de fuctionibus written by Gottfried Wilhelm Leibnitz (1646-1716) in 1673; Leibnitz used the word in the non-analytical sense. He considered a function in terms of mathematical job the employee being just a curve. On July 5, 1698, Johan Bernoulli, in a letter to Leibnitz, for the first time deliberately assigned a specialised use of the term function in the analytical sense. At the end of that month, Leibnitz replied showing his approval. Function is found in English in 1779 in Chambers Cylopaedia: The term function is used in algebra, for an analytical expression any way compounded of a variable quantity, and of numbers, or constant quantities.
Chapter
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
A mathematician knows how to solve a problem, he can not solve it. MILNE
3.1 Introduction
The word trigonometry is derived from the Greek words trigon and metron and it means measuring the sides of a triangle. The subject was originally developed to solve geometric problems involving triangles. It was studied by sea captains for navigation, surveyor to map out the new lands, by engineers and others. Currently, trigonometry is used in many areas such as the science of seismology, designing electric circuits, describing the state of an atom, predicting the heights of tides in the ocean, analysing a musical tone and in many other areas. In earlier classes, we have studied the trigonometric Arya Bhatt ratios of acute angles as the ratio of the sides of a right (476-550 B.C.) angled triangle. We have also studied the trigonometric identities and application of trigonometric ratios in solving the problems related to heights and distances. In this Chapter, we will generalise the concept of trigonometric ratios to trigonometric functions and study their properties.
3.2 Angles
Angle is a measure of rotation of a given ray about its initial point. The original ray is Vertex
Fig 3.1
50
MATHEMATICS
called the initial side and the final position of the ray after rotation is called the terminal side of the angle. The point of rotation is called the vertex. If the direction of rotation is anticlockwise, the angle is said to be positive and if the direction of rotation is clockwise, then the angle is negative (Fig 3.1). The measure of an angle is the amount of rotation performed to get the terminal side from the initial side. There are several units for Fig 3.2 measuring angles. The definition of an angle suggests a unit, viz. one complete revolution from the position of the initial side as indicated in Fig 3.2. This is often convenient for large angles. For example, we can say that a rapidly spinning wheel is making an angle of say 15 revolution per second. We shall describe two other units of measurement of an angle which are most commonly used, viz. degree measure and radian measure.
1 3.2.1 Degree measure If a rotation from the initial side to terminal side is of 360 a revolution, the angle is said to have a measure of one degree, written as 1. A degree is divided into 60 minutes, and a minute is divided into 60 seconds . One sixtieth of a degree is called a minute, written as 1, and one sixtieth of a minute is called a second, written as 1. Thus, 1 = 60, 1 = 60 Some of the angles whose measures are 360,180, 270, 420, 30, 420 are shown in Fig 3.3.
th
Fig 3.3
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
51
3.2.2 Radian measure There is another unit for measurement of an angle, called
the radian measure. Angle subtended at the centre by an arc of length 1 unit in a unit circle (circle of radius 1 unit) is said to have a measure of 1 radian. In the Fig 3.4(i) to (iv), OA is the initial side and OB is the terminal side. The figures show the angles whose measures are 1 radian, 1 radian, 1
(i)
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)
Fig 3.4 (i) to (iv)
We know that the circumference of a circle of radius 1 unit is 2. Thus, one complete revolution of the initial side subtends an angle of 2 radian. More generally, in a circle of radius r, an arc of length r will subtend an angle of 1 radian. It is well-known that equal arcs of a circle subtend equal angle at the centre. Since in a circle of radius r, an arc of length r subtends an angle whose measure is 1 l radian, an arc of length l will subtend an angle whose measure is radian. Thus, if in r a circle of radius r, an arc of length l subtends an angle radian at the centre, we have =
l or l = r . r
52
MATHEMATICS
P 2 1 1 A 0 1 2 Q
Fig 3.5
3.2.4 Relation between degree and radian Since a circle subtends at the centre an angle whose radian measure is 2 and its degree measure is 360, it follows that
2 radian = 360 or radian = 180 The above relation enables us to express a radian measure in terms of degree measure and a degree measure in terms of radian measure. Using approximate value of as
22 , we have 7
1 radian =
180 = 57 16 approximately.
Also
1 =
The relation between degree measures and radian measure of some common angles are given in the following table: Degree Radian 30 45 60 90 180
270
360
2
3 2
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
53
Notational Convention
Since angles are measured either in degrees or in radians, we adopt the convention that whenever we write angle , we mean the angle whose degree measure is and whenever we write angle , we mean the angle whose radian measure is . Note that when an angle is expressed in radians, the word radian is frequently
= 45 are written with the understanding that and 4 4 are radian measures. Thus, we can say that
omitted. Thus, = 180 and Radian measure = Degree measure =
Example 1 Convert 40 20 into radian measure. Solution We know that 180 = radian. Hence Therefore 40 20 = 40
40 20 =
Example 2 Convert 6 radians into degree measure. Solution We know that radian = 180. Hence 6 radians =
= 343
= 343 + 38 + Hence
2 minute 11
Example 3 Find the radius of the circle in which a central angle of 60 intercepts an arc of length 37.4 cm (use =
22 ). 7
54
MATHEMATICS
60 radian = 180 3
Example 4 The minute hand of a watch is 1.5 cm long. How far does its tip move in 40 minutes? (Use = 3.14). Solution In 60 minutes, the minute hand of a watch completes one revolution. Therefore, in 40 minutes, the minute hand turns through or
Example 5 If the arcs of the same lengths in two circles subtend angles 65and 110 at the centre, find the ratio of their radii. Solution Let r1 and r2 be the radii of the two circles. Given that 1 = 65 = and
2 = 110 =
Let l be the length of each of the arc. Then l = r11 = r22, which gives
r1 22 13 22 r1 = r2 , i.e., r = 36 36 13 2
Hence r1 : r2 = 22 : 13.
EXERCISE 3.1
1. Find the radian measures corresponding to the following degree measures: (i) 25 (ii) 4730 (iii) 240 (iv) 520
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
55
2.
Find the degree measures corresponding to the following radian measurs (Use = (i)
22 ). 7
(ii) 4 (iii)
3. 4.
5 7 (iv) 3 6 A wheel makes 360 revolutions in one minute. Through how many radians does it turn in one second? Find the degree measure of the angle subtended at the centre of a circle of 22 ). 7 In a circle of diameter 40 cm, the length of a chord is 20 cm. Find the length of minor arc of the chord. If in two circles, arcs of the same length subtend angles 60 and 75 at the centre, find the ratio of their radii. Find the angle in radian through which a pendulum swings if its length is 75 cm and th e tip describes an arc of length (i) 10 cm (ii) 15 cm (iii) 21 cm
radius 100 cm by an arc of length 22 cm (Use =
11 16
5. 6. 7.
, 2
Fig 3.6
56
MATHEMATICS
3 . All angles which are integral multiples of are called 2 2 quadrantal angles. The coordinates of the points A, B, C and D are, respectively, (1, 0), (0, 1), (1, 0) and (0, 1). Therefore, for quadrantal angles, we have
cos 0 = 1 cos sin 0 = 0, sin
=0 2 cos = 1
=1 2 sin = 0
3 3 =0 sin = 1 2 2 cos 2 = 1 sin 2 = 0 Now, if we take one complete revolution from the point P, we again come back to same point P. Thus, we also observe that if x increases (or decreases) by any integral multiple of 2, the values of sine and cosine functions do not change. Thus, sin (2n + x) = sin x , n Z , cos (2n + x) = cos x , n Z Further, sin x = 0, if x = 0, , 2 , 3, ..., i.e., when x is an integral multiple of
cos and cos x = 0, if x = multiple of
. Thus 2
, sin x = 0 implies x = n, where n is any integer cos x = 0 implies x = (2n + 1) , where n is any integer. 2 We now define other trigonometric functions in terms of sine and cosine functions:
1 , x n, where n is any integer. sin x 1 , x (2n + 1) , where n is any integer. sec x = 2 cos x sin x , x (2n +1) , where n is any integer. tan x = 2 cos x cos x , x n , where n is any integer. cot x = sin x
cosec x =
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
57
We have shown that for all real x, sin2 x + cos2 x = 1 It follows that 1 + tan2 x = sec2 x 1 + cot2 x = cosec2 x (why?) (why?)
In earlier classes, we have discussed the values of trigonometric ratios for 0, 30, 45, 60 and 90. The values of trigonometric functions for these angles are same as that of trigonometric ratios studied in earlier classes. Thus, we have the following table: 0 sin cos tan 0 1 0
4
1 2 1 2
3
3 2
2
1 0 not defined
3 2
1 0 not defined
1 2
3 2 1 3
0 1 0
0 1 0
1 2
3
The values of cosec x, sec x and cot x are the reciprocal of the values of sin x, cos x and tan x, respectively. 3.3.1 Sign of trigonometric functions Let P (a, b) be a point on the unit circle with centre at the origin such that AOP = x. If AOQ = x, then the coordinates of the point Q will be (a, b) (Fig 3.7). Therefore cos ( x) = cos x and sin ( x) = sin x Since for every point P (a, b) on the unit circle, 1 a 1 and
Fig 3.7
58
MATHEMATICS
1 b 1, we have 1 cos x 1 and 1 sin x 1 for all x. We have learnt in previous classes that in the first quadrant (0 < x < second quadrant ( ( < x <
3 3 ) a and b are both negative and in the fourth quadrant ( < x < 2) a is 2 2 positive and b is negative. Therefore, sin x is positive for 0 < x < , and negative for
< x < 2. Similarly, cos x is positive for 0 < x < positive for
functions in different quadrants. In fact, we have the following table. I sin x cos x tan x cosec x sec x cot x + + + + + + II + + III + + IV + +
3.3.2 Domain and range of trigonometric functions From the definition of sine
and cosine functions, we observe that they are defined for all real numbers. Further, we observe that for each real number x, 1 sin x 1 and 1 cos x 1 Thus, domain of y = sin x and y = cos x is the set of all real numbers and range is the interval [1, 1], i.e., 1 y 1.
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
59
1 sin x , the domain of y = cosec x is the set { x : x R and x n , n Z} and range is the set {y : y R, y 1 or y 1}. Similarly, the domain
Since cosec x =
, n Z} and range is the set 2 {y : y R, y 1or y 1}. The domain of y = tan x is the set {x : x R and
of y = sec x is the set {x : x R and x (2n + 1)
, n Z} and range is the set of all real numbers. The domain of 2 y = cot x is the set {x : x R and x n , n Z} and the range is the set of all real numbers.
x (2n + 1) We further observe that in the first quadrant, as x increases from 0 to increases from 0 to 1, as x increases from third quadrant, as x increases from to
3 , sin x decreases from 0 to 1and finally, in 2 3 to 2. the fourth quadrant, sin x increases from 1 to 0 as x increases from 2
I quadrant sin cos tan cot sec increases from 0 to 1 II quadrant decreases from 1 to 0 III quadrant IV quadrant
, sin x 2
decreases from 1 to 0 decreases from 0 to 1 increases from 1 to 0 increases from 0 to 1 increases from 0 to increases from to 0 increases from 0 to increases from to 0
decreases from to 0 decreases from 0 to decreases from to 0 decreases from 0to increases from 1 to increases from to1 decreases from 1to decreases from to 1 increases from to1 decreases from1to
Similarly, we can discuss the behaviour of other trigonometric functions. In fact, we have the following table: Remark In the above table, the statement tan x increases from 0 to (infinity) for 0<x<
simply means that tan x increases as x increases for 0 < x < and 2 2
60
MATHEMATICS
. Similarly, to say that 2 cosec x decreases from 1 to (minus infinity) in the fourth quadrant means that
assumes arbitraily large positive values as x approaches to cosec x decreases for x ( of functions and variables. We have already seen that values of sin x and cos x repeats after an interval of 2. Hence, values of cosec x and sec x will also repeat after an interval of 2. We
3 , 2) and assumes arbitrarily large negative values as 2 x approaches to 2. The symbols and simply specify certain types of behaviour
Fig 3.8
Fig 3.9
Fig 3.10
Fig 3.11
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
61
Fig 3.12
Fig 3.13
shall see in the next section that tan ( + x) = tan x. Hence, values of tan x will repeat after an interval of . Since cot x is reciprocal of tan x, its values will also repeat after an interval of . Using this knowledge and behaviour of trigonometic functions, we can sketch the graph of these functions. The graph of these functions are given above: Example 6 If cos x = 3 , x lies in the third quadrant, find the values of other five 5 trigonometric functions. Solution Since cos x = Now or Hence
16 9 = 25 25
4 5 5 4
62
MATHEMATICS
Since cot x =
13 5 13 , 5 5 13 12 5 12 ) ( )= 5 13 13
Since x lies in second quadrant, sec x will be negative. Therefore sec x = which also gives
cos x =
Further, we have
1 13 = . sin x 12
31 . 3
Solution We know that values of sin x repeats after an interval of 2. Therefore sin
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
63
Example 9 Find the value of cos (1710). Solution We know that values of cos x repeats after an interval of 2 or 360. Therefore, cos (1710) = cos (1710 + 5 360) = cos (1710 + 1800) = cos 90 = 0.
EXERCISE 3.2
Find the values of other five trigonometric functions in Exercises 1 to 5. 1. cos x = 2. sin x = 3. cot x = 4. sec x =
19 3 15 ) 4
11 ) 3
10. cot (
64
MATHEMATICS
3.
Consider the unit circle with centre at the origin. Let x be the angle P4OP1and y be the angle P1OP2. Then (x + y) is the angle P4OP2. Also let ( y) be the angle P4OP3. Therefore, P 1 , P 2 , P 3 and P 4 will have the coordinates P 1 (cos x, sin x), P2 [cos (x + y), sin (x + y)], P3 [cos ( y), sin ( y)] and P4 (1, 0) (Fig 3.14).
Fig 3.14
Consider the triangles P1OP3 and P2OP4. They are congruent (Why?). Therefore, P1P3 and P2P4 are equal. By using distance formula, we get P 1 P 3 2 = [cos x cos ( y)]2 + [sin x sin(y]2 = (cos x cos y)2 + (sin x + sin y)2 = cos2 + cos2 y 2 cos x cos y + sin2 x + sin2 y + 2sin x sin y = 2 2 (cos x cos y sin x sin y) (Why?) Also, P 2 P 4 2 = [1 cos (x + y)] 2 + [0 sin (x + y)]2 = 1 2cos (x + y) + cos2 (x + y) + sin2 (x + y) = 2 2 cos (x + y)
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
65
Since P 1 P 3 = P2P4, we have P1P32 = P2P42. Therefore, 2 2 (cos x cos y sin x sin y) = 2 2 cos (x + y). Hence cos (x + y) = cos x cos y sin x sin y 4. cos (x y) = cos x cos y + sin x sin y Replacing y by y in identity 3, we get cos (x + ( y)) = cos x cos ( y) sin x sin ( y) or cos (x y) = cos x cos y + sin x sin y 5. cos (
x ) = sin x 2
and y by x in Identity (4), we get 2
sin (
( x) y 2
x ) cos y + sin ( x) sin y 2 2 = sin x cos y + cos x sin y 8. sin (x y) = sin x cos y cos x sin y If we replace y by y, in the Identity 7, we get the result. 9. By taking suitable values of x and y in the identities 3, 4, 7 and 8, we get the following results: cos ( + x ) = sin x 2 cos ( x) = cos x sin ( + x ) = cos x 2 sin ( x) = sin x
66
MATHEMATICS
Similar results for tan x, cot x, sec x and cosec x can be obtianed from the results of sin x and cos x. 10. If none of the angles x, y and (x + y) is an odd multiple of tan (x + y) =
, then 2
Since none of the x, y and (x + y) is an odd multiple of cos y and cos (x + y) are non-zero. Now tan (x + y) =
sin( x + y ) sin x cos y + cos x sin y = . cos( x + y ) cos x cos y sin x sin y
sin x cos y cos x sin y + cos x cos y cos x cos y tan (x + y) = cos x cos y sin x sin y cos x cos y cos x cos y
tan x + tan y = 1 tan x tan y
11. tan ( x y) =
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
67
Since, none of the x, y and (x + y) is multiple of , we find that sin x sin y and sin (x + y) are non-zero. Now, cot ( x + y) =
cos ( x + y ) cos x cos y sin x sin y = sin ( x + y ) sin x cos y + cos x sin y
Dividing numerator and denominator by sin x sin y, we have cot (x + y) = 13. cot (x y) =
We know that cos (x + y) = cos x cos y sin x sin y Replacing y by x, we get cos 2x = cos2x sin2 x = 2 cos2 x 1 = cos2 x (1 cos2 x) = 2 cos2x 1 Again, cos 2x = cos2 x sin2 x = 1 sin2 x sin2 x = 1 2 sin2 x. We have
cos2 x sin 2 x cos 2x = cos x sin x = cos2 x + sin 2 x
2 2
2tan x 1 + tan 2 x
sin (x + y) = sin x cos y + cos x sin y Replacing y by x, we get sin 2x = 2 sin x cos x. Again sin 2x =
68
MATHEMATICS
Dividing each term by cos2 x, we get sin 2x = 16. tan 2x = We know that
2tan x 1 +tan 2 x
2tan x 1 tan 2 x
2 tan x 1 tan 2 x
17. sin 3x = 3 sin x 4 sin3 x We have, sin 3x = sin (2x + x) = sin 2x cos x + cos 2x sin x = 2 sin x cos x cos x + (1 2sin2 x) sin x = 2 sin x (1 sin2 x) + sin x 2 sin3 x = 2 sin x 2 sin3 x + sin x 2 sin3 x = 3 sin x 4 sin3 x 18. cos 3x = 4 cos3 x 3 cos x We have, cos 3x = cos (2x +x) = cos 2x cos x sin 2x sin x = (2cos2 x 1) cos x 2sin x cos x sin x = (2cos2 x 1) cos x 2cos x (1 cos2 x) = 2cos3 x cos x 2cos x + 2 cos3 x = 4cos3 x 3cos x. 19. tan 3 x =
3 tan x tan 3 x 1 3tan 2 x
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
69
20.
x+ y x y cos 2 2 x+ y x y sin 2 2
(ii) cos x cos y = 2sin (iii) sin x + sin y = 2sin (iv) sin x sin y = 2cos
x+ y x y cos 2 2 x+ y x y sin 2 2
... (1) ... (2) ... ... ... ... (3) (4) (5) (6)
We know that cos (x + y) = cos x cos y sin x sin y and cos (x y) = cos x cos y + sin x sin y Adding and subtracting (1) and (2), we get cos (x + y) + cos(x y) = 2 cos x cos y and cos (x + y) cos (x y) = 2 sin x sin y Further sin (x + y) = sin x cos y + cos x sin y and sin (x y) = sin x cos y cos x sin y Adding and subtracting (5) and (6), we get sin (x + y) + sin (x y) = 2 sin x cos y sin (x + y) sin (x y) = 2cos x sin y Let x + y = and x y = . Therefore
+ x = and y = 2 2 Substituting the values of x and y in (3), (4), (7) and (8), we get
70
MATHEMATICS
+ sin sin = 2 cos sin 2 2 Since and can take any real values, we can replace by x and by y. Thus, we get
cos x + cos y = 2 cos sin x + sin y = 2 sin
Remarks As a part of identities given in 20, we can prove the following results: 21. (i) 2 cos x cos y = cos (x + y) + cos (x y) (ii) 2 sin x sin y = cos (x + y) cos (x y) (iii) 2 sin x cos y = sin (x + y) + sin (x y) (iv) 2 cos x sin y = sin (x + y) sin (x y). Example 10 Prove that
5 3sin sec 4sin cot =1 6 3 6 4 Solution We have 5 L.H.S. = 3sin sec 4sin cot 6 3 6 4
=3
1 2 4 sin 2
1 = 3 4 sin 6 6
1 3 1 1 3 1 = . 2 2 2 2 2 2
13 . 12
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
71
13 = tan 12
= tan + = tan 12 12 4 6
1 3 = 3 1 = 2 3 1 3 +1 3
sin (x + y ) sin x cos y + cos x sin y = sin (x y) sin x cos y cos x sin y
tan 3x =
or tan 3x tan 3x tan 2x tan x = tan 2x + tan x or tan 3x tan 2x tan x = tan 3x tan 2x tan x or tan 3x tan 2x tan x = tan 3x tan 2x tan x. Example 15 Prove that
72
MATHEMATICS
L.H.S.
sin 5 x + sin x 2sin 3x sin 5 x 2sin 3 x + sin x = cos5 x cos x cos5 x cos x 2sin 3 x cos 2 x 2sin 3 x sin 3 x (cos 2 x 1) = 2sin 3x sin 2x sin 3x sin 2x
1 cos 2 x 2sin 2 x = = tan x = R.H.S. sin 2 x 2sin x cos x
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
73
EXERCISE 3.3
Prove that: 1. sin2
2 3. cot
1 + cos2 tan2 = 6 3 4 2
2. 2sin2
7 3 cos 2 = + cosec2 6 3 2 6
5 2 3 + cosec + 3tan 2 = 6 + 2cos 2 + 2sec 2 = 10 4. 2sin 6 6 6 4 4 3 5. Find the value of: (i) sin 75 (ii) tan 15
6. Prove the following:
7.
8.
3 3 9. cos + x cos (2 + x) cot x + cot (2 + x) = 1 2 2 10. sin (n + 1)x sin (n + 2)x + cos (n + 1)x cos (n + 2)x = cos x
11.
14. sin2 x + 2 sin 4x + sin 6x = 4 cos2 x sin 4x 15. cot 4x (sin 5x + sin 3x) = cot x (sin 5x sin 3x) 16. 18. 20.
cos 9 x cos 5 x sin 17 x sin 3 x = sin 2 x cos 10 x sin 5x + sin 3 x cos 5x + cos 3 x sin x + sin 3 x cos x + cos 3 x
= tan 4 x = tan 2 x
= tan
x y 2
= 2 sin x
= cot 3x
74
MATHEMATICS
24.
2 and . 3 3 1 3
.
Example 19 Find the principal solutions of the equation tan x = Solution We know that, tan and Thus
= 6
1 tan 2 = tan = 6 6 3
tan
5 11 1 = tan = . 6 6 3
5 11 and . 6 6 We will now find the general solutions of trigonometric equations. We have already
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
75
x+ y 2
sin
x y 2
=0
= 0 or sin
x y 2
=0
= n, where n Z 2 2 2 i.e. x = (2n + 1) y or x = 2n + y, where nZ Hence x = (2n + 1) + (1)2n + 1 y or x = 2n +(1)2n y, where n Z. Combining these two results, we get x = n + (1)n y, where n Z. = (2n + 1) or Theorem 2 For any real numbers x and y, cos x = cos y, implies x = 2n y, where n Z Proof If cos x = cos y, then cos x cos y = 0 i.e., Thus Therefore i.e. Hence sin
x+ y 2
x+ y 2 x y 2
x+ y
x y
2 sin sin
sin
=0
=0
or
x y
x y 2
=0
x+ y 2
Theorem 3 Prove that if x and y are not odd mulitple of tan x = tan y implies x = n + y, where n Z
, then 2
76
MATHEMATICS
Proof or
sin (x y) = 0
(Why?)
x y = n, i.e., x = n + y, where n Z
3 2
= sin
4 = sin + = sin 3 3 3
x = n + ( 1) n
Note
4 3 is one such value of x for which sin x = . One may take any 3 2
3
. The solutions obtained will be the same 2 although these may apparently look different. .
1 = cos 2 3
x = 2n
, where n Z. 3
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
77
or Therefore or
5 tan2 x = tan x + 6
2 x = n + x + x = n +
5 , where nZ 6
1 2 3
, where nZ 3
n or x = n , where nZ. 4 6
Example 24 Solve 2 cos2 x + 3 sin x = 0 Solution The equation can be written as or or Hence But Therefore
2
2 ( 1 sin 2 x ) + 3 sin x = 0
2 sin x 3 sin x 2 = 0
(2sinx + 1) (sinx 2) = 0
sin x =
sin x =
78
MATHEMATICS
x = n + ( 1) n
7 , where n Z. 6
EXERCISE 3.4
Find the principal and general solutions of the following equations: 1.
tan x = 3
2. sec x = 2
3. cot x = 3 4. cosec x = 2 Find the general solution for each of the following equations: 5. cos 4 x = cos 2 x 6. cos 3x + cos x cos 2x = 0 7. sin 2x + cos x = 0 8. sec2 2x = 1 tan 2x 9. sin x + sin 3x + sin 5x = 0
Miscellaneous Examples
Example 25 If sin x =
3 5 find the value of sin (x + y).
, cos y =
12 13
Solution We know that sin (x + y) = sin x cos y + cos x sin y Now Therefore cos2 x = 1 sin2 x = 1
9 25
... (1)
16 25
cos x =
4 5
144 169 = 25 169
.
5 13
Since y lies in second quadrant, hence sin y is positive. Therefore, sin y = the values of sin x, sin y, cos x and cos y in (1), we get
. Substituting
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
79
sin( x + y ) =
3 12 4 5 + 5 13 5 13
36 20 56 = . 65 65 65
Example 26
Prove that
Solution
L.H.S. =
= =
5 x 15 x 5 x 15 x + 2 2 2 1 2sin 2 sin = 2 2 2
5x 5x = sin 5x sin = sin 5x sin = R.H.S. 2 2
. 8
. Then 2 x = . 8 4
2 tan x 1 tan 2 x
tan 2 x =
or
Let y = tan
80
MATHEMATICS
or Therefore Since
y2 + 2y 1 = 0 y=
2 2 2 2 = 1 2
tan
= 2 1 . 8
x x x 3 3 Example 28 If tan x = , < x < , find the value of sin , cos and tan . 4 2 2 2 2
Solution Since < x < Also Therefore, sin Now Therefore Now Therefore or Again Therefore
x 2
3 , cos x is negative. 2
x 3 < < . 2 2 4
is positive and cos
x 2
is negative.
9 16 = 25 16
or cos x =
4 5
(Why?)
2 sin 2
sin2 sin
x 2 x 2
x 4 9 = 1 cos x = 1 + = . 5 5 2
=
9 10
=
x 2
3 10
(Why?)
4 5 = 1 5
2cos2 cos2
= 1+ cos x = 1 =
1 10
x 2
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
81
or
cos
x 2 x 2
=
sin
1 10 x
2 = x 2
(Why?)
10 = 3. 10 1 3
Hence
tan
=
cos
Example 29 Solution
We have
L.H.S. = 1 + cos 2 x + 2 = =
2 2 1 + cos 2 x + 1 + cos 2 x 3 3 . + 2 2
= = =
2 cos
82
MATHEMATICS
3. (cos x + cos y)2 + (sin x sin y)2 = 4 cos2 4. (cos x cos y)2 + (sin x sin y)2 = 4 sin2
x+ y 2
6.
cos
3x 2
, cos
x 2
and tan
x 2
4 8. tan x = , x in quadrant II 3
10. sin x =
1 , x in quadrant II 4
Summary
If in a circle of radius r, an arc of length l subtends and angle of radians, then l=r Radian measure = Degree measure = cos2 x + sin2 x = 1 1 + tan2 x = sec2 x 1 + cot2 x = cosec2 x cos (2n + x) = cos x sin (2n + x) = sin x sin ( x) = sin x cos ( x) = cos x
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
83
cos (x + y) = cos x cos y sin x sin y cos (x y) = cos x cos y + sin x sin y cos ( sin (
x ) = sin x 2
x ) = cos x 2
sin (x + y) = sin x cos y + cos x sin y sin (x y) = sin x cos y cos x sin y
, then 2
1 tan 2 x 1 + tan 2 x
84
MATHEMATICS
2 tan x 1 + tan 2 x
tan 2x =
(i) cos x + cos y = 2cos (ii) cos x cos y = 2sin (iii) sin x + sin y = 2 sin (iv) sin x sin y = 2cos
x+ y x y cos 2 2
x+ y x y sin 2 2
x+ y x y cos 2 2
(ii) 2sin x sin y = cos (x + y) cos (x y) (iii) 2sin x cos y = sin (x + y) + sin (x y) (iv) 2 cos x sin y = sin (x + y) sin (x y). sin x = 0 gives x = n, where n Z. cos x = 0 gives x = (2n + 1)
, where n Z. 2
sin x = sin y implies x = n + ( 1)n y, where n Z. cos x = cos y, implies x = 2n y, where n Z. tan x = tan y implies x = n + y, where n Z.
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
85
Historical Note
The study of trigonometry was first started in India. The ancient Indian Mathematicians, Aryabhatta (476A.D.), Brahmagupta (598 A.D.), Bhaskara I (600 A.D.) and Bhaskara II (1114 A.D.) got important results. All this knowledge first went from India to middle-east and from there to Europe. The Greeks had also started the study of trigonometry but their approach was so clumsy that when the Indian approach became known, it was immediately adopted throughout the world. In India, the predecessor of the modern trigonometric functions, known as the sine of an angle, and the introduction of the sine function represents the main contribution of the siddhantas (Sanskrit astronomical works) to the history of mathematics. Bhaskara I (about 600 A.D.) gave formulae to find the values of sine functions for angles more than 90. A sixteenth century Malayalam work Yuktibhasa (period) contains a proof for the expansion of sin (A + B). Exact expressin for sines or cosines of 18, 36, 54, 72, etc., are given by Bhaskara II. The symbols sin1 x, cos1 x, etc., for arc sin x, arc cos x, etc., were suggested by the astronomer Sir John F.W. Hersehel (1813 A.D.) The names of Thales (about 600 B.C.) is invariably associated with height and distance problems. He is credited with the determination of the height of a great pyramid in Egypt by measuring shadows of the pyramid and an auxiliary staff (or gnomon) of known height, and comparing the ratios:
Chapter
4.1 Introduction
One key basis for mathematical thinking is deductive reasoning. An informal, and example of deductive reasoning, borrowed from the study of logic, is an argument expressed in three statements: (a) Socrates is a man. (b) All men are mortal, therefore, (c) Socrates is mortal. If statements (a) and (b) are true, then the truth of (c) is established. To make this simple mathematical example, we could write: (i) Eight is divisible by two. G . Peano (ii) Any number divisible by two is an even number, (1858-1932) therefore, (iii) Eight is an even number. Thus, deduction in a nutshell is given a statement to be proven, often called a conjecture or a theorem in mathematics, valid deductive steps are derived and a proof may or may not be established, i.e., deduction is the application of a general case to a particular case. In contrast to deduction, inductive reasoning depends on working with each case, and developing a conjecture by observing incidences till we have observed each and every case. It is frequently used in mathematics and is a key aspect of scientific reasoning, where collecting and analysing data is the norm. Thus, in simple language, we can say the word induction means the generalisation from particular cases or facts.
87
In algebra or in other discipline of mathematics, there are certain results or statements that are formulated in terms of n, where n is a positive integer. To prove such statements the well-suited principle that is usedbased on the specific technique, is known as the principle of mathematical induction.
4.2 Motivation
In mathematics, we use a form of complete induction called mathematical induction. To understand the basic principles of mathematical induction, suppose a set of thin rectangular tiles are placed on one end, as shown in Fig 4.1.
Fig 4.1
When the first tile is pushed in the indicated direction, all the tiles will fall. To be absolutely sure that all the tiles will fall, it is sufficient to know that (a) The first tile falls, and (b) In the event that any tile falls its successor necessarily falls. This is the underlying principle of mathematical induction. We know, the set of natural numbers N is a special ordered subset of the real numbers. In fact, N is the smallest subset of R with the following property: A set S is said to be an inductive set if 1 S and x + 1 S whenever x S. Since N is the smallest subset of R which is an inductive set, it follows that any subset of R that is an inductive set must contain N. Illustration Suppose we wish to find the formula for the sum of positive integers 1, 2, 3,...,n, that is, a formula which will give the value of 1 + 2 + 3 when n = 3, the value 1 + 2 + 3 + 4, when n = 4 and so on and suppose that in some manner we are led to believe that the formula 1 + 2 + 3+...+ n =
How can this formula actually be proved? We can, of course, verify the statement for as many positive integral values of n as we like, but this process will not prove the formula for all values of n. What is needed is some kind of chain reaction which will
88
MATHEMATICS
have the effect that once the formula is proved for a particular positive integer the formula will automatically follow for the next positive integer and the next indefinitely. Such a reaction may be considered as produced by the method of mathematical induction.
89
positive integer k and we need to prove that P (k + 1) is true. Since P (k) is true, we have 1 + 3 + 5 + 7 + ... + (2k 1) = k2 ... (1) Consider 1 + 3 + 5 + 7 + ... + (2k 1) + {2(k +1) 1} ... (2) = k2 + (2k + 1) = (k + 1)2 [Using (1)] Therefore, P (k + 1) is true and the inductive proof is now completed. Hence P(n) is true for all natural numbers n. Example 1 For all n 1, prove that 12 + 22 + 32 + 42 ++ n2 =
n (n + 1)(2 n + 1) . 6
n(n + 1)(2n + 1) 6
Solution Let the given statement be P(n), i.e., P(n) : 12 + 22 + 32 + 42 ++ n2 = For n = 1, P(1): 1 =
1(1 + 1) (2 1 + 1) 1 2 3 =1 which is true. = 6 6 Assume that P(k) is true for some positive integers k, i.e.,
k (k + 1)(2k + 1) 6 We shall now prove that P(k + 1) is also true. Now, we have (12 +22 +32 +42 ++k2 ) + (k + 1) 2
12 + 22 + 32 + 42 ++ k2 = =
... (1)
k (k + 1)(2k + 1) + ( k + 1)2 6
k (k + 1) (2k + 1) + 6(k + 1)2 6
[Using (1)]
(k + 1) (2k 2 + 7 k + 6) = 6
(k + 1)( k + 1 + 1){2( k + 1) + 1} 6 Thus P(k + 1) is true, whenever P (k) is true. Hence, from the principle of mathematical induction, the statement P(n) is true for all natural numbers N.
=
90
MATHEMATICS
Example 2 Prove that 2n > n for all positive integers n. Solution Let P(n): 2n > n When n =1, 21 >1. Hence P(1) is true. Assume that P(k) is true for any positive integers k, i.e., 2k > k We shall now prove that P(k +1) is true whenever P(k) is true. Multiplying both sides of (1) by 2, we get 2. 2k > 2k i.e., 2
k+1
... (1)
> 2k = k + k > k + 1
Therefore, P(k + 1) is true when P(k) is true. Hence, by principle of mathematical induction, P(n) is true for every positive integer n. Example 3 For all n 1, prove that
1 1 1 1 n + + + ... + = 1.2 2.3 3.4 n( n + 1) n + 1 1 1 1 = = , which is true. Thus, P(n) is true for n = 1. 1.2 2 1 +1
... (1)
k 1 + k + 1 (k + 1)( k + 2)
[Using (1)]
91
(k 2 + 2 k + 1) k +1 k +1 k (k + 2) + 1 ( k + 1)2 = = = = = (k + 1) ( k + 2) (k + 1)(k + 2) ( k + 1) ( k + 2 ) k + 2 ( k + 1) + 1
Thus P(k + 1) is true whenever P(k) is true. Hence, by the principle of mathematical induction, P(n) is true for all natural numbers. Example 4 For every positive integer n, prove that 7n 3n is divisible by 4. Solution We can write P(n) : 7n 3n is divisible by 4. We note that P(1): 71 31 = 4 which is divisile by 4. Thus P(n) is true for n = 1 Let P(k) be true for some natural number k, i.e., P(k) : 7k 3k is divisible by 4. We can write 7k 3k = 4d, where d N. Now, we wish to prove that P(k + 1) is true whenever P(k) is true. Now 7(k + 1) 3(k + 1) = 7(k + 1) 7.3k + 7.3k 3(k + 1) = 7(7k 3k) + (7 3)3k = 7(4d) + (7 3)3k = 7(4d) + 4.3k = 4(7d + 3k) From the last line, we see that 7(k + 1) 3(k + 1) is divisible by 4. Thus, P(k + 1) is true when P(k) is true. Therefore, by princlple of mathematical induction the statement is true for every positive integer n. Example 5 Prove that (1 + x)n (1 + nx), for all natural number n, where x > 1. Solution Let P(n) be the given statement, i.e., P(n): (1 + x)n (1 + nx), for x > 1. We note that P(n) is true when n = 1, since ( 1+x) (1 + x) for x > 1 Assume that P(k): (1 + x)k (1 + kx), x > 1 is true. We want to prove that P(k + 1) is true for x > 1 whenever P(k) is true. Consider the identity (1 + x)k + 1 = (1 + x)k (1 + x) Given that x > 1, so (1+x) > 0. Therefore , by using (1 + x)k (1 + kx), we have (1 + x) k + 1 (1 + kx)(1 + x) i.e. (1 + x)k + 1 (1 + x + kx + kx2).
... (3)
92
MATHEMATICS
Here k is a natural number and x2 0 so that kx2 0. Therefore (1 + x + kx + kx2) (1 + x + kx), and so we obtain (1 + x)k + 1 (1 + x + kx) i.e. (1 + x)k + 1 [1 + (1 + k)x] Thus, the statement in (2) is established. Hence, by the principle of mathematical induction, P(n) is true for all natural numbers. Example 6 Prove that 2.7n + 3.5n 5 is divisible by 24, for all n N. Solution Let the statement P(n) be defined as P(n) : 2.7n + 3.5n 5 is divisible by 24. We note that P(n) is true for n = 1, since 2.7 + 3.5 5 = 24, which is divisible by 24. Assume that P(k) is true i.e. 2.7k + 3.5k 5 = 24q, when q N ... (1)
Now, we wish to prove that P(k + 1) is true whenever P(k) is true. We have 2.7k+1 + 3.5k+1 5 = 2.7k . 71 + 3.5k . 51 5 = 7 [2.7k + 3.5k 5 3.5k + 5] + 3.5k . 5 5 = 7 [24q 3.5k + 5] + 15.5k 5 = 7 24q 21.5k + 35 + 15.5k 5 = 7 24q 6.5k + 30 = 7 24q 6 (5k 5) = 7 24q 6 (4p) [(5k 5) is a multiple of 4 (why?)] = 7 24q 24p = 24 (7q p) = 24 r; r = 7q p, is some natural number. ... (2)
The expresion on the R.H.S. of (1) is divisible by 24. Thus P(k + 1) is true whenever P(k) is true. Hence, by principle of mathematical induction, P(n) is true for all n N.
93
12 + 22 + ... + n2 >
n3 , nN 3
13 3
k3 3
...(1)
We shall now prove that P(k + 1) is true whenever P(k) is true. We have 12 + 22 + 32 + ... + k2 + (k + 1)2
= 12 + 22 + ... + k 2 + ( k + 1) >
2
k3 2 + ( k + 1) 3
[by (1)]
= =
1 3 [k + 3k2 + 6k + 3] 3
Therefore, P(k + 1) is also true whenever P(k) is true. Hence, by mathematical induction P(n) is true for all n N. Example 8 Prove the rule of exponents (ab)n = anbn by using principle of mathematical induction for every natural number. Solution Let P(n) be the given statement i.e. P(n) : (ab)n = anbn. We note that P(n) is true for n = 1 since (ab)1 = a1b1. Let P(k) be true, i.e., (ab)k = akbk We shall now prove that P(k + 1) is true whenever P(k) is true. Now, we have (ab)k + 1 = (ab)k (ab)
... (1)
94
MATHEMATICS
[by (1)]
Therefore, P(k + 1) is also true whenever P(k) is true. Hence, by principle of mathematical induction, P(n) is true for all n N. EXERCISE 4.1 Prove the following by using the principle of mathematical induction for all n N: 1. 1 + 3 + 32 + ... + 3n 1 =
(3n 1) . 2
2
n(n + 1) 2. 1 + 2 + 3 + +n = . 2
3 3 3 3
1 1 1 2n 3. 1+ (1 + 2) + (1 + 2 + 3) + ...+ (1 + 2 + 3 + ...n) = (n + 1) .
4. 1.2.3 + 2.3.4 ++ n(n+1) (n+2) = 5. 1.3 + 2.32 + 3.33 ++ n.3n =
n( n + 1) (n + 2) ( n + 3) . 4
(2n 1)3n +1 + 3 . 4
9.
1 1 1 1 1 + + + ... + n = 1 n . 2 4 8 2 2
10.
11.
95
a (r n 1) . r 1
3 5 13. 1 + 1 + 1 4
7 (2n + 1) 2 1 + ... 1 + = ( n + 1) . n2 9
1 1 1 1 14. 1 + 1 + 1 + ... 1 + = (n + 1) . 1 2 3 n
15. 12 + 32 + 52 + + (2n1)2 =
n(2n 1)(2n + 1) . 3
18. 1 + 2 + 3 ++ n <
1 (2n + 1)2. 8
19. n (n + 1) (n + 5) is a multiple of 3. 20. 102n 1 + 1 is divisible by 11. 21. x2n y2n is divisible by x + y. 22. 32n+2 8n 9 is divisible by 8. 23. 41n 14n is a multiple of 27. 24. (2n + 7) < (n + 3)2.
Summary
One key basis for mathematical thinking is deductive reasoning. In contrast to deduction, inductive reasoning depends on working with different cases and developing a conjective by observing incidences till we have observed each and every case. Thus, in simple language we can say the word induction means the generalisation from particular cases or facts. The principle of mathematical induction is one such tool which can be used to prove a wide variety of mathematical statements. Each such statement is assumed as P(n) associated with positive integer n, for which the correctness
96
MATHEMATICS
for the case n = 1 is examined. Then assuming the truth of P(k) for some positive integer k, the truth of P (k+1) is established.
Historical Note
Unlike other concepts and methods, proof by mathematical induction is not the invention of a particular individual at a fixed moment. It is said that the principle of mathematical induction was known by the Phythagoreans. The French mathematician Blaise Pascal is credited with the origin of the principle of mathematical induction. The name induction was used by the English mathematician John Wallis. Later the principle was employed to provide a proof of the binomial theorem. De Morgan contributed many accomplishments in the field of mathematics on many different subjects. He was the first person to define and name mathematical induction and developed De Morgans rule to determine the convergence of a mathematical series. G. Peano undertook the task of deducing the properties of natural numbers from a set of explicitly stated assumptions, now known as Peanos axioms.The principle of mathematical induction is a restatement of one of the Peanos axioms.
Chapter
5.1 Introduction
In earlier classes, we have studied linear equations in one and two variables and quadratic equations in one variable. We have seen that the equation x2 + 1 = 0 has no real solution as x2 + 1 = 0 gives x2 = 1 and square of every real number is non-negative. So, we need to extend the real number system to a larger system so that we can find the solution of the equation x2 = 1. In fact, the main objective is to solve the equation ax2 + bx + c = 0, where D = b2 4ac < 0, which is not possible in the system of real numbers.
W. R. Hamilton (1805-1865)
Let us denote 1 by the symbol i. Then, we have i = 1 . This means that i is a solution of the equation x2 + 1 = 0. A number of the form a + ib, where a and b are real numbers, is defined to be a
1 complex number. For example, 2 + i3, ( 1) + i 3 , 4 + i are complex numbers. 11 For the complex number z = a + ib, a is called the real part, denoted by Re z and b is called the imaginary part denoted by Im z of the complex number z. For example, if z = 2 + i5, then Re z = 2 and Im z = 5. Two complex numbers z1 = a + ib and z2 = c + id are equal if a = c and b = d.
98
MATHEMATICS
Example 1 If 4x + i(3x y) = 3 + i ( 6), where x and y are real numbers, then find the values of x and y. Solution We have 4x + i (3x y) = 3 + i (6) Equating the real and the imaginary parts of (1), we get 4x = 3, 3x y = 6, which, on solving simultaneously, give x = ... (1)
3 33 and y = . 4 4
99
5.3.3 Multiplication of two complex numbers Let z1 = a + ib and z2 = c + id be any two complex numbers. Then, the product z1 z2 is defined as follows: z1 z2 = (ac bd) + i(ad + bc) For example, (3 + i5) (2 + i6) = (3 2 5 6) + i(3 6 + 5 2) = 24 + i28 The multiplication of complex numbers possesses the following properties, which we state without proofs. (i) The closure law The product of two complex numbers is a complex number, the product z1 z2 is a complex number for all complex numbers z1 and z2. (ii) The commutative law For any two complex numbers z1 and z2, z1 z2 = z2 z1 . (iii) The associative law For any three complex numbers z 1 , z 2 , z 3 , (z1 z2) z3 = z1 (z2 z3). (iv) The existence of multiplicative identity There exists the complex number 1 + i 0 (denoted as 1), called the multiplicative identity such that z.1 = z, for every complex number z. (v) The existence of multiplicative inverse For every non-zero complex number z = a + ib or a + bi(a 0, b 0), we have the complex number
a b 1 +i 2 or z1 ), called the multiplicative inverse 2 2 (denoted by a +b a +b z of z such that
2
1 z. = 1 (the multiplicative identity). z (vi) The distributive law For any three complex numbers z1, z2, z3, (a) z1 (z2 + z3) = z1 z2 + z1 z3 (b) (z1 + z2) z3 = z1 z3 + z2 z3 5.3.4 Division of two complex numbers Given any two complex numbers z1 and z2,
where z2 0 , the quotient z is defined by 2
z1 1 = z1 z2 z2 z1
z1 = 6 + 3i and z2 = 2 i
z1 1 = (6 + 3i) = 6 + 3i ) 2i ( z2
( 1) 2 +i 2 2 2 22 + ( 1) 2 + ( 1)
100
MATHEMATICS
2+i 1 1 = ( 6 + 3i ) = 12 3 + i ( 6 + 6 ) = ( 9 + 12i ) 5 5 5
5.3.5 Power of i we know that
i 3 = i 2 i = ( 1) i = i , i5 = i 2 i4 = i2
( )
= ( 1) = 1
2
( )
i = ( 1) i = i ,
2
i6 = i2
( )
= ( 1) = 1 , etc.
3
Also, we have
1 i i i 1 = = = i, i i 1 i 3 =
i 2 =
1 1 = = 1, 2 1 i
5.3.6 The square roots of a negative real number Note that i2 = 1 and ( i)2 = i2 = 1 Therefore, the square roots of 1 are i, i. However, by the symbol , we would mean i only. Now, we can see that i and i both are the solutions of the equation x2 + 1 = 0 or 2 x = 1. Similarly
( 3 i) = ( 3)
2 2
i2 = 3 ( 1) = 3
2
( 3 i) = ( 3 )
Therefore, the square roots of 3 are Again, the symbol
i2 = 3
3 i and 3 i . 3 i only, i.e., a 1 =
3 is meant to represent
a =
3 =
a i,
3i .
result also holds true when either a > 0, b < 0 or a < 0, b > 0. What if a < 0, b < 0? Let us examine. Note that
101
i 2 = 1 1 =
( 1) ( 1)
(by assuming
a b =
Further, if any of a and b is zero, then, clearly, 5.3.7 Identities We prove the following identity
( z1 + z2 )
Proof We have,
(z1 + z2)2 = (z1 + z2) (z1 + z2), = (z1 + z2) z1 + (z1 + z2) z2 =
z12 + z2 z1 + z1 z2 +
2 z2 2 = z12 + z2 z1 + z1 z2 + z2 2 = z12 + 2 z1 z2 + z2
Similarly, we can prove the following identities: (i) (ii) (iii) (iv)
( z1 z2 ) ( z1 z2 )
2 3
( z1 + z2 )
2 z12 z 2 = ( z1 + z 2 ) ( z1 z 2 )
In fact, many other identities which are true for all real numbers, can be proved to be true for all complex numbers. Example 2 Express the following in the form of a + bi:
1 (i) ( 5i ) i 8
Solution (i)
(ii)
( i ) ( 2i )
1 i 8
( 5i )
1 5 2 5 5 5 i = i = ( 1) = = + i0 8 8 8 8 8
3
1 1 2 1 i5 = i (ii) ( i ) ( 2i ) i = 2 8 88 256 8
( )
i=
1 i. 256
102
MATHEMATICS
Example 3 Express (5 3i)3 in the form a + ib. Solution We have, (5 3i)3 = 53 3 52 (3i) + 3 5 (3i)2 (3i)3 = 125 225i 135 + 27i = 10 198i. Example 4 Express 3 + 2 2 3 i in the form of a + ib Solution We have, 3 + 2
)(
) (2
3 i
= 6 + 3i + 2 6i
) = ( 3 + 2 i) (2 3 i ) 2 i = ( 6 + 2 ) + 3 (1 + 2 2 ) i
2
of z, denoted as z , is the complex number a ib, i.e., z = a ib. For example, and
3 + i = 32 + 12 = 10 ,
3 + i = 3 i , 2 5 i = 2 + 5 i , 3i 5 = 3i 5 Observe that the multiplicative inverse of the non-zero complex number z is given by
z1 = or
b a a ib 1 +i 2 = 2 = 2 2 = a +b a +b a 2 + b2 a + ib
2
z z
2
z z= z
Furthermore, the following results can easily be derived. For any two compex numbers z1 and z2 , we have
(i)
z1 z2 = z1 z2
(ii)
z z1 = 1 provided z 0 2 z2 z2
z1 z1 z1 z2 = z1 z2 (v) z = z provided z2 0. 2 2
(iii)
z1 z2 = z1 z2
(iv)
103
z = 2 + 3i and
= 22 + ( 3) 2 = 13
z z
2
2 + 3i 2 3 = + i 13 13 13
1 2 + 3i = 2 3i (2 3i )(2 + 3i)
2 + 3i 2 + 3i 2 3 = = + i 2 13 13 13 2 (3i)
2
5 + 2i 1 2i
5 + 2i 1 2i =
(ii) i35
5 + 2i 1 + 2i 1 2i 1 + 2i
5 + 5 2i + 2i 2 1
( 2i )
=
35 (ii) i =
3 + 6 2i 3(1 + 2 2i ) = = 1 + 2 2i . 1+ 2 3
1 i
35
(i )
2
17
= i
i 1 i = 2 =i i i i
EXERCISE 5.1
Express each of the complex number given in the Exercises 1 to 10 in the form a + ib. 1.
( 5i )
3 i 5
2. i + i
3. i
104
MATHEMATICS
5. (1 i) ( 1 + i6) 7.
1 7 1 4 3 + i 3 + 4 + i 3 3 + i
3
5 1 2 +i 4+i 2 5 5
4
8. (1 i)
1 9. + 3i 3
1 10. 2 i 3
Find the multiplicative inverse of each of the complex numbers given in the Exercises 11 to 13. 11. 4 3i 13. i 5 + 3i 14. Express the following expression in the form of a + ib : 12.
(3 + i 5 ) (3 i 5 ) ( 3 + 2 i) ( 3 i 2 )
5.5 Argand Plane and Polar Representation
We already know that corresponding to each ordered pair of real numbers (x, y), we get a unique point in the XYplane and vice-versa with reference to a set of mutually perpendicular lines known as the x-axis and the y-axis. The complex number x + iy which corresponds to the ordered pair (x, y) can be represented geometrically as the unique point P(x, y) in the XY-plane and vice-versa. Some complex numbers such as 2 + 4i, 2 + 3i, 0 + 1i, 2 + 0i, 5 2i and Fig 5.1 1 2i which correspond to the ordered pairs (2, 4), ( 2, 3), (0, 1), (2, 0), ( 5, 2), and (1, 2), respectively, have been represented geometrically by the points A, B, C, D, E, and F, respectively in the Fig 5.1. The plane having a complex number assigned to each of its point is called the complex plane or the Argand plane.
105
(Fig 5.2). The points on the x-axis corresponds to the complex numbers of the form a + i 0 and the points on the y-axis corresponds to the complex numbers of the form
Fig 5.2
0 + i b. The x-axis and y-axis in the Argand plane are called, respectively, the real axis and the imaginary axis. The representation of a complex number z = x + iy and its conjugate z = x iy in the Argand plane are, respectively, the points P (x, y) and Q (x, y). Geometrically, the point (x, y) is the mirror image of the point (x, y) on the real axis (Fig 5.3).
Fig 5.3
106
MATHEMATICS
5.5.1 Polar representation of a complex number Let the point P represent the nonzero complex number z = x + iy. Let the directed line segment OP be of length r and be the angle which OP makes with the positive direction of x-axis (Fig 5.4). We may note that the point P is uniquely determined by the ordered pair of real numbers (r, ), called the polar coordinates of the point P. We consider the origin as the pole and the positive Fig 5.4 direction of the x axis as the initial line. We have, x = r cos , y = r sin and therefore, z = r (cos + i sin ). The latter is said to be the polar form of the complex number. Here r = x 2 + y 2 = z is the modus of z and is called the argument (or amplitude) of z which is denoted by arg z. For any complex number z 0, there corresponds only one value of in 0 < 2. However, any other interval of length 2, for example < , can be such an interval.We shall take the value of such that < , called principal argument of z and is denoted by arg z, unless specified otherwise. (Figs. 5.5 and 5.6)
107
Example 7 Represent the complex number z = 1 + i 3 in the polar form. Solution Let 1 = r cos , = r sin By squaring and adding, we get
r 2 cos 2 + sin 2 = 4
i.e., Therefore,
r =
(conventionally, r >0)
cos =
16 1+ i 3
16 1 i 3 1+ i 3 1 i 3
16 1 i 3
=
2
( ) = 16 (1 i 3 ) = ( 1+ 3 1 (i 3 )
16 + 48 = r 2 cos 2 + sin 2
)=
+i
(Fig 5.8).
r = 64, i.e., r = 8
2
cos = , sin =
Fig 5.8
2 = 3 3
108
MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 5.2
Find the modulus and the arguments of each of the complex numbers in Exercises 1 to 2. 1. z = 1 i 2. z = +i Convert each of the complex numbers given in Exercises 3 to 8 in the polar form: 3. 1 i 4. 1 + i 5. 1 i 6. 3 7. +i 8. i
b b 2 4ac b 4ac b 2 i = 2a 2a
Note At this point of time, some would be interested to know as to how many roots does an equation have? In this regard, the following theorem known as the Fundamental theorem of Algebra is stated below (without proof). A polynomial equation has at least one root. As a consequence of this theorem, the following result, which is of immense importance, is arrived at: A polynomial equation of degree n has n roots. Example 9 Solve x2 + 2 = 0 Solution We have, x2 + 2 = 0 or x2 = 2 i.e., x = 2 = 2 i
109
1 3 1 3i = 2 1 2
5x2 + x + 5 = 0
EXERCISE 5.3
Solve each of the following equations: 1. x2 + 3 = 0 2. 2x2 + x + 1 = 0 4. x2 + x 2 = 0 5. x2 + 3x + 5 = 0 7. 9.
2 x2 + x + 2 = 0
3. x2 + 3x + 9 = 0 6. x2 x + 2 = 0
8. 10.
3x2 2 x + 3 3 = 0
x2 + x +1 = 0 2
x2 + x +
1 =0 2
Miscellaneous Examples
Example 12 Find the conjugate of
(3 2i) (2 + 3i ) (1 + 2i ) (2 i ) .
Solution We have , =
(3 2i ) (2 + 3i ) (1 + 2i) (2 i )
6 + 9i 4i + 6 12 + 5i 4 3i = 2 i + 4i + 2 4 + 3i 4 3i
63 16 48 36i + 20i + 15 63 16i i = = 25 25 16 + 9 25
Therefore, conjugate of
(3 2i ) (2 + 3i ) 63 16 is + i (1 + 2i) (2 i ) 25 25 .
110
MATHEMATICS
Example 13 Find the modulus and argument of the complex numbers: (i)
1+ i , 1 i
(ii)
1 1+ i
1+ i 1 + i 1+ i 1 1+ 2i = =i= 0 + i = 1 i 1 i 1+ i 1+ 1
1 = r sin
2
1+ i is 1 and the argument is . 1 i 2
1 1 i 1 i 1 i = = = 1 + i (1 + i) (1 i) 1 + 1 2 2
1 1 = r cos , = r sin 2 2
1 1 1 ; cos = , sin = 2 2 2
4
1 1 is , argument is . 2 1+ i 4
a + ib 2 2 a ib , prove that x + y = 1.
111
So that, Therefore,
x iy =
a 2 b2 2ab 2 2i 2 2 a +b a +b
( a 2 b 2 )2 4a 2b 2 (a 2 + b 2 ) 2 + 2 2 2 = 2 2 2 =1 x + y = (x + iy) (x iy) = (a 2 + b 2 ) 2 (a + b ) (a + b )
2 2
Thus
= n, n Z.
i 1 in the polar form. cos + i sin 3 3
Solution We have, z =
i 1 1 3 + i 2 2
2(i 1) 1 3i 2 i + 3 1 + 3i = = 1+ 3 1 + 3i 1 3i
3 +1 = r sin 2
3 1 + 2
3 +1 i 2
Now, put
3 1 = r cos , 2
112
MATHEMATICS
( 3)
+ 1 2 4 = =2 4 4
2
cos =
3 1 3 +1 , sin = 2 2 2 2
5 5 2 cos + i sin 12 12
2. For any two complex numbers z1 and z2, prove that Re (z1 z2) = Re z1 Re z2 Imz1 Imz2.
1 + 7i
(i)
(2 i)
(ii)
1 + 3i 1 2i
20 =0 3
7.
x2 2 x +
3 =0 2
8.
27 x 2 10 x + 1 = 0
113
9.
21x 2 28 x + 10 = 0
z1 + z2 +1 10. If z1 = 2 i, z2 = 1 + i, find z z + i . 1 2
( x 2 + 1) 2 ( x + i )2 11. If a + ib = , prove that a2 + b2 = 2 x 2 + 1 2 . 2 x2 + 1
z1 z2 (i) Re z , 1
(ii) Im
1 . z1 z1
1+ 2i . 1 3i 14. Find the real numbers x and y if (x iy) (3 + 5i) is the conjugate of 6 24i.
13. Find the modulus and argument of the complex number 15. Find the modulus of
1+ i 1 i 1 i 1+ i . u v + = 4( x 2 y 2 ) . x y
= 2x .
114
MATHEMATICS
Summary
A number of the form a + ib, where a and b are real numbers, is called a complex number, a is called the real part and b is called the imaginary part of the complex number. Let z1 = a + ib and z2 = c + id. Then (i) z1 + z2 = (a + c) + i (b + d) (ii) z1 z2 = (ac bd) + i (ad + bc) For any non-zero complex number z = a + ib (a 0, b 0), there exists the complex number
For any integer k, i4k = 1, i4k + 1 = i, i4k + 2 = 1, i4k + 3 = i The conjugate of the complex number z = a + ib, denoted by z , is given by z = a ib. The polar form of the complex number z = x + iy is r (cos + i sin), where r=
x y , sin = . ( is known as the r r argument of z. The value of , such that < , is called the principal argument of z.
A polynomial equation of n degree has n roots. The solutions of the quadratic equation ax2 + bx + c = 0, where a, b, c R, a 0, b2 4ac < 0, are given by x =
b 4ac b 2 i 2a
.
115
Historical Note The fact that square root of a negative number does not exist in the real number system was recognised by the Greeks. But the credit goes to the Indian mathematician Mahavira (850 A.D.) who first stated this difficulty clearly. He mentions in his work Ganitasara Sangraha as in the nature of things a negative (quantity) is not a square (quantity), it has, therefore, no square root. Bhaskara, another Indian mathematician, also writes in his work Bijaganita, written in 1150. A.D. There is no square root of a negative quantity, for it is not a square. Cardan (1545 A.D.) considered the problem of solving x + y = 10, xy = 40. He obtained x = 5 + 15 and y = 5 15 as the solution of it, which was discarded by him by saying that these numbers are useless. Albert Girard (about 1625 A.D.) accepted square root of negative numbers and said that this will enable us to get as many roots as the degree of the polynomial equation. Euler was the first to introduce the symbol i for 1 and W.R. Hamilton (about 1830 A.D.) regarded the complex number a + ib as an ordered pair of real numbers (a, b) thus giving it a purely mathematical definition and avoiding use of the so called imaginary numbers.
Chapter
LINEAR INEQUALITIES
Mathematics is the art of saying many things in many different ways. MAXWELL
6.1 Introduction
In earlier classes, we have studied equations in one variable and two variables and also solved some statement problems by translating them in the form of equations. Now a natural question arises: Is it always possible to translate a statement problem in the form of an equation? For example, the height of all the students in your class is less than 160 cm. Your classroom can occupy atmost 60 tables or chairs or both. Here we get certain statements involving a sign < (less than), > (greater than), (less than or equal) and (greater than or equal) which are known as inequalities. In this Chapter, we will study linear inequalities in one and two variables. The study of inequalities is very useful in solving problems in the field of science, mathematics, statistics, optimisation problems, economics, psychology, etc.
6.2 Inequalities
Let us consider the following situations: (i) Ravi goes to market with Rs 200 to buy rice, which is available in packets of 1kg. The price of one packet of rice is Rs 30. If x denotes the number of packets of rice, which he buys, then the total amount spent by him is Rs 30x. Since, he has to buy rice in packets only, he may not be able to spend the entire amount of Rs 200. (Why?) Hence 30x < 200 ... (1) Clearly the statement (i) is not an equation as it does not involve the sign of equality. (ii) Reshma has Rs 120 and wants to buy some registers and pens. The cost of one register is Rs 40 and that of a pen is Rs 20. In this case, if x denotes the number of registers and y, the number of pens which Reshma buys, then the total amount spent by her is Rs (40x + 20y) and we have 40x + 20y 120 ... (2)
LINEAR INEQUALITIES
117
Since in this case the total amount spent may be upto Rs 120. Note that the statement (2) consists of two statements and 40x + 20y < 120 40x + 20y = 120 ... (3) ... (4)
Statement (3) is not an equation, i.e., it is an inequality while statement (4) is an equation.
Definition 1 Two real numbers or two algebraic expressions related by the symbol
<, >, or form an inequality. Statements such as (1), (2) and (3) above are inequalities. 3 < 5; 7 > 5 are the examples of numerical inequalities while x < 5; y > 2; x 3, y 4 are the examples of literal inequalities. 3 < 5 < 7 (read as 5 is greater than 3 and less than 7), 3 < x < 5 (read as x is greater than or equal to 3 and less than 5) and 2 < y < 4 are the examples of double inequalities. Some more examples of inequalities are: ax + b < 0 ax + b > 0 ax + b 0 ax + b 0 ax + by < c ax + by > c ax + by c ax + by c ax + bx + c 0
2
... (5) ... (6) ... (7) ... (8) ... (9) ... (10) ... (11) ... (12) ... (13) ... (14)
ax2 + bx + c > 0
Inequalities (5), (6), (9), (10) and (14) are strict inequalities while inequalities (7), (8), (11), (12), and (13) are slack inequalities. Inequalities from (5) to (8) are linear inequalities in one variable x when a 0, while inequalities from (9) to (12) are linear inequalities in two variables x and y when a 0, b 0. Inequalities (13) and (14) are not linear (in fact, these are quadratic inequalities in one variable x when a 0). In this Chapter, we shall confine ourselves to the study of linear inequalities in one and two variables only.
118
MATHEMATICS
6.3 Algebraic Solutions of Linear Inequalities in One Variable and their Graphical Representation
Let us consider the inequality (1) of Section 6.2, viz, 30x < 200 Note that here x denotes the number of packets of rice. Obviously, x cannot be a negative integer or a fraction. Left hand side (L.H.S.) of this inequality is 30x and right hand side (RHS) is 200. Therefore, we have For x = 0, L.H.S. = 30 (0) = 0 < 200 (R.H.S.), which is true. For x = 1, L.H.S. = 30 (1) = 30 < 200 (R.H.S.), which is true. For x = 2, L.H.S. = 30 (2) = 60 < 200, which is true. For x = 3, L.H.S. = 30 (3) = 90 < 200, which is true. For x = 4, L.H.S. = 30 (4) = 120 < 200, which is true. For x = 5, L.H.S. = 30 (5) = 150 < 200, which is true. For x = 6, L.H.S. = 30 (6) = 180 < 200, which is true. For x = 7, L.H.S. = 30 (7) = 210 < 200, which is false. In the above situation, we find that the values of x, which makes the above inequality a true statement, are 0,1,2,3,4,5,6. These values of x, which make above inequality a true statement, are called solutions of inequality and the set {0,1,2,3,4,5,6} is called its solution set. Thus, any solution of an inequality in one variable is a value of the variable which makes it a true statement. We have found the solutions of the above inequality by trial and error method which is not very efficient. Obviously, this method is time consuming and sometimes not feasible. We must have some better or systematic techniques for solving inequalities. Before that we should go through some more properties of numerical inequalities and follow them as rules while solving the inequalities. You will recall that while solving linear equations, we followed the following rules: Rule 1 Equal numbers may be added to (or subtracted from) both sides of an equation. Rule 2 Both sides of an equation may be multiplied (or divided) by the same non-zero number. In the case of solving inequalities, we again follow the same rules except with a difference that in Rule 2, the sign of inequality is reversed (i.e., < becomes >, becomes and so on) whenever we multiply (or divide) both sides of an inequality by a negative number. It is evident from the facts that 3 > 2 while 3 < 2, 8 < 7 while ( 8) ( 2) > ( 7) ( 2) , i.e., 16 > 14.
LINEAR INEQUALITIES
119
Thus, we state the following rules for solving an inequality: Rule 1 Equal numbers may be added to (or subtracted from) both sides of an inequality without affecting the sign of inequality. Rule 2 Both sides of an inequality can be multiplied (or divided) by the same positive number. But when both sides are multiplied or divided by a negative number, then the sign of inequality is reversed. Now, let us consider some examples. Example 1 Solve 30 x < 200 when (i) x is a natural number, Solution We are given 30 x < 200 or (ii) x is an integer.
30 x 200 < (Rule 2), i.e., x < 20 / 3. 30 30 (i) When x is a natural number, in this case the following values of x make the statement true. 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6. The solution set of the inequality is {1,2,3,4,5,6}. (ii) When x is an integer, the solutions of the given inequality are ..., 3, 2, 1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 The solution set of the inequality is {...,3, 2,1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}
Example 2 Solve 5x 3 < 3x +1 when (i) x is an integer, (ii) x is a real number. Solution We have, 5x 3 < 3x + 1 or 5x 3 + 3 < 3x +1 +3 (Rule 1) or 5x < 3x +4 or 5x 3x < 3x + 4 3x (Rule 1) or 2x < 4 or x < 2 (Rule 2) (i) When x is an integer, the solutions of the given inequality are ..., 4, 3, 2, 1, 0, 1 (ii) When x is a real number, the solutions of the inequality are given by x < 2, i.e., all real numbers x which are less than 2. Therefore, the solution set of the inequality is x ( , 2). We have considered solutions of inequalities in the set of natural numbers, set of integers and in the set of real numbers. Henceforth, unless stated otherwise, we shall solve the inequalities in this Chapter in the set of real numbers.
120
MATHEMATICS
Example 3 Solve 4x + 3 < 6x +7. Solution We have, 4x + 3 < 6x + 7 or 4x 6x < 6x + 4 6x or 2x < 4 or x > 2 i.e., all the real numbers which are greater than 2, are the solutions of the given inequality. Hence, the solution set is (2, ). Example 4 Solve Solution We have
5 2x x 5. 3 6
5 2x x 5 3 6 or 2 (5 2x) x 30. or 10 4x x 30 or 5x 40, i.e., x 8 Thus, all real numbers x which are greater than or equal to 8 are the solutions of the given inequality, i.e., x [8, ).
Example 5 Solve 7x + 3 < 5x + 9. Show the graph of the solutions on number line. Solution We have 7x + 3 < 5x + 9 or 2x < 6 or x < 3 The graphical representation of the solutions are given in Fig 6.1.
Fig 6.1
or or
3x 4 x 3 2 4 2 (3x 4) (x 3)
LINEAR INEQUALITIES
121
or or
6x 8 x 3 5x 5 or x 1
Fig 6.2
Example 7 The marks obtained by a student of Class XI in first and second terminal examination are 62 and 48, respectively. Find the number of minimum marks he should get in the annual examination to have an average of at least 60 marks. Solution Let x be the marks obtained by student in the annual examination. Then
62 + 48 + x 60 3 or 110 + x 180 or x 70 Thus, the student must obtain a minimum of 70 marks to get an average of at least 60 marks.
Example 8 Find all pairs of consecutive odd natural numbers, both of which are larger than 10, such that their sum is less than 40. Solution Let x be the smaller of the two consecutive odd natural number, so that the other one is x +2. Then, we should have x > 10 and x + ( x + 2) < 40 Solving (2), we get 2x + 2 < 40 i.e., x < 19 From (1) and (3), we get 10 < x < 19 ... (1) ... (2)
... (3)
Since x is an odd number, x can take the values 11, 13, 15, and 17. So, the required possible pairs will be (11, 13), (13, 15), (15, 17), (17, 19)
122
MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 6.1
1. Solve 24x < 100, when (i) x is a natural number. 2. Solve 12x > 30, when (i) x is a natural number. 3. Solve 5x 3 < 7, when (i) x is an integer. 4. Solve 3x + 8 >2, when (i) x is an integer. (ii) x is an integer. (ii) x is an integer. (ii) x is a real number. (ii) x is a real number.
x x x + + < 11 2 3
10.
x x > +1 3 2
x (5 x 2) (7 x 3) < 4 3 5
(2 x 1) (3 x 2) (2 x) 3 4 5
Solve the inequalities in Exercises 17 to 20 and show the graph of the solution in each case on number line 17. 3x 2 < 2x + 1 19. 3 (1 x) < 2 (x + 4) 21. 22. 18. 5x 3 > 3x 5 20.
23. 24.
x (5 x 2) (7 x 3) < 2 3 5 Ravi obtained 70 and 75 marks in first two unit test. Find the number if minimum marks he should get in the third test to have an average of at least 60 marks. To receive Grade A in a course, one must obtain an average of 90 marks or more in five examinations (each of 100 marks). If Sunitas marks in first four examinations are 87, 92, 94 and 95, find minimum marks that Sunita must obtain in fifth examination to get grade A in the course. Find all pairs of consecutive odd positive integers both of which are smaller than 10 such that their sum is more than 11. Find all pairs of consecutive even positive integers, both of which are larger than 5 such that their sum is less than 23.
LINEAR INEQUALITIES
123
25. The longest side of a triangle is 3 times the shortest side and the third side is 2 cm shorter than the longest side. If the perimeter of the triangle is at least 61 cm, find the minimum length of the shortest side. 26. A man wants to cut three lengths from a single piece of board of length 91cm. The second length is to be 3cm longer than the shortest and the third length is to be twice as long as the shortest. What are the possible lengths of the shortest board if the third piece is to be at least 5cm longer than the second? [Hint: If x is the length of the shortest board, then x , (x + 3) and 2x are the lengths of the second and third piece, respectively. Thus, x + (x + 3) + 2x 91 and 2x (x + 3) + 5].
Fig 6.3
Fig 6.4
A point in the Cartesian plane will either lie on a line or will lie in either of the half planes I or II. We shall now examine the relationship, if any, of the points in the plane and the inequalities ax + by < c or ax + by > c. Let us consider the line ax + by = c, a 0, b 0 ... (1)
124
MATHEMATICS
There are three possibilities namely: (i) ax + by = c (ii) ax + by > c (iii) ax + by < c. In case (i), clearly, all points (x, y) satisfying (i) lie on the line it represents and conversely. Consider case (ii), let us first assume that b > 0. Consider a point P (,) on the line ax + by = c, b > 0, so that a + b = c.Take an arbitrary point Q ( , ) in the half plane II (Fig 6.5). Now, from Fig 6.5, we interpret, > (Why?) or b > b or a + b > a + b (Why?) or a + b > c i.e., Q(, ) satisfies the inequality ax + by > c. Fig 6.5 Thus, all the points lying in the half plane II above the line ax + by = c satisfies the inequality ax + by > c. Conversely, let (, ) be a point on line ax + by = c and an arbitrary point Q(, ) satisfying ax + by > c so that a + b > c a + b > a + b (Why?) > (as b > 0) This means that the point (, ) lies in the half plane II. Thus, any point in the half plane II satisfies ax + by > c, and conversely any point satisfying the inequality ax + by > c lies in half plane II. In case b < 0, we can similarly prove that any point satisfying ax + by > c lies in the half plane I, and conversely. Hence, we deduce that all points satisfying ax + by > c lies in one of the half planes II or I according as b > 0 or b < 0, and conversely. Thus, graph of the inequality ax + by > c will be one of the half plane (called solution region) and represented by shading in the corresponding half plane. Note 1 The region containing all the solutions of an inequality is called the solution region. 2. In order to identify the half plane represented by an inequality, it is just sufficient to take any point (a, b) (not online) and check whether it satisfies the inequality or not. If it satisfies, then the inequality represents the half plane and shade the region
LINEAR INEQUALITIES
125
which contains the point, otherwise, the inequality represents that half plane which does not contain the point within it. For convenience, the point (0, 0) is preferred. 3. If an inequality is of the type ax + by c or ax + by c, then the points on the line ax + by = c are also included in the solution region. So draw a dark line in the solution region. 4. If an inequality is of the form ax + by > c or ax + by < c, then the points on the line ax + by = c are not to be included in the solution region. So draw a broken or dotted line in the solution region. In Section 6.2, we obtained the following linear inequalities in two variables x and y: 40x + 20y 120 ... (1) while translating the word problem of purchasing of registers and pens by Reshma. Let us now solve this inequality keeping in mind that x and y can be only whole numbers, since the number of articles cannot be a fraction or a negative number. In this case, we find the pairs of values of x and y, which make the statement (1) true. In fact, the set of such pairs will be the solution set of the inequality (1). To start with, let x = 0. Then L.H.S. of (1) is 40x + 20y = 40 (0) + 20y = 20y. Thus, we have 20y 120 or y 6 ... (2) For x = 0, the corresponding values of y can be 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 only. In this case, the solutions of (1) are (0, 0), (0, 1), (0,2), (0,3), (0,4), (0, 5) and (0, 6). Similarly, other solutions of (1), when x = 1, 2 and 3 are: (1, 0), (1, 1), (1, 2), (1, 3), (1, 4), (2, 0), (2, 1), (2, 2), (3, 0) This is shown in Fig 6.6. Let us now extend the domain of x and y from whole numbers to real numbers, and see what will be the solutions of (1) in this case. You will see that the graphical method of solution will be very convenient in this case. For this purpose, let us consider the (corresponding) equation and draw its graph. 40x + 20y = 120 ... (3) In order to draw the graph of the inequality (1), we take one point say (0, 0), in half plane I and check whether values of x and y satisfy the Fig 6.6 inequality or not.
126
MATHEMATICS
We observe that x = 0, y = 0 satisfy the inequality. Thus, we say that the half plane I is the graph (Fig 6.7) of the inequality. Since the points on the line also satisfy the inequality (1) above, the line is also a part of the graph. Thus, the graph of the given inequality is half plane I including the line itself. Clearly half plane II is not the part of the graph. Hence, solutions of inequality (1) will consist of all the points of its graph (half plane I including the line). We shall now consider some examples to explain the above procedure for solving a linear inequality involving two variables. Example 9 Solve 3x + 2y > 6 graphically.
Fig 6.7
Solution Graph of 3x + 2y = 6 is given as dotted line in the Fig 6.8. This line divides the xy-plane in two half planes I and II. We select a point (not on the line), say (0, 0), which lies in one of the half planes (Fig 6.8) and determine if this point satisfies the given inequality, we note that 3 (0) + 2 (0) > 6 or 0 > 6 , which is false. Hence, half plane I is not the solution region of the given inequality. Clearly, any point on the line does not satisfy the given strict inequality. In other words, the shaded half plane II Fig 6.8 excluding the points on the line is the solution region of the inequality. Example 10 Solve 3x 6 0 graphically in two dimensional plane. Solution Graph of 3x 6 = 0 is given in the Fig 6.9. We select a point, say (0, 0) and substituting it in given inequality, we see that: 3 (0) 6 0 or 6 0 which is false. Thus, the solution region is the shaded region on the right hand side of the line x = 2.
Fig 6.9
LINEAR INEQUALITIES
127
Example 11 Solve y < 2 graphically. Solution Graph of y = 2 is given in the Fig 6.10. Let us select a point, (0, 0) in lower half plane I and putting y = 0 in the given inequality, we see that 1 0 < 2 or 0 < 2 which is true. Thus, the solution region is the shaded region below the line y = 2. Hence, every point below the line (excluding all the points on the line) determines the solution of the given inequality.
Fig 6.10
EXERCISE 6.2
Solve the following inequalities graphically in two-dimensional plane: 1. x + y < 5 2. 2x + y 6 3. 3x + 4y 12 4. y + 8 2x 5. x y 2 6. 2x 3y > 6 7. 3x + 2y 6 8. 3y 5x < 30 9. y < 2 10. x > 3. 6.5 Solution of System of Linear Inequalities in Two Variables In previous Section, you have learnt how to solve linear inequality in one or two variables graphically. We will now illustrate the method for solving a system of linear inequalities in two variables graphically through some examples. Example 12 Solve the following system of linear inequalities graphically. x+y5 ... (1) xy3 ... (2) Solution The graph of linear equation x+y=5 is drawn in Fig 6.11. We note that solution of inequality (1) is represented by the shaded region above the line x + y = 5, including the points on the line. On the same set of axes, we draw the graph of the equation x y = 3 as Fig 6.11 shown in Fig 6.11. Then we note that inequality (2) represents the shaded region above
128
MATHEMATICS
the line x y = 3, including the points on the line. Clearly, the double shaded region, common to the above two shaded regions is the required solution region of the given system of inequalities. Example 13 Solve the following system of inequalities graphically 5x + 4y 40 ... (1) x2 ... (2) y3 ... (3) Solution We first draw the graph of the line 5x + 4y = 40, x = 2 and y = 3 Then we note that the inequality (1) represents shaded region below the line 5x + 4y = 40 and inequality (2) represents the shaded region right of line x = 2 but inequality (3) represents the shaded region above the line y = 3. Hence, shaded region (Fig 6.12) including all the point on the lines are also the solution of the given system of the linear inequalities. In many practical situations involving system of inequalities the variable x and y often represent quantities that cannot have negative values, for example, number of units produced, number of articles purchased, number of hours worked, etc. Clearly, in such cases, x 0, y 0 and the solution region lies only in the first quadrant. Example 14 Solve the following system of inequalities 8x + 3y 100 ... (1) x0 ... (2) y0 ... (3) Solution We draw the graph of the line 8x + 3y = 100 The inequality 8x + 3y 100 represents the shaded region below the line, including the points on the line 8x +3y =100 (Fig 6.13).
Fig 6.12
Fig 6.13
LINEAR INEQUALITIES
129
Since x 0, y 0, every point in the shaded region in the first quadrant, including the points on the line and the axes, represents the solution of the given system of inequalities. Example 15 Solve the following system of inequalities graphically x + 2y 8 ... (1) 2x + y 8 ... (2) x>0 ... (3) ... (4) y>0 Solution We draw the graphs of the lines x + 2y = 8 and 2x + y = 8. The inequality (1) and (2) represent Fig 6.14 the region below the two lines, including the point on the respective lines. Since x 0, y 0, every point in the shaded region in the first quadrant represent a solution of the given system of inequalities (Fig 6.14).
EXERCISE 6.3
Solve the following system of inequalities graphically: 1. x 3, y 2 3. 2x + y 6, 3x + 4y < 12 5. 2x y >1, x 2y < 1 7. 2x + y 8, x + 2y 10 9. 5x + 4y 20, x 1, y 2 10. 3x + 4y 60, x +3y 30, x 0, y 0 11. 2x + y 4, x + y 3, 2x 3y 6 12. x 2y 3, 3x + 4y 12, x 0 , y 1. 13. 4x + 3y 60, y 2x, x 3, x, y 0 14. 3x + 2y 150, x + 4y 80, x 15, y 0 15. x + 2y 10, x + y 1, x y 0, x 0, y 0 2. 3x + 2y 12, x 1, y 2 4. x + y > 4, 2x y > 0 6. x + y 6, x + y 4 8. x + y 9, y > x, x 0
130
MATHEMATICS
Miscellaneous Examples
Example 16 Solve 8 5x 3 < 7. Solution In this case, we have two inequalities, 8 5x 3 and 5x 3 < 7, which we will solve simultaneously. We have 8 5x 3 < 7 or 5 5x < 10 or 1 x < 2 Example 17 Solve 5 Solution We have 5 or or 10 5 3x 16 5x
5 3x 8. 2
5 3x 8 2 or 15 3x 11
11 3
11 x 5 3 Example 18 Solve the system of inequalities: 3x 7 < 5 + x 11 5 x 1 and represent the solutions on the number line.
which can be written as
Solution From inequality (1), we have 3x 7 < 5 + x or x<6 ... (3) Also, from inequality (2), we have 11 5 x 1 or 5 x 10 i.e., x 2 ... (4) If we draw the graph of inequalities (3) and (4) on the number line, we see that the values of x, which are common to both, are shown by bold line in Fig 6.15.
Fig 6.15
Thus, solution of the system are real numbers x lying between 2 and 6 including 2, i.e., 2x<6
LINEAR INEQUALITIES
131
Example 19 In an experiment, a solution of hydrochloric acid is to be kept between 30 and 35 Celsius. What is the range of temperature in degree Fahrenheit if conversion formula is given by C =
Celsius and degree Fahrenheit, respectively. Solution It is given that 30 < C < 35. Putting C= 30 < or
or 54 < (F 32) < 63 or 86 < F < 95. Thus, the required range of temperature is between 86 F and 95 F. Example 20 A manufacturer has 600 litres of a 12% solution of acid. How many litres of a 30% acid solution must be added to it so that acid content in the resulting mixture will be more than 15% but less than 18%? Solution Let x litres of 30% acid solution is required to be added. Then Total mixture = (x + 600) litres Therefore 30% x + 12% of 600 > 15% of (x + 600) and 30% x + 12% of 600 < 18% of (x + 600) or
30 x 12 15 + (600) > (x + 600) 100 100 100 30 x 12 18 + (600) < (x + 600) 100 100 100
30x + 7200 > 15x + 9000 30x + 7200 < 18x + 10800 15x > 1800 and 12x < 3600 x > 120 and x < 300, 120 < x < 300
132
MATHEMATICS
Thus, the number of litres of the 30% solution of acid will have to be more than 120 litres but less than 300 litres.
34 12 < 4
7x 18 2 3x 2 5
15 <
3( x 2 ) 0 5
6. 7
( 3x +11 ) 11 . 2
Solve the inequalities in Exercises 7 to 11 and represent the solution graphically on number line. 7. 8. 9. 10. 5x + 1 > 24, 5x 1 < 24 2 (x 1) < x + 5, 3 (x + 2) > 2 x 3x 7 > 2 (x 6) , 6 x > 11 2x 5 (2x 7) 3 (2x + 3) 0 , 2x + 19 6x + 47 .
11. A solution is to be kept between 68 F and 77 F. What is the range in temperature in degree Celsius (C) if the Celsius / Fahrenheit (F) conversion formula is given by F=
9 C + 32 ? 5
12. A solution of 8% boric acid is to be diluted by adding a 2% boric acid solution to it. The resulting mixture is to be more than 4% but less than 6% boric acid. If we have 640 litres of the 8% solution, how many litres of the 2% solution will have to be added? 13. How many litres of water will have to be added to 1125 litres of the 45% solution of acid so that the resulting mixture will contain more than 25% but less than 30% acid content? 14. IQ of a person is given by the formula IQ =
MA 100, CA
where MA is mental age and CA is chronological age. If 80 IQ 140 for a group of 12 years old children, find the range of their mental age.
LINEAR INEQUALITIES
133
Summary
Two real numbers or two algebraic expressions related by the symbols <, >, or form an inequality. Equal numbers may be added to (or subtracted from ) both sides of an inequality. Both sides of an inequality can be multiplied (or divided ) by the same positive number. But when both sides are multiplied (or divided) by a negative number, then the inequality is reversed. The values of x, which make an inequality a true statement, are called solutions of the inequality. To represent x < a (or x > a) on a number line, put a circle on the number a and dark line to the left (or right) of the number a. To represent x a (or x a) on a number line, put a dark circle on the number a and dark the line to the left (or right) of the number x. If an inequality is having or symbol, then the points on the line are also included in the solutions of the inequality and the graph of the inequality lies left (below) or right (above) of the graph of the equality represented by dark line that satisfies an arbitrary point in that part. If an inequality is having < or > symbol, then the points on the line are not included in the solutions of the inequality and the graph of the inequality lies to the left (below) or right (above) of the graph of the corresponding equality represented by dotted line that satisfies an arbitrary point in that part. The solution region of a system of inequalities is the region which satisfies all the given inequalities in the system simultaneously.
Chapter
7.1 Introduction
Suppose you have a suitcase with a number lock. The number lock has 4 wheels each labelled with 10 digits from 0 to 9. The lock can be opened if 4 specific digits are arranged in a particular sequence with no repetition. Some how, you have forgotten this specific sequence of digits. You remember only the first digit which is 7. In order to open the lock, how many sequences of 3-digits you may have to check with? To answer this question, you may, immediately, start listing all possible arrangements of 9 remaining digits taken 3 at a time. But, Jacob Bernoulli this method will be tedious, because the number of possible (1654-1705) sequences may be large. Here, in this Chapter, we shall learn some basic counting techniques which will enable us to answer this question without actually listing 3-digit arrangements. In fact, these techniques will be useful in determining the number of different ways of arranging and selecting objects without actually listing them. As a first step, we shall examine a principle which is most fundamental to the learning of these techniques.
135
Let us name the three pants as P1, P2 , P3 and the two shirts as S1, S2. Then, these six possibilities can be illustrated in the Fig. 7.1. Let us consider another problem of the same type. Sabnam has 2 school bags, 3 tiffin boxes and 2 water bottles. In how many ways can she carry these items (choosing one each). A school bag can be chosen in 2 different ways. After a school bag is chosen, a tiffin box can be chosen in 3 different ways. Hence, there are 2 3 = 6 pairs of school bag and a tiffin box. For each of these pairs a water Fig 7.1 bottle can be chosen in 2 differnt ways. Hence, there are 6 2 = 12 different ways in which, Sabnam can carry these items to school. If we name the 2 school bags as B1, B2, the three tiffin boxes as T1, T2, T3 and the two water bottles as W1, W2, these possibilities can be illustrated in the Fig. 7.2.
Fig 7.2
136
MATHEMATICS
In fact, the problems of the above types are solved by applying the following principle known as the fundamental principle of counting, or, simply, the multiplication principle, which states that If an event can occur in m different ways, following which another event can occur in n different ways, then the total number of occurrence of the events in the given order is mn. The above principle can be generalised for any finite number of events. For example, for 3 events, the principle is as follows: If an event can occur in m different ways, following which another event can occur in n different ways, following which a third event can occur in p different ways, then the total number of occurrence to the events in the given order is m n p. In the first problem, the required number of ways of wearing a pant and a shirt was the number of different ways of the occurence of the following events in succession: (i) (ii) the event of choosing a pant the event of choosing a shirt.
In the second problem, the required number of ways was the number of different ways of the occurence of the following events in succession: (i) (ii) (iii) the event of choosing a school bag the event of choosing a tiffin box the event of choosing a water bottle.
Here, in both the cases, the events in each problem could occur in various possible orders. But, we have to choose any one of the possible orders and count the number of different ways of the occurence of the events in this chosen order. Example 1 Find the number of 4 letter words, with or without meaning, which can be formed out of the letters of the word ROSE, where the repetition of the letters is not allowed. Solution There are as many words as there are ways of filling in 4 vacant places by the 4 letters, keeping in mind that the repetition is not allowed. The first place can be filled in 4 different ways by anyone of the 4 letters R,O,S,E. Following which, the second place can be filled in by anyone of the remaining 3 letters in 3 different ways, following which the third place can be filled in 2 different ways; following which, the fourth place can be filled in 1 way. Thus, the number of ways in which the 4 places can be filled, by the multiplication principle, is 4 3 2 1 = 24. Hence, the required number of words is 24.
137
Note If the repetition of the letters was allowed, how many words can be formed? One can easily understand that each of the 4 vacant places can be filled in succession in 4 different ways. Hence, the required number of words = 4 4 4 4 = 256.
Example 2 Given 4 flags of different colours, how many different signals can be generated, if a signal requires the use of 2 flags one below the other? Solution There will be as many signals as there are ways of filling in 2 vacant places in succession by the 4 flags of different colours. The upper vacant place can be filled in 4 different ways by anyone of the 4 flags; following which, the lower vacant place can be filled in 3 different ways by anyone of the remaining 3 different flags. Hence, by the multiplication principle, the required number of signals = 4 3 = 12. Example 3 How many 2 digit even numbers can be formed from the digits 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 if the digits can be repeated? Solution There will be as many ways as there are ways of filling 2 vacant places in succession by the five given digits. Here, in this case, we start filling in units place, because the options for this place are 2 and 4 only and this can be done in 2 ways; following which the tens place can be filled by any of the 5 digits in 5 different ways as the digits can be repeated. Therefore, by the multiplication principle, the required number of two digits even numbers is 2 5, i.e., 10. Example 4 Find the number of different signals that can be generated by arranging at least 2 flags in order (one below the other) on a vertical staff, if five different flags are available. Solution A signal can consist of either 2 flags, 3 flags, 4 flags or 5 flags. Now, let us count the possible number of signals consisting of 2 flags, 3 flags, 4 flags and 5 flags separately and then add the respective numbers. There will be as many 2 flag signals as there are ways of filling in 2 vacant places in succession by the 5 flags available. By Multiplication rule, the number of ways is 5 4 = 20. Similarly, there will be as many 3 flag signals as there are ways of filling in 3 vacant places in succession by the 5 flags.
138
MATHEMATICS
The number of ways is 5 4 3 = 60. Continuing the same way, we find that The number of 4 flag signals = 5 4 3 2 = 120 and the number of 5 flag signals = 5 4 3 2 1 = 120 Therefore, the required no of signals = 20 + 60 + 120 + 120 = 320.
EXERCISE 7.1
1. How many 3-digit numbers can be formed from the digits 1, 2, 3, 4 and 5 assuming that (i) (ii) 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. repetition of the digits is allowed? repetition of the digits is not allowed?
How many 3-digit even numbers can be formed from the digits 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 if the digits can be repeated? How many 4-letter code can be formed using the first 10 letters of the English alphabet, if no letter can be repeated? How many 5-digit telephone numbers can be constructed using the digits 0 to 9 if each number starts with 67 and no digit appears more than once? A coin is tossed 3 times and the outcomes are recorded. How many possible outcomes are there? Given 5 flags of different colours, how many different signals can be generated if each signal requires the use of 2 flags, one below the other?
7.3 Permutations
In Example 1 of the previous Section, we are actually counting the different possible arrangements of the letters such as ROSE, REOS, ..., etc. Here, in this list, each arrangement is different from other. In other words, the order of writing the letters is important. Each arrangement is called a permutation of 4 different letters taken all at a time. Now, if we have to determine the number of 3-letter words, with or without meaning, which can be formed out of the letters of the word NUMBER, where the repetition of the letters is not allowed, we need to count the arrangements NUM, NMU, MUN, NUB, ..., etc. Here, we are counting the permutations of 6 different letters taken 3 at a time. The required number of words = 6 5 4 = 120 (by using multiplication principle). If the repetition of the letters was allowed, the required number of words would be 6 6 6 = 216.
139
Definition 1 A permutation is an arrangement in a definite order of a number of objects taken some or all at a time. In the following sub Section, we shall obtain the formula needed to answer these questions immediately. 7.3.1 Permutations when all the objects are distinct Theorem 1 The number of permutations of n different objects taken r at a time, where 0 < r n and the objects do not repeat is n ( n 1) ( n 2). . .( n r + 1), which is denoted by nPr. Proof There will be as many permutations as there are ways of filling in r vacant places ...
r vacant places
by
the n objects. The first place can be filled in n ways; following which, the second place can be filled in (n 1) ways, following which the third place can be filled in (n 2) ways,..., the rth place can be filled in (n (r 1)) ways. Therefore, the number of ways of filling in r vacant places in succession is n(n 1) (n 2) . . . (n (r 1)) or n ( n 1) (n 2) ... (n r + 1) This expression for nPr is cumbersome and we need a notation which will help to reduce the size of this expression. The symbol n! (read as factorial n or n factorial ) comes to our rescue. In the following text we will learn what actually n! means. 7.3.2 Factorial notation The notation n! represents the product of first n natural numbers, i.e., the product 1 2 3 . . . (n 1) n is denoted as n!. We read this symbol as n factorial. Thus, 1 2 3 4 . . . (n 1) n = n ! 1=1! 12=2! 1 2 3 = 3 ! 1 2 3 4 = 4 ! and so on. We define 0 ! = 1 We can write 5 ! = 5 4 ! = 5 4 3 ! = 5 4 3 2 ! = 5 4 3 2 1! Clearly, for a natural number n n ! = n (n 1) ! = n (n 1) (n 2) ! [provided (n 2)] = n (n 1) (n 2) (n 3) ! [provided (n 3)] and so on.
140
MATHEMATICS
(ii) 7 !
(iii) 7 ! 5!
7! 5!
Solution
(i) We have
7 6 5! 7! = = 7 6 = 42 5! 5!
and
(ii)
We have
Example 8 If
1 1 x + = 8! 9! 10! , find x.
1 1 x Solution We have 8! + 9 8! = 10 9 8!
Therefore So
1 x = or 9 10 9 x = 100. 1+
10 x = 9 10 9
EXERCISE 7.2
1. Evaluate (i) 8 ! (ii) 4 ! 3 !
141
2.
Is 3 ! + 4 ! = 7 ! ?
n! Evaluate n r ! , when ( )
3. Compute
8! 6! 2!
4. If
1 1 x + = , find x 6! 7! 8!
5.
(i) n = 6, r = 2
(ii) n = 9, r = 5.
Pr =
n! ,0rn n r )! (
n
Let us now go back to the stage where we had determined the following formula: Pr = n (n 1) (n 2) . . . (n r + 1) Multiplying numerator and denomirator by (n r) (n r 1) . . . 3 2 1, we get
n
Pr =
Thus
Pr =
n! ( n r )! , where 0 < r n
This is a much more convenient expression for nPr than the previous one.
n! = n! 0! Counting permutations is merely counting the number of ways in which some or all objects at a time are rearranged. Arranging no object at all is the same as leaving behind all the objects and we know that there is only one way of doing so. Thus, we can have
In particular, when r = n, n Pn =
n
P0 = 1 =
n! n! = n ! ( n 0)!
... (1)
Pr =
n! ,0r n . ( n r )!
142
MATHEMATICS
Theorem 2 The number of permutations of n different objects taken r at a time, where repetition is allowed, is nr. Proof is very similar to that of Theorem 1 and is left for the reader to arrive at. Here, we are solving some of the problems of the pervious Section using the formula for nPr to illustrate its usefulness. In Example 1, the required number of words = 4P4 = 4! = 24. Here repetition is not allowed. If repeation is allowed, the required number of words would be 44 = 256. The number of 3-letter words which can be formed by the letters of the word
P2 =
7.3.4 Permutations when all the objects are not distinct objects Suppose we have to find the number of ways of rearranging the letters of the word ROOT. In this case, the letters of the word are not all different. There are 2 Os, which are of the same kind. Let us treat, temporarily, the 2 Os as different, say, O1 and O2. The number of permutations of 4-different letters, in this case, taken all at a time is 4!. Consider one of these permutations say, RO 1O2T. Corresponding to this permutation,we have 2 ! permutations RO1O2T and RO2O1T which will be exactly the same permutation if O1 and O2 are not treated as different, i.e., if O1 and O2 are the same O at both places.
TOOR
143
R O1T O 2 R O 2 T O1
ROTO
T O1R O 2 T O 2 R O1
R T O1 O 2 R T O 2 O1
TORO
RTOO
T R O1 O 2 T R O 2 O1
O1 O 2 R T O2 O1 T R
TROO
OORT
O1 R O 2 T O 2 R O1 T
O1 T O 2 R O 2 T O1 R
OROT
OTOR
O1 R T O 2 O 2 R T O1
O1 T R O 2 O 2 T R O1
ORTO
OTRO
O1 O 2 T R O 2 O1 T R
OOTR
Let us now find the number of ways of rearranging the letters of the word INSTITUTE. In this case there are 9 letters, in which I appears 2 times and T appears 3 times. Temporarily, let us treat these letters different and name them as I1, I2, T1, T2, T3. The number of permutations of 9 different letters, in this case, taken all at a time is 9 !. Consider one such permutation, say, I1 NT1 SI2 T2 U E T3. Here if I1, I2 are not same
144
MATHEMATICS
and T1, T2, T3 are not same, then I1, I2 can be arranged in 2! ways and T1, T2, T3 can be arranged in 3! ways. Therefore, 2! 3! permutations will be just the same permutation corresponding to this chosen permutation I1NT1SI2T2UET3. Hence, total number of different permutations will be
9! 2! 3!
We can state (without proof) the following theorems: Theorem 3 The number of permutations of n objects, where p objects are of the same kind and rest are all different =
n! p! .
In fact, we have a more general theorem. Theorem 4 The number of permutations of n objects, where p1 objects are of one kind, p2 are of second kind, ..., pk are of kth kind and the rest, if any, are of different kind is
Example 9 Find the number of permutations of the letters of the word ALLAHABAD. Solution Here, there are 9 objects (letters) of which there are 4As, 2 Ls and rest are all different. Therefore, the required number of arrangements =
9! 5 6 7 8 9 = = 7560 4! 2! 2
Example 10 How many 4-digit numbers can be formed by using the digits 1 to 9 if repetition of digits is not allowed? Solution Here order matters for example 1234 and 1324 are two different numbers. Therefore, there will be as many 4 digit numbers as there are permutations of 9 different digits taken 4 at a time.
9 Therefore, the required 4 digit numbers = P4 =
9! 9! = = 9 8 7 6 = 3024. ( 9 4 )! 5!
Example 11 How many numbers lying between 100 and 1000 can be formed with the digits 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, if the repetition of the digits is not allowed? Solution Every number between 100 and 1000 is a 3-digit number. We, first, have to
145
count the permutations of 6 digits taken 3 at a time. This number would be 6P3. But, these permutations will include those also where 0 is at the 100s place. For example, 092, 042, . . ., etc are such numbers which are actually 2-digit numbers and hence the number of such numbers has to be subtracted from 6P3 to get the required number. To get the number of such numbers, we fix 0 at the 100s place and rearrange the remaining 5 digits taking 2 at a time. This number is 5P2. So The required number
= 6 P3 5 P2 =
6! 5! 3! 3!
(i)
P5 = 42 P3 , n > 4
n
(ii)
n 1
P4 5 = ,n>4 P4 3
n>4
so n(n 1) (n 2) 0
n 1
P4 5 = P4 3
146
MATHEMATICS
4! 5! = 6 ( 4 r )! ( 5 r + 1)!
or or or or or or Hence
5! 6 5! = ( 4 r )! ( 5 r + 1) ( 5 r )( 5 r 1)!
(6 r) (5 r) = 6 r2 11r + 24 = 0 r2 8r 3r + 24 = 0 (r 8) (r 3) = 0 r = 8 or r = 3. r = 8, 3.
Example 14 Find the number of different 8-letter arrangements that can be made from the letters of the word DAUGHTER so that (i) all vowels occur together (ii) all vowels do not occur together. Solution (i) There are 8 different letters in the word DAUGHTER, in which there are 3 vowels, namely, A, U and E. Since the vowels have to occur together, we can for the time being, assume them as a single object (AUE). This single object together with 5 remaining letters (objects) will be counted as 6 objects. Then we count permutations of these 6 objects taken all at a time. This number would be 6P6 = 6!. Corresponding to each of these permutations, we shall have 3! permutations of the three vowels A, U, E taken all at a time . Hence, by the multiplication principle the required number of permutations = 6 ! 3 ! = 4320. (ii) If we have to count those permutations in which all vowels are never together, we first have to find all possible arrangments of 8 letters taken all at a time, which can be done in 8! ways. Then, we have to subtract from this number, the number of permutations in which the vowels are always together.
8 ! 6 ! 3 ! = 6 ! (78 6) = 2 6 ! (28 3) = 50 6 ! = 50 720 = 36000 Example 15 In how many ways can 4 red, 3 yellow and 2 green discs be arranged in a row if the discs of the same colour are indistinguishable ? Therefore, the required number
Solution Total number of discs are 4 + 3 + 2 = 9. Out of 9 discs, 4 are of the first kind
147
(red), 3 are of the second kind (yellow) and 2 are of the third kind (green). Therefore, the number of arrangements
9! = 1260 . 4! 3! 2!
Example 16 Find the number of arrangements of the letters of the word INDEPENDENCE. In how many of these arrangements, (i) do the words start with P (ii) do all the vowels always occur together (iii) do the vowels never occur together (iv) do the words begin with I and end in P? Solution There are 12 letters, of which N appears 3 times, E appears 4 times and D appears 2 times and the rest are all different. Therefore
=
(ii)
11! = 138600 . 3! 2! 4!
for the time
There are 5 vowels in the given word, which are 4 Es and 1 I. Since, they have to always occur together, we treat them as a single object being. This single object together with 7 remaining objects will account for 8 objects. These 8 objects, in which there are 3Ns and 2 Ds, can be rearranged in
=
(iii)
8! 5! = 16800 3! 2! 4!
The required number of arrangements = the total number of arrangements (without any restriction) the number of arrangements where all the vowels occur together.
148
MATHEMATICS
(iv)
= 1663200 16800 = 1646400 Let us fix I and P at the extreme ends (I at the left end and P at the right end). We are left with 10 letters. Hence, the required number of arrangements =
10! = 12600 3! 2! 4!
EXERCISE 7.3
1. How many 3-digit numbers can be formed by using the digits 1 to 9 if no digit is repeated? 2. How many 4-digit numbers are there with no digit repeated? 3. How many 3-digit even numbers can be made using the digits 1, 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, if no digit is repeated? 4. Find the number of 4-digit numbers that can be formed using the digits 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 if no digit is repeated. How many of these will be even? 5. From a committee of 8 persons, in how many ways can we choose a chairman and a vice chairman assuming one person can not hold more than one position? 6. Find n if n 1P3 : nP4 = 1 : 9. 7. Find r if (i) 5 Pr = 2 6 Pr1 (ii) 5 Pr = 6 Pr 1 . 8. How many words, with or without meaning, can be formed using all the letters of the word EQUATION, using each letter exactly once? 9. How many words, with or without meaning can be made from the letters of the word MONDAY, assuming that no letter is repeated, if. (i) 4 letters are used at a time, (ii) all letters are used at a time, (iii) all letters are used but first letter is a vowel? 10. In how many of the distinct permutations of the letters in MISSISSIPPI do the four Is not come together? 11. In how many ways can the letters of the word PERMUTATIONS be arranged if the (i) words start with P and end with S, (ii) vowels are all together, (iii) there are always 4 letters between P and S?
7.4 Combinations
Let us now assume that there is a group of 3 lawn tennis players X, Y, Z. A team consisting of 2 players is to be formed. In how many ways can we do so? Is the team of X and Y different from the team of Y and X ? Here, order is not important. In fact, there are only 3 possible ways in which the team could be constructed.
149
Fig. 7.3
These are XY, YZ and ZX (Fig 7.3). Here, each selection is called a combination of 3 different objects taken 2 at a time. In a combination, the order is not important. Now consider some more illustrations. Twelve persons meet in a room and each shakes hand with all the others. How do we determine the number of hand shakes. X shaking hands with Y and Y with X will not be two different hand shakes. Here, order is not important. There will be as many hand shakes as there are combinations of 12 different things taken 2 at a time. Seven points lie on a circle. How many chords can be drawn by joining these points pairwise? There will be as many chords as there are combinations of 7 different things taken 2 at a time. Now, we obtain the formula for finding the number of combinations of n different objects taken r at a time, denoted by nCr.. Suppose we have 4 different objects A, B, C and D. Taking 2 at a time, if we have to make combinations, these will be AB, AC, AD, BC, BD, CD. Here, AB and BA are the same combination as order does not alter the combination. This is why we have not included BA, CA, DA, CB, DB and DC in this list. There are as many as 6 combinations of 4 different objects taken 2 at a time, i.e., 4C2 = 6. Corresponding to each combination in the list, we can arrive at 2! permutations as 2 objects in each combination can be rearranged in 2! ways. Hence, the number of permutations = 4C2 2!. On the other hand, the number of permutations of 4 different things taken 2 at a time = 4P2. Therefore
4
P2 = 4C2 2! or
4! = 4C2 4 2 )! 2! (
Now, let us suppose that we have 5 different objects A, B, C, D, E. Taking 3 at a time, if we have to make combinations, these will be ABC, ABD, ABE, BCD, BCE, CDE, ACE, ACD, ADE, BDE. Corresponding to each of these 5C3 combinations, there are 3! permutations, because, the three objects in each combination can be
150
MATHEMATICS
P3 = 5C3 3! or
5! = 5 C3 5 3)! 3! (
These examples suggest the following theorem showing relationship between permutaion and combination: Theorem 5 n Pr = n C r r! , 0 < r n. Proof Corresponding to each combination of nCr we have r ! permutations, because r objects in every combination can be rearranged in r ! ways. Hence, the total number of permutations of n different things taken r at a time is nCr r!. On the other hand, it is
n
n r
. Thus
Pr = n C r r! , 0 < r n .
n
Cr =
n! r!( n r )! .
n! = 1. n! 0!
2.
We define nC0 = 1, i.e., the number of combinations of n different things taken nothing at all is considered to be 1. Counting combinations is merely counting the number of ways in which some or all objects at a time are selected. Selecting nothing at all is the same as leaving behind all the objects and we know that there is only one way of doing so. This way we define nC0 = 1. As
3.
Hence
n r
n r (n r ) , 0 r n.
4.
Cn r =
n! n! = n r !r ! = n C r , ( n r )!( n ( n r ) )! ( )
151
Ca = nCb a = b or a = n b, i.e., n = a + b
n
Theorem 6
C r + n C r 1 =
n
n +1
Cr
Proof We have
Cr + n Cr 1 =
n! n! + r ( r 1)!( n r )! ( r 1)!( n r + 1) ( n r )!
1 n! 1 r + n r + 1 ( r 1)!( n r )!
n! n r +1+ r ( n + 1)! = n +1 C = r ( r 1)!( n r )! r ( n r + 1) r!( n + 1 r )!
n
n! n! = 9!( n 9 )! ( n 8 )! 8!
or Therefore
1 1 = 9 n 8
n
or n 8 = 9
C17 = 1 .
or
n = 17
C17 =
17
Example 18 A committee of 3 persons is to be constituted from a group of 2 men and 3 women. In how many ways can this be done? How many of these committees would consist of 1 man and 2 women? Solution Here, order does not matter. Therefore, we need to count combinations. There will be as many committees as there are combinations of 5 different persons
5 taken 3 at a time. Hence, the required number of ways = C3 =
5! 4 5 = = 10 . 3! 2! 2
Now, 1 man can be selected from 2 men in 2C1 ways and 2 women can be selected from 3 women in 3C2 ways. Therefore, the required number of committees
152
MATHEMATICS
2 3 = C1 C2 =
2! 3! = 6. 1! 1! 2! 1!
Example 19 What is the number of ways of choosing 4 cards from a pack of 52 playing cards? In how many of these (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) four cards are of the same suit, four cards belong to four different suits, are face cards, two are red cards and two are black cards, cards are of the same colour?
Solution There will be as many ways of choosing 4 cards from 52 cards as there are combinations of 52 different things, taken 4 at a time. Therefore The required number of ways =
52
C4 =
52! 49 50 51 52 = 4! 48! 2 3 4
= 270725
(i) There are four suits: diamond, club, spade, heart and there are 13 cards of each suit. Therefore, there are 13C4 ways of choosing 4 diamonds. Similarly, there are 13 C4 ways of choosing 4 clubs, 13C4 ways of choosing 4 spades and 13C4 ways of choosing 4 hearts. Therefore The required number of ways = 13C4 + 13C4 + 13C4 + 13C4. = 4 (ii) There are13 cards in each suit. Therefore, there are 13C1 ways of choosing 1 card from 13 cards of diamond, 13 C1 ways of choosing 1 card from 13 cards of hearts, 13C1 ways of choosing 1 card from 13 cards of clubs, 13C1 ways of choosing 1 card from 13 cards of spades. Hence, by multiplication principle, the required number of ways = 13C1 13C1 13C1 13C1 = 134
(iii) There are 12 face cards and 4 are to be slected out of these 12 cards. This can be done in 12C4 ways. Therefore, the required number of ways =
13! = 2860 4! 9!
12! = 495 . 4! 8!
153
(iv) There are 26 red cards and 26 black cards. Therefore, the required number of ways = 26C2 26C2
C 4 ways.
EXERCISE 7.4
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. If nC8 = nC2, find nC2. Determine n if (ii) 2nC3 : nC3 = 11 : 1 (i) 2nC2 : nC2 = 12 : 1 How many chords can be drawn through 21 points on a circle? In how many ways can a team of 3 boys and 3 girls be selected from 5 boys and 4 girls? Find the number of ways of selecting 9 balls from 6 red balls, 5 white balls and 5 blue balls if each selection consists of 3 balls of each colour. Determine the number of 5 card combinations out of a deck of 52 cards if there is exactly one ace in each combination. In how many ways can one select a cricket team of eleven from 17 players in which only 5 players can bowl if each cricket team of 11 must include exactly 4 bowlers? A bag contains 5 black and 6 red balls. Determine the number of ways in which 2 black and 3 red balls can be selected. In how many ways can a student choose a programme of 5 courses if 9 courses are available and 2 specific courses are compulsory for every student?
8. 9.
Miscellaneous Examples
Example 20 How many words, with or without meaning, each of 3 vowels and 2 consonants can be formed from the letters of the word INVOLUTE ? Solution In the word INVOLUTE, there are 4 vowels, namely, I,O,E,Uand 4 consonants, namely, N, V, L and T.
154
MATHEMATICS
The number of ways of selecting 3 vowels out of 4 = 4C3 = 4. The number of ways of selecting 2 consonants out of 4 = 4C2 = 6.
Therefore, the number of combinations of 3 vowels and 2 consonants is 4 6 = 24.
Now, each of these 24 combinations has 5 letters which can be arranged among themselves in 5 ! ways. Therefore, the required number of different words is 24 5 ! = 2880. Example 21 A group consists of 4 girls and 7 boys. In how many ways can a team of 5 members be selected if the team has (i) no girl ? (ii) at least one boy and one girl ? (iii) at least 3 girls ? Solution (i) Since, the team will not include any girl, therefore, only boys are to be selected. 5 boys out of 7 boys can be selected in 7C5 ways. Therefore, the required number of ways (ii)
7! 6 7 7 = C5 = 5! 2! = 2 = 21
Since, at least one boy and one girl are to be there in every team. Therefore, the team can consist of (a) 1 boy and 4 girls (c) 3 boys and 2 girls (b) 2 boys and 3 girls (d) 4 boys and 1 girl.
1 boy and 4 girls can be selected in 7C1 4C4 ways. 2 boys and 3 girls can be selected in 7C2 4C3 ways. 3 boys and 2 girls can be selected in 7C3 4C2 ways. 4 boys and 1 girl can be selected in 7C4 4C1 ways. Therefore, the required number of ways = 7C1 4C4 + 7C2 4C3 + 7C3 4C2 + 7C4 4C1 = 7 + 84 + 210 + 140 = 441 (iii) Since, the team has to consist of at least 3 girls, the team can consist of (a) 3 girls and 2 boys, or (b) 4 girls and 1 boy. Note that the team cannot have all 5 girls, because, the group has only 4 girls. 3 girls and 2 boys can be selected in 4C3 7C2 ways. 4 girls and 1 boy can be selected in 4C4 7C1 ways. Therefore, the required number of ways = 4C3 7C2 + 4C4 7C1 = 84 + 7 = 91
155
Example 22 Find the number of words with or without meaning which can be made using all the letters of the word AGAIN. If these words are written as in a dictionary, what will be the 50th word? Solution There are 5 letters in the word AGAIN, in which A appears 2 times. Therefore, the required number of words =
5! = 60 . 2!
To get the number of words starting with A, we fix the letter A at the extreme left position, we then rearrange the remaining 4 letters taken all at a time. There will be as many arrangements of these 4 letters taken 4 at a time as there are permutations of 4 different things taken 4 at a time. Hence, the number of words starting with
4! = 12 as after placing G 2! at the extreme left position, we are left with the letters A, A, I and N. Similarly, there are 12 words starting with the next letter I. Total number of words so far obtained = 24 + 12 + 12 =48.
A = 4! = 24. Then, starting with G, the number of words = The 49th word is NAAGI. The 50th word is NAAIG. Example 23 How many numbers greater than 1000000 can be formed by using the digits 1, 2, 0, 2, 4, 2, 4? Solution Since, 1000000 is a 7-digit number and the number of digits to be used is also 7. Therefore, the numbers to be counted will be 7-digit only. Also, the numbers have to be greater than 1000000, so they can begin either with 1, 2 or 4. The number of numbers beginning with 1 =
6! 4 5 6 = = 60, as when 1 is 3! 2! 2
fixed at the extreme left position, the remaining digits to be rearranged will be 0, 2, 2, 2, 4, 4, in which there are 3, 2s and 2, 4s. Total numbers begining with 2 =
6! 3 4 5 6 = = 180 2! 2! 2
6! = 4 5 6 = 120 3!
156
MATHEMATICS
Therefore, the required number of numbers = 60 + 180 + 120 = 360. Alternative Method
7! The number of 7-digit arrangements, clearly, 3! 2! = 420 . But, this will include those
numbers also, which have 0 at the extreme left position. The number of such
6! 3! = 4 5 2 3 4 5 6 = 14400.
= 5! 6P3 = 5!
157
5. 6.
7.
8. 9. 10.
11.
listed as in a dictionary, how many words are there in this list before the first word starting with E ? How many 6-digit numbers can be formed from the digits 0, 1, 3, 5, 7 and 9 which are divisible by 10 and no digit is repeated ? The English alphabet has 5 vowels and 21 consonants. How many words with two different vowels and 2 different consonants can be formed from the alphabet ? In an examination, a question paper consists of 12 questions divided into two parts i.e., Part I and Part II, containing 5 and 7 questions, respectively. A student is required to attempt 8 questions in all, selecting at least 3 from each part. In how many ways can a student select the questions ? Determine the number of 5-card combinations out of a deck of 52 cards if each selection of 5 cards has exactly one king. It is required to seat 5 men and 4 women in a row so that the women occupy the even places. How many such arrangements are possible ? From a class of 25 students, 10 are to be chosen for an excursion party. There are 3 students who decide that either all of them will join or none of them will join. In how many ways can the excursion party be chosen ? In how many ways can the letters of the word ASSASSINATION be arranged so that all the Ss are together ?
Summary
Fundamental principle of counting If an event can occur in m different ways, following which another event can occur in n different ways, then the total number of occurrence of the events in the given order is m n. The number of permutations of n different things taken r at a time, where repetition is not allowed, is denoted by nPr and is given by nPr =
n! (n r )! ,
where 0 r n. n! = 1 2 3 ...n n! = n (n 1) ! The number of permutations of n different things, taken r at a time, where repeatition is allowed, is nr. The number of permutations of n objects taken all at a time, where p1 objects
158
MATHEMATICS
are of first kind, p2 objects are of the second kind, ..., pk objects are of the kth
n! kind and rest, if any, are all different is p ! p !... p ! . 1 2 k
Cr , is given by nCr = =
n! r!( n r )! , 0 r n.
Historical Note
The concepts of permutations and combinations can be traced back to the advent of Jainism in India and perhaps even earlier. The credit, however, goes to the Jains who treated its subject matter as a self-contained topic in mathematics, under the name Vikalpa. Among the Jains, Mahavira, (around 850 A.D.) is perhaps the worlds first mathematician credited with providing the general formulae for permutations and combinations. In the 6th century B.C., Sushruta, in his medicinal work, Sushruta Samhita, asserts that 63 combinations can be made out of 6 different tastes, taken one at a time, two at a time, etc. Pingala, a Sanskrit scholar around third century B.C., gives the method of determining the number of combinations of a given number of letters, taken one at a time, two at a time, etc. in his work Chhanda Sutra. Bhaskaracharya (born 1114 A.D.) treated the subject matter of permutations and combinations under the name Anka Pasha in his famous work Lilavati. In addition to the general formulae for nCr and nPr already provided by Mahavira, Bhaskaracharya gives several important theorems and results concerning the subject. Outside India, the subject matter of permutations and combinations had its humble beginnings in China in the famous book IKing (Book of changes). It is difficult to give the approximate time of this work, since in 213 B.C., the emperor had ordered all books and manuscripts in the country to be burnt which fortunately was not completely carried out. Greeks and later Latin writers also did some scattered work on the theory of permutations and combinations. Some Arabic and Hebrew writers used the concepts of permutations and combinations in studying astronomy. Rabbi ben Ezra, for instance, determined the number of combinations of known planets taken two at a time, three at a time and so on. This was around 1140 A.D. It appears that Rabbi ben Ezra did not
159
know the formula for nCr. However, he was aware that nCr = nCnr for specific values n and r. In 1321 A.D., Levi Ben Gerson, another Hebrew writer came up with the formulae for nPr , nPn and the general formula for nCr. The first book which gives a complete treatment of the subject matter of permutations and combinations is Ars Conjectandi written by a Swiss, Jacob Bernoulli (1654 1705 A.D.), posthumously published in 1713 A.D. This book contains essentially the theory of permutations and combinations as is known today.
Chapter
BINOMIAL THEOREM
Mathematics is a most exact science and its conclusions are capable of absolute proofs. C.P. STEINMETZ
8.1 Introduction
In earlier classes, we have learnt how to find the squares and cubes of binomials like a + b and a b. Using them, we could evaluate the numerical values of numbers like (98)2 = (100 2)2, (999)3 = (1000 1)3, etc. However, for higher powers like (98)5, (101)6, etc., the calculations become difficult by using repeated multiplication. This difficulty was overcome by a theorem known as binomial theorem. It gives an easier way to expand (a + b)n, where n is an integer or a rational number. In this Chapter, we study binomial theorem for positive integral indices only.
Let us have a look at the following identities done earlier: (a+ b)0 = 1 a+b0 (a+ b)1 = a + b (a+ b)2 = a2 + 2ab + b2 (a+ b)3 = a3 + 3a2b + 3ab2 + b3 (a+ b)4 = (a + b)3 (a + b) = a4 + 4a3b + 6a2b2 + 4ab3 + b4 In these expansions, we observe that (i) The total number of terms in the expansion is one more than the index. For example, in the expansion of (a + b)2 , number of terms is 3 whereas the index of (a + b)2 is 2. (ii) Powers of the first quantity a go on decreasing by 1 whereas the powers of the second quantity b increase by 1, in the successive terms. (iii) In each term of the expansion, the sum of the indices of a and b is the same and is equal to the index of a + b.
BINOMIAL THEOREM
161
Fig 8.1
Do we observe any pattern in this table that will help us to write the next row? Yes we do. It can be seen that the addition of 1s in the row for index 1 gives rise to 2 in the row for index 2. The addition of 1, 2 and 2, 1 in the row for index 2, gives rise to 3 and 3 in the row for index 3 and so on. Also, 1 is present at the beginning and at the end of each row. This can be continued till any index of our interest. We can extend the pattern given in Fig 8.2 by writing a few more rows.
Fig 8.2
Pascals Triangle
The structure given in Fig 8.2 looks like a triangle with 1 at the top vertex and running down the two slanting sides. This array of numbers is known as Pascals triangle, after the name of French mathematician Blaise Pascal. It is also known as Meru Prastara by Pingla. Expansions for the higher powers of a binomial are also possible by using Pascals triangle. Let us expand (2x + 3y)5 by using Pascals triangle. The row for index 5 is 1 5 10 10 5 1 Using this row and our observations (i), (ii) and (iii), we get (2x + 3y)5 = (2x)5 + 5(2x)4 (3y) + 10(2x)3 (3y)2 +10 (2x)2 (3y)3 + 5(2x)(3y)4 +(3y)5 = 32x5 + 240x4y + 720x3y2 + 1080x2y3 + 810xy4 + 243y5.
162
MATHEMATICS
Now, if we want to find the expansion of (2x + 3y)12, we are first required to get the row for index 12. This can be done by writing all the rows of the Pascals triangle till index 12. This is a slightly lengthy process. The process, as you observe, will become more difficult, if we need the expansions involving still larger powers. We thus try to find a rule that will help us to find the expansion of the binomial for any power without writing all the rows of the Pascals triangle, that come before the row of the desired index. For this, we make use of the concept of combinations studied earlier to rewrite the numbers in the Pascals triangle. We know that
n
Cr =
n! r!(n r )! , 0 r n and
n is a non-negative integer. Also, nC0 = 1 = nCn The Pascals triangle can now be rewritten as (Fig 8.3)
Fig 8.3
Pascals triangle
Observing this pattern, we can now write the row of the Pascals triangle for any index without writing the earlier rows. For example, for the index 7 the row would be
7
Thus, using this row and the observations (i), (ii) and (iii), we have (a + b)7 = 7C0 a7 + 7C1a6b + 7C2a5b2 + 7C3a4b3 + 7C4a3b4 + 7C5a2b5 + 7C6ab6 + 7C7b7 An expansion of a binomial to any positive integral index say n can now be visualised using these observations. We are now in a position to write the expansion of a binomial to any positive integral index.
BINOMIAL THEOREM
163
8.2.1 Binomial theorem for any positive integer n, (a + b)n = nC0an + nC1an1b + nC2an2 b2 + ...+ nCn 1a.bn1 + nCnbn Proof The proof is obtained by applying principle of mathematical induction. Let the given statement be P(n) : (a + b)n = nC0an + nC1an 1b + nC2an 2b2 + ...+ nCn1a.bn 1 + nCnbn For n = 1, we have P (1) : (a + b)1 = 1C0a1 + 1C1b1 = a + b Thus, P (1) is true. Suppose P (k) is true for some positive integer k, i.e. (a + b)k = kC0ak + kC1ak 1b + kC2ak 2b2 + ...+ kCkbk We shall prove that P(k + 1) is also true, i.e., (a + b)k + 1 =
k+1
... (1)
C0 ak + 1 +
k+1
C 1 ak b +
k+1
C2 ak 1b2 + ...+
k+1
Ck+1 bk + 1
Now, (a + b)k + 1 = (a + b) (a + b)k = (a + b) (kC0 ak + kC1ak 1 b + kC2 ak 2 b2 +...+ kCk 1 abk 1 + kCk bk) [from (1)] = kC0 ak + 1 + kC1 akb + kC2ak 1b2 +...+ kCk 1 a2bk 1 + kCk abk + kC0 akb + kC1ak 1b2 + kC2ak 2b3+...+ kCk-1abk + kCkbk + 1 [by actual multiplication] = kC0ak + 1 + (kC1+ kC0) akb + (kC2 + kC1)ak 1b2 + ... + (kCk+ kCk1) abk + kCkbk + 1 (by using
k+1
= k + 1C0a k + 1 + k + 1C1akb + k + 1C2 ak 1b2 +...+ k + 1Ckabk + k + 1Ck + 1 bk +1 C0=1, kCr + kCr1 =
k+1
Cr
and
Ck = 1= k + 1Ck + 1)
Thus, it has been proved that P (k + 1) is true whenever P(k) is true. Therefore, by principle of mathematical induction, P(n) is true for every positive integer n. We illustrate this theorem by expanding (x + 2)6: (x + 2)6 = 6C0x6 + 6C1x5.2 + 6C2x422 + 6C3x3.23 + 6C4x2.24 + 6C5x.25 + 6C6.26. = x6 + 12x5 + 60x4 + 160x3 + 240x2 + 192x + 64 Thus (x + 2)6 = x6 + 12x5 + 60x4 + 160x3 + 240x2 + 192x + 64.
164
MATHEMATICS
k =0
C k a n k b k stands for
C0anb0 + nC1an1b1 + ...+ nC ranrbr + ...+nCnannbn, where b0 = 1 = ann. Hence the theorem can also be stated as
( a + b) n = n C k a n k b k .
k =0
2. 3. 4.
5.
The coefficients Cr occuring in the binomial theorem are known as binomial coefficients. There are (n+1) terms in the expansion of (a+b)n, i.e., one more than the index. In the successive terms of the expansion the index of a goes on decreasing by unity. It is n in the first term, (n1) in the second term, and so on ending with zero in the last term. At the same time the index of b increases by unity, starting with zero in the first term, 1 in the second and so on ending with n in the last term. In the expansion of (a+b)n, the sum of the indices of a and b is n + 0 = n in the first term, (n 1) + 1 = n in the second term and so on 0 + n = n in the last term. Thus, it can be seen that the sum of the indices of a and b is n in every term of the expansion.
8.2.2 Some special cases In the expansion of (a + b)n, (i) Taking a = x and b = y, we obtain (x y)n = [x + (y)]n = nC0xn + nC1xn 1(y) + nC2xn2(y)2 + nC3xn3(y)3 + ... + nCn (y)n = nC0xn nC1xn 1y + nC2xn 2y2 nC3xn 3y3 + ... + (1)n nCn yn Thus (xy)n = nC0xn nC1xn 1 y + nC2xn 2 y2 + ... + (1)n nCn yn Using this, we have (x2y)5 =
5 5
C4 x(2y)4 5C5(2y)5
= x5 10x4y + 40x3y2 80x2y3 + 80xy4 32y5. (ii) Taking a = 1, b = x, we obtain (1 + x)n = nC0(1)n + nC1(1)n 1x + nC2(1)n 2 x2 + ... + nCnxn = nC0 + nC1x + nC2x2 + nC3x3 + ... + nCnxn Thus (1 + x)n = nC0 + nC1x + nC2x2 + nC3x3 + ... + nCnxn
BINOMIAL THEOREM
165
In particular, for x = 1, we have 2n = nC0 + nC1 + nC2 + ... + nCn. (iii) Taking a = 1, b = x, we obtain (1 x)n = nC0 nC1x + nC2x2 ... + ( 1)n nCnxn In particular, for x = 1, we get 0 = nC0 nC1 + nC2 ... + (1)n nCn
2 3 Example 1 Expand x + , x 0 x Solution By using binomial theorem, we have
4
= x8 + 4.x6 .
3 9 27 81 + 6.x4 . 2 + 4.x2. 3 + 4 x x x x
108 81 + . x x4
Solution We express 98 as the sum or difference of two numbers whose powers are easier to calculate, and then use Binomial Theorem. Write 98 = 100 2 Therefore, (98)5 = (100 2)5 = 5C0 (100)5 5C1 (100)4.2 + 5C2 (100)322 5C3 (100)2 (2)3 + 5C4 (100) (2)4 5C5 (2)5 = 10000000000 5 100000000 2 + 10 1000000 4 10 10000 8 + 5 100 16 32 = 10040008000 1000800032 = 9039207968. Example 3 Which is larger (1.01)1000000 or 10,000? Solution Splitting 1.01 and using binomial theorem to write the first few terms we have
166
MATHEMATICS
(1.01)1000000 = (1 + 0.01)1000000 =
1000000
C0 +
1000000
= 1 + 1000000 0.01 + other positive terms = 1 + 10000 + other positive terms > 10000 Hence (1.01)1000000 > 10000
Example 4 Using binomial theorem, prove that 6n5n always leaves remainder 1 when divided by 25. Solution For two numbers a and b if we can find numbers q and r such that a = bq + r, then we say that b divides a with q as quotient and r as remainder. Thus, in order to show that 6n 5n leaves remainder 1 when divided by 25, we prove that 6n 5n = 25k + 1, where k is some natural number. We have (1 + a)n = nC0 + nC1a + nC2a2 + ... + nCnan For a = 5, we get (1 + 5)n = nC0 + nC15 + nC252 + ... + nCn5n i.e. i.e. or or (6)n = 1 + 5n + 52.nC2 + 53.nC3 + ... + 5n 6n 5n = 1+52 (nC2 + nC35 + ... + 5n-2) 6n 5n = 1+ 25 (nC2 + 5 .nC3 + ... + 5n-2) 6n 5n = 25k+1 where k = nC2 + 5 .nC3 + ... + 5n2.
EXERCISE 8.1
Expand each of the expressions in Exercises 1 to 5. 1. (12x)
5
2 x 2. x 2
3. (2x 3)6
BINOMIAL THEOREM
167
x 1 4. + 3 x
1 5. x + x
Using binomial theorem, evaluate each of the following: 6. (96)3 7. (102)5 8. (101)4 9. (99)5 10. Using Binomial Theorem, indicate which number is larger (1.1)10000 or 1000. 11. Find (a + b)4 (a b)4. Hence, evaluate ( 3 + 2)4 ( 3
2 )4 .
12. Find (x + 1)6 + (x 1)6. Hence or otherwise evaluate ( 2 + 1)6 + ( 2 1)6. 13. Show that 9n+1 8n 9 is divisible by 64, whenever n is a positive integer. 14. Prove that
3
r=0
r n
C r = 4n .
8.3
1.
2.
n +1 term. 2 8 For example, in the expansion of (x + 2y)8, the middle term is +1 i.e., 2
5th term. (ii) If n is odd, then n +1 is even, so there will be two middle terms in the
th
th
168
MATHEMATICS
th
7 +1 7 +1 + 1 , i.e., 5th term. , i.e., 4th and (2x y) , the middle terms are 2 2
th th
7
3.
This term is called the term independent of x or the constant term. Example 5 Find a if the 17th and 18th terms of the expansion (2 + a)50 are equal. Solution The (r + 1)th term of the expansion (x + y)n is given by Tr + 1 = nCrxnryr. For the 17th term, we have, r + 1 = 17, i.e., r = 16 Therefore, T17 = T16 + 1 = 50C16 (2)50 16 a16 = 50C 16 234 a16. Similarly, Given that So
50
C 16 . 2 34 C 17 . 2 33
=
Therefore
50
50
a 17 a 16
i.e.,
a=
C16 2
50
C17
BINOMIAL THEOREM
169
2n + 1 , Solution As 2n is even, the middle term of the expansion (1 + x)2n is 2 th i.e., (n + 1) term which is given by,
th
(2n)! n x n! n!
1.2.3.4...(2n 2) (2n 1) (2n) n x n!n! [1.3.5 ... (2n 1)][2.4.6...( 2n)] n x n!n!
1.3.5...( 2n 1) n n 2 x n!
Example 7 Find the coefficient of x6y3 in the expansion of (x + 2y)9. Solution Suppose x6y3 occurs in the (r + 1)th term of the expansion (x + 2y)9. Now Tr+1 = 9Cr x9 r (2y)r = 9Cr 2 r . x9 r . y r . Comparing the indices of x as well as y in x6y3 and in Tr + 1 , we get r = 3. Thus, the coefficient of x6y3 is
9
C3 2 3 =
Example 8 The second, third and fourth terms in the binomial expansion (x + a)n are 240, 720 and 1080, respectively. Find x, a and n. Solution Given that second term T2 = 240
170
MATHEMATICS
We have So Similarly
T2 = nC1xn 1 . a
n n n
(n 1)! a . =6 (n 2)! x
... (4)
or
a 6 = x ( n 1)
a 9 = x 2( n 2)
6 9 = n 1 2 (n 2) .
Hence, from (1), 5x4a = 240, and from (4),
Thus, n = 5
a 3 = x 2
Solving these equations for a and x, we get x = 2 and a = 3. Example 9 The coefficients of three consecutive terms in the expansion of (1 + a)n are in the ratio1: 7 : 42. Find n. Solution Suppose the three consecutive terms in the expansion of (1 + a)n are (r 1)th, rth and (r + 1)th terms. The (r 1)th term is nCr 2 ar 2, and its coefficient is nCr 2. Similarly, the coefficients of rth and (r + 1)th terms are nCr 1 and nCr , respectively. Since the coefficients are in the ratio 1 : 7 : 42, so we have,
n n
Cr 2 1 = , i.e., n 8r + 9 = 0 7 C r 1 C r 1 7 = , i.e., n 7r + 1 = 0 42 Cr
... (1)
and
... (2)
BINOMIAL THEOREM
171
EXERCISE 8.2
Find the coefficient of 1. x5 in (x + 3)8 2. a5b7 in (a 2b)12 . 4. (x2 yx)12, x 0.
18
6.
x 8. + 9 y 3
10
10. The coefficients of the (r 1)th, rth and (r + 1)th terms in the expansion of (x + 1)n are in the ratio 1 : 3 : 5. Find n and r. 11. Prove that the coefficient of xn in the expansion of (1 + x)2n is twice the coefficient of xn in the expansion of (1 + x)2n 1. 12. Find a positive value of m for which the coefficient of x2 in the expansion (1 + x)m is 6.
Miscellaneous Examples
1 3 2 Example 10 Find the term independent of x in the expansion of x . 3x 2 3 2 6 Solution We have Tr + 1 = C r x 2
6r 6
1 3x
2 6r
= Cr
3 2
6r
(x )
( 1)
1 1 r x 3
172
MATHEMATICS
r = ( 1)
Cr
(3)6 2 r 12 3r x (2)6 r
Example 11 If the coefficients of ar 1, ar and ar + 1 in the expansion of (1 + a)n are in arithmetic progression, prove that n2 n(4r + 1) + 4r2 2 = 0. Solution The (r + 1)th term in the expansion is nCrar. Thus it can be seen that ar occurs in the (r + 1)th term, and its coefficient is nCr. Hence the coefficients of ar 1, ar and ar + 1 are nCr 1, nCr and nCr + 1, respectively. Since these coefficients are in arithmetic progression, so we have, nCr 1+ nCr + 1 = 2.nCr. This gives
or
1 (r 1)! (n r 1)!
= 2
1 ( r 1)! (n r 1)![r (n r )]
i.e.
1 1 2 + = (n r + 1) (n r ) r (r + 1) r (n r ) , r (r + 1) + (n r ) (n r + 1) 2 = (n r ) (n r + 1)r (r + 1) r (n r )
r(r + 1) + (n r) (n r + 1) = 2 (r + 1) (n r + 1) r2 + r + n2 nr + n nr + r2 r = 2(nr r2 + r + n r + 1)
or or or
BINOMIAL THEOREM
173
or i.e.,
Example 12 Show that the coefficient of the middle term in the expansion of (1 + x)2n is equal to the sum of the coefficients of two middle terms in the expansion of (1 + x)2n 1. Solution As 2n is even so the expansion (1 + x)2n has only one middle term which is
2n + 1 2
th
The (n + 1)th term is 2nCnxn. The coefficient of xn is 2nCn Similarly, (2n 1) being odd, the other expansion has two middle terms,
2n 1 + 1 2n 1 + 1 + 1 i.e., nth and (n + 1)th terms. The coefficients of and 2 2 2n 1 2n 1 Cn 1 and Cn, respectively. these terms are Now
2n 1
th
th
Cn 1 +
2n 1
Cn= 2nCn
n+1
Cr]. as required.
Example 13 Find the coefficient of a4 in the product (1 + 2a)4 (2 a)5 using binomial theorem. Solution We first expand each of the factors of the given product using Binomial Theorem. We have (1 + 2a)4 = 4C0 + 4C1 (2a) + 4C2 (2a)2 + 4C3 (2a)3 + 4C4 (2a)4 = 1 + 4 (2a) + 6(4a2) + 4 (8a3) + 16a4. = 1 + 8a + 24a2 + 32a3 + 16a4 and (2 a)5 = 5C0 (2)5 5C1 (2)4 (a) + 5C2 (2)3 (a)2 5C3 (2)2 (a)3 + 5C4 (2) (a)4 5C5 (a)5 = 32 80a + 80a2 40a3 + 10a4 a5 Thus (1 + 2a)4 (2 a)5 = (1 + 8a + 24a2 + 32a3+ 16a4) (32 80a + 80a2 40a3 + 10a4 a5) The complete multiplication of the two brackets need not be carried out. We write only those terms which involve a4. This can be done if we note that ar. a4 r = a4. The terms containing a4 are 1 (10a4) + (8a) (40a3) + (24a2) (80a2) + (32a3) ( 80a) + (16a4) (32) = 438a4
174
MATHEMATICS
Thus, the coefficient of a4 in the given product is 438. Example 14 Find the rth term from the end in the expansion of (x + a)n. Solution There are (n + 1) terms in the expansion of (x + a)n. Observing the terms we can say that the first term from the end is the last term, i.e., (n + 1)th term of the expansion and n + 1 = (n + 1) (1 1). The second term from the end is the nth term of the expansion, and n = (n + 1) (2 1). The third term from the end is the (n 1)th term of the expansion and n 1 = (n + 1) (3 1) and so on. Thus rth term from the end will be term number (n + 1) (r 1) = (n r + 2) of the expansion. And the (n r + 2)th term is nCn r + 1 xr 1 an r + 1.
3 1 Example 15 Find the term independent of x in the expansion of x + 3 , x > 0. 2 x
18
Solution We have Tr + 1 =
18
Cr
( )
3
18 r
1 3 2 x
18
Cr x
18 r 3
. 2
r
1
r 3 .x
18
C2
1 .x 2r
18 2 r 3
Since we have to find a term independent of x, i.e., term not having x, so take We get r = 9. The required term is 18C9
18 2r =0. 3
1 . 29
Example 16 The sum of the coefficients of the first three terms in the expansion of
3 x 2 , x 0, m being a natural number, is 559. Find the term of the expansion x containing x3. 3 Solution The coefficients of the first three terms of x 2 are mC0, (3) mC1 x m and 9 C2. Therefore, by the given condition, we have
m
9m (m 1) = 559 2
BINOMIAL THEOREM
175
Cr x12 r
3 2 = x
12
Cr ( 3)r . x12 3r
Since we need the term containing x3, so put 12 3r = 3 i.e., r = 3. Thus, the required term is 12C3 ( 3)3 x3, i.e., 5940 x3. Example 17 If the coefficients of (r 5)th and (2r 1)th terms in the expansion of (1 + x)34 are equal, find r. Solution The coefficients of (r 5)th and (2r 1)th terms of the expansion (1 + x)34 are 34Cr 6 and 34C2r 2, respectively. Since they are equal so 34Cr 6 = 34C2r 2 Therefore, either r 6 = 2r 2 or r6 = 34 (2r 2) [Using the fact that if nCr = nCp, then either r = p or r = n p] So, we get r = 4 or r = 14. r being a natural number, r = 4 is not possible. So, r = 14.
3+ 2
) (
6
3 2
4
) (
n
+ a2 a2 1 .
7. Find an approximation of (0.99)5 using the first three terms of its expansion. 8. Find n, if the ratio of the fifth term from the beginning to the fifth term from the
4 1 end in the expansion of 2 + 4 is 3
6 :1 .
176
MATHEMATICS
x 2 9. Expand using Binomial Theorem 1 + , x 0 . 2 x 2 2 3 10. Find the expansion of (3x 2ax + 3a ) using binomial theorem.
Summary
The expansion of a binomial for any positive integral n is given by Binomial Theorem, which is (a + b) n = n C 0 a n + n C 1 a n 1b + n C 2 a n 2b 2 + ...+ n Cn 1a.bn 1 + nCnbn. The coefficients of the expansions are arranged in an array. This array is called Pascals triangle. The general term of an expansion (a + b)n is Tr + 1 = nCran r. br.
th
n +1 n+1 +1 terms. term.If n is odd, then the middle terms are and 2 2
th th
Historical Note
The ancient Indian mathematicians knew about the coefficients in the expansions of (x + y)n, 0 n 7. The arrangement of these coefficients was in the form of a diagram called Meru-Prastara, provided by Pingla in his book Chhanda shastra (200B.C.). This triangular arrangement is also found in the work of Chinese mathematician Chu-shi-kie in 1303 A.D. The term binomial coefficients was first introduced by the German mathematician, Michael Stipel (1486-1567A.D.) in approximately 1544 A.D. Bombelli (1572 A.D.) also gave the coefficients in the expansion of (a + b)n, for n = 1,2 ...,7 and Oughtred (1631 A.D.) gave them for n = 1, 2,..., 10. The arithmetic triangle, popularly known as Pascals triangle and similar to the Meru-Prastara of Pingla was constructed by the French mathematician Blaise Pascal (1623-1662 A.D.) in 1665. The present form of the binomial theorem for integral values of n appeared in Trate du triange arithmetic, written by Pascal and published posthumously in 1665 A.D.
Chapter
9.1 Introduction
In mathematics, the word, sequence is used in much the same way as it is in ordinary English. When we say that a collection of objects is listed in a sequence, we usually mean that the collection is ordered in such a way that it has an identified first member, second member, third member and so on. For example, population of human beings or bacteria at different times form a sequence. The amount of money deposited in a bank, over a number of years form a sequence. Depreciated values of certain commodity occur in a sequence. Sequences have important applications in several Fibonacci (1175-1250) spheres of human activities. Sequences, following specific patterns are called progressions. In previous class, we have studied about arithmetic progression (A.P). In this Chapter, besides discussing more about A.P.; arithmetic mean, geometric mean, relationship between A.M. and G.M., special series in forms of sum to n terms of consecutive natural numbers, sum to n terms of squares of natural numbers and sum to n terms of cubes of natural numbers will also be studied.
9.2 Sequences
Let us consider the following examples: Assume that there is a generation gap of 30 years, we are asked to find the number of ancestors, i.e., parents, grandparents, great grandparents, etc. that a person might have over 300 years. Here, the total number of generations = 300 = 10 30
178
MATHEMATICS
The number of persons ancestors for the first, second, third, , tenth generations are 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, , 1024. These numbers form what we call a sequence. Consider the successive quotients that we obtain in the division of 10 by 3 at different steps of division. In this process we get 3,3.3,3.33,3.333, ... and so on. These quotients also form a sequence. The various numbers occurring in a sequence are called its terms. We denote the terms of a sequence by a1, a2, a3, , an, , etc., the subscripts denote the position of the term. The nth term is the number at the nth position of the sequence and is denoted by an. The nth term is also called the general term of the sequence. Thus, the terms of the sequence of persons ancestors mentioned above are: a1 = 2, a2 = 4, a3 = 8, , a10 = 1024. Similarly, in the example of successive quotients a1 = 3, a2 = 3.3, a3 = 3.33, , a6 = 3.33333, etc. A sequence containing finite number of terms is called a finite sequence. For example, sequence of ancestors is a finite sequence since it contains 10 terms (a fixed number). A sequence is called infinite, if it is not a finite sequence. For example, the sequence of successive quotients mentioned above is an infinite sequence, infinite in the sense that it never ends. Often, it is possible to express the rule, which yields the various terms of a sequence in terms of algebraic formula. Consider for instance, the sequence of even natural numbers 2, 4, 6, Here a1 = 2 = 2 1 a2 = 4 = 2 2 a3 = 6 = 2 3 .... .... .... .... .... .... a4 = 8 = 2 4 .... .... .... .... .... ....
a23 = 46 = 2 23, a24 = 48 = 2 24, and so on. In fact, we see that the nth term of this sequence can be written as an = 2n, where n is a natural number. Similarly, in the sequence of odd natural numbers 1,3,5, , the nth term is given by the formula, an = 2n 1, where n is a natural number. In some cases, an arrangement of numbers such as 1, 1, 2, 3, 5, 8,.. has no visible pattern, but the sequence is generated by the recurrence relation given by a1 = a2 = 1 a3 = a1 + a2 a n = a n 2 + a n 1, n > 2 This sequence is called Fibonacci sequence.
179
In the sequence of primes 2,3,5,7,, we find that there is no formula for the nth prime. Such sequence can only be described by verbal description. In every sequence, we should not expect that its terms will necessarily be given by a specific formula. However, we expect a theoretical scheme or a rule for generating the terms a1, a2, a3,,an, in succession. In view of the above, a sequence can be regarded as a function whose domain is the set of natural numbers or some subset of it of the type {1, 2, 3...k}. Sometimes, we use the functional notation a(n) for an.
9.3 Series
Let a1, a2, a3,,an, be a given sequence. Then, the expression a1 + a2 + a3 +,+ an + ... is called the series associated with the given sequence .The series is finite or infinite according as the given sequence is finite or infinite. Series are often represented in compact form, called sigma notation, using the Greek letter (sigma) as means of indicating the summation involved. Thus, the series a1 + a2 + a3 + ... + an is abbreviated as
ak .
k =1
Remark When the series is used, it refers to the indicated sum not to the sum itself. For example, 1 + 3 + 5 + 7 is a finite series with four terms. When we use the phrase sum of a series, we will mean the number that results from adding the terms, the sum of the series is 16. We now consider some examples. Example 1 Write the first three terms in each of the following sequences defined by the following: (i) an = 2n + 5, (ii) an =
n3 . 4
Solution (i) Here an = 2n + 5 Substituting n = 1, 2, 3, we get a1 = 2(1) + 5 = 7, a2 = 9, a3 = 11 Therefore, the required terms are 7, 9 and 11. (ii) Here an =
n3 1 3 1 1 = , a2 = , a3 = 0 . Thus, a1 = 4 4 2 4
180
MATHEMATICS
Hence, the first three terms are 1 , 1 and 0. 2 4 Example 2 What is the 20th term of the sequence defined by an = (n 1) (2 n) (3 + n) ? Solution Putting n = 20 , we obtain a20 = (20 1) (2 20) (3 + 20) = 19 ( 18) (23) = 7866. Example 3 Let the sequence an be defined as follows: a1 = 1, an = an 1 + 2 for n 2. Find first five terms and write corresponding series. Solution We have a1 = 1, a2 = a1 + 2 = 1 + 2 = 3, a3 = a2 + 2 = 3 + 2 = 5, a4 = a3 + 2 = 5 + 2 = 7, a5 = a4 + 2 = 7 + 2 = 9. Hence, the first five terms of the sequence are 1,3,5,7 and 9. The corresponding series is 1 + 3 + 5 + 7 + 9 +...
EXERCISE 9.1
Write the first five terms of each of the sequences in Exercises 1 to 6 whose nth terms are: 1. an = n (n + 2) 2. an =
n n +1
3. an = 2n 6. a n = n
4.
an =
2n 3 6
5.
an = (1)n1 5n+1
n2 + 5 . 4
Find the indicated terms in each of the sequences in Exercises 7 to 10 whose nth terms are: 7. an = 4n 3; a17, a24
9. an = (1)n 1n3; a9
181
Write the first five terms of each of the sequences in Exercises 11 to 13 and obtain the corresponding series: 11. a1 = 3, an = 3an 1 + 2 for all n > 1 13. a1 = a2 = 2, an = an 11, n > 2 14. The Fibonacci sequence is defined by 1 = a1 = a2 and an = an 1 + an 2, n > 2. Find 12. a1 = 1, an =
an 1 ,n2 n
an +1 an , for n = 1, 2, 3, 4, 5
182
MATHEMATICS
Sn =
We can also write, Sn =
n [ 2a + (n 1)d ] 2 n [a + l ] 2
Let us consider some examples. Example 4 In an A.P. if mth term is n and the nth term is m, where m n, find the pth term. Solution We have am = a + (m 1) d = n, and an = a + (n 1) d = m Solving (1) and (2), we get (m n) d = n m, or d = 1, and a= n+m1 Therefore a p = a + (p 1)d = n + m 1 + ( p 1) (1) = n + m p Hence, the pth term is n + m p. Example 5 If the sum of n terms of an A.P. is nP + are constants, find the common difference. Solution Let a1, a2, an be the given A.P. Then Sn = a1 + a2 + a3 +...+ an1 + an = nP + ... (1) ... (2) ... (3) ... (4)
1 n (n 1) Q 2
Therefore S1 = a1 = P, S2 = a1 + a2 = 2P + Q So that a 2 = S2 S 1 = P + Q Hence, the common difference is given by d = a2 a1 = (P + Q) P = Q. Example 6 The sum of n terms of two arithmetic progressions are in the ratio (3n + 8) : (7n + 15). Find the ratio of their 12th terms. Solution Let a1, a2 and d1, d2 be the first terms and common difference of the first and second arithmetic progression, respectively. According to the given condition, we have
183
or
or
2a1 + ( n 1) d1 3n + 8 = 2a2 + ( n 1) d 2 7n + 15
12th term of first A.P. a +11d1 = 1 th 12 term of second A.P a2 +11d 2
... (1)
Now
Hence, the required ratio is 7 : 16. Example 7 The income of a person is Rs. 3,00,000, in the first year and he receives an increase of Rs.10,000 to his income per year for the next 19 years. Find the total amount, he received in 20 years. Solution Here, we have an A.P. with a = 3,00,000, d = 10,000, and n = 20. Using the sum formula, we get,
20 [600000 + 19 10000] = 10 (790000) = 79,00,000. 2 Hence, the person received Rs. 79,00,000 as the total amount at the end of 20 years. S20 =
9.4.1 Arithmetic mean Given two numbers a and b. We can insert a number A between them so that a, A, b is an A.P. Such a number A is called the arithmetic mean (A.M.) of the numbers a and b. Note that, in this case, we have A a = b A, i.e., A =
a+b 2
We may also interpret the A.M. between two numbers a and b as their average
a +b . For example, the A.M. of two numbers 4 and 16 is 10. We have, thus 2
constructed an A.P. 4, 10, 16 by inserting a number 10 between 4 and 16. The natural
184
MATHEMATICS
question now arises : Can we insert two or more numbers between given two numbers so that the resulting sequence comes out to be an A.P. ? Observe that two numbers 8 and 12 can be inserted between 4 and 16 so that the resulting sequence 4, 8, 12, 16 becomes an A.P. More generally, given any two numbers a and b, we can insert as many numbers as we like between them such that the resulting sequence is an A.P. Let A1, A2, A3, , An be n numbers between a and b such that a, A1, A2, A3, , An, b is an A.P. Here, b is the (n + 2) th term, i.e., b = a + [(n + 2) 1]d = a + (n + 1) d. This gives
d=
ba . n +1 ba n +1 2(b a ) n +1
A2 = a + 2d = a +
3(b a ) n +1
..... .....
An = a + nd = a +
n (b a ) n +1 .
Example 8 Insert 6 numbers between 3 and 24 such that the resulting sequence is an A.P. Solution Let A1, A2, A3, A4, A5 and A6 be six numbers between 3 and 24 such that 3, A1, A2, A3, A4, A5, A6, 24 are in A.P. Here, a = 3, b = 24, n = 8. Therefore, 24 = 3 + (8 1) d, so that d = 3. Thus A1 = a + d = 3 + 3 = 6; A2 = a + 2d = 3 + 2 3 = 9; A3 = a + 3d = 3 + 3 3 = 12; A4 = a + 4d = 3 + 4 3 = 15; A5 = a + 5d = 3 + 5 3 = 18; A6 = a + 6d = 3 + 6 3 = 21. Hence, six numbers between 3 and 24 are 6, 9, 12, 15, 18 and 21.
185
EXERCISE 9.2
1. Find the sum of odd integers from 1 to 2001. 2. Find the sum of all natural numbers lying between 100 and 1000, which are multiples of 5. 3. In an A.P., the first term is 2 and the sum of the first five terms is one-fourth of the next five terms. Show that 20th term is 112. 4. How many terms of the A.P. 6,
6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11.
1 (pq +1), where p q. 2 If the sum of a certain number of terms of the A.P. 25, 22, 19, is 116. Find the last term. Find the sum to n terms of the A.P., whose kth term is 5k + 1. If the sum of n terms of an A.P. is (pn + qn2), where p and q are constants, find the common difference. The sums of n terms of two arithmetic progressions are in the ratio 5n + 4 : 9n + 6. Find the ratio of their 18th terms. If the sum of first p terms of an A.P. is equal to the sum of the first q terms, then find the sum of the first (p + q) terms. Sum of the first p, q and r terms of an A.P are. a, b and c, respectively.
terms is Prove that
a b c ( q r ) + ( r p ) + ( p q) = 0 p q r
12. The ratio of the sums of m and n terms of an A.P. is m2 : n2. Show that the ratio of mth and nth term is (2m 1) : (2n 1). 13. If the sum of n terms of an A.P. is 3n2 + 5n and its mth term is 164, find the value of m. 14. Insert five numbers between 8 and 26 such that the resulting sequence is an A.P. 15. If
16. Between 1 and 31, m numbers have been inserted in such a way that the resulting sequence is an A. P. and the ratio of 7th and (m 1)th numbers is 5 : 9. Find the value of m.
186
MATHEMATICS
17. A man starts repaying a loan as first instalment of Rs. 100. If he increases the instalment by Rs 5 every month, what amount he will pay in the 30th instalment? 18. The difference between any two consecutive interior angles of a polygon is 5. If the smallest angle is 120 , find the number of the sides of the polygon.
In each of these sequences, how their terms progress? We note that each term, except the first progresses in a definite order. In (i), we have and so on.
1 it. In (i), this constant ratio is 2; in (ii), it is and in (iii), the constant ratio is 0.01. 3 Such sequences are called geometric sequence or geometric progression abbreviated as G.P. A sequence a1, a2, a3, , an, is called geometric progression, if each term is
non-zero and
ak + 1 ak
= r (constant), for k 1.
By letting a1 = a, we obtain a geometric progression, a, ar, ar2, ar3,., where a is called the first term and r is called the common ratio of the G.P. Common ratio in
1 and 0.01, respectively. 3 As in case of arithmetic progression, the problem of finding the nth term or sum of n terms of a geometric progression containing a large number of terms would be difficult without the use of the formulae which we shall develop in the next Section. We shall use the following notations with these formulae: a = the first term, r = the common ratio, l = the last term,
geometric progression (i), (ii) and (iii) above are 2,
187
n = the numbers of terms, Sn = the sum of n terms. 9.5.1 General term of a G .P. Let us consider a G.P. with first non-zero term a and common ratio r. Write a few terms of it. The second term is obtained by multiplying a by r, thus a2 = ar. Similarly, third term is obtained by multiplying a2 by r. Thus, a3 = a2r = ar2, and so on. We write below these and few more terms. 1st term = a1 = a = ar11, 2nd term = a2 = ar = ar21, 3rd term = a3 = ar2 = ar31 4th term = a4 = ar3 = ar41, 5th term = a5 = ar4 = ar51 Do you see a pattern? What will be 16th term? a16 = ar161 = ar15 Therefore, the pattern suggests that the nth term of a G.P. is given by
an = ar n1 .
Thus, a, G.P. can be written as a, ar, ar2, ar3, arn 1; a, ar, ar2,...,arn 1... ;according as G.P. is finite or infinite, respectively. The series a + ar + ar2 + ... + arn1 or a + ar + ar2 + ... + arn1 +...are called finite or infinite geometric series, respectively. 9.5.2. Sum to n terms of a G .P. Let the first term of a G.P. be a and the common ratio be r. Let us denote by Sn the sum to first n terms of G.P. Then Sn = a + ar + ar2 +...+ arn1 ... (1) Case 1 If r = 1, we have Sn = a + a + a + ... + a (n terms) = na Case 2 If r 1, multiplying (1) by r, we have rSn = ar + ar2 + ar3 + ... + arn Subtracting (2) from (1), we get (1 r) Sn = a arn = a(1 rn)
Sn = a (1 r n ) 1 r
... (2)
This gives
a( r n 1) r 1 th th Example 9 Find the 10 and n terms of the G.P. 5, 25,125, . Solution Here a = 5 and r = 5. Thus, a10 = 5(5)101 = 5(5)9 = 510 and an = arn1 = 5(5)n1 = 5n .
or
Sn =
Example10 Which term of the G.P., 2,8,32, ... up to n terms is 131072? Solution Let 131072 be the nth term of the given G.P. Here a = 2 and r = 4. Therefore 131072 = an = 2(4)n 1 or 65536 = 4n 1 This gives 48 = 4n 1. So that n 1 = 8, i.e., n = 9. Hence, 131072 is the 9th term of the G.P.
188
MATHEMATICS
Example11 In a G.P., the 3rd term is 24 and the 6th term is 192.Find the 10th term. Solution Here, a3 = ar = 24
2 5
... (1)
and a6 = ar = 192 ... (2) Dividing (2) by (1), we get r = 2. Substituting r = 2 in (1), we get a = 6. Hence a10 = 6 (2)9 = 3072. Example12 Find the sum of first n terms and the sum of first 5 terms of the geometric
2 4 series 1 + + + ... 3 9
Solution Here a = 1 and r =
2 . Therefore 3
2 n 1 n a (1 r n ) 3 3 1 2 = Sn = = 2 3 1 r 1 3
2 5 211 In particular, S5 = 3 1 = 3 243 3
211 . 81
3 3 Example 13 How many terms of the G.P. 3, , ,... are needed to give the 2 4 3069 sum 512 ?
Solution Let n be the number of terms needed. Given that a = 3, r = Since
Sn = a (1 r n ) 1 r
Therefore
3069 = 512
3(1
1 ) 2n = 6 1 1 n 1 2 1 2
189
or or or
1 3069 = 1 n 2 3072 1 3069 3 1 1 = = n = 3072 3072 1024 2 2n = 1024 = 210, which gives n = 10.
Example 14 The sum of first three terms of a G.P. is Find the common ratio and the terms. Solution Let
... (2)
1 13 1 r = or 12r2 + 25r + 12 = 0. r 12
This is a quadratic in r, solving, we get r =
3 4 or . 4 3 4 3 3 3 4 4 and , 1, for r = , Thus, the three terms of G.P. are : , 1, for r = 3 4 4 4 3 3 Example15 Find the sum of the sequence 7, 77, 777, 7777, ... to n terms.
Solution This is not a G.P., however, we can relate it to a G.P. by writing the terms as Sn = 7 + 77 + 777 + 7777 + ... to n terms = =
7 [9 + 99 + 999 + 9999 + ...to n term] 9 7 [(10 1) + (102 1) + (103 1) + (104 1) + ...n terms] 9
190
MATHEMATICS
7 10 (10n 1) 7 10(10n 1) n = n . 9 10 1 9 9 Example 16 A person has 2 parents, 4 grandparents, 8 great grandparents, and so on. Find the number of his ancestors during the ten generations preceding his own.
We have S10 = 2(210 1) = 2046 Hence, the number of ancestors preceding the person is 2046. 9.5.3 Geometric Mean (G .M.) The geometric mean of two positive numbers a and b is the number ab . Therefore, the geometric mean of 2 and 8 is 4. We observe that the three numbers 2,4,8 are consecutive terms of a G.P. This leads to a generalisation of the concept of geometric means of two numbers. Given any two positive numbers a and b, we can insert as many numbers as we like between them to make the resulting sequence in a G.P. Let G1, G2,, Gn be n numbers between positive numbers a and b such that a,G1,G2,G3,,Gn,b is a G.P. Thus, b being the (n + 2)th term,we have
b = ar
n +1
or
1
b n + 1 . r= a b n+1 G 3 = ar = a , a
3 3
Hence
2 b n+1 G1 = ar = a , b n+1 2 G 2 = ar = a , a a
b n +1 G n = ar n = a a
Example17 Insert three numbers between 1 and 256 so that the resulting sequence is a G.P. Solution Let G1, G2,G3 be three numbers between 1 and 256 such that 1, G1,G2,G3 ,256 is a G.P.
191
Therefore 256 = r4 giving r = 4 (Taking real roots only) For r = 4, we have G1 = ar = 4, G2 = ar2 = 16, G3 = ar3 = 64 Similarly, for r = 4, numbers are 4,16 and 64. Hence, we can insert, 4, 16, 64 or 4, 16, 64, between 1 and 256 so that the resulting sequences are in G.P.
A=
Thus, we have
a+b and G = ab 2
AG=
a +b a + b 2 ab ab = 2 2
a b
... (1)
Example 18 If A.M. and G.M. of two positive numbers a and b are 10 and 8, respectively, find the numbers. Solution Given that and From (1) and (2), we get a + b = 20 ... (3) ab = 64 ... (4) 2 Putting the value of a and b from (3), (4) in the identity (a b) = (a + b)2 4ab, we get (a b)2 = 400 256 = 144 or a b = 12 ... (5) Solving (3) and (5), we obtain a = 4, b = 16 or a = 16, b = 4 Thus, the numbers a and b are 4, 16 or 16, 4 respectively.
A.M. =
a+b =10 2
G.M. = ab = 8
192
MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 9.3
1. Find the 20th and nth terms of the G.P. 2. 3. 4. 5.
5 5 5 , , , ... 2 4 8 Find the 12th term of a G.P. whose 8th term is 192 and the common ratio is 2. The 5 th, 8 th and 11 th terms of a G.P. are p, q and s, respectively. Show that q2 = ps. The 4th term of a G.P. is square of its second term, and the first term is 3. Determine its 7th term. Which term of the following sequences:
2, 2 2 , 4,... is 128 ?
(a) (c)
(b)
1 1 1 1 , , ,... is ? 3 9 27 19683
2 2 , x, are in G.P.? 7 7 Find the sum to indicated number of terms in each of the geometric progressions in Exercises 7 to 10: 7. 0.15, 0.015, 0.0015, ... 20 terms.
6. For what values of x, the numbers 8. 7 , 21 , 3 7 , ... n terms. 9. 1, a, a2, a3, ... n terms (if a 1). 10. x3, x5, x7, ... n terms (if x 1). 11. Evaluate
(2 + 3k ) .
k =1
11
39 12. The sum of first three terms of a G.P. is and their product is 1. Find the 10 common ratio and the terms. 13. How many terms of G.P. 3, 32, 33, are needed to give the sum 120? 14. The sum of first three terms of a G.P. is 16 and the sum of the next three terms is 128. Determine the first term, the common ratio and the sum to n terms of the G.P. 15. Given a G.P. with a = 729 and 7th term 64, determine S7. 16. Find a G.P. for which sum of the first two terms is 4 and the fifth term is 4 times the third term. 17. If the 4th, 10th and 16th terms of a G.P. are x, y and z, respectively. Prove that x, y, z are in G.P.
193
18. Find the sum to n terms of the sequence, 8, 88, 888, 8888 . 19. Find the sum of the products of the corresponding terms of the sequences 2, 4, 8,
1 . 2 Show that the products of the corresponding terms of the sequences a, ar, ar2, arn 1 and A, AR, AR2, ARn 1 form a G.P, and find the common ratio. Find four numbers forming a geometric progression in which the third term is greater than the first term by 9, and the second term is greater than the 4th by 18. If the pth, qth and rth terms of a G.P. are a, b and c, respectively. Prove that aq r br pcP q = 1. If the first and the nth term of a G.P. are a and b, respectively, and if P is the product of n terms, prove that P2 = (ab)n. Show that the ratio of the sum of first n terms of a G.P. to the sum of terms from
16, 32 and 128, 32, 8, 2, (n + 1)th to (2n)th term is
1 . rn 25. If a, b, c and d are in G.P. show that (a2 + b2 + c2) (b2 + c2 + d2) = (ab + bc + cd)2 . 26. Insert two number between 3 and 81 so that the resulting sequence is G.P.
a and b. 28. The sum of two numbers is 6 times their geometric means, show that numbers are in the ratio 3 + 2 2 : 3 2 2 . 29. If A and G be A.M. and G.M., respectively between two positive numbers, prove that the numbers are A ( A + G )( A G ) .
)(
30. The number of bacteria in a certain culture doubles every hour. If there were 30 bacteria present in the culture originally, how many bacteria will be present at the end of 2nd hour, 4th hour and nth hour ? 31. What will Rs 500 amounts to in 10 years after its deposit in a bank which pays annual interest rate of 10% compounded annually? 32. If A.M. and G.M. of roots of a quadratic equation are 8 and 5, respectively, then obtain the quadratic equation.
194
MATHEMATICS
n (n + 1) 2
(ii) Here Sn= 12 + 22 + 32 + + n2 We consider the identity k3 (k 1)3 = 3k2 3k + 1 Putting k = 1, 2 successively, we obtain 13 03 = 3 (1)2 3 (1) + 1 23 13 = 3 (2)2 3 (2) + 1 33 23 = 3(3)2 3 (3) + 1 ....................................... ....................................... ...................................... n3 (n 1)3 = 3 (n)2 3 (n) + 1 Adding both sides, we get n3 03 = 3 (12 + 22 + 32 + ... + n2) 3 (1 + 2 + 3 + ... + n) + n
n3 = 3 k 2 3 k + n
k 1 k 1 n n
k =1 + 2 + 3 + ... + n =
k =1
n (n + 1) 2
Hence Sn = =
k 2 = 3 n3 +
k =1
3n (n + 1) 1 n = (2n3 + 3n 2 + n) 2 6
n (n +1)(2n + 1) 6 (iii) Here Sn = 13 + 23 + ...+n3 We consider the identity, (k + 1)4 k4 = 4k3 + 6k2 + 4k + 1 Putting k = 1, 2, 3 n, we get
195
24 14 = 4(1)3 + 6(1)2 + 4(1) + 1 34 24 = 4(2)3 + 6(2)2 + 4(2) + 1 44 34 = 4(3)3 + 6(3)2 + 4(3) + 1 .................................................. .................................................. .................................................. (n 1)4 (n 2)4 = 4(n 2)3 + 6(n 2)2 + 4(n 2) + 1 n4 (n 1)4 = 4(n 1)3 + 6(n 1)2 + 4(n 1) + 1 (n + 1)4 n4 = 4n3 + 6n2 + 4n + 1 Adding both sides, we get (n + 1)4 14 = 4(13 + 23 + 33 +...+ n3) + 6(12 + 22 + 32 + ...+ n2) + 4(1 + 2 + 3 +...+ n) + n
= 4 k3 + 6 k2 + 4 k + n
k =1 k =1 k =1 n n n
... (1)
k =1
k =
n
n (n + 1) 2
and
k =1
k2 =
n (n + 1) (2n + 1) 6
6n (n + 1) (2n + 1) 4n (n + 1) n 6 2
or
Hence,
Example 19 Find the sum to n terms of the series: 5 + 11 + 19 + 29 + 41 Solution Let us write or On subtraction, we get Sn = 5 + 11 + 19 + 29 + ... + an1 + an Sn = 5 + 11 + 19 + ... + an2 + an1 + an
196
MATHEMATICS
0 = 5 + [6 + 8 + 10 + 12 + ...(n 1) terms] an or an = 5 +
(n 1)[12 + (n 2) 2] 2
= 5 + (n 1) (n + 4) = n2 + 3n + 1 Hence
2 2 Sn = ak = ( k + 3k + 1) = k + 3 k + n k =1 k =1 k =1 1 n n n n
Example 20 Find the sum to n terms of the series whose nth term is n (n+3). Solution Given that an = n (n + 3) = n2 + 3n Thus, the sum to n terms is given by Sn =
ak = k 2 + 3 k
k =1 k =1 k =1
EXERCISE 9.4
Find the sum to n terms of each of the series in Exercises 1 to 7. 1. 1 2 + 2 3 + 3 4 + 4 5 +... 3. 3 12 + 5 22 + 7 32 + ... 5. 52 + 62 + 72 + ... + 202 7. 12 + (12 + 22) + (12 + 22 + 32) + ... Find the sum to n terms of the series in Exercises 8 to 10 whose nth terms is given by 8. n (n+1) (n+4). 10. (2n 1) 2 9. n2 + 2n 2. 1 2 3 + 2 3 4 + 3 4 5 + ... 4.
1 1 1 + + + 1 2 2 3 3 4 ...
6. 3 8 + 6 11 + 9 14 + ...
197
Miscellaneous Examples
Example21 If pth, qth, r th and sth terms of an A.P. are in G.P, then show that (p q), (q r), (r s) are also in G.P. Solution Here ap = a + (p 1) d aq = a + (q 1) d ar = a + (r 1) d as = a + (s 1) d Given that ap, aq, ar and as are in G.P., So
aq ap = ar aq ar q r = = aq a p aq p q (why ?)
... (5)
Similarly
ar as ar as r s = = = aq ar aq ar q r
(why ?)
... (6)
Let a x = b y = c z = k Then a = kx , b = ky and c = kz. Since a, b, c are in G.P., therefore, b2 = ac Using (1) in (2), we get k2y = kx + z, which gives 2y = x + z. Hence, x, y and z are in A.P. Solution
Example 23 If a, b, c, d and p are different real numbers such that (a2 + b2 + c2)p2 2(ab + bc + cd) p + (b2 + c2 + d2) 0, then show that a, b, c and d are in G.P. Solution Given that (a2 + b2 + c2) p2 2 (ab + bc + cd) p + (b2 + c2 + d2) 0 ... (1)
198
MATHEMATICS
But L.H.S. = (a2p2 2abp + b2) + (b2p2 2bcp + c2) + (c2p2 2cdp + d2), which gives (ap b)2 + (bp c)2 + (cp d)2 0 ... (2)
Since the sum of squares of real numbers is non negative, therefore, from (1) and (2), we have, (ap b)2 + (bp c)2 + (cp d)2 = 0 or ap b = 0, bp c = 0, cp d = 0
b c d = = =p a b c
Hence a, b, c and d are in G.P. Example 24 If p,q,r are in G.P. and the equations, px2 + 2qx + r = 0 and dx2 + 2ex + f = 0 have a common root, then show that Solution
d e f , , are in A.P. p q r
Since p ,q, r are in G.P. q2 = pr. Thus x = dx2 + 2ex + f = 0 (Why ?). Therefore
q q d + 2e + f = 0, p p
or
... (1)
2e d f d 2e fp = + + = 0, or q p r p q pr
Hence
d e f , , are in A.P. p q r
199
8. The sum of some terms of G.P. is 315 whose first term and the common ratio are 5 and 2, respectively. Find the last term and the number of terms. 9. The first term of a G.P. is 1. The sum of the third term and fifth term is 90. Find the common ratio of G.P. 10. The sum of three numbers in G.P. is 56. If we subtract 1, 7, 21 from these numbers in that order, we obtain an arithmetic progression. Find the numbers. 11. A G.P. consists of an even number of terms. If the sum of all the terms is 5 times the sum of terms occupying odd places, then find its common ratio. 12. The sum of the first four terms of an A.P. is 56. The sum of the last four terms is 112. If its first term is 11, then find the number of terms. 13. If
14. Let S be the sum, P the product and R the sum of reciprocals of n terms in a G.P. Prove that P2Rn = Sn. 15. The pth, qth and rth terms of an A.P. are a, b, c, respectively. Show that (q r )a + (r p )b + (p q )c = 0
1 1 1 1 1 1 16. If a + ,b + ,c + are in A.P., prove that a, b, c are in A.P. b c c a a b 17. If a, b, c, d are in G.P, prove that (an + bn), (bn + cn), (cn + dn) are in G.P. 18. If a and b are the roots of x2 3x + p = 0 and c, d are roots of x2 12x + q = 0, where a, b, c, d form a G.P. Prove that (q + p) : (q p) = 17:15.
200
MATHEMATICS
19. The ratio of the A.M. and G.M. of two positive numbers a and b, is m : n. Show that a : b = m + m2 n 2 : m m2 n 2
)(
).
1 1 1 20. If a, b, c are in A.P.; b, c, d are in G.P. and , , are in A.P. prove that a, c, e c d e are in G.P. 21. Find the sum of the following series up to n terms: (i) 5 + 55 +555 + (ii) .6 +. 66 +. 666+ 22. Find the 20th term of the series 2 4 + 4 6 + 6 8 + ... + n terms. 23. Find the sum of the first n terms of the series: 3+ 7 +13 +21 +31 + 24. If S1, S2, S3 are the sum of first n natural numbers, their squares and their
cubes, respectively, show that 9 S2 = S3 (1 + 8S1). 2 25. Find the sum of the following series up to n terms:
13 13 + 22 13 + 23 + 33 + + + ... 1 1+ 3 1+ 3 + 5
28.
29.
30.
31. 32.
1 22 + 2 32 + ... + n (n + 1) 2 3n + 5 = 12 2 + 22 3 + ... + n2 (n + 1) 3n + 1 . A farmer buys a used tractor for Rs 12000. He pays Rs 6000 cash and agrees to pay the balance in annual instalments of Rs 500 plus 12% interest on the unpaid amount. How much will the tractor cost him? Shamshad Ali buys a scooter for Rs 22000. He pays Rs 4000 cash and agrees to pay the balance in annual instalment of Rs 1000 plus 10% interest on the unpaid amount. How much will the scooter cost him? A person writes a letter to four of his friends. He asks each one of them to copy the letter and mail to four different persons with instruction that they move the chain similarly. Assuming that the chain is not broken and that it costs 50 paise to mail one letter. Find the amount spent on the postage when 8th set of letter is mailed. A man deposited Rs 10000 in a bank at the rate of 5% simple interest annually. Find the amount in 15th year since he deposited the amount and also calculate the total amount after 20 years. A manufacturer reckons that the value of a machine, which costs him Rs. 15625, will depreciate each year by 20%. Find the estimated value at the end of 5 years. 150 workers were engaged to finish a job in a certain number of days. 4 workers dropped out on second day, 4 more workers dropped out on third day and so on.
201
It took 8 more days to finish the work. Find the number of days in which the work was completed.
Summary
By a sequence, we mean an arrangement of a number in a definite order according to some rule. Also, we define a sequence as a function whose domain is the set of natural numbers or some subsets of the type {1, 2, 3....k). A sequence containing a finite number of terms is called a finite sequence. A sequence is called infinite if it is not a finite sequence. Let a1, a2, a3, ... be the sequence, then the sum expressed as a1 + a2 + a3 + ... is called series. A series is called finite series if it has got finite number of terms. An arithmetic progression (A.P.) is a sequence in which terms increase or decrease regularly by the same constant. This constant is called common difference of the A.P. Usually, we denote the first terms of A.P. by a, the common difference by d and the last term by l. The general term or the nth term of the A.P. is given by an = a + (n 1) d. The sum Sn of the first n terms of an A.P. is given by
The arithmetic mean A of any two numbers a and b is given by sequence a, A, b is in A.P.
A sequence is said to be a geometric progression or G.P., if the ratio of any term to its preceding term is same throughout. This constant factor is called the common ratio. Usually, we denote the first term of a G.P. by a and its common ratio by r. The general or the nth term of G.P. is given by an= arn 1. The sum Sn of the first n terms of G.P. is given by
202
MATHEMATICS
a rn 1 Sn = r 1
) or a (1 r ) , if r 1
n
1r
The geometric mean (G.M.) of any two positive numbers a and b is given by
Historical Note
Evidence is found that Babylonians, some 4000 years ago, knew of arithmetic and geometric sequences. According to Boethius (510 A.D.), arithmetic and geometric sequences were known to early Greek writers. Among the Indian mathematician, Aryabhatta (476 A.D.) was the first to give the formula for the sum of squares and cubes of natural numbers in his famous work Aryabhatiyam, written around 499 A.D. He also gave the formula for finding the sum to n terms of an arithmetic sequence starting with p th term. Noted Indian mathematicians Brahmgupta (598 A.D.), Mahavira (850 A.D.) and Bhaskara (1114-1185 A.D.) also considered the sum of squares and cubes. Another specific type of sequence having important applications in mathematics, called Fibonacci sequence, was discovered by Italian mathematician Leonardo Fibonacci (1170-1250 A.D.). Seventeenth century witnessed the classification of series into specific forms. In 1671 A.D. James Gregory used the term infinite series in connection with infinite sequence. It was only through the rigorous development of algebraic and set theoretic tools that the concepts related to sequence and series could be formulated suitably.
Chapter
10
STRAIGHT LINES
G eometry, as a logical system, is a means and even the most powerful means to make children feel the strength of the human spirit that is of their own spirit. H. FREUDENTHAL
10.1 Introduction
We are familiar with two-dimensional coordinate geometry from earlier classes. Mainly, it is a combination of algebra and geometry. A systematic study of geometry by the use of algebra was first carried out by celebrated French philosopher and mathematician Ren Descartes, in his book La Gomtry, published in 1637. This book introduced the notion of the equation of a curve and related analytical methods into the study of geometry. The resulting combination of analysis and geometry is referred now as analytical geometry. In the earlier classes, we initiated Ren Descartes the study of coordinate geometry, where we studied about (1596 -1650) coordinate axes, coordinate plane, plotting of points in a plane, distance between two points, section formule, etc. All these concepts are the basics of coordinate geometry. Let us have a brief recall of coordinate geometry done in earlier classes. To recapitulate, the location of the points (6, 4) and (3, 0) in the XY-plane is shown in Fig 10.1. We may note that the point (6, 4) is at 6 units distance from the y-axis measured along the positive x-axis and at 4 units distance from the x-axis measured along the negative y-axis. Similarly, the point (3, 0) is at 3 units distance from the y-axis measured along the positive x-axis and has zero distance from the x-axis. Fig 10.1 We also studied there following important formulae:
204
MATHEMATICS
PQ =
(x
x1 ) + ( y2 y1 )
2
( 3 6 )2 + ( 0 + 4 )2 =
9 + 16 = 5 units.
II. The coordinates of a point dividing the line segment joining the points (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) internally, in the ratio m: n are
m x 2 + n x1 m y 2 + n y1 . , m+n m+n
1.( 3) + 3.1 =0 1+ 3
For example, the coordinates of the point which divides the line segment joining A (1, 3) and B (3, 9) internally, in the ratio 1: 3 are given by x = and y =
1.9 + 3.( 3) = 0. 1+ 3
III. In particular, if m = n, the coordinates of the mid-point of the line segment joining the points (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) are
x1 + x2 y1 + y 2 , . 2 2
IV. Area of the triangle whose vertices are (x1, y1), (x2, y2) and (x3, y3) is
1 x1 ( y 2 y 3 ) + x 2 ( y 3 y 1 ) + x 3 ( y1 y 2 ) . 2 For example, the area of the triangle, whose vertices are (4, 4), (3, 2) and ( 3, 16) is
54 1 4( 2 16) + 3(16 4) + (3)(4 + 2) = = 27. 2 2
Remark If the area of the triangle ABC is zero, then three points A, B and C lie on a line, i.e., they are collinear. In the this Chapter, we shall continue the study of coordinate geometry to study properties of the simplest geometric figure straight line. Despite its simplicity, the line is a vital concept of geometry and enters into our daily experiences in numerous interesting and useful ways. Main focus is on representing the line algebraically, for which slope is most essential.
STRAIGHT LINES
205
The angle (say) made by the line l with positive direction of x-axis and measured anti clockwise is called the inclination of the line. Obviously 0 180 (Fig 10.2). We observe that lines parallel to x-axis, or coinciding with x-axis, have inclination of 0. The inclination of a vertical line (parallel to or coinciding with y-axis) is 90. Definition 1 If is the inclination of a line l, then tan is called the slope or gradient of Fig 10.2 the line l. The slope of a line whose inclination is 90 is not defined. The slope of a line is denoted by m. Thus, m = tan , 90 It may be observed that the slope of x-axis is zero and slope of y-axis is not defined. 10.2.1 Slope of a line when coordinates of any two points on the line are given We know that a line is completely determined when we are given two points on it. Hence, we proceed to find the slope of a line in terms of the coordinates of two points on the line. Let P(x 1, y 1 ) and Q(x 2, y 2 ) be two points on non-vertical line l whose inclination is . Obviously, x1 x2, otherwise the line will become perpendicular to x-axis and its slope will not be defined. The inclination of the line l may be acute or obtuse. Let us take these two cases. Draw perpendicular QR to x-axis and PM perpendicular to RQ as shown in Figs. 10.3 (i) and (ii). Case 1 When angle is acute: In Fig 10.3 (i), MPQ = . Therefore, slope of line l = m = tan . But in MPQ, we have tan =
Fig 10. 3 (i)
... (1)
MQ y2 y1 = . MP x2 x1
... (2)
206
MATHEMATICS
m=
y2 y1 . x2 x1
Case II When angle is obtuse: In Fig 10.3 (ii), we have MPQ = 180 . Therefore, = 180 MPQ. Now, slope of the line l
Fig 10. 3 (ii)
y2 y1 MQ y y . = 2 1 = x2 x1 MP x1 x2
Consequently, we see that in both the cases the slope m of the line through the points (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) is given by m =
y2 y1 . x2 x1
10.2.2 Conditions for parallelism and perpendicularity of lines in terms of their slopes In a coordinate plane, suppose that non-vertical lines l1 and l2 have slopes m1 and m2, respectively. Let their inclinations be and , respectively. If the line l1 is parallel to l2 (Fig 10.4), then their inclinations are equal, i.e., = , and hence, tan = tan Therefore m1 = m2, i.e., their slopes are equal. Conversely, if the slope of two lines l1 and l2 is same, i.e., m1 = m2. Then tan = tan .
Fig 10. 4
By the property of tangent function (between 0 and 180), = . Therefore, the lines are parallel.
STRAIGHT LINES
207
Hence, two non vertical lines l1 and l2 are parallel if and only if their slopes are equal. If the lines l1 and l2 are perpendicular (Fig 10.5), then = + 90. Therefore,tan = tan ( + 90) = cot = i.e.,
1 tan
m1 m2 = 1
1 m2 = m 1
or
Conversely, if m1 m2 = 1, i.e., tan tan = 1. Then tan = cot = tan ( + 90) or tan ( 90) Fig 10. 5 Therefore, and differ by 90. Thus, lines l1 and l2 are perpendicular to each other. Hence, two non-vertical lines are perpendicular to each other if and only if their slopes are negative reciprocals of each other, i.e., m2=
1 or, m1 m2 = 1. m1
m=
4 ( 2) 6 3 = = . 1 3 4 2
(b) The slope of the line through the points (3, 2) and (7, 2) is
m=
2 ( 2) 0 = = 0. 73 4
(c) The slope of the line through the points (3, 2) and (3, 4) is
208
MATHEMATICS
4 ( 2) 6 = , which is not defined. 33 0 (d) Here inclination of the line = 60. Therefore, slope of the line is m=
m = tan 60 =
3.
10.2.3 Angle between two lines When we think about more than one line in a plane, then we find that these lines are either intersecting or parallel. Here we will discuss the angle between two lines in terms of their slopes. Let L1 and L2 be two non-vertical lines with slopes m1 and m2, respectively. If 1 and 2 are the inclinations of lines L1 and L2, respectively. Then
(as 1 + m1m2 0)
m2 m1 , as 1 + m1m2 0 1 + m1m2
Fig 10. 6
STRAIGHT LINES
209
Case I If
m 2 m1 is positive, then tan will be positive and tan will be negative, 1 + m1 m 2 m 2 m1 is negative, then tan will be negative and tan will be positive, 1 + m1 m 2
which means that will be obtuse and will be acute. Thus, the acute angle (say ) between lines L1 and L2 with slopes m1 and m2, respectively, is given by
tan = m 2 m1 , as 1 + m1m 2 0 1 + m1m 2
... (1)
The obtuse angle (say ) can be found by using =1800 . Example 2 If the angle between two lines is
the slope of the other line. Solution We know that the acute angle between two lines with slopes m1 and m2 is given by Let m1 =
tan = m2 m1 1 + m1m 2
... (1)
1 , m2 = m and = . 4 2
1 2 1 2
tan = 4
1 1+ m 2
or 1 =
1 1+ m 2
which gives
1 1 m 2 = 1 or 2 = 1. 1 1 1+ 1+ m m 2 2 m
1 Therefore m = 3 or m = . 3
210
MATHEMATICS
Fig 10. 7
Example 3 Line through the points (2, 6) and (4, 8) is perpendicular to the line through the points (8, 12) and (x, 24). Find the value of x. Solution Slope of the line through the points ( 2, 6) and (4, 8) is
m1 =
86 2 1 = = 4 ( 2 ) 6 3
Slope of the line through the points (8, 12) and (x, 24) is
Fig 10. 8
STRAIGHT LINES
211
Example 4 Three points P (h, k), Q (x1, y1) and R (x2, y2) lie on a line. Show that (h x1) (y2 y1) = (k y1) (x2 x1). Solution Since points P, Q and R are collinear, we have Slope of PQ = Slope of QR, i.e.,
y1 k y y = 2 1 x1 h x2 x1
or or
k y1 y 2 y1 = h x1 x2 x1 ,
(h x1) (y2 y1) = (k y1) (x2 x1).
Example 5 In Fig 10.9, time and distance graph of a linear motion is given. Two positions of time and distance are recorded as, when T = 0, D = 2 and when T = 3, D = 8. Using the concept of slope, find law of motion, i.e., how distance depends upon time. Solution Let (T, D) be any point on the line, where D denotes the distance at time T. Therefore, points (0, 2), (3, 8) and (T, D) are collinear so that
Fig 10.9
6 (T 3) = 3 (D 8)
EXERCISE 10.1
1. Draw a quadrilateral in the Cartesian plane, whose vertices are ( 4, 5), (0, 7), (5, 5) and ( 4, 2). Also, find its area. 2. The base of an equilateral triangle with side 2a lies along the y-axis such that the mid-point of the base is at the origin. Find vertices of the triangle. 3. Find the distance between P (x1, y1) and Q (x2, y2) when : (i) PQ is parallel to the y-axis, (ii) PQ is parallel to the x-axis. 4. Find a point on the x-axis, which is equidistant from the points (7, 6) and (3, 4). 5. Find the slope of a line, which passes through the origin, and the mid-point of the line segment joining the points P (0, 4) and B (8, 0).
212
MATHEMATICS
6. Without using the Pythagoras theorem, show that the points (4, 4), (3, 5) and (1, 1) are the vertices of a right angled triangle. 7. Find the slope of the line, which makes an angle of 30 with the positive direction of y-axis measured anticlockwise. 8. Find the value of x for which the points (x, 1), (2,1) and (4, 5) are collinear. 9. Without using distance formula, show that points ( 2, 1), (4, 0), (3, 3) and (3, 2) are the vertices of a parallelogram. 10. Find the angle between the x-axis and the line joining the points (3,1) and (4,2). 11. The slope of a line is double of the slope of another line. If tangent of the angle between them is
12. A line passes through (x1, y1) and (h, k). If slope of the line is m, show that k y1 = m (h x1). 13. If three points (h, 0), (a, b) and (0, k) lie on a line, show that
a b + = 1. h k
14. Consider the following population and year graph (Fig 10.10), find the slope of the line AB and using it, find what will be the population in the year 2010?
Fig 10.10
STRAIGHT LINES
213
How can we say that a given point lies on the given line? Its answer may be that for a given line we should have a definite condition on the points lying on the line. Suppose P (x, y) is an arbitrary point in the XY-plane and L is the given line. For the equation of L, we wish to construct a statement or condition for the point P that is true, when P is on L, otherwise false. Of course the statement is merely an algebraic equation involving the variables x and y. Now, we will discuss the equation of a line under different conditions. 10.3.1 Horizontal and vertical lines If a horizontal line L is at a distance a from the x-axis then ordinate of every point lying on the line is either a or a [Fig 10.11 (a)]. Therefore, equation of the line L is either y = a or y = a. Choice of sign will depend upon the position of the line according as the line is above or below the y-axis. Similarly, the equation of a vertical line at a distance b from the x-axis is either x = b or x = b [Fig 10.11(b)].
Fig 10.11
Example 6 Find the equations of the lines parallel to axes and passing through ( 2, 3). Solution Position of the lines is shown in the Fig 10.12. The y-coordinate of every point on the line parallel to x-axis is 3, therefore, equation of the line parallel tox-axis and passing through ( 2, 3) is y = 3. Similarly, equation of the line parallel to y-axis and passing through ( 2, 3) is x = 2.
Fig 10.12
214
MATHEMATICS
10.3.2 Point-slope form Suppose that P0 (x0, y0) is a fixed point on a non-vertical line L, whose slope is m. Let P (x, y) be an arbitrary point on L (Fig 10.13). Then, by the definition, the slope of L is given by
m=
y y0 , i.e., y y 0 = m ( x x 0 ) x x0
...(1)
Since the point P0 (x0 , y0) along with all points (x, y) on L satisfies (1) and no other point in the plane satisfies (1). Equation (1) is indeed the equation for the given line L.
Fig 10.13
Thus, the point (x, y) lies on the line with slope m through the fixed point (x0, y0), if and only if, its coordinates satisfy the equation y y0 = m (x x0) Example 7 Find the equation of the line through ( 2, 3) with slope 4. Solution Here m = 4 and given point (x0 , y0) is ( 2, 3). By slope-intercept form formula (1) above, equation of the given line is y 3 = 4 (x + 2) or 4x + y + 5 = 0, which is the required equation. 10.3.3 Two-point form Let the line L passes through two given points P1 (x1, y1) and P2 (x2, y2). Let P (x, y) be a general point on L (Fig 10.14). The three points P1, P2 and P are collinear, therefore, we have slope of P1P = slope of P1P2
Fig 10.14
i.e.,
y y1 y 2 y1 = , x x1 x 2 x1
or y y 1 =
y 2 y1 ( x x1 ). x 2 x1
STRAIGHT LINES
215
Thus, equation of the line passing through the points (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) is given by
y y1 =
y 2 y1 ( x x1) x 2 x1
... (2)
Example 8 Write the equation of the line through the points (1, 1) and (3, 5). Solution Here x1 = 1, y1 = 1, x2 = 3 and y2 = 5. Using two-point form (2) above for the equation of the line, we have
y ( 1) =
or
5 ( 1) (x 1) 3 1
10.3.4 Slope-intercept form Sometimes a line is known to us with its slope and an intercept on one of the axes. We will now find equations of such lines. Case I Suppose a line L with slope m cuts the y-axis at a distance c from the origin (Fig10.15). The distance c is called the yintercept of the line L. Obviously, coordinates of the point where the line meet the y-axis are (0, c). Thus, L has slope m and passes through a fixed point (0, c). Therefore, by point-slope form, the equation of L is y c = m ( x 0 ) or y = mx + c Thus, the point (x, y) on the line with slope Fig 10.15 m and y-intercept c lies on the line if and only if y = mx + c ...(3) Note that the value of c will be positive or negative according as the intercept is made on the positive or negative side of the y-axis, respectively. Case II Suppose line L with slope m makes x-intercept d. Then equation of L is ... (4) Students may derive this equation themselves by the same method as in Case I. Example 9 Write the equation of the lines for which tan = inclination of the line and (i) y-intercept is
y = m( x d )
1 , where is the 2
3 (ii) x-intercept is 4. 2
216
MATHEMATICS
1 3 and y - intercept c = . 2 2
y=
which is the required equation.
1 3 x or 2 y x + 3 = 0 , 2 2 1 and d = 4. 2
y=
1 ( x 4) or 2 y x + 4 = 0 , 2
which is the required equation. 10.3.5 Intercept - form Suppose a line L makes x-intercept a and y-intercept b on the axes. Obviously L meets x-axis at the point (a, 0) and y-axis at the point (0, b) (Fig .10.16). By two-point form of the equation of the line, we have
y0=
i.e.,
b0 (x a) or ay = bx + ab , 0a
x y + = 1. a b
Fig 10.16
Thus, equation of the line making intercepts a and b on x-and y-axis, respectively, is
x y + =1 a b
... (5)
Example 10 Find the equation of the line, which makes intercepts 3 and 2 on the x- and y-axes respectively. Solution Here a = 3 and b = 2. By intercept form (5) above, equation of the line is
x y + =1 3 2
or
2x 3 y + 6 = 0 .
STRAIGHT LINES
217
10.3.6 Normal form Suppose a non-vertical line is known to us with following data: (i) Length of the perpendicular (normal) from origin to the line. (ii) Angle which normal makes with the positive direction of x-axis. Let L be the line, whose perpendicular distance from origin O be OA = p and the angle between the positive x-axis and OA be XOA = . The possible positions of line L in the Cartesian plane are shown in the Fig 10.17. Now, our purpose is to find slope of L and a point on it. Draw perpendicular AM on the x-axis in each case.
Fig 10.17
In each case, we have OM = p cos and MA = p sin , so that the coordinates of the point A are (p cos , p sin ). Further, line L is perpendicular to OA. Therefore The slope of the line L = Thus, the line L has slope
218
MATHEMATICS
y p sin =
or x cos + y sin = p. Hence, the equation of the line having normal distance p from the origin and angle which the normal makes with the positive direction of x-axis is given by x cos + y sin = p ... (6) Example 11 Find the equation of the line whose perpendicular distance from the origin is 4 units and the angle which the normal makes with positive direction of x-axis is 15. Solution Here, we are given p = 4 and = 150 (Fig10.18).
Now and
cos 15 = sin 15 =
3 +1 2 2 3 1 (Why?) 2 2
Fig 10.18
3 +1 x +
) (
3 1 y = 8 2.
Example 12 The Fahrenheit temperature F and absolute temperature K satisfy a linear equation. Given that K = 273 when F = 32 and that K = 373 when F = 212. Express K in terms of F and find the value of F, when K = 0. Solution Assuming F along x-axis and K along y-axis, we have two points (32, 273) and (212, 373) in XY-plane. By two-point form, the point (F, K) satisfies the equation
K 273 =
or
STRAIGHT LINES
219
0=
5 ( F 32 ) + 273 9
or F 32 =
273 9 = 491.4 5
or F= 459.4 .
Alternate method We know that simplest form of the equation of a line is y = mx + c. Again assuming Falong x-axis and K along y-axis, we can take equation in the form K = mF + c ... (1) Equation (1) is satisfied by (32, 273) and (212, 373). Therefore 273 = 32m + c ... (2) and 373 = 212m + c Solving (2) and (3), we get m= ... (3)
5 2297 and c = . 9 9
... (4)
Note We know, that the equation y = mx + c, contains two constants, namely, m and c. For finding these two constants, we need two conditions satisfied by the equation of line. In all the examples above, we are given two conditions to determine the equation of the line.
EXERCISE 10.2
In Exercises 1 to 8, find the equation of the line which satisfy the given conditions: 1. Write the equations for the x-and y-axes. 2. Passing through the point ( 4, 3) with slope 3. Passing through (0, 0) with slope m. 4. Passing through 2, 2 3 and inclined with the x-axis at an angle of 75o. 5. Intersecting the x-axis at a distance of 3 units to the left of origin with slope 2. 6. Intersecting the y-axis at a distance of 2 units above the origin and making an angle of 30o with positive direction of the x-axis. 7. Passing through the points (1, 1) and (2, 4).
1 . 2
220
MATHEMATICS
8. Perpendicular distance from the origin is 5 units and the angle made by the perpendicular with the positive x-axis is 300. 9. The vertices of PQR are P (2, 1), Q (2, 3) and R (4, 5). Find equation of the median through the vertex R. 10. Find the equation of the line passing through (3, 5) and perpendicular to the line through the points (2, 5) and (3, 6). 11. A line perpendicular to the line segment joining the points (1, 0) and (2, 3) divides it in the ratio 1: n. Find the equation of the line. 12. Find the equation of a line that cuts off equal intercepts on the coordinate axes and passes through the point (2, 3). 13. Find equation of the line passing through the point (2, 2) and cutting off intercepts on the axes whose sum is 9. 14.
15. 16.
17.
18.
2 with the 3 positive x-axis. Also, find the equation of line parallel to it and crossing the y-axis at a distance of 2 units below the origin. The perpendicular from the origin to a line meets it at the point (2, 9), find the equation of the line. The length L (in centimetrs) of a copper rod is a linear function of its Celsius temperature C. In an experiment, if L = 124.942 when C = 20 and L= 125.134 when C = 110, express L in terms of C. The owner of a milk store finds that, he can sell 980 litres of milk each week at Rs 14/litre and 1220 litres of milk each week at Rs 16/litre. Assuming a linear relationship between selling price and demand, how many litres could he sell weekly at Rs 17/litre? P (a, b) is the mid-point of a line segment between axes. Show that equation
Find equation of the line through the point (0, 2) making an angle of the line is
x y + = 2. a b
19. Point R (h, k) divides a line segment between the axes in the ratio 1: 2. Find equation of the line. 20. By using the concept of equation of a line, prove that the three points (3, 0), ( 2, 2) and (8, 2) are collinear.
STRAIGHT LINES
221
Therefore, any equation of the form Ax + By + C = 0, where A and B are not zero simultaneously is called general linear equation or general equation of a line. 10.4.1 Different forms of Ax + By + C = 0 The general equation of a line can be reduced into various forms of the equation of a line, by the following procedures: (a) Slope-intercept form If B 0, then Ax + By + C = 0 can be written as
y=
where
A C x or y = mx + c B B
... (1)
A C and c = . B B We know that Equation (1) is the slope-intercept form of the equation of a line m= A C , and y-intercept is . B B
whose slope is
If B = 0, then x = x-intercept is
C . A
where
a=
C C and b = . A B
We know that equation (1) is intercept form of the equation of a line whose x-intercept is
C C and y-intercept is . A B
If C = 0, then Ax + By + C = 0 can be written as Ax + By = 0, which is a line passing through the origin and, therefore, has zero intercepts on the axes. (c) Normal form Let x cos + y sin = p be the normal form of the line represented by the equation Ax + By + C = 0 or Ax + By = C. Thus, both the equations are same and therefore,
A B C = = p cos sin
222
MATHEMATICS
which gives
2
cos =
2
Ap Bp and sin = . C C
2
Now
Ap sin + cos = C
2 p =
( ) ( )
Bp + C
C or p =
2
=1
or Therefore
C 2 2 A +B
2 A +B
cos =
A
2 2 A +B
and sin =
B
2 2 A +B
Thus, the normal form of the equation Ax + By + C = 0 is x cos + y sin = p, where cos =
A A +B
2 2
, sin =
B A +B
2 2
and p =
C
2 A +B 2
Proper choice of signs is made so that p should be positive. Example 13 Equation of a line is 3x 4y + 10 = 0. Find its (i) slope, (ii) x - and y-intercepts. Solution (i) Given equation 3x 4y + 10 = 0 can be written as
y=
3 5 x+ 4 2
... (1)
Comparing (1) with y = mx + c, we have slope of the given line as m = (ii) Equation 3x 4y + 10 = 0 can be written as
3 x 4 y = 10 or x y + =1 10 5 3 2
3 . 4
... (2)
5 . 2
STRAIGHT LINES
223
3x + y 8 = 0
Dividing (1) by
... (1)
( 3)
+ (1)2 = 2 , we get
3 1 x + y = 4 or cos 30 x + sin 30 y = 4 ... (2) 2 2 Comparing (2) with x cos + y sin = p, we get p = 4 and = 30.
Example15 Find the angle between the lines y 3 x 5 = 0 and Solution Given lines are
3y x + 6 = 0 .
y 3 x 5 = 0 or y = 3 x + 5
and
3 y x + 6 = 0 or y = 3 x 2 3
1 . 3
tan =
... (3)
which gives = 30. Hence, angle between two lines is either 30 or 180 30 = 150. Example 16 Show that two lines a1 x + b1 y + c1 = 0 and a 2 x + b 2 y + c 2 = 0 , where b1, b2 0 are:
224
MATHEMATICS
(i) Parallel if
a1 b1
a2 b2
y = a1 x c1 b1 b1
and
y = a2 x c2 b2 b2 b1
Slopes of the lines (1) and (2) are m1 = a1 and m2 = (i) Lines are parallel, if m1 = m2, which gives
a 2 , respectively. Now b2
a1 a 2 a1 a = . = 2 or b1 b2 b1 b2
a1 a2 . = 1 or a a + b b = 0 1 2 1 2 b1 b2
Example 17 Find the equation of a line perpendicular to the line x 2 y + 3 = 0 and passing through the point (1, 2). Solution Given line x 2 y + 3 = 0 can be written as
y=
1 3 x+ 2 2
...(1)
m2 =
1 = 2 m1
Equation of the line with slope 2 and passing through the point (1, 2) is
y ( 2) = 2(x 1) or y = 2 x ,
which is the required equation.
STRAIGHT LINES
225
Fig10.19
the line meets the x-and y-axes at the points Q and R, respectively. Then, coordinates of the points are is given by
1 area (PQR) = PM.QR , which gives PM = 2
C Q , 0 and R A
... (1)
1 C C C x1 0 + + y1 + 0 ( y 1 0 ) 2 B A B = 1 C C C2 x1 + y 1 + 2 B A AB
or
2 area (PQR) =
2
C . A x1 + B y 1 + C , and AB
C QR = 0 + + A
C 0 B
C AB
2 2 A +B
226
MATHEMATICS
PM =
A x1 + B y 1 + C
2 2 A +B
. 2 2 A +B Thus, the perpendicular distance (d) of a line Ax + By+ C = 0 from a point (x1, y1) is given by
d= A x1 + B y1 + C
2 2 A +B
or
d=
A x1 + B y1 + C
10.5.1 Distance between two parallel lines We know that slopes of two parallel lines are equal. Therefore, two parallel lines can be taken in the form ... (1) y = mx + c1 and y = mx + c2 ... (2) Line (1) will intersect x-axis at the point
c1 A m , 0 as shown in Fig10.20.
Fig10.20
Distance between two lines is equal to the length of the perpendicular from point A to line (2). Therefore, distance between the lines (1) and (2) is
( m)
c1 + ( c2 ) m 1 + m2
or d =
c1 c2 1 + m2
STRAIGHT LINES
227
C1 C 2 A 2 + B2
Students can derive it themselves. Example 18 Find the distance of the point (3, 5) from the line 3x 4y 26 = 0. Solution Given line is 3x 4y 26 = 0 ... (1) Comparing (1) with general equation of line Ax + By + C = 0, we get A = 3, B = 4 and C = 26. Given point is (x1, y1) = (3, 5). The distance of the given point from given line is
d= Ax1 + By1 + C A +B
2 2
3.3 + ( 4 )( 5 ) 26 3 + ( 4 )
2 2
3 = . 5
Example 19 Find the distance between the parallel lines 3x 4y +7 = 0 and 3x 4y + 5 = 0 Solution Here A = 3, B = 4, C1 = 7 and C2 = 5. Therefore, the required distance is
d= 75 32 + ( 4 )
2
2 = . 5
EXERCISE 10.3
1. Reduce the following equations into slope - intercept form and find their slopes and the y - intercepts. (i) x + 7y = 0, (ii) 6x + 3y 5 = 0, (iii) y = 0. 2. Reduce the following equations into intercept form and find their intercepts on the axes. (i) 3x + 2y 12 = 0, (ii) 4x 3y = 6, (iii) 3y + 2 = 0. 3. Reduce the following equations into normal form. Find their perpendicular distances from the origin and angle between perpendicular and the positive x-axis. (iii) x y = 4. (i) x 3y + 8 = 0, (ii) y 2 = 0, 4. Find the distance of the point (1, 1) from the line 12(x + 6) = 5(y 2). 5. Find the points on the x-axis, whose distances from the line
x y + = 1 are 4 units. 3 4
6. Find the distance between parallel lines (i) 15x + 8y 34 = 0 and 15x + 8y + 31 = 0 (ii) l (x + y) + p = 0 and l (x + y) r = 0.
228
MATHEMATICS
7. Find equation of the line parallel to the line 3 x 4 y + 2 = 0 and passing through the point (2, 3). 8. Find equation of the line perpendicular to the line x 7y + 5 = 0 and having x intercept 3. 9. Find angles between the lines
3 x + y = 1and x + 3 y = 1.
10. The line through the points (h, 3) and (4, 1) intersects the line 7 x 9 y 19 = 0. at right angle. Find the value of h. 11. Prove that the line through the point (x1, y1) and parallel to the line Ax + By + C = 0 is A (x x1) + B (y y1) = 0. 12. Two lines passing through the point (2, 3) intersects each other at an angle of 60o. If slope of one line is 2, find equation of the other line. 13. Find the equation of the right bisector of the line segment joining the points (3, 4) and (1, 2). 14. Find the coordinates of the foot of perpendicular from the point (1, 3) to the line 3x 4y 16 = 0. 15. The perpendicular from the origin to the line y = mx + c meets it at the point (1, 2). Find the values of m and c. 16. If p and q are the lengths of perpendiculars from the origin to the lines x cos y sin = k cos 2 and x sec + y cosec = k, respectively, prove that p2 + 4q2 = k2. 17. In the triangle ABC with vertices A (2, 3), B (4, 1) and C (1, 2), find the equation and length of altitude from the vertex A. 18. If p is the length of perpendicular from the origin to the line whose intercepts on the axes are a and b, then show that
1 1 1 = 2 + 2. 2 p a b
Miscellaneous Examples
Example 20 If the lines 2 x + y 3 = 0 , 5 x + ky 3 = 0 and 3 x y 2 = 0 are concurrent, find the value of k. Solution Three lines are said to be concurrent, if they pass through a common point, i.e., point of intersection of any two lines lies on the third line. Here given lines are 2x + y 3 = 0 ... (1) 5x + ky 3 = 0 ... (2)
STRAIGHT LINES
229
... (3)
1 x y = = or x = 1, y = 1 . 23 9+ 4 23
Therefore, the point of intersection of two lines is (1, 1). Since above three lines are concurrent, the point (1, 1) will satisfy equation (3) so that 5.1 + k .1 3 = 0 or k = 2. Example 21 Find the distance of the line 4x y = 0 from the point P (4, 1) measured along the line making an angle of 135 with the positive x-axis. Solution Given line is 4x y = 0 In order to find the distance of the line (1) from the point P (4, 1) along another line, we have to find the point of intersection of both the lines. For this purpose, we will first find the equation of the second line (Fig 10.21). Slope of second line is tan 135 = 1. Equation of the line with slope 1 through the point P (4, 1) is ... (1)
Fig 10.21
y 1 = 1 (x 4) or x + y 5 = 0
... (2)
Solving (1) and (2), we get x = 1 and y = 4 so that point of intersection of the two lines is Q (1, 4). Now, distance of line (1) from the point P (4, 1) along the line (2) = The distance between the points P (4, 1) and Q (1, 4). =
(1 4 )2 + ( 4 1)2 = 3
2 units .
Example 22 Assuming that straight lines work as the plane mirror for a point, find the image of the point (1, 2) in the line x 3 y + 4 = 0 . Solution Let Q (h, k) is the image of the point P (1, 2) in the line x 3y + 4 = 0 ... (1)
230
MATHEMATICS
Fig10.22
Therefore, the line (1) is the perpendicular bisector of line segment PQ (Fig 10.22). Hence so that Slope of line PQ =
k 2 1 = h 1 1 3
1 , Slope of line x 3 y + 4 = 0
... (2)
or 3h + k = 5
h +1 k + 2 3 + 4 = 0 or h 3k = 3 2 2
Solving (2) and (3), we get h =
... (3)
6 7 and k = . 5 5
y = m1 x + c1 , y = m 2 x + c 2
(c c ) and x = 0 is
1 2
2 m1 m 2
STRAIGHT LINES
231
Solution Given lines are y = m1 x + c1 ... (1) y = m2 x + c2 ... (2) x=0 ... (3) We know that line y = mx + c meets the line x = 0 (y-axis) at the point (0, c). Therefore, two vertices of the triangle formed by lines (1) to (3) are P (0, c1) and Q (0, c2) (Fig 10. 23). Third vertex can be obtained by solving equations (1) and (2). Solving (1) and (2), we get
x=
( c2 c1 ) ( m1 m2 )
and y =
( m1c2 m2c1 ) ( m1 m2 )
Fig 10.23
( c2 c1 ) ( m1c2 m2 c1 ) Therefore, third vertex of the triangle is R m m , ( ( m1 m2 ) . 2) 1 Now, the area of the triangle is
m c m2 c1 c c 1 c2 + 2 .1 ( c2 c1 ) + 0 0 1 2 2 m1 m2 m1 m2
m c m c ( c c ) = c
1 2 2 1 1
m1 m2
2 m1 m 2
Example 24 A line is such that its segment between the lines 5x y + 4 = 0 and 3x + 4y 4 = 0 is bisected at the point (1, 5). Obtain its equation. Solution Given lines are 5x y + 4 = 0 ... (1) 3x + 4y 4 = 0 ... (2) Let the required line intersects the lines (1) and (2) at the points , (1, 1) and (2, 2), respectively (Fig10.24). Therefore 51 1 + 4 = 0 and 3 2 + 4 2 4 = 0
Fig 10.24
232
MATHEMATICS
4 3 2 . 4 We are given that the mid point of the segment of the required line between (1, 1) and (2, 2) is (1, 5). Therefore
or 1 = 51 + 4 and 2 =
+ 1 + 2 = 1 and 1 2 = 5 , 2 2
or
1 + 2 = 2 and
5 1 + 4 + 2
4 32 4 = 5,
... (3)
1 =
5 5 y 5 = 1 ( x 1) or y 5 = 23 (x 1) 26 1 1 1 23
or 107x 3y 92 = 0, which is the equation of required line. Example 25 Show that the path of a moving point such that its distances from two lines 3x 2y = 5 and 3x + 2y = 5 are equal is a straight line. Solution Given lines are 3x 2y = 5 and 3x + 2y = 5 (1) (2)
Let (h, k) is any point, whose distances from the lines (1) and (2) are equal. Therefore
3h 2k 5 9+4
3h + 2k 5 9+4
or 3h 2k 5 = 3h + 2k 5 ,
STRAIGHT LINES
233
x y + = 1 is 3 4
4 units. 5. Find perpendicular distance from the origin of the line joining the points (cos, sin ) and (cos , sin ). 6. Find the equation of the line parallel to y-axis and drawn through the point of intersection of the lines x 7y + 5 = 0 and 3x + y = 0. 7. Find the equation of a line drawn perpendicular to the line
x y + = 1 through the 4 6
point, where it meets the y-axis. Find the area of the triangle formed by the lines y x = 0, x + y = 0 and x k = 0. Find the value of p so that the three lines 3x + y 2 = 0, px + 2 y 3 = 0 and 2x y 3 = 0 may intersect at one point. If three lines whose equations are y = m1x + c1, y = m2x + c2 and y = m3x + c3 are concurrent, then show that m1(c2 c3) + m2 (c3 c1) + m3 (c1 c2) = 0. Find the equation of the lines through the point (3, 2) which make an angle of 45o with the line x 2y = 3. Find the equation of the line passing through the point of intersection of the lines 4x + 7y 3 = 0 and 2x 3y + 1 = 0 that has equal intercepts on the axes.
234
MATHEMATICS
13. Show that the equation of the line passing through the origin and making an angle with the line y = mx + c is
y m + tan = . x 1 m tan
14. In what ratio, the line joining (1, 1) and (5, 7) is divided by the line x + y = 4? 15. Find the distance of the line 4x + 7y + 5 = 0 from the point (1, 2) along the line 2x y = 0. 16. Find the direction in which a straight line must be drawn through the point (1, 2) so that its point of intersection with the line x + y = 4 may be at a distance of 3 units from this point. 17. The hypotenuse of a right angled triangle has its ends at the points (1, 3) and ( 4, 1). Find the equation of the legs (perpendicular sides) of the triangle. 18. Find the image of the point (3, 8) with respect to the line x +3y = 7 assuming the line to be a plane mirror. 19. If the lines y = 3x +1 and 2y = x + 3 are equally inclined to the line y = mx + 4, find the value of m. 20. If sum of the perpendicular distances of a variable point P (x, y) from the lines x + y 5 = 0 and 3x 2y +7 = 0 is always 10. Show that P must move on a line. 21. Find equation of the line which is equidistant from parallel lines 9x + 6y 7 = 0 and 3x + 2y + 6 = 0. 22. A ray of light passing through the point (1, 2) reflects on the x-axis at point A and the reflected ray passes through the point (5, 3). Find the coordinates of A. 23. Prove that the product of the lengths of the perpendiculars drawn from the
x y cos + sin = 1is b 2 . a b 24. A person standing at the junction (crossing) of two straight paths represented by the equations 2x 3y + 4 = 0 and 3x + 4y 5 = 0 wants to reach the path whose equation is 6x 7y + 8 = 0 in the least time. Find equation of the path that he should follow.
points
) (
Summary
Slope (m) of a non-vertical line passing through the points (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) is given by m =
y 2 y1 y1 y 2 = , x 1 x 2. x 2 x1 x1 x 2 If a line makes an angle with the positive direction of x-axis, then the slope of the line is given by m = tan , 90. Slope of horizontal line is zero and slope of vertical line is undefined.
STRAIGHT LINES
235
m2 m1 given by tan = 1 + m m ,1 + m1 m2 0 . 1 2
Two lines are parallel if and only if their slopes are equal. Two lines are perpendicular if and only if product of their slopes is 1. Three points A, B and C are collinear, if and only if slope of AB = slope of BC. Equation of the horizontal line having distance a from the x-axis is either y = a or y = a. Equation of the vertical line having distance b from the y-axis is either x = b or x = b. The point (x, y) lies on the line with slope m and through the fixed point (xo, yo), if and only if its coordinates satisfy the equation y y o = m (x xo). Equation of the line passing through the points (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) is given by
y y1 =
y 2 y1 ( x x1). x 2 x1
The point (x, y) on the line with slope m and y-intercept c lies on the line if and only if y = mx + c . If a line with slope m makes x-intercept d. Then equation of the line is y = m (x d). Equation of a line making intercepts a and b on the x-and y-axis, respectively, is
x y + = 1. a b
The equation of the line having normal distance from origin p and angle between normal and the positive x-axis is given by x cos + y sin = p . Any equation of the form Ax + By + C = 0, with A and B are not zero, simultaneously, is called the general linear equation or general equation of a line. The perpendicular distance (d) of a line Ax + By+ C = 0 from a point (x1, y1) is given by d = . 2 2 A +B Distance between the parallel lines Ax + By + C1 = 0 and Ax + By + C2 = 0, is given by d =
Ax1 + B y1 + C
C1 C 2
2 2 A +B
Chapter
11
CONIC SECTIONS
Let the relation of knowledge to real life be very visible to your pupils and let them understand how by knowledge the world could be transformed. BERTRAND RUSSELL
11.1 Introduction
In the preceding Chapter 10, we have studied various forms of the equations of a line. In this Chapter, we shall study about some other curves, viz., circles, ellipses, parabolas and hyperbolas. The names parabola and hyperbola are given by Apollonius. These curves are in fact, known as conic sections or more commonly conics because they can be obtained as intersections of a plane with a double napped right circular cone. These curves have a very wide range of applications in fields such as planetary motion, Apollonius (262 B.C. -190 B.C.) design of telescopes and antennas, reflectors in flashlights and automobile headlights, etc. Now, in the subsequent sections we will see how the intersection of a plane with a double napped right circular cone results in different types of curves.
Fig 11. 1
CONIC SECTIONS
237
Fig 11. 2
Fig 11. 3
cone and extending indefinitely far in both directions (Fig11.2). The point V is called the vertex; the line l is the axis of the cone. The rotating line m is called a generator of the cone. The vertex separates the cone into two parts called nappes. If we take the intersection of a plane with a cone, the section so obtained is called a conic section. Thus, conic sections are the curves obtained by intersecting a right circular cone by a plane. We obtain different kinds of conic sections depending on the position of the intersecting plane with respect to the cone and by the angle made by it with the vertical axis of the cone. Let be the angle made by the intersecting plane with the vertical axis of the cone (Fig11.3). The intersection of the plane with the cone can take place either at the vertex of the cone or at any other part of the nappe either below or above the vertex. 11.2.1 Circle, ellipse, parabola and hyperbola When the plane cuts the nappe (other than the vertex) of the cone, we have the following situations: (a) When = 90o, the section is a circle (Fig11.4). (b) When < < 90o, the section is an ellipse (Fig11.5). (c) When = ; the section is a parabola (Fig11.6). (In each of the above three situations, the plane cuts entirely across one nappe of the cone). (d) When 0 < ; the plane cuts through both the nappes and the curves of intersection is a hyperbola (Fig11.7).
238
MATHEMATICS
Fig 11. 4
Fig 11. 5
Fig 11. 6
Fig 11. 7
11.2.2 Degenerated conic sections When the plane cuts at the vertex of the cone, we have the following different cases: (a) When < 90o, then the section is a point (Fig11.8). (b) When = , the plane contains a generator of the cone and the section is a straight line (Fig11.9). It is the degenerated case of a parabola. (c) When 0 < , the section is a pair of intersecting straight lines (Fig11.10). It is the degenerated case of a hyperbola.
CONIC SECTIONS
239
In the following sections, we shall obtain the equations of each of these conic sections in standard form by defining them based on geometric properties.
Fig 11. 8
Fig 11. 9
11.3 Circle
Fig 11. 10
Definition 1 A circle is the set of all points in a plane that are equidistant from a fixed point in the plane. The fixed point is called the centre of the circle and the distance from the centre to a point on the circle is called the radius of the circle (Fig 11.11).
240
MATHEMATICS
Fig 11. 11
Fig 11. 12
The equation of the circle is simplest if the centre of the circle is at the origin. However, we derive below the equation of the circle with a given centre and radius (Fig 11.12). Given C (h, k) be the centre and r the radius of circle. Let P(x, y) be any point on the circle (Fig11.12). Then, by the definition, | CP | = r . By the distance formula, we have
(x h)2 + (y k )2 = r
i.e.
(x h)2 + (y k)2 = r2
This is the required equation of the circle with centre at (h,k) and radius r . Example 1 Find an equation of the circle with centre at (0,0) and radius r. Solution Here h = k = 0. Therefore, the equation of the circle is x2 + y2 = r2. Example 2 Find the equation of the circle with centre (3, 2) and radius 4. Solution Here h = 3, k = 2 and r = 4. Therefore, the equation of the required circle is (x + 3)2 + (y 2)2 = 16 Example 3 Find the centre and the radius of the circle x2 + y2 + 8x + 10y 8 = 0 Solution The given equation is (x2 + 8x) + (y2 + 10y) = 8 Now, completing the squares within the parenthesis, we get (x2 + 8x + 16) + (y2 + 10y + 25) = 8 + 16 + 25 i.e. (x + 4)2 + (y + 5)2 = 49 i.e. {x ( 4)}2 + {y (5)}2 = 72 Therefore, the given circle has centre at ( 4, 5) and radius 7.
CONIC SECTIONS
241
Example 4 Find the equation of the circle which passes through the points (2, 2), and (3,4) and whose centre lies on the line x + y = 2. Solution Let the equation of the circle be (x h)2 + (y k)2 = r2. Since the circle passes through (2, 2) and (3,4), we have ... (1) (2 h)2 + (2 k)2 = r2 and (3 h)2 + (4 k)2 = r2 ... (2) Also since the centre lies on the line x + y = 2, we have h+k=2 ... (3) Solving the equations (1), (2) and (3), we get h = 0.7, k = 1.3 and r2 = 12.58 Hence, the equation of the required circle is (x 0.7)2 + (y 1.3)2 = 12.58.
EXERCISE 11.1
In each of the following Exercises 1 to 5, find the equation of the circle with 1. centre (0,2) and radius 2 3. centre ( 2. centre (2,3) and radius 4 4. centre (1,1) and radius
1 1 1 , ) and radius 12 2 4
a2 b2 .
7. x2 + y2 4x 8y 45 = 0 9. 2x2 + 2y2 x = 0
In each of the following Exercises 6 to 9, find the centre and radius of the circles.
10. Find the equation of the circle passing through the points (4,1) and (6,5) and whose centre is on the line 4x + y = 16. 11. Find the equation of the circle passing through the points (2,3) and (1,1) and whose centre is on the line x 3y 11 = 0. 12. Find the equation of the circle with radius 5 whose centre lies on x-axis and passes through the point (2,3). 13. Find the equation of the circle passing through (0,0) and making intercepts a and b on the coordinate axes. 14. Find the equation of a circle with centre (2,2) and passes through the point (4,5). 15. Does the point (2.5, 3.5) lie inside, outside or on the circle x2 + y2 = 25?
242
MATHEMATICS
11.4 Parabola
Definition 2 A parabola is the set of all points in a plane that are equidistant from a fixed line and a fixed point (not on the line) in the plane. The fixed line is called the directrix of the parabola and the fixed point F is called the focus (Fig 11.13). (Para means for and bola means throwing, i.e., the shape described when you throw a ball in the air). Note If the fixed point lies on the fixed line, then the set of points in the plane, which are equidistant from the fixed point and the fixed line is the straight line through the fixed point and perpendicular to the fixed line. We call this straight line as degenerate case of the parabola. A line through the focus and perpendicular to the directrix is called the axis of the parabola. The point of intersection of parabola with the axis is called the vertex of the parabola (Fig11.14).
Fig 11. 13
equation of a parabola is simplest if the vertex is at the origin and the axis of symmetry is along the x-axis or y-axis. The four possible such orientations of parabola are shown below in Fig11.15 (a) to (d).
Fig 11.14
CONIC SECTIONS
243
We will derive the equation for the parabola shown above in Fig 11.15 (a) with focus at (a, 0) a > 0; and directricx x = a as below: Let F be the focus and l the directrix. Let FM be perpendicular to the directrix and bisect FM at the point O. Produce MO to X. By the definition of parabola, the mid-point O is on the parabola and is called the vertex of the parabola. Take O as origin, OX the x-axis and OY perpendicular to it as the y-axis. Let the distance from the directrix to the focus be 2a. Then, the coordinates of the focus are (a, 0), and the equation of the directrix is x + a = 0 as in Fig11.16. Fig 11.16 Let P(x, y) be any point on the parabola such that PF = PB, ... (1) where PB is perpendicular to l. The coordinates of B are ( a, y). By the distance formula, we have
(x + a) 2
244
MATHEMATICS
Hence, any point on the parabola satisfies y2 = 4ax. Conversely, let P(x, y) satisfy the equation (2) PF = =
(x a) 2 + y 2
... (2)
(x a) 2 + 4ax
(x + a) 2 = PB
... (3)
and so P(x,y) lies on the parabola. Thus, from (2) and (3) we have proved that the equation to the parabola with vertex at the origin, focus at (a,0) and directrix x = a is y2 = 4ax. Discussion In equation (2), since a > 0, x can assume any positive value or zero but no negative value and the curve extends indefinitely far into the first and the fourth quadrants. The axis of the parabola is the positive x-axis. Similarly, we can derive the equations of the parabolas in: Fig 11.15 (b) as y2 = 4ax, Fig 11.15 (c) as x2 = 4ay, Fig 11.15 (d) as x2 = 4ay, These four equations are known as standard equations of parabolas. Note The standard equations of parabolas have focus on one of the coordinate axis; vertex at the origin and thereby the directrix is parallel to the other coordinate axis. However, the study of the equations of parabolas with focus at any point and any line as directrix is beyond the scope here. From the standard equations of the parabolas, Fig11.15, we have the following observations: 1. Parabola is symmetric with respect to the axis of the parabola.If the equation has a y2 term, then the axis of symmetry is along the x-axis and if the equation has an x2 term, then the axis of symmetry is along the y-axis. When the axis of symmetry is along the x-axis the parabola opens to the (a) right if the coefficient of x is positive, (b) left if the coefficient of x is negative. When the axis of symmetry is along the y-axis the parabola opens (c) upwards if the coefficient of y is positive. (d) downwards if the coefficient of y is negative.
2.
3.
CONIC SECTIONS
245
And since the parabola is symmetric with respect to x-axis AF = FB and so AB = Length of the latus rectum = 4a.
Fig 11.17
Fig 11.18
Example 5 Find the coordinates of the focus, axis, the equation of the directrix and latus rectum of the parabola y2 = 8x. Solution The given equation involves y2, so the axis of symmetry is along the x-axis. The coefficient of x is positive so the parabola opens to the right. Comparing with the given equation y2 = 4ax, we find that a = 2.
Fig 11.19
Thus, the focus of the parabola is (2, 0) and the equation of the directrix of the parabola is x = 2 (Fig 11.19). Length of the latus rectum is 4a = 4 2 = 8.
246
MATHEMATICS
Example 6 Find the equation of the parabola with focus (2,0) and directrix x = 2. Solution Since the focus (2,0) lies on the x-axis, the x-axis itself is the axis of the parabola. Hence the equation of the parabola is of the form either y2 = 4ax or y2 = 4ax. Since the directrix is x = 2 and the focus is (2,0), the parabola is to be of the form y 2 = 4ax with a = 2. Hence the required equation is y2 = 4(2)x = 8x Example 7 Find the equation of the parabola with vertex at (0, 0) and focus at (0, 2). Solution Since the vertex is at (0,0) and the focus is at (0,2) which lies on y-axis, the y-axis is the axis of the parabola. Therefore, equation of the parabola is of the form x2 = 4ay. thus, we have x2 = 4(2)y, i.e., x2 = 8y. Example 8 Find the equation of the parabola which is symmetric about the y-axis, and passes through the point (2,3). Solution Since the parabola is symmetric about y-axis and has its vertex at the origin, the equation is of the form x2 = 4ay or x2 = 4ay, where the sign depends on whether the parabola opens upwards or downwards. But the parabola passes through (2,3) which lies in the fourth quadrant, it must open downwards. Thus the equation is of the form x2 = 4ay. Since the parabola passes through ( 2,3), we have 22 = 4a (3), i.e., a = Therefore, the equation of the parabola is
1 3
EXERCISE 11.2
In each of the following Exercises 1 to 6, find the coordinates of the focus, axis of the parabola, the equation of the directrix and the length of the latus rectum. 1. y2 = 12x 4. x2 = 16y 2. x2 = 6y 5. y2 = 10x 3. 6. y2 = 8x x2 = 9y
In each of the Exercises 7 to 12, find the equation of the parabola that satisfies the given conditions:
CONIC SECTIONS
247
11. Vertex (0,0) passing through (2,3) and axis is along x-axis. 12. Vertex (0,0), passing through (5,2) and symmetric with respect to y-axis.
11. 5 Ellipse
Definition 4 An ellipse is the set of all points in a plane, the sum of whose distances from two fixed points in the plane is a constant. The two fixed points are called the foci (plural of focus) of the ellipse (Fig11.20). Note The constant which is the sum of the distances of a point on the ellipse from the two fixed points is always greater than the distance between the two fixed points.
Fig 11.20
The mid point of the line segment joining the foci is called the centre of the ellipse. The line segment through the foci of the ellipse is called the major axis and the line segment through the centre and perpendicular to the major axis is called the minor axis. The end points of the major axis are called the vertices of the ellipse(Fig 11.21).
Fig 11.21
Fig 11.22
We denote the length of the major axis by 2a, the length of the minor axis by 2b and the distance between the foci by 2c. Thus, the length of the semi major axis is a and semi-minor axis is b (Fig11.22).
248
MATHEMATICS
11.5.1 Relationship between semi-major axis, semi-minor axis and the distance of the focus from the centre of the ellipse (Fig 11.23). Take a point P at one end of the major axis. Sum of the distances of the point P to the foci is F1 P + F2P = F1O + OP + F2P (Since, F1P = F1O + OP) = c + a + a c = 2a Take a point Q at one end of the minor axis. Sum of the distances from the point Q to the foci is F1Q + F2Q =
Fig 11.23
b2 + c2
b2 + c2 = 2 b2 + c 2
Since both P and Q lies on the ellipse. By the definition of ellipse, we have 2 b 2 + c 2 = 2a, i.e., or a 2 = b2 + c2 , i.e., a = b2 + c 2 c=
11.5.2 Special cases of an ellipse In the equation c2 = a2 b2 obtained above, if we keep a fixed and vary c from 0 to a, the resulting ellipses will vary in shape.
a 2 b2 .
Case (i) When c = 0, both foci merge together with the centre of the ellipse and a2 = b2, i.e., a = b, and so the ellipse becomes circle (Fig11.24). Thus, circle is a special case of an ellipse which is dealt in Section 11.3. Case (ii) When c = a, then b = 0. The ellipse reduces to the line segment F1F2 joining the two foci (Fig11.25).
Fig 11.24
11.5.3 Eccentricity
Fig 11.25
Definition 5 The eccentricity of an ellipse is the ratio of the distances from the centre of the ellipse to one of the foci and to one of the vertices of the ellipse (eccentricity is denoted by e) i.e., e =
c . a
CONIC SECTIONS
249
Then since the focus is at a distance of c from the centre, in terms of the eccentricity the focus is at a distance of ae from the centre. 11.5.4 Standard equations of an ellipse The equation of an ellipse is simplest if the centre of the ellipse is at the origin and the foci are
on the x-axis or y-axis. The two such possible orientations are shown in Fig 11.26. We will derive the equation for the ellipse shown above in Fig 11.26 (a) with foci on the x-axis. Let F1 and F2 be the foci and O be the midpoint of the line segment F1F2. Let O be the origin and the line from O through F2 be the positive x-axis and that through F1as the negative x-axis. Let, the line through O perpendicular to the x-axis be the y-axis. Let the coordinates of F1 be ( c, 0) and F2 be (c, 0) (Fig 11.27). Let P(x, y) be any point on the ellipse such that the sum of the distances from P to the two x2 y 2 + =1 foci be 2a so given a 2 b2 ... (1) PF1 + PF2 = 2a. Fig 11.27 Using the distance formula, we have
( x + c) 2 + y 2 +
i.e.,
( x c) 2 + y 2 = 2a ( x c )2 + y 2
( x + c) 2 + y 2 = 2a
250
MATHEMATICS
( x c) 2 + y 2 + ( x c) 2 + y 2
( x c) 2 + y 2 = a
Squaring again and simplifying, we get
c x a
x2 y2 + 2 =1 a2 a c2
i.e.,
x2 y2 + 2 =1 a2 b x2 y2 + 2 = 1. a2 b
(Since c2 = a2 b2)
Conversely, let P (x, y) satisfy the equation (2) with 0 < c < a. Then
x2 1 2 y =b a
2 2
Therefore, PF1
= =
( x + c) 2 + y 2
a2 x2 ( x + c) 2 + b 2 a2
a2 x2 ( x + c) 2 + ( a 2 c 2 ) (since b2 = a2 c2) a2
cx c a+ =a+ x a a
2
Similarly
PF2 = a x a
CONIC SECTIONS
251
Hence
PF1 + PF2 = a +
c c x + a x = 2a a a
... (3)
P(x, y) lies on the ellipse. Hence from (2) and (3), we proved that the equation of an ellipse with centre of the origin and major axis along the x-axis is
x2 y 2 + = 1. a 2 b2 Discussion From the equation of the ellipse obtained above, it follows that for every point P (x, y) on the ellipse, we have
x2 y2 = 1 2 1, i.e., x2 a2, so a x a. a2 b
Therefore, the ellipse lies between the lines x = a and x = a and touches these lines. Similarly, the ellipse lies between the lines y = b and y = b and touches these lines. Similarly, we can derive the equation of the ellipse in Fig 11.26 (b) as These two equations are known as standard equations of the ellipses. Note The standard equations of ellipses have centre at the origin and the major and minor axis are coordinate axes. However, the study of the ellipses with centre at any other point, and any line through the centre as major and the minor axes passing through the centre and perpendicular to major axis are beyond the scope here. From the standard equations of the ellipses (Fig11.26), we have the following observations: 1. Ellipse is symmetric with respect to both the coordinate axes since if (x, y) is a point on the ellipse, then ( x, y), (x, y) and ( x, y) are also points on the ellipse. 2. The foci always lie on the major axis. The major axis can be determined by finding the intercepts on the axes of symmetry. That is, major axis is along the x-axis if the coefficient of x2 has the larger denominator and it is along the y-axis if the coefficient of y2 has the larger denominator.
x2 y2 + =1 . b2 a 2
252
MATHEMATICS
x2 y 2 + =1 a 2 b2
Fig 11. 28
Let the length of AF2 be l. Then the coordinates of A are (c, l ),i.e., (ae, l ) Since A lies on the ellipse
x2 y 2 + = 1 , we have a 2 b2
(ae) 2 l 2 2 =1 a2 b
l2 = b2 (1 e2) But Therefore
e2 =
l2 =
c2 a2 b2 b2 = =1 2 a2 a2 a
b4 b2 , i.e., l = a a2
2b2 . a
Since the ellipse is symmetric with respect to y-axis (of course, it is symmetric w.r.t. both the coordinate axes), AF2 = F2B and so length of the latus rectum is
Example 9 Find the coordinates of the foci, the vertices, the length of major axis, the minor axis, the eccentricity and the latus rectum of the ellipse
x2 y 2 + =1 25 9 x2 y2 Solution Since denominator of is larger than the denominator of , the major 25 9
CONIC SECTIONS
253
axis is along the x-axis. Comparing the given equation with a = 5 and b = 3. Also
x2 y 2 + = 1 , we get a 2 b2
c = a 2 b 2 = 25 9 = 4
Therefore, the coordinates of the foci are ( 4,0) and (4,0), vertices are ( 5, 0) and (5, 0). Length of the major axis is 10 units length of the minor axis 2b is 6 units and the
2b 2 18 4 = and latus rectum is . 5 a 5 Example 10 Find the coordinates of the foci, the vertices, the lengths of major and minor axes and the eccentricity of the ellipse 9x2 + 4y2 = 36.
eccentricity is Solution The given equation of the ellipse can be written in standard form as
x2 y2 + =1 4 9
y2 x2 is larger than the denominator of , the major axis is 9 4 along the y-axis. Comparing the given equation with the standard equation
x2 y2 + = 1 , we have b = 2 and a = 3. b2 a 2
Also and c=
e=
a2 b2
c 5 = a 3
94= 5
Hence the foci are (0, 5 ) and (0, 5 ), vertices are (0,3) and (0, 3), length of the major axis is 6 units, the length of the minor axis is 4 units and the eccentricity of the
5 . 3 Example 11 Find the equation of the ellipse whose vertices are ( 13, 0) and foci are ( 5, 0). Solution Since the vertices are on x-axis, the equation will be of the form
ellipse is
254
MATHEMATICS
Given that a = 13, c = 5. Therefore, from the relation c2 = a2 b2, we get 25 = 169 b2 , i.e., b = 12 Hence the equation of the ellipse is
x2 y2 + = 1. 169 144
Example 12 Find the equation of the ellipse, whose length of the major axis is 20 and foci are (0, 5). Solution Since the foci are on y-axis, the major axis is along the y-axis. So, equation of the ellipse is of the form Given that a = semi-major axis = and the relation
x2 y2 + =1. b2 a 2
20 = 10 2
Example 13 Find the equation of the ellipse, with major axis along the x-axis and passing through the points (4, 3) and ( 1,4). Solution The standard form of the ellipse is and (1, 4) lie on the ellipse, we have
16 9 + 2 =1 2 a b
and
1 16 + 2 =1 2 a b
247 247 2 and b = . 7 15
CONIC SECTIONS
255
EXERCISE 11.3
In each of the Exercises 1 to 9, find the coordinates of the foci, the vertices, the length of major axis, the minor axis, the eccentricity and the length of the latus rectum of the ellipse. 1.
x2 y2 + =1 36 16 x2 y2 + =1 25 100
2.
x2 y2 + =1 4 25 x2 y 2 + =1 49 36
3.
x2 y2 + =1 16 9
4.
5.
6.
x2 y2 =1 + 100 400
8. 16x2 + y2 = 16
9. 4x2 + 9y2 = 36
In each of the following Exercises 10 to 20, find the equation for the ellipse that satisfies the given conditions: 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. Vertices ( 5, 0), foci ( 4, 0) Vertices (0, 13), foci (0, 5) Vertices ( 6, 0), foci ( 4, 0) Ends of major axis ( 3, 0), ends of minor axis (0, 2)
Ends of major axis (0, 5 ), ends of minor axis ( 1, 0) Length of major axis 26, foci ( 5, 0) Length of minor axis 16, foci (0, 6). Foci ( 3, 0), a = 4 b = 3, c = 4, centre at the origin; foci on a x axis. Centre at (0,0), major axis on the y-axis and passes through the points (3, 2) and (1,6). 20. Major axis on the x-axis and passes through the points (4,3) and (6,2). 11.6 Hyperbola Definition 7 A hyperbola is the set of all points in a plane, the difference of whose distances from two fixed points in the plane is a constant.
256
MATHEMATICS
Fig 11.29
The term difference that is used in the definition means the distance to the further point minus the distance to the closer point. The two fixed points are called the foci of the hyperbola. The mid-point of the line segment joining the foci is called the centre of the hyperbola. The line through the foci is called the transverse axis and the line through the centre and perpendicular to the transverse axis is called the conjugate axis. The points at which the hyperbola intersects the transverse axis are called the vertices of the hyperbola (Fig 11.29). We denote the distance between the two foci by 2c, the distance between two vertices (the length of the transverse axis) by 2a and we define the quantity b as b =
c2 a2
Fig 11.30
Also 2b is the length of the conjugate axis (Fig 11.30). To find the constant P1F2 P1F1 :
By taking the point P at A and B in the Fig 11.30, we have BF1 BF2 = AF2 AF1 (by the definition of the hyperbola) BA +AF1 BF2 = AB + BF2 AF1 i.e., AF1 = BF2 So that, BF1 BF2 = BA + AF1 BF2 = BA = 2a
CONIC SECTIONS
257
11.6.1 Eccentricity
c is called the eccentricity of the a hyperbola. Since c a, the eccentricity is never less than one. In terms of the eccentricity, the foci are at a distance of ae from the centre.
Definition 8 Just like an ellipse, the ratio e = 11.6.2 Standard equation of Hyperbola The equation of a hyperbola is simplest if the centre of the hyperbola is at the origin and the foci are on the x-axis or y-axis. The two such possible orientations are shown in Fig11.31.
(b)
We will derive the equation for the hyperbola shown in Fig 11.31(a) with foci on the x-axis. Let F1 and F2 be the foci and O be the mid-point of the line segment F1F2. Let O be the origin and the line through O through F2 be the positive x-axis and that through F 1 as the negative x-axis. The line through O perpendicular to the x-axis be the y-axis. Let the coordinates of F1 be ( c,0) and F2 be (c,0) (Fig 11.32). Let P(x, y) be any point on the hyperbola such that the difference of the distances from P to the farther point minus the closer point be 2a. So given, PF1 PF2 = 2a Fig 11.32
258
MATHEMATICS
i.e.,
(x + c ) 2 + y 2 = 2a + (x c) 2 + y 2
cx a= a
(x c) 2 + y 2
i.e.,
x2 y 2 =1 a 2 b2
(Since c2 a2 = b2)
x2 y 2 = 1 1. a 2 b2 Conversely, let P(x, y) satisfy the above equation with 0 < a < c. Then
y
2
= b
x2 a2 2 a
Therefore,
PF1 = + = +
(x + c ) 2 + y 2
x2 a2 c (x + c )2 + b 2 x = a+ a2 a
Similarly,
PF2 = a
a x c c x > a. Therefore, a
CONIC SECTIONS
259
Therefore
c c PF1 = a + x , PF2 = a x . a a
In that case P F2 PF1 = 2a. So, any point that satisfies
x2 y 2 = 1 , lies on the a 2 b2
hyperbola. Thus, we proved that the equation of hyperbola with origin (0,0) and transverse axis along x-axis is
x2 y 2 =1. a 2 b2
Note A hyperbola in which a = b is called an equilateral hyperbola. Discussion From the equation of the hyperbola we have obtained, it follows that, we
lines x = + a and x = a, (i.e. no real intercept on the conjugate axis). Similarly, we can derive the equation of the hyperbola in Fig 11.31 (b) as
y 2 x2 =1 a 2 b2
These two equations are known as the standard equations of hyperbolas. Note The standard equations of hyperbolas have transverse and conjugate axes as the coordinate axes and the centre at the origin. However, there are hyperbolas with any two perpendicular lines as transverse and conjugate axes, but the study of such cases will be dealt in higher classes. From the standard equations of hyperbolas (Fig11.29), we have the following observations: 1. Hyperbola is symmetric with respect to both the axes, since if (x, y) is a point on the hyperbola, then ( x, y), (x, y) and ( x, y) are also points on the hyperbola.
260
MATHEMATICS
2.
The foci are always on the transverse axis. It is the positive term whose denominator gives the transverse axis. For example, has transverse axis along x-axis of length 6, while has transverse axis along y-axis of length 10.
x2 y 2 =1 9 16
y 2 x2 =1 25 16
11.6.3 Latus rectum Definition 9 Latus rectum of hyperbola is a line segment perpendicular to the transverse axis through any of the foci and whose end points lie on the hyperbola. As in ellipse, it is easy to show that the length of the latus rectum in hyperbola is
2b 2 . a Example 14 Find the coordinates of the foci and the vertices, the eccentricity,the length of the latus rectum of the hyperbolas:
(i)
x2 y2 = 1 , (ii) y2 16x2 = 1 9 16
x2 y 2 = 1 with the standard equation 9 16
x2 y 2 =1 a 2 b2
Here, a = 3, b = 4 and c =
a 2 + b 2 = 9 + 16 = 5
Therefore, the coordinates of the foci are ( 5, 0) and that of vertices are ( 3, 0).Also,
y 2 x2 = 1 , we find that a 2 b2
CONIC SECTIONS
261
Therefore, the coordinates of the foci are (0, (0, 4). Also,
2b 2 1 17 c = 2 = . . The latus rectum The eccentricity e = = 2 a 4 a Example 15 Find the equation of the hyperbola with foci (0, 3) and vertices
(0,
11 ). 2
Solution Since the foci is on y-axis, the equation of the hyperbola is of the form
y 2 x2 =1 a 2 b2
Since vertices are (0,
11 11 ), a = 2 2 2 Also, since foci are (0, 3); c = 3 and b = c2 a2 = 25/4. Therefore, the equation of the hyperbola is
Example 16 Find the equation of the hyperbola where foci are (0, 12) and the length of the latus rectum is 36. Solution Since foci are (0, 12), it follows that c = 12. Length of the latus rectum = Therefore
2b 2 = 36 or b2 = 18a a
c2 = a2 + b2; gives 144 = a2 + 18a a2 + 18a 144 = 0, i.e., a = 24, 6. So Since a cannot be negative, we take a = 6 and so b2 = 108. Therefore, the equation of the required hyperbola is
x2 y2 = 1 , i.e., 3y2 x2 = 108 36 108
262
MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 11.4
In each of the Exercises 1 to 6, find the coordinates of the foci and the vertices, the eccentricity and the length of the latus rectum of the hyperbolas.
x2 y2 y 2 x2 =1 =1 2. 3. 9y2 4x2 = 36 16 9 9 27 4. 16x2 9y2 = 576 5. 5y2 9x2 = 36 6. 49y2 16x2 = 784. In each of the Exercises 7 to 15, find the equations of the hyperbola satisfying the given conditions. 7. Vertices ( 2, 0), foci ( 3, 0) 8. Vertices (0, 5), foci (0, 8) 9. Vertices (0, 3), foci (0, 5) 10. Foci ( 5, 0), the transverse axis is of length 8. 11. Foci (0, 13), the conjugate axis is of length 24.
1.
12. Foci ( 3 5 , 0), the latus rectum is of length 8. 13. Foci ( 4, 0), the latus rectum is of length 12 14. vertices ( 7,0), e =
4 . 3
Miscellaneous Examples
Example 17 The focus of a parabolic mirror as shown in Fig 11.33 is at a distance of 5 cm from its vertex. If the mirror is 45 cm deep, find the distance AB (Fig 11.33). Solution Since the distance from the focus to the vertex is 5 cm. We have, a = 5. If the origin is taken at the vertex and the axis of the mirror lies along the positive x-axis, the equation of the parabolic section is y2 = 4 (5) x = 20 x Note that x = 45. Thus y2 = 900 Therefore y = 30 Hence AB = 2y = 2 30 = 60 cm.
Fig 11.33 Example 18 A beam is supported at its ends by supports which are 12 metres apart. Since the load is concentrated at its centre, there
CONIC SECTIONS
263
is a deflection of 3 cm at the centre and the deflected beam is in the shape of a parabola. How far from the centre is the deflection 1 cm? Solution Let the vertex be at the lowest point and the axis vertical. Let the coordinate axis be chosen as shown in Fig 11.34.
Fig 11.34
The equation of the parabola takes the form x2 = 4ay. Since it passes through
2 = 24 100
24 = 2 6 metres
Example 19 A rod AB of length 15 cm rests in between two coordinate axes in such a way that the end point A lies on x-axis and end point B lies on y-axis. A point P(x, y) is taken on the rod in such a way that AP = 6 cm. Show that the locus of P is an ellipse. Solution Let AB be the rod making an angle with OX as shown in Fig 11.35 and P (x, y) the point on it such that AP = 6 cm. Since AB = 15 cm, we have PB = 9 cm. From P draw PQ and PR perpendicular on y-axis and x-axis, respectively.
Fig 11.35
264
MATHEMATICS
x 9
y 6
or
x2 y2 + =1 81 36
4. 5.
6. 7.
8.
CONIC SECTIONS
265
Summary
In this Chapter the following concepts and generalisations are studied. A circle is the set of all points in a plane that are equidistant from a fixed point in the plane. The equation of a circle with centre (h, k) and the radius r is (x h)2 + (y k)2 = r2. A parabola is the set of all points in a plane that are equidistant from a fixed line and a fixed point in the plane. The equation of the parabola with focus at (a, 0) a > 0 and directrix x = a is y2 = 4ax. Latus rectum of a parabola is a line segment perpendicular to the axis of the parabola, through the focus and whose end points lie on the hyperbola. Length of the latus rectum of the parabola y2 = 4ax is 4a. An ellipse is the set of all points in a plane, the sum of whose distances from two fixed points in the plane is a constant. The equations of an ellipse with foci on the x-axis is
x2 y 2 + =1. a 2 b2
Latus rectum of an ellipse is a line segment perpendicular to the major axis through any of the foci and whose end points lie on the ellipse. Length of the latus rectum of the ellipse
x2 y 2 2b 2 + 2 = 1 is . a2 b a
The eccentricity of an ellipse is the ratio between the distances from the centre of the ellipse to one of the foci and to one of the vertices of the ellipse. A hyperbola is the set of all points in a plane, the difference of whose distances from two fixed points in the plane is a constant. The equation of a hyperbola with foci on the x-axis is :
x2 y 2 =1 a 2 b2
266
MATHEMATICS
Latus rectum of hyperbola is a line segment perpendicular to the transverse axis through any of the foci and whose end points lie on the hyperbola. Length of the latus rectum of the hyperbola :
x2 y 2 2b2 2 = 1 is : . a a2 b
The eccentricity of a hyperbola is the ratio of the distances from the centre of the hyperbola to one of the foci and to one of the vertices of the hyperbola.
Historical Note
Geometry is one of the most ancient branches of mathematics. The Greek geometers investigated the properties of many curves that have theoretical and practical importance. Euclid wrote his treatise on geometry around 300 B.C. He was the first who organised the geometric figures based on certain axioms suggested by physical considerations. Geometry as initially studied by the ancient Indians and Greeks, who made essentially no use of the process of algebra. The synthetic approach to the subject of geometry as given by Euclid and in Sulbasutras, etc., was continued for some 1300 years. In the 200 B.C., Apollonius wrote a book called The Conic which was all about conic sections with many important discoveries that have remained unsurpassed for eighteen centuries. Modern analytic geometry is called Cartesian after the name of Rene Descartes (1596-1650 A.D.) whose relevant La Geometrie was published in 1637. But the fundamental principle and method of analytical geometry were already discovered by Pierre de Fermat (1601-1665 A.D.). Unfortunately, Fermats treatise on the subject, entitled Ad Locus Planos et So LIDOS Isagoge (Introduction to Plane and Solid Loci) was published only posthumously in 1679 A.D. So, Descartes came to be regarded as the unique inventor of the analytical geometry. Isaac Barrow avoided using cartesian method. Newton used method of undetermined coefficients to find equations of curves. He used several types of coordinates including polar and bipolar. Leibnitz used the terms abscissa, ordinate and coordinate. L Hospital (about 1700 A.D.) wrote an important textbook on analytical geometry. Clairaut (1729 A.D.) was the first to give the distance formula although in clumsy form. He also gave the intercept form of the linear equation. Cramer
CONIC SECTIONS
267
(1750 A.D.) made formal use of the two axes and gave the equation of a circle as ( y a)2 + (b x)2 = r He gave the best exposition of the analytical geometry of his time. Monge (1781 A.D.) gave the modern point-slope form of equation of a line as y y = a (x x) and the condition of perpendicularity of two lines as aa + 1 = 0. S.F. Lacroix (17651843 A.D.) was a prolific textbook writer, but his contributions to analytical geometry are found scattered. He gave the two-point form of equation of a line as
y =
(x )
( ax b) 1 + a2
.
a a His formula for finding angle between two lines was tan = 1 + aa . It is, of course, surprising that one has to wait for more than 150 years after the invention of analytical geometry before finding such essential basic formula. In 1818, C. Lame, a civil engineer, gave mE + mE = 0 as the curve passing through the points of intersection of two loci E = 0 and E = 0. Many important discoveries, both in Mathematics and Science, have been linked to the conic sections. The Greeks particularly Archimedes (287212 B.C.) and Apollonius (200 B.C.) studied conic sections for their own beauty. These curves are important tools for present day exploration of outer space and also for research into behaviour of atomic particles.
Chapter
12
12.1 Introduction
You may recall that to locate the position of a point in a plane, we need two intersecting mutually perpendicular lines in the plane. These lines are called the coordinate axes and the two numbers are called the coordinates of the point with respect to the axes. In actual life, we do not have to deal with points lying in a plane only. For example, consider the position of a ball thrown in space at different points of time or the position of an aeroplane as it flies from one place to another at different times during its flight. Similarly, if we were to locate the position of the Leonhard Euler (1707-1783) lowest tip of an electric bulb hanging from the ceiling of a room or the position of the central tip of the ceiling fan in a room, we will not only require the perpendicular distances of the point to be located from two perpendicular walls of the room but also the height of the point from the floor of the room. Therefore, we need not only two but three numbers representing the perpendicular distances of the point from three mutually perpendicular planes, namely the floor of the room and two adjacent walls of the room. The three numbers representing the three distances are called the coordinates of the point with reference to the three coordinate planes. So, a point in space has three coordinates. In this Chapter, we shall study the basic concepts of geometry in three dimensional space.* * For various activities in three dimensional geometry one may refer to the Book, A Hand Book for
designing Mathematics Laboratory in Schools, NCERT, 2005.
269
270
MATHEMATICS
accordingly. Thus, to each point P in the space there corresponds an ordered triplet (x, y, z) of real numbers. Conversely, given any triplet (x, y, z), we would first fix the point L on the x-axis corresponding to x, then locate the point M in the XY-plane such that (x, y) are the coordinates of the point M in the XY-plane. Note that LM is perpendicular to the x-axis or is parallel to the y-axis. Having reached the point M, we draw a perpendicular MP to the XY-plane and locate on it the point P corresponding to z. The point P so obtained has then the coordinates (x, y, z). Thus, there is a one to one correspondence between the points in space and ordered triplet (x, y, z) of real numbers. Alternatively, through the point P in the space, we draw three planes parallel to the coordinate planes, meeting the x-axis, y-axis and z-axis in the points A, B and C, respectively (Fig 12.3). Let OA = x, OB = y and OC = z. Then, the point P will have the coordinates x, y and z and we write P (x, y, z). Conversely, given x, y and z, we locate the three points A, B and C on the three coordinate axes. Through the points A, B and C we draw planes parallel to Fig 12.3 the YZ-plane, ZX-plane and XY-plane, respectively. The point of interesection of these three planes, namely, ADPF, BDPE and CEPF is obviously the point P, corresponding to the ordered triplet (x, y, z). We observe that if P (x, y, z) is any point in the space, then x, y and z are perpendicular distances from YZ, ZX and XY planes, respectively. Note The coordinates of the origin O are (0,0,0). The coordinates of any point on the x-axis will be as (x,0,0) and the coordinates of any point in the YZ-plane will be as (0, y, z). Remark The sign of the coordinates of a point determine the octant in which the point lies. The following table shows the signs of the coordinates in eight octants. Table 12.1
s ant Oct nates rdi Coo
I + + +
II + +
III +
IV + +
V + +
VI +
VII
VIII +
x y z
271
Example 1 In Fig 12.3, if P is (2,4,5), find the coordinates of F. Solution For the point F, the distance measured along OY is zero. Therefore, the coordinates of F are (2,0,5). Example 2 Find the octant in which the points (3,1,2) and (3,1, 2) lie. Solution From the Table 12.1, the point (3,1, 2) lies in second octant and the point (3, 1, 2) lies in octant VI.
EXERCISE 12.1
1. 2. 3. A point is on the x -axis. What are its y-coordinate and z-coordinates? A point is in the XZ-plane. What can you say about its y-coordinate? Name the octants in which the following points lie: (1,. 2, 3), (4, 2, 3), (4, 2, 5), (4, 2, 5), ( 4, 2, 5), ( 4, 2, 5), (3, 1, 6) (2, 4, 7). 4. Fill in the blanks: (i) The x-axis and y-axis taken together determine a plane known as_______. (ii) The coordinates of points in the XY-plane are of the form _______. (iii) Coordinate planes divide the space into ______ octants.
Fig 12.4
... (1)
Also, triangle ANQ is right angle triangle with ANQ a right angle.
272
MATHEMATICS
(1) and (2), we have PQ2 = PA2 + AN2 + NQ2 PA = y2 y1, AN = x2 x1 and NQ = z2 z1 PQ = (x2 x1)2 + (y2 y1) + (z2 z1)2 PQ =
( x2 x1 ) 2 +( y 2 y1 ) 2 +( z2 z1 ) 2
2
This gives us the distance between two points (x1, y1, z1) and (x2, y2, z2). In particular, if x1 = y1 = z1 = 0, i.e., point P is origin O, then OQ =
2 2 2 x2 + y 2 + z 2 ,
which gives the distance between the origin O and any point Q (x2, y2, z2). Example 3 Find the distance between the points P(1, 3, 4) and Q ( 4, 1, 2). Solution The distance PQ between the points P (1,3, 4) and Q ( 4, 1, 2) is PQ = = =
(4 1) 2 + (1 + 3) 2 + (2 4) 2
25 + 16 + 4
45 = 3 5 units
Example 4 Show that the points P (2, 3, 5), Q (1, 2, 3) and R (7, 0, 1) are collinear. Solution We know that points are said to be collinear if they lie on a line. Now, PQ = QR = and PR =
(1 + 2) 2 + ( 2 3) 2 + (3 5) 2 = 9 + 1 + 4 = 14 (7 1) 2 + (0 2) 2 + (1 3) 2 = 36 + 4 + 16 = 56 = 2 14 (7 + 2) 2 + (0 3) 2 + (1 5) 2 = 81 + 9 + 36 = 126 = 3 14
Thus, PQ + QR = PR. Hence, P, Q and R are collinear. Example 5 Are the points A (3, 6, 9), B (10, 20, 30) and C (25, 41, 5), the vertices of a right angled triangle? Solution By the distance formula, we have AB 2 = (10 3)2 + (20 6)2 + (30 9)2 = 49 + 196 + 441 = 686 BC
2
273
= 225 + 3721 + 625 = 4571 CA 2 We find that = (3 25)2 + (6 + 41)2 + (9 5)2 = 484 + 2209 + 16 = 2709 CA2 + AB2 BC2. Hence, the triangle ABC is not a right angled triangle. Example 6 Find the equation of set of points P such that PA2 + PB2 = 2k2, where A and B are the points (3, 4, 5) and (1, 3, 7), respectively. Solution Let the coordinates of point P be (x, y, z). Here PA2 = (x 3)2 + (y 4)2 + ( z 5)2 PB2 = (x + 1)2 + (y 3)2 + (z + 7)2 By the given condition PA2 + PB2 = 2k2, we have (x 3)2 + (y 4)2 + (z 5)2 + (x + 1)2 + (y 3)2 + (z + 7)2 = 2k2 i.e., 2x2 + 2y2 + 2z2 4x 14y + 4z = 2k2 109.
EXERCISE 12.2
1. Find the distance between the following pairs of points: (i) (2, 3, 5) and (4, 3, 1) (iii) (1, 3, 4) and (1, 3, 4) 3. Verify the following: (i) (0, 7, 10), (1, 6, 6) and (4, 9, 6) are the vertices of an isosceles triangle. (ii) (0, 7, 10), (1, 6, 6) and ( 4, 9, 6) are the vertices of a right angled triangle. (iii) (1, 2, 1), (1, 2, 5), (4, 7, 8) and (2, 3, 4) are the vertices of a parallelogram. 4. Find the equation of the set of points which are equidistant from the points (1, 2, 3) and (3, 2, 1). 5. Find the equation of the set of points P, the sum of whose distances from A (4, 0, 0) and B ( 4, 0, 0) is equal to 10. (ii) (3, 7, 2) and (2, 4, 1) (iv) (2, 1, 3) and (2, 1, 3).
2. Show that the points (2, 3, 5), (1, 2, 3) and (7, 0, 1) are collinear.
274
MATHEMATICS
divide PQ in the given ratio m : n internally. Draw PL, QM and RN perpendicular to the XY-plane. Obviously PL || RN || QM and feet of these perpendiculars lie in a XY-plane. The points L, M and N will lie on a line which is the intersection of the plane containing PL, RN and QM with the XY-plane. Through the point R draw a line ST parallel to the line LM. Line ST will intersect the line LP externally at the point S and the line MQ at T, as shown in Fig 12.5. Also note that quadrilaterals LNRS and NMTR are parallelograms. The triangles PSR and QTR are similar. Therefore,
Fig 12.5
m PR SP SL PL NR PL z z1 = = = = = n QR QT QM TM QM NR z2 z
This implies
z=
mz 2 +nz1 m+n
y =
Hence, the coordinates of the point R which divides the line segment joining two points P (x1, y1, z1) and Q (x2, y2, z2) internally in the ratio m : n are
mx2 + nx1 my2 + ny1 mz2 + nz1 m+n , m+n , m+n If the point R divides PQ externally in the ratio m : n, then its coordinates are obtained by replacing n by n so that coordinates of point R will be
mx2 nx1 my2 ny1 mz 2 nz1 , , mn mn mn Case 1 Coordinates of the mid-point: In case R is the mid-point of PQ, then
m : n = 1 : 1 so that x =
x1 + x2 y + y2 z + z2 ,y = 1 and z = 1 . 2 2 2
275
These are the coordinates of the mid point of the segment joining P (x1, y1, z1) and Q (x2, y2, z2). Case 2 The coordinates of the point R which divides PQ in the ratio k : 1 are obtained by taking k =
Generally, this result is used in solving problems involving a general point on the line passing through two given points. Example 7 Find the coordinates of the point which divides the line segment joining the points (1, 2, 3) and (3, 4, 5) in the ratio 2 : 3 (i) internally, and (ii) externally. Solution (i) Let P (x, y, z) be the point which divides line segment joining A(1, 2, 3) and B (3, 4, 5) internally in the ratio 2 : 3. Therefore
x=
, z=
9 2 1 , , 5 5 5 (ii) Let P (x, y, z) be the point which divides segment joining A (1, 2, 3) and B (3, 4, 5) externally in the ratio 2 : 3. Then
Thus, the required point is
x =
Therefore, the required point is (3, 14, 19). Example 8 Using section formula, prove that the three points ( 4, 6, 10), (2, 4, 6) and (14, 0, 2) are collinear. Solution Let A ( 4, 6, 10), B (2, 4, 6) and C(14, 0, 2) be the given points. Let the point P divides AB in the ratio k : 1. Then coordinates of the point P are
2 k 4 4 k + 6 6 k + 10 , , k +1 k +1 k +1
Let us examine whether for some value of k, the point P coincides with point C.
276
MATHEMATICS
On putting
2k 4 =14 , we get k = 3 k +1 2
3 4( ) + 6 2 =0 3 +1 2
When
4k + 6 3 = k = , then k +1 2
and
6k + 10 = k +1
3 6( ) + 10 2 = 2 3 +1 2
Therefore, C (14, 0, 2) is a point which divides AB externally in the ratio 3 : 2 and is same as P.Hence A, B, C are collinear. Example 9 Find the coordinates of the centroid of the triangle whose vertices are (x1, y1, z1), (x2, y2, z2) and (x3, y3, z3). Solution Let ABC be the triangle. Let the coordinates of the vertices A, B,C be (x1, y1, z1), (x2, y2, z2) and (x3, y3, z3), respectively. Let D be the mid-point of BC. Hence coordinates of D are
x2 + x3 y 2 + y3 z2 + z3 , , 2 2 2 Let G be the centroid of the triangle. Therefore, it divides the median AD in the ratio 2 : 1. Hence, the coordinates of G are
x2 + x3 y2 + y3 z 2 + z3 2 + x1 2 + y1 2 + z1 2 2 2 , , 2 +1 2 +1 2 +1
or
x1 + x2 + x3 y1 + y2 + y3 z1 + z2 + z3 , , 3 3 3
Example 10 Find the ratio in which the line segment joining the points (4, 8, 10) and (6, 10, 8) is divided by the YZ-plane. Solution Let YZ-plane divides the line segment joining A (4, 8, 10) and B (6, 10, 8) at P (x, y, z) in the ratio k : 1. Then the coordinates of P are
277
4 + 6k 8 + 10k 10 8k , , k +1 k +1 k +1
Since P lies on the YZ-plane, its x-coordinate is zero, i.e., or
4 + 6k =0 k +1
EXERCISE 12.3
1. 2. 3. 4. Find the coordinates of the point which divides the line segment joining the points ( 2, 3, 5) and (1, 4, 6) in the ratio (i) 2 : 3 internally, (ii) 2 : 3 externally. Given that P (3, 2, 4), Q (5, 4, 6) and R (9, 8, 10) are collinear. Find the ratio in which Q divides PR. Find the ratio in which the YZ-plane divides the line segment formed by joining the points (2, 4, 7) and (3, 5, 8). Using section formula, show that the points A (2, 3, 4), B (1, 2, 1) and
5.
1 C 0 , , 2 are collinear. 3 Find the coordinates of the points which trisect the line segment joining the points P (4, 2, 6) and Q (10, 16, 6).
Miscellaneous Examples
Example 11 Show that the points A (1, 2, 3), B (1, 2, 1), C (2, 3, 2) and D (4, 7, 6) are the vertices of a parallelogram ABCD, but it is not a rectangle. Solution To show ABCD is a parallelogram we need to show opposite side are equal Note that. AB = BC = CD = DA =
(1 1) 2 +(2 2) 2 +(1 3) 2 = (2 + 1) 2 +(3 + 2) 2 +( 2 + 1) 2 = ( 4 2) 2 +(7 3) 2 +(6 2) 2 = (1 4) 2 +(2 7) 2 +(3 6) 2 =
4 + 16 + 16 = 6
9 + 25 + 9 =
43
4 + 16 + 16 = 6 9 + 25 + 9 = 43
278
MATHEMATICS
Now, it is required to prove that ABCD is not a rectangle. For this, we show that diagonals AC and BD are unequal. We have AC BD = =
( 2 1) 2 +(3 2) 2 +(2 3) 2 = 1 + 1 + 1= 3 ( 4 + 1) 2 +(7 + 2) 2 +(6 + 1) 2 = 25 + 81 + 49 = 155 .
Since AC BD, ABCD is not a rectangle. Note We can also show that ABCD is a parallelogram, using the property that diagonals AC and BD bisect each other. Example 12 Find the equation of the set of the points P such that its distances from the points A (3, 4, 5) and B ( 2, 1, 4) are equal. Solution If P (x, y, z) be any point such that PA = PB. Now or or
( x 3) 2 + ( y 4) 2 + ( z + 5) 2 = ( x + 2) 2 + ( y 1) 2 + ( z 4) 2
( x 3) 2 + ( y 4) 2 + ( z + 5) 2 = ( x + 2) 2 + ( y 1) 2 + ( z 4) 2
10 x + 6y 18z 29 = 0.
Example 13 The centroid of a triangle ABC is at the point (1, 1, 1). If the coordinates of A and B are (3, 5, 7) and (1, 7, 6), respectively, find the coordinates of the point C. Solution Let the coordinates of C be (x, y, z) and the coordinates of the centroid G be (1, 1, 1). Then
279
4. Find the coordinates of a point on y-axis which are at a distance of 5 2 from the point P (3, 2, 5). 5. A point R with x-coordinate 4 lies on the line segment joining the points P(2, 3, 4) and Q (8, 0, 10). Find the coordinates of the point R. [Hint Suppose R divides PQ in the ratio k : 1. The coordinates of the point R are given
8k + 2 3 10k + 4 by , , ]. k +1 k +1 k +1 6.If A and B be the points (3, 4, 5) and (1, 3, 7), respectively, find the equation of the set of points P such that PA2 + PB2 = k2, where k is a constant.
Summary
In three dimensions, the coordinate axes of a rectangular Cartesian coordinate system are three mutually perpendicular lines. The axes are called the x, y and z-axes. The three planes determined by the pair of axes are the coordinate planes, called XY, YZ and ZX-planes. The three coordinate planes divide the space into eight parts known as octants. The coordinates of a point P in three dimensional geometry is always written in the form of triplet like (x, y, z). Here x, y and z are the distances from the YZ, ZX and XY-planes. (i) Any point on x-axis is of the form (x, 0, 0) (ii) Any point on y-axis is of the form (0, y, 0) (iii) Any point on z-axis is of the form (0, 0, z). Distance between two points P(x1, y1, z1) and Q (x2, y2, z2) is given by
PQ = ( x2 x1 )2 + ( y2 y1 )2 + ( z2 z1 )2
The coordinates of the point R which divides the line segment joining two points P (x1 y1 z1) and Q (x2, y2, z2) internally and externally in the ratio m : n are given by
mx2 + nx1 my2 + ny1 mz2 + nz1 mx2 nx1 my2 ny1 mz2 nz1 , , , , and m+ n m+n mn mn , m+n mn respectively.
The coordinates of the mid-point of the line segment joining two points
280
MATHEMATICS
Historical Note
Rene Descartes (15961650 A.D.), the father of analytical geometry, essentially dealt with plane geometry only in 1637 A.D. The same is true of his co-inventor Pierre Fermat (1601-1665 A.D.) and La Hire (1640-1718 A.D.). Although suggestions for the three dimensional coordinate geometry can be found in their works but no details. Descartes had the idea of coordinates in three dimensions but did not develop it. J.Bernoulli (1667-1748 A.D.) in a letter of 1715 A.D. to Leibnitz introduced the three coordinate planes which we use today. It was Antoinne Parent (1666-1716 A.D.), who gave a systematic development of analytical solid geometry for the first time in a paper presented to the French Academy in 1700 A.D. L.Euler (1707-1783 A.D.) took up systematically the three dimensional coordinate geometry, in Chapter 5 of the appendix to the second volume of his Introduction to Geometry in 1748 A.D. It was not until the middle of the nineteenth century that geometry was extended to more than three dimensions, the well-known application of which is in the Space-Time Continuum of Einsteins Theory of Relativity.
Chapter
13
13.1 Introduction
This chapter is an introduction to Calculus. Calculus is that branch of mathematics which mainly deals with the study of change in the value of a function as the points in the domain change. First, we give an intuitive idea of derivative (without actually defining it). Then we give a naive definition of limit and study some algebra of limits. Then we come back to a definition of derivative and study some algebra of derivatives. We also obtain derivatives of certain standard functions.
Physical experiments have confirmed that the body dropped from a tall cliff covers a distance of 4.9t2 metres in t seconds, i.e., distance s in metres covered by the body as a function of time t in seconds is given by s = 4.9t2. The adjoining Table 13.1 gives the distance travelled in metres at various intervals of time in seconds of a body dropped from a tall cliff. The objective is to find the veloctiy of the body at time t = 2 seconds from this data. One way to approach this problem is to find the average velocity for various intervals of time ending at t = 2 seconds and hope that these throw some light on the velocity at t = 2 seconds. Average velocity between t = t1 and t = t2 equals distance travelled between t = t1 and t = t2 seconds divided by (t2 t1). Hence the average velocity in the first two seconds
282
MATHEMATICS
Table 13.1
(19.6 0 ) m = 9.8 m / s . ( 2 0) s
s 0 4.9 11.025 15.876 17.689 18.63225 19.6 20.59225 21.609 23.716 30.625 44.1 78.4
Table 13.2
t1 v
0 9.8
1 14.7
1.5 17.15
1.8 18.62
1.9 19.11
1.95 19.355
1.99 19.551
From Table 13.2, we observe that the average velocity is gradually increasing. As we make the time intervals ending at t = 2 smaller, we see that we get a better idea of the velocity at t = 2. Hoping that nothing really dramatic happens between 1.99 seconds and 2 seconds, we conclude that the average velocity at t = 2 seconds is just above 19.551m/s. This conclusion is somewhat strengthened by the following set of computation. Compute the average velocities for various time intervals starting at t = 2 seconds. As before the average velocity v between t = 2 seconds and t = t2 seconds is =
Distance travelled between 2 seconds and t2 seconds t2 2 Distance travelled in t2 seconds Distance travelled in 2 seconds t2 2
283
The following Table 13.3 gives the average velocity v in metres per second between t = 2 seconds and t2 seconds.
Table 13.3
t2 v
2.5
2.2
2.1
2.05
2.01
Here again we note that if we take smaller time intervals starting at t = 2, we get better idea of the velocity at t = 2. In the first set of computations, what we have done is to find average velocities in increasing time intervals ending at t = 2 and then hope that nothing dramatic happens just before t = 2. In the second set of computations, we have found the average velocities decreasing in time intervals ending at t = 2 and then hope that nothing dramatic happens just after t = 2. Purely on the physical grounds, both these sequences of average velocities must approach a common limit. We can safely conclude that the velocity of the body at t = 2 is between 19.551m/s and 19.649 m/s. Technically, we say that the instantaneous velocity at t = 2 is between 19.551 m/s and 19.649 m/s. As is well-known, velocity is the rate of change of distance. Hence what we have accomplished is the following. From the given data of distance covered at various time instants we have estimated the rate of change of the distance at a given instant of time. We say that the derivative of the distance function s = 4.9t2 at t = 2 is between 19.551 and 19.649. An alternate way of viewing this limiting process is shown in Fig 13.1. This is a plot of distance s of the body from the top of the cliff versus the time t elapsed. In the limit as the sequence of time intervals h1, h2, ..., approaches zero, the sequence of average velocities approaches the same limit as does the Fig 13.1 sequence of ratios
284
MATHEMATICS
13.3 Limits
The above discussion clearly points towards the fact that we need to understand limiting process in greater clarity. We study a few illustrative examples to gain some familiarity with the concept of limits. Consider the function f(x) = x2. Observe that as x takes values very close to 0, the value of f(x) also moves towards 0 (See Fig 2.10 Chapter 2). We say
lim f ( x ) = 0
x 0
(to be read as limit of f (x) as x tends to zero equals zero). The limit of f (x) as x tends to zero is to be thought of as the value f (x) should assume at x = 0. In general as x a, f (x) l, then l is called limit of the function f (x) which is symbolically written as lim f ( x ) = l . x a Consider the following function g(x) = |x|, x 0. Observe that g(0) is not defined. Computing the value of g(x) for values of x very near to 0, we see that the value of g(x) moves towards 0. So, lim g(x) = 0. This is intuitively x0 clear from the graph of y = |x| for x 0. (See Fig 2.13, Chapter 2). Consider the following function.
x2 4 , x2. x2 Compute the value of h(x) for values of x very near to 2 (but not at 2). Convince yourself that all these values are near to 4. This is somewhat strengthened by considering the graph of the function y = h(x) given here (Fig 13.2). h( x) =
Fig 13.2
285
In all these illustrations the value which the function should assume at a given point x = a did not really depend on how is x tending to a. Note that there are essentially two ways x could approach a number a either from left or from right, i.e., all the values of x near a could be less than a or could be greater than a. This naturally leads to two limits the right hand limit and the left hand limit. Right hand limit of a function f(x) is that value of f(x) which is dictated by the values of f(x) when x tends to a from the right. Similarly, the left hand limit. To illustrate this, consider the function
1, x 0 f ( x) = 2, x > 0
Graph of this function is shown in the Fig 13.3. It is clear that the value of f at 0 dictated by values of f(x) with x 0 equals 1, i.e., the left hand limit of f (x) at 0 is
lim f ( x) =1 .
x0
Similarly, the value of f at 0 dictated by values of f (x) with x > 0 equals 2., i.e., the right hand limit of f (x) at 0 is
x 0 +
lim f ( x ) = 2 .
Fig 13.3
In this case the right and left hand limits are different, and hence we say that the limit of f (x) as x tends to zero does not exist (even though the function is defined at 0). Summary We say xlim f(x) is the expected value of f at x = a given the values of f near a x to the left of a. This value is called the left hand limit of f at a. We say lim+ f ( x ) is the expected value f at x = a given the values of
xa
f near x to the right of a. This value is called the right hand limit of f(x) at a. If the right and left hand limits coincide, we call that common value as the limit of f(x) at x = a and denote it by lim f(x). x a Illustration 1 Consider the function f(x) = x + 10. We want to find the limit of this function at x = 5. Let us compute the value of the function f(x) for x very near to 5. Some of the points near and to the left of 5 are 4.9, 4.95, 4.99, 4.995. . ., etc. Values of the function at these points are tabulated below. Similarly, the real number 5.001,
286
MATHEMATICS
5.01, 5.1 are also points near and to the right of 5. Value of the function at these points are also given in the Table 13.4.
Table 13.4
x f(x)
4.9 14.9
4.95 14.95
4.99 14.99
4.995 14.995
5.001 15.001
5.01 15.01
5.1 15.1
From the Table 13.4, we deduce that value of f(x) at x = 5 should be greater than 14.995 and less than 15.001 assuming nothing dramatic happens between x = 4.995 and 5.001. It is reasonable to assume that the value of the f(x) at x = 5 as dictated by the numbers to the left of 5 is 15, i.e.,
x 5
lim f ( x ) = 15 .
Similarly, when x approaches 5 from the right, f(x) should be taking value 15, i.e.,
x 5+
lim f ( x ) = 15 .
Hence, it is likely that the left hand limit of f(x) and the right hand limit of f(x) are both equal to 15. Thus,
x 5
This conclusion about the limit being equal to 15 is somewhat strengthened by seeing the graph of this function which is given in Fig 2.16, Chapter 2. In this figure, we note that as x appraches 5 from either right or left, the graph of the function f(x) = x +10 approaches the point (5, 15). We observe that the value of the function at x = 2 also happens to be equal to 12. Illustration 2 Consider the function f(x) = x3. Let us try to find the limit of this function at x = 1. Proceeding as in the previous case, we tabulate the value of f(x) at x near 1. This is given in the Table 13.5.
Table 13.5
x f(x)
0.9 0.729
0.99 0.970299
0.999 0.997002999
1.001 1.003003001
1.01 1.030301
1.1 1.331
From this table, we deduce that value of f(x) at x = 1 should be greater than 0.997002999 and less than 1.003003001 assuming nothing dramatic happens between
287
x = 0.999 and 1.001. It is reasonable to assume that the value of the f(x) at x = 1 as dictated by the numbers to the left of 1 is 1, i.e.,
x 1
lim f ( x ) = 1 . lim f ( x ) = 1 .
Similarly, when x approaches 1 from the right, f(x) should be taking value 1., i.e.,
x 1+
Hence, it is likely that the left hand limit of f(x) and the right hand limit of f(x) are both equal to 1. Thus,
x 1
This conclusion about the limit being equal to 1 is somewhat strengthened by seeing the graph of this function which is given in Fig 2.11, Chapter 2. In this figure, we note that as x approaches 1 from either right or left, the graph of the function f(x) = x3 approaches the point (1, 1). We observe, again, that the value of the function at x = 1 also happens to be equal to 1. Illustration 3 Consider the function f(x) = 3x. Let us try to find the limit of this function at x = 2. The following Table 13.6 is now self-explanatory.
Table 13.6
x f(x)
1.9 5.7
1.95 5.85
1.99 5.97
1.999 5.997
2.001 6.003
2.01 6.03
2.1 6.3
As before we observe that as x approaches 2 from either left or right, the value of f(x) seem to approach 6. We record this as
x 2
Its graph shown in Fig 13.4 strengthens this fact. Here again we note that the value of the function at x = 2 coincides with the limit at x = 2. Illustration 4 Consider the constant function f(x) = 3. Let us try to find its limit at x = 2. This function being the constant function takes the same
Fig 13.4
288
MATHEMATICS
value (3, in this case) everywhere, i.e., its value at points close to 2 is 3. Hence
lim f ( x ) = lim+ f ( x ) = lim f ( x ) = 3
x2 x 2 x2
Graph of f(x) = 3 is anyway the line parallel to x-axis passing through (0, 3) and is shown in Fig 2.9, Chapter 2. From this also it is clear that the required limit is 3. In fact, it is easily observed that lim f ( x ) = 3 for any real number a. x a Illustration 5 Consider the function f(x) = x2 + x. We want to find lim f ( x ) . We x 1 tabulate the values of f(x) near x = 1 in Table 13.7.
Table 13.7
x f(x)
0.9 1.71
0.99 1.9701
0.999 1.997001
1.01 2.0301
1.1 2.31
1.2 2.64
From the graph of f(x) = x2 + x shown in the Fig 13.5, it is clear that as x approaches 1, the graph approaches (1, 2). Here, again we observe that the
lim f (x) = f (1) x1
Fig 13.5
Then Also
289
Illustration 6 Consider the function f(x) = sin x. We are interested in lim sin x ,
x 2
where the angle is measured in radians. Here, we tabulate the (approximate) value of f(x) near this, we may deduce that
x
Further, this is supported by the graph of f(x) = sin x which is given in the Fig 3.8 (Chapter 3). In this case too, we observe that lim sin x = 1.
x 2
0.1 2
0.9950
0.01 2
0.9999
+ 0.01 2
0.9999
+ 0.1 2
0.9950
Illustration 7 Consider the function f(x) = x + cos x. We want to find the lim f (x).
x0
Here we tabulate the (approximate) value of f(x) near 0 (Table 13.9). Table 13.9 x f(x) 0.1 0.9850 0.01 0.98995 0.001 0.9989995 0.001 1.0009995 0.01 1.00995 0.1 1.0950
In this case too, we observe that lim f (x) = f (0) = 1. Now, can you convince yourself that
lim [ x + cos x ] = lim x + lim cos x is indeed true? x 0 x 0 x 0
290
MATHEMATICS
1 for x > 0 . We want to know lim f (x). x0 x2 Here, observe that the domain of the function is given to be all positive real numbers. Hence, when we tabulate the values of f(x), it does not make sense to talk of x approaching 0 from the left. Below we tabulate the values of the function for positive x close to 0 (in this table n denotes any positive integer). From the Table 13.10 given below, we see that as x tends to 0, f(x) becomes larger and larger. What we mean here is that the value of f(x) may be made larger than any given number.
Table 13.10
1 1
lim f ( x ) = +
x 0
0.1 100
0.01 10000
10n 102n
We also remark that we will not come across such limits in this course. Illustration 9 We want to find lim f ( x ) , where x 0
x 2, x < 0 f ( x) = 0 , x = 0 x + 2, x > 0
As usual we make a table of x near 0 with f(x). Observe that for negative values of x we need to evaluate x 2 and for positive values, we need to evaluate x + 2.
Table 13.11
x f(x)
0.1 2.1
0.01 2.01
0.001 2.001
0.001 2.001
0.01 2.01
0.1 2.1
From the first three entries of the Table 13.11, we deduce that the value of the function is decreasing to 2 and hence.
x 0
lim f ( x ) = 2
291
From the last three entires of the table we deduce that the value of the function is increasing from 2 and hence
x 0+
lim f ( x ) = 2
Since the left and right hand limits at 0 do not coincide, we say that the limit of the function at 0 does not exist. Graph of this function is given in the Fig13.6. Here, we remark that the value of the function at x = 0 is well defined and is, indeed, equal to 0, but the limit of the function at x = 0 is not even defined. Illustration 10 As a final illustration, we find lim f ( x ) , x 1 where
x + 2 x 1 f ( x) = x =1 0
Table 13.12 Fig 13.6
x f(x)
0.9 2.9
0.99 2.99
0.999 2.999
1.001 3.001
1.01 3.01
1.1 3.1
As usual we tabulate the values of f(x) for x near 1. From the values of f(x) for x less than 1, it seems that the function should take value 3 at x = 1., i.e.,
x 1
lim f ( x ) = 3 .
Similarly, the value of f(x) should be 3 as dictated by values of f(x) at x greater than 1. i.e.
x 1+
lim f ( x ) = 3 .
But then the left and right hand limits coincide and hence
lim f ( x ) = lim f ( x ) = lim f ( x ) = 3 . +
x 1 x 1
x 1
Graph of function given in Fig 13.7 strengthens our deduction about the limit. Here, we
Fig 13.7
292
MATHEMATICS
note that in general, at a given point the value of the function and its limit may be different (even when both are defined). 13.3.1 Algebra of limits In the above illustrations, we have observed that the limiting process respects addition, subtraction, multiplication and division as long as the limits and functions under consideration are well defined. This is not a coincidence. In fact, below we formalise these as a theorem without proof. Theorem 1 Let f and g be two functions such that both lim f (x) and lim g(x) exist.
x a x a
Then (i) Limit of sum of two functions is sum of the limits of the functions, i.e.,
lim [f(x) + g (x)] = lim f(x) + lim g(x).
x a x a x a
(ii) Limit of difference of two functions is difference of the limits of the functions, i.e.,
(iii) Limit of product of two functions is product of the limits of the functions, i.e.,
(iv) Limit of quotient of two functions is quotient of the limits of the functions (whenever the denominator is non zero), i.e.,
lim
x a
g ( x)
f ( x)
lim f ( x )
x a
lim g ( x )
x a
Note In particular as a special case of (iii), when g is the constant function such that g(x) = , for some real number , we have
lim ( . f ) ( x ) = .lim f ( x ) . xa x a
In the next two subsections, we illustrate how to exploit this theorem to evaluate limits of special types of functions. 13.3.2 Limits of polynomials and rational functions A function f is said to be a polynomial function if f(x) is zero function or if f(x) = a0 + a1x + a2x2 +. . . + anxn, where ais are real numbers such that an 0 for some natural number n. We know that lim x = a. Hence
x a
293
lim x n = a n
x a
Now, let f ( x ) = a0 + a1 x + a2 x 2 + ... + an x n be a polynomial function. Thinking of each of a0 , a1 x, a2 x 2 ,..., an x n as a function, we have
lim f
xa
( x ) = lim a0 + a1 x + a2 x 2 + ... + an x n x a
2 n = lim a0 + lim a1 x + lim a2 x + ... + lim an x x a x a xa x a 2 n = a0 + a1 lim x + a2 lim x + ... + an lim x x a x a x a
= a0 + a1a + a2 a 2 + ... + an a n = f (a) (Make sure that you understand the justification for each step in the above!)
lim f ( x ) = lim
x a
g ( x) h( x)
x a
lim g ( x )
x a
lim h ( x )
x a
g (a) h ( a)
However, if h(a) = 0, there are two scenarios (i) when g(a) 0 and (ii) when g(a) = 0. In the former case we say that the limit does not exist. In the latter case we can write g(x) = (x a)k g1 (x), where k is the maximum of powers of (x a) in g(x) Similarly, h(x) = (x a)l h1 (x) as h (a) = 0. Now, if k l, we have
lim f ( x ) =
xa
lim g ( x )
x a
lim h ( x )
x a
lim ( x a ) g1 ( x )
k x a
lim ( x a ) h1 ( x )
l x a
294
MATHEMATICS
lim ( x a )
=
xa x a
( k l )
g1 ( x )
lim h1 ( x )
0. g1 ( a ) h1 ( a )
=0
(ii) lim x ( x + 1) x 3
(iii)
x 1
Solution The required limits are all limits of some polynomial functions. Hence the limits are the values of the function at the prescribed points. We have (i) lim [x3 x2 + 1] = 13 12 + 1 = 1 x1 (ii) lim x ( x + 1) = 3 ( 3 + 1) = 3 ( 4 ) = 12 x 3 (iii)
x 1
(iii)
x2 4 lim 3 2 x 2 x 4 x + 4 x
(iv)
x3 2 x2 lim 2 x 2 x 5 x + 6
1 x2 3 (v) lim 2 . 2 x 1 x x x 3x + 2 x
Solution All the functions under consideration are rational functions. Hence, we first evaluate these functions at the prescribed points. If this is of the form
0 , we try to 0
rewrite the function cancelling the factors which are causing the limit to be of the form
0 . 0
295
x ( x 2)
( x + 2)
=
as x 2
2 ( 2 2) 2+2
0 = 0. 4
0 . 0
Hence lim
x 2
( x + 2 )( x 2 ) x2 4 2 = lim x2 x ( x 2) x3 4 x 2 + 4 x
( x + 2) 2+2 4 = lim x x 2 = 2 2 2 = 0 x 2 ( ) ( )
which is not defined. (iv) Evaluating the function at 2, we get it of the form
x2 ( x 2) x3 2 x 2 lim 2 = lim x 2 ( x 2 )( x 3 ) x2 x 5 x + 6
0 . 0
Hence
= lim x 2
( 2) 4 x2 = = = 4. ( x 3) 2 3 1
2
296
MATHEMATICS
1 1 x2 x2 3 = x ( x 1) x x 2 3 x + 2 x 2 x x 3x 2 + 2 x
x2 1 = x x 1 x x 1 x 2 ) ( )( ) ( x2 4x + 4 1 = x x 1 x 2 )( ) (
x2 4x + 3 = x x 1 x 2 ( )( )
Evaluating the function at 1, we get it of the form
0 . 0
Hence
( x 3)( x 1) = lim x x 1 x 2 x 1 ( )( )
x3 1 3 = lim x x 2 = 1 1 2 = 2. x 1 ( ) ( )
We remark that we could cancel the term (x 1) in the above evaluation because x 1. Evaluation of an important limit which will be used in the sequel is given as a theorem below. Theorem 2 For any positive integer n,
lim xn an = na n1 . x a x a
Remark The expression in the above theorem for the limit is true even if n is any rational number and a is positive.
297
Proof Dividing (xn an) by (x a), we see that xn an = (xa) (xn1 + xn2 a + xn3 a2 + ... + x an2 + an1) Thus, lim
xn an = lim (xn1 + xn2 a + xn3 a2 + ... + x an2 + an1) x a x a x a
Example 3 Evaluate:
(ii) lim
x 0
1+ x 1 x
lim
x 1
3 2
x 0
y 1 1+ x 1 = lim y 1 y 1 x
1 1
y 2 12 = lim y 1 y 1
298
MATHEMATICS
13.4 Limits of Trigonometric Functions The following facts (stated as theorems) about functions in general come in handy in calculating limits of some trigonometric functions. Theorem 3 Let f and g be two real valued functions with the same domain such that f (x) g( x) for all x in the domain of definition, For some a, if both lim f(x) and x a
lim g(x) exist, then lim f(x) lim g(x). This is illustrated in Fig 13.8. x a x a x a
Fig 13.8
Theorem 4 (Sandwich Theorem) Let f, g and h be real functions such that f (x) g( x) h(x) for all x in the common domain of definition. For some real number a, if lim f(x) = l = lim h(x), then lim g(x) = l. This is illustrated in Fig 13.9. xa xa
x a
Fig 13.9
Given below is a beautiful geometric proof of the following important inequality relating trigonometric functions.
cos x <
sin x <1 x
(*)
299
Proof We know that sin ( x) = sin x and cos( x) = cos x. Hence, it is sufficient to prove the inequality for 0 < x <
. 2 In the Fig 13.10, O is the centre of the unit circle such that
. Line segments B A and 2 CD are perpendiculars to OA. Further, join AC. Then Area of OAC < Area of sector OAC < Area of OAB.
Fig 13.10
1 x 1 OA.CD < ..(OA) 2 < OA.AB . 2 2 2 i.e., CD < x . OA < AB. From OCD,
i.e.,
CD AB (since OC = OA) and hence CD = OA sin x. Also tan x = and OA OA hence AB = OA. tan x. Thus OA sin x < OA. x < OA. tan x. Since length OA is positive, we have sin x < x < tan x.
sin x = Since 0 < x < 1<
sin x =1. x 0 x
(ii) lim
1 cos x =0. x 0 x
sin x is sandwiched between the x function cos x and the constant function which takes value 1.
300
MATHEMATICS
Further, since lim cos x = 1, we see that the proof of (i) of the theorem is x0 complete by sandwich theorem.
x 0 . This 2
x . 2 sin 4 x sin 2 x
(ii) lim
Example 4 Evaluate:
(i) lim
x 0
x 0
tan x x
Solution (i)
lim
x 0
301
A general rule that needs to be kept in mind while evaluating limits is the following.
f ( x) Say, given that the limit lim g x exists and we want to evaluate this. First we check xa ( )
the value of f (a) and g(a). If both are 0, then we see if we can get the factor which is causing the terms to vanish, i.e., see if we can write f(x) = f1 (x) f2(x) so that f1 (a) = 0 and f2 (a) 0. Similarly, we write g(x) = g1 (x) g2(x), where g1(a) = 0 and g2(a) 0. Cancel out the common factors from f(x) and g(x) (if possible) and write
g ( x)
Then
f ( x)
p ( x)
lim
x a
g ( x)
f ( x)
EXERCISE 13.1
Evaluate the following limits in Exercises 1 to 22. 1. lim x + 3 x 3 4. lim
22 2. lim x x 7
5. lim
x10 + x 5 + 1 x 1
2 3. lim r r 1
4x + 3 x 4 x 2
3 x 2 x 10 x2 4
1
x 1
6. lim
( x + 1)5 1
x
x0
7. lim
x 2
8. lim
x 3
x 4 81 2 x2 5x 3
9. lim
x 0
ax + b cx + 1
10. lim z 1
z3 1
1
11. lim
z 6 1
ax 2 + bx + c ,a+b+c 0 x 1 cx 2 + bx + a
1 1 + 12. lim x 2 x 2 x + 2
13. lim
x 0
sin ax bx
14. lim
x 0
sin ax , a, b 0 sin bx
302
MATHEMATICS
16. lim
x 0
cos x x
17. lim
cos 2 x 1 x 0 cos x 1
x 0
20. lim
x 0
22.
x 2
lim
x 1 x >1
x <1 x =1 x >1
303
29. Let a1, a2, . . ., an be fixed real numbers and define a function
f ( x ) = ( x a1 ) ( x a2 ) ... ( x an ) .
What is xlim (x) ? For some a a1, a2, ..., an, compute lim f (x). x a a
1
f ( x) 2 x2 1
x 1
= , evaluate lim f ( x ) . x 1
32.
13.5 Derivatives
We have seen in the Section 13.2, that by knowing the position of a body at various time intervals it is possible to find the rate at which the position of the body is changing. It is of very general interest to know a certain parameter at various instants of time and try to finding the rate at which it is changing. There are several real life situations where such a process needs to be carried out. For instance, people maintaining a reservoir need to know when will a reservoir overflow knowing the depth of the water at several instances of time, Rocket Scientists need to compute the precise velocity with which the satellite needs to be shot out from the rocket knowing the height of the rocket at various times. Financial institutions need to predict the changes in the value of a particular stock knowing its present value. In these, and many such cases it is desirable to know how a particular parameter is changing with respect to some other parameter. The heart of the matter is derivative of a function at a given point in its domain of definition.
304
MATHEMATICS
Definition 1 Suppose f is a real valued function and a is a point in its domain of definition. The derivative of f at a is defined by
h provided this limit exists. Derivative of f (x) at a is denoted by f(a). lim f ( a + h) f (a )
h0
Example 5 Find the derivative at x = 2 of the function f(x) = 3x. Solution We have f (2) = lim
f ( 2 + h ) f ( 2) h 3( 2 + h ) 3( 2) h
h0
= lim
h0
= lim
h 0
6 + 3h 6 3h = lim = lim 3 = 3 . h 0 h h 0 h
The derivative of the function 3x at x = 2 is 3. Example 6 Find the derivative of the function f(x) = 2x2 + 3x 5 at x = 1. Also prove that f (0) + 3f ( 1) = 0. Solution We first find the derivatives of f(x) at x = 1 and at x = 0. We have
f ' ( 1) = lim
f ( 1 + h ) f ( 1) h
h0
2 ( 1 + h )2 + 3 ( 1 + h ) 5 2 ( 1)2 + 3 ( 1) 5 = lim h 0 h
= lim
2h 2 h = lim ( 2h 1) = 2 ( 0 ) 1 = 1 h0 h f (0 + h ) f (0) h
h0
and
f ' ( 0 ) = lim
h0
2 ( 0 + h )2 + 3 ( 0 + h ) 5 2 ( 0 )2 + 3 ( 0 ) 5 = lim h 0 h
305
= lim Clearly
2h 2 + 3h = lim ( 2h + 3) = 2 ( 0 ) + 3 = 3 h0 h0 h
f ' ( 0 ) + 3 f ' ( 1) = 0
Remark At this stage note that evaluating derivative at a point involves effective use of various rules, limits are subjected to. The following illustrates this. Example 7 Find the derivative of sin x at x = 0. Solution Let f(x) = sin x. Then f (0) = lim
f (0 + h) f (0) h sin ( 0 + h ) sin ( 0 ) h
h0
= lim
h0
= lim
sin h =1 h 0 h
Example 8 Find the derivative of f(x) = 3 at x = 0 and at x = 3. Solution Since the derivative measures the change in function, intuitively it is clear that the derivative of the constant function must be zero at every point. This is indeed, supported by the following computation.
f ' ( 0 ) = lim
f ( 0 + h ) f (0) h f ( 3 + h ) f ( 3) h
h0
= lim = lim
h0
33 0 = lim = 0 . h0 h h 33 =0. h
Similarly
f ' ( 3) = lim
h0
h0
We now present a geometric interpretation of derivative of a function at a point. Let y = f(x) be a function and let P = (a, f(a)) and Q = (a + h, f(a + h) be two points close to each other on the graph of this function. The Fig 13.11 is now self explanatory.
Fig 13.11
306
MATHEMATICS
f (a + h) f (a)
h From the triangle PQR, it is clear that the ratio whose limit we are taking is precisely equal to tan(QPR) which is the slope of the chord PQ. In the limiting process, as h tends to 0, the point Q tends to P and we have QR h0 Q P PR h This is equivalent to the fact that the chord PQ tends to the tangent at P of the curve y = f(x). Thus the limit turns out to be equal to the slope of the tangent. Hence lim = lim f (a + h) f (a )
h0
f ( a ) = tan .
For a given function f we can find the derivative at every point. If the derivative exists at every point, it defines a new function called the derivative of f . Formally, we define derivative of a function as follows. Definition 2 Suppose f is a real valued function, the function defined by
h wherever the limit exists is defined to be the derivative of f at x and is denoted by f(x). This definition of derivative is also called the first principle of derivative. h Clearly the domain of definition of f (x) is wherever the above limit exists. There are different notations for derivative of a function. Sometimes f (x) is denoted by lim f ( x + h) f ( x)
h0
Thus
f ' ( x ) = lim
f ( x + h) f ( x)
h0
d ( f ( x )) or if y = f(x), it is denoted by dy . This is referred to as derivative of f(x) dx dx or y with respect to x. It is also denoted by D (f (x) ). Further, derivative of f at x = a
is also denoted by
d f ( x) dx
or
df dx
df or even . dx x = a
307
= lim = lim
10 ( x + h ) 10 ( x ) h
h0
Example 10 Find the derivative of f(x) = x2. Solution We have, f (x) = lim
f ( x + h) f ( x) h
h0
( x + h )2 ( x )2 lim
h0
= lim ( h + 2 x ) = 2 x h 0
Example 11 Find the derivative of the constant function f (x) = a for a fixed real number a. Solution We have, f (x) = lim = lim
f ( x + h) f ( x) h
h0
h 0
aa 0 = lim = 0 as h 0 h 0 h h
1 x
f ( x + h) f ( x) h
h0
1 1 = lim ( x + h) x h 0 h
1 x ( x + h) = lim h x x + h h 0 ) (
1 1 h = lim h x x + h = lim x x + h h 0 ( h 0 ) ) (
1 x2
308
MATHEMATICS
13.5.1 Algebra of derivative of functions Since the very definition of derivatives involve limits in a rather direct fashion, we expect the rules for derivatives to follow closely that of limits. We collect these in the following theorem. Theorem 5 Let f and g be two functions such that their derivatives are defined in a common domain. Then
(i)
(ii)
d d d f ( x ) g ( x ) = dx f ( x) dx g ( x ) . dx
(iii) Derivative of product of two functions is given by the following product rule.
d d d f ( x ) . g ( x ) = dx f ( x ) . g ( x ) + f ( x) . dx g ( x) dx
(iv) Derivative of quotient of two functions is given by the following quotient rule (whenever the denominator is nonzero).
d d f ( x ) . g ( x) f ( x) g ( x) d f ( x ) dx dx = dx g ( x ) ( g ( x ) )2
The proofs of these follow essentially from the analogous theorem for limits. We will not prove these here. As in the case of limits this theorem tells us how to compute derivatives of special types of functions. The last two statements in the theorem may be restated in the following fashion which aids in recalling them easily: Let u = f ( x ) and v = g (x). Then
( uv )
= u v + uv
This is referred to a Leibnitz rule for differentiating product of functions or the product rule. Similarly, the quotient rule is
309
u u v uv = v2 v
Now, let us tackle derivatives of some standard functions. It is easy to see that the derivative of the function f(x) = x is the constant function 1. This is because f(x) = lim
f ( x + h) f ( x) h
h0
= lim
x+hx h 0 h
= lim1 = 1 . h0 We use this and the above theorem to compute the derivative of f(x) = 10x = x + .... + x (ten terms). By (1) of the above theorem
df ( x ) d = dx dx
=
( x + ... + x )
(ten terms)
d d x +. . .+ x (ten terms) dx dx = 1 + ... + 1 (ten terms) = 10. We note that this limit may be evaluated using product rule too. Write f(x) = 10x = uv, where u is the constant function taking value 10 everywhere and v(x) = x. Here, f(x) = 10x = uv we know that the derivative of u equals 0. Also derivative of v(x) = x equals 1. Thus by the product rule we have
f ( x ) = (10 x ) = ( uv ) = u v + uv = 0.x + 10.1 = 10
On similar lines the derivative of f(x) = x2 may be evaluated. We have f(x) = x2 = x .x and hence
d d d df ( x.x ) = ( x ) .x + x. ( x ) = dx dx dx dx
= 1. x + x.1 = 2 x . More generally, we have the following theorem. Theorem 6 Derivative of f(x) = xn is nxn 1 for any positive integer n. Proof By definition of the derivative function, we have
f ' ( x ) = lim f ( x + h) f ( x) h
h0
= lim
h 0
( x + h )n x n
h
310
MATHEMATICS
C0 x n +
( C )x
n 1
n 1
h + ... +
C n h n and
+... + h
n
n1
). Thus
df ( x ) ( x + h) xn = lim dx h 0 h
= lim
h nx n 1 + .... + h n1 h
h 0
n 1 n 1 = lim nx + ... + h , = nx n1 . h 0
Alternatively, we may also prove this by induction on n and the product rule as follows. The result is true for n = 1, which has been proved earlier. We have
d n d x.x n1 x = dx dx
=
( )
) ( )
)
( )
(
= 1.x
= x n 1 + ( n 1) x n1 = nx n1 . Remark The above theorem is true for all powers of x, i.e., n can be any real number (but we will not prove it here). 13.4.2 Derivative of polynomials and trigonometric functions We start with the
df ( x ) = nan x n1 + ( n 1) an 1 x x 2 + ... + 2a2 x + a1 . dx Proof of this theorem is just putting together part (i) of Theorem 5 and Theorem 6.
Example 13 Compute the derivative of 6x100 x55 + x. Solution A direct application of the above theorem tells that the derivative of the above function is 600 x99 55 x54 + 1 .
311
Example 14 Find the derivative of f(x) = 1 + x + x2 + x3 +... + x50 at x = 1. Solution A direct application of the above Theorem 7 tells that the derivative of the above function is 1 + 2x + 3x2 + . . . + 50x49. At x = 1 the value of this function equals 1 + 2(1) + 3(1)2 + .. . + 50(1)49 = 1 + 2 + 3 + . . . + 50 = Example 15 Find the derivative of f(x) =
( 50 )( 51)
2
= 1275.
x +1 x Solution Clearly this function is defined everywhere except at x = 0. We use the quotient rule with u = x + 1 and v = x. Hence u = 1 and v = 1. Therefore
df ( x) d x + 1 d u u v uv 1( x ) ( x + 1)1 1 = = = 2 = dx v = 2 2 dx dx x v x x
Example 16 Compute the derivative of sin x. Solution Let f(x) = sin x. Then
f ( x + h) f ( x) sin ( x + h ) sin ( x ) df ( x ) = lim = lim h0 h0 dx h h
Example 17 Compute the derivative of tan x. Solution Let f(x) = tan x. Then
f ( x + h) f ( x) tan ( x + h ) tan ( x ) df ( x ) = lim = lim h0 h0 dx h h
312
MATHEMATICS
1 = sec 2 x . cos2 x
Example 18 Compute the derivative of f(x) = sin2 x. Solution We use the Leibnitz product rule to evaluate this.
df ( x ) d = ( sin x sin x ) dx dx
= ( sin x ) sin x + sin x ( sin x )
EXERCISE 13.2
1. 2. 3. 4. Find the derivative of x2 2 at x = 10. Find the derivative of 99x at x = l00. Find the derivative of x at x = 1. Find the derivative of the following functions from first principle. (i) (iii)
x 3 27
(ii) (iv)
( x 1)( x 2 )
x +1 x 1
313
Prove that f (1) = 100 f ( 0 ) . 6. Find the derivative of x n + ax n 1 + a 2 x n 2 + . . . + a n 1 x + a n for some fixed real number a. 7. For some constants a and b, find the derivative of (i)
( x a) ( x b)
(ii)
( ax
+b
(iii)
xa x b
3 4
(ii)
( 5x
+ 3x 1
) ( x 1)
x 3 ( 5 + 3 x )
x 4 3 4 x 5
5 9 (iv) x 3 6 x
(vi)
2 x2 x + 1 3x 1
10. Find the derivative of cos x from first principle. 11. Find the derivative of the following functions: (i) sin x cos x (iv) cosec x (vi) 5sin x 6 cos x + 7 (ii) sec x (v) 3cot x + 5cosec x (vii) 2 tan x 7 sec x (iii) 5sec x + 4 cos x
Miscellaneous Examples
Example 19 Find the derivative of f from the first principles, where f is given by (i) f (x) =
2x + 3 x2
(ii)
f (x) = x +
1 x
f ( x ) = lim
h 0
f ( x + h) f ( x) h
2 ( x + h ) + 3 2x + 3 x2 = lim x + h 2 h 0 h
314
MATHEMATICS
= lim h 0 = lim h 0
7 7 2 = lim ( x 2 ) ( x + h 2 ) = h 0 ( x 2)
(ii) Again, note that the function f is also not defined at x = 2. The function is not defined at x = 0. But, we have
f ( x )
1 x
1 1 1 h + x + h x h
1 x xh 1 1 lim h + = lim h 1 = h 0 h x ( x + h ) h 0 h x ( x + h )
1 1 = lim 1 x x + h = 1 2 h 0 x ( )
Again, note that the function f is not defined at x = 0. Example 20 Find the derivative of f(x) from the first principles, where f(x) is (i) sin x + cos x (ii) x sin x Solution (i) we have f ' ( x ) = = lim
f ( x + h) f ( x) h
h0
= lim
h 0
sin x cos h + cos x sin h + cos x cos h sin x sin h sin x cos x h
315
= lim = lim
h 0
h0
( x + h ) sin ( x + h ) x sin x
h
h0
h0
h0
h0
x sin x ( cos h 1) h
h0
Solution (i) Recall the trigonometric formula sin 2x = 2 sin x cos x. Thus
= 2 cos 2 x sin 2 x
316
MATHEMATICS
1 . Here, we use the fact tan x that the derivative of tan x is sec2 x which we saw in Example 17 and also that the derivative of the constant function is 0.
Alternatively, this may be computed by noting that cot x =
d d 1 dg (cot x ) = = dx dx tan x dx
=
(ii)
x + cos x tan x
317
) 8 Find the derivative of the following functions (it is to be understood that a, b, c, d, p, q, r and s are fixed non-zero constants and m and n are integers):
(i) x (ii) ( x) 1 (iii) sin (x + 1) (iv) cos (x 2. (x + a)
r 3. (px + q) + s x
1 x 6. 1 1 x 1+
9.
px 2 + qx + r ax + b
4.
( ax + b )( cx + d )2
1 ax + bx + c
2
ax + b 5. cx + d
ax + b px + qx + r
2
7.
8.
10.
a b 2 + cos x 4 x x
cos x 1 + sin x
318
MATHEMATICS
(x
+ 1 cos x
( ax
+ sin x
) ( p + q cos x )
x 2 cos 4 27. sin x
30.
x sin n x
25.
( x + cos x ) ( x tan x )
x 1 + tan x
28.
( x + sec x ) ( x tan x )
Summary
The expected value of the function as dictated by the points to the left of a point defines the left hand limit of the function at that point. Similarly the right hand limit. Limit of a function at a point is the common value of the left and right hand limits, if they coincide. For a function f and a real number a, lim f(x) and f (a) may not be same (In x a fact, one may be defined and not the other one). For functions f and g the following holds:
lim [ f ( x ) g ( x) ] = lim f ( x ) lim g ( x)
x a x a x a
319
lim
x 0
sin x =1 x
1 cos x =0 x 0 x The derivative of a function f at a is defined by lim f ( a + h) f ( a) h Derivative of a function f at any point x is defined by f ( a) = lim
h 0
Historical Note
In the history of mathematics two names are prominent to share the credit for inventing calculus, Issac Newton (1642 1727) and G.W. Leibnitz (1646 1717). Both of them independently invented calculus around the seventeenth century. After the advent of calculus many mathematicians contributed for further development of calculus. The rigorous concept is mainly attributed to the great
320
MATHEMATICS
mathematicians, A.L. Cauchy, J.L.Lagrange and Karl Weierstrass. Cauchy gave the foundation of calculus as we have now generally accepted in our textbooks. Cauchy used D Alemberts limit concept to define the derivative of a function. Starting with definition of a limit, Cauchy gave examples such as the limit of
sin
Chapter
14
MATHEMATICAL REASONING
There are few things which we know which are not capable of mathematical reasoning and when these can not, it is a sign that our knowledge of them is very small and confused and where a mathematical reasoning can be had, it is as great a folly to make use of another, as to grope for a thing in the dark when you have a candle stick standing by you. ARTHENBOT
14.1 Introduction
In this Chapter, we shall discuss about some basic ideas of Mathematical Reasoning. All of us know that human beings evolved from the lower species over many millennia. The main asset that made humans superior to other species was the ability to reason. How well this ability can be used depends on each persons power of reasoning. How to develop this power? Here, we shall discuss the process of reasoning especially in the context of mathematics. In mathematical language, there are two kinds of reasoning inductive and deductive. We have already discussed the inductive reasoning in the context of mathematical induction. In this Chapter, we shall discuss some fundamentals of deductive reasoning.
14.2 Statements
The basic unit involved in mathematical reasoning is a mathematical statement. Let us start with two sentences: In 2003, the president of India was a woman. An elephant weighs more than a human being.
322
MATHEMATICS
When we read these sentences, we immediately decide that the first sentence is false and the second is correct. There is no confusion regarding these. In mathematics such sentences are called statements. On the other hand, consider the sentence: Women are more intelligent than men. Some people may think it is true while others may disagree. Regarding this sentence we cannot say whether it is always true or false . That means this sentence is ambiguous. Such a sentence is not acceptable as a statement in mathematics. A sentence is called a mathematically acceptable statement if it is either true or false but not both. Whenever we mention a statement here, it is a mathematically acceptable statement. While studying mathematics, we come across many such sentences. Some examples are: Two plus two equals four. The sum of two positive numbers is positive. All prime numbers are odd numbers. Of these sentences, the first two are true and the third one is false. There is no ambiguity regarding these sentences. Therefore, they are statements. Can you think of an example of a sentence which is vague or ambiguous? Consider the sentence: The sum of x and y is greater than 0 Here, we are not in a position to determine whether it is true or false, unless we know what x and y are. For example, it is false where x = 1, y = 3 and true when x = 1 and y = 0. Therefore, this sentence is not a statement. But the sentence: For any natural numbers x and y, the sum of x and y is greater than 0 is a statement. Now, consider the following sentences : How beautiful! Open the door.
Where are you going? Are they statements? No, because the first one is an exclamation, the second an order and the third a question. None of these is considered as a statement in mathematical language. Sentences involving variable time such as today, tomorrow or yesterday are not statements. This is because it is not known what time is referred here. For example, the sentence Tomorrow is Friday
MATHEMATICAL REASONING
323
is not a statement. The sentence is correct (true) on a Thursday but not on other days. The same argument holds for sentences with pronouns unless a particular person is referred to and for variable places such as here, there etc., For example, the sentences
She is a mathematics graduate. Kashmir is far from here. are not statements. Here is another sentence There are 40 days in a month. Would you call this a statement? Note that the period mentioned in the sentence above is a variable time that is any of 12 months. But we know that the sentence is always false (irrespective of the month) since the maximum number of days in a month can never exceed 31. Therefore, this sentence is a statement. So, what makes a sentence a statement is the fact that the sentence is either true or false but not both. While dealing with statements, we usually denote them by small letters p, q, r,... For example, we denote the statement Fire is always hot by p. This is also written as p: Fire is always hot. Example 1 Check whether the following sentences are statements. Give reasons for your answer. (i) 8 is less than 6. (iii) The sun is a star. (v) There is no rain without clouds. (ii) Every set is a finite set. (iv) Mathematics is fun. (vi) How far is Chennai from here?
Solution (i) This sentence is false because 8 is greater than 6. Hence it is a statement. (ii) This sentence is also false since there are sets which are not finite. Hence it is a statement. (iii) It is a scientifically established fact that sun is a star and, therefore, this sentence is always true. Hence it is a statement. (iv) This sentence is subjective in the sense that for those who like mathematics, it may be fun but for others it may not be. This means that this sentence is not always true. Hence it is not a statement.
324
MATHEMATICS
(v) It is a scientifically established natural phenomenon that cloud is formed before it rains. Therefore, this sentence is always true. Hence it is a statement. (vi) This is a question which also contains the word Here. Hence it is not a statement. The above examples show that whenever we say that a sentence is a statement we should always say why it is so. This why of it is more important than the answer.
EXERCISE 14.1
1. Which of the following sentences are statements? Give reasons for your answer. (i) There are 35 days in a month. (ii) Mathematics is difficult. (iii) The sum of 5 and 7 is greater than 10. (iv) The square of a number is an even number. (v) The sides of a quadrilateral have equal length. (vi) Answer this question. (vii) The product of (1) and 8 is 8. (viii) The sum of all interior angles of a triangle is 180. (ix) Today is a windy day. (x) All real numbers are complex numbers. 2. Give three examples of sentences which are not statements. Give reasons for the answers.
MATHEMATICAL REASONING
325
It is not the case that New Delhi is a city This can also be written as It is false that New Delhi is a city. This can simply be expressed as New Delhi is not a city. Definition 1 If p is a statement, then the negation of p is also a statement and is denoted by p, and read as not p. Note While forming the negation of a statement, phrases like, It is not the case or It is false that are also used. Here is an example to illustrate how, by looking at the negation of a statement, we may improve our understanding of it. Let us consider the statement p: Everyone in Germany speaks German. The denial of this sentence tells us that not everyone in Germany speaks German. This does not mean that no person in Germany speaks German. It says merely that at least one person in Germany does not speak German. We shall consider more examples. Example 2 Write the negation of the following statements. (i) Both the diagonals of a rectangle have the same length. (ii)
7 is rational.
Solution (i) This statement says that in a rectangle, both the diagonals have the same length. This means that if you take any rectangle, then both the diagonals have the same length. The negation of this statement is It is false that both the diagonals in a rectangle have the same length This means the statement There is atleast one rectangle whose both diagonals do not have the same length. (ii) The negation of the statement in (ii) may also be written as It is not the case that 7 is rational. This can also be rewritten as
7 is not rational.
326
MATHEMATICS
Example 3 Write the negation of the following statements and check whether the resulting statements are true, (i) Australia is a continent. (ii) There does not exist a quadrilateral which has all its sides equal. (iii) Every natural number is greater than 0. (iv) The sum of 3 and 4 is 9. Solution (i) The negation of the statement is It is false that Australia is a continent. This can also be rewritten as Australia is not a continent. We know that this statement is false. (ii) The negation of the statement is It is not the case that there does not exist a quadrilateral which has all its sides equal. This also means the following: There exists a quadrilateral which has all its sides equal. This statement is true because we know that square is a quadrilaterial such that its four sides are equal. (iii) The negation of the statement is It is false that every natural number is greater than 0. This can be rewritten as There exists a natural number which is not greater than 0. This is a false statement. (iv) The negation is It is false that the sum of 3 and 4 is 9. This can be written as The sum of 3 and 4 is not equal to 9. This statement is true. 14.3.2 Compound statements Many mathematical statements are obtained by combining one or more statements using some connecting words like and, or, etc. Consider the following statement p: There is something wrong with the bulb or with the wiring. This statement tells us that there is something wrong with the bulb or there is
MATHEMATICAL REASONING
327
something wrong with the wiring. That means the given statement is actually made up of two smaller statements: q: There is something wrong with the bulb. r: There is something wrong with the wiring. connected by or Now, suppose two statements are given as below: p: 7 is an odd number. q: 7 is a prime number. These two statements can be combined with and r: 7 is both odd and prime number. This is a compound statement. This leads us to the following definition: Definition 2 A Compound Statement is a statement which is made up of two or more statements. In this case, each statement is called a component statement. Let us consider some examples. Example 4 Find the component statements of the following compound statements. (i) The sky is blue and the grass is green. (ii) It is raining and it is cold. (iii) All rational numbers are real and all real numbers are complex. (iv) 0 is a positive number or a negative number. Solution Let us consider one by one (i) The component statements are p: The sky is blue. q: The grass is green. The connecting word is and. (ii) The component statements are p: It is raining. q: It is cold.
328
MATHEMATICS
(vi) 24 is a multiple of 2, 4 and 8. Solution (i) The component statements are p: A square is a quadrilateral. q: A square has all its sides equal. We know that both these statements are true. Here the connecting word is and. (ii) The component statements are p: All prime numbers are odd number. q: All prime numbers are even number. Both these statements are false and the connecting word is or. (iii) The component statements are p: A person who has taken Mathematics can go for MCA. q: A person who has taken computer science can go for MCA. Both these statements are true. Here the connecting word is or. (iv) The component statements are p: Chandigarh is the capital of Haryana. q: Chandigarh is the capital of UP. The first statement is true but the second is false. Here the connecting word is and. (v) The component statements are
MATHEMATICAL REASONING
329
p: q:
The first statement is false and second is true. Here the connecting word is or. (vi) The component statements are p: 24 is a multiple of 2. q: 24 is a multiple of 4. r: 24 is a multiple of 8. All the three statements are true. Here the connecting words are and. Thus, we observe that compound statements are actually made-up of two or more statements connected by the words like and, or, etc. These words have special meaning in mathematics. We shall discuss this mattter in the following section.
EXERCISE 14.2
1. Write the negation of the following statements: (i) Chennai is the capital of Tamil Nadu. (ii) (iii) (iv)
2 is not a complex number
All triangles are not equilateral triangle. The number 2 is greater than 7.
(v) Every natural number is an integer. 2. Are the following pairs of statements negations of each other: (i) The number x is not a rational number. The number x is not an irrational number. The number x is a rational number. The number x is an irrational number. 3. Find the component statements of the following compound statements and check whether they are true or false. (i) Number 3 is prime or it is odd. (ii) (iii) All integers are positive or negative. 100 is divisible by 3, 11 and 5. (ii)
330
MATHEMATICS
Or, etc. are often used in Mathematical Statements. These are called connectives. When we use these compound statements, it is necessary to understand the role of these words. We discuss this below.
14.4.1 The word And Let us look at a compound statement with And.
p: A point occupies a position and its location can be determined. The statement can be broken into two component statements as q: A point occupies a position. r: Its location can be determined. Here, we observe that both statements are true. Let us look at another statement. p: 42 is divisible by 5, 6 and 7. This statement has following component statements q: 42 is divisible by 5. r: 42 is divisible by 6. s: 42 is divisible by 7. Here, we know that the first is false while the other two are true. We have the following rules regarding the connective And 1. 2. The compound statement with And is true if all its component statements are true. The component statement with And is false if any of its component statements is false (this includes the case that some of its component statements are false or all of its component statements are false). Example 6 Write the component statements of the following compound statements and check whether the compound statement is true or false. (i) A line is straight and extends indefinitely in both directions. (ii) 0 is less than every positive integer and every negative integer. (iii) All living things have two legs and two eyes. Solution (i) The component statements are p: A line is straight. q: A line extends indefinitely in both directions.
MATHEMATICAL REASONING
331
Both these statements are true, therefore, the compound statement is true. (ii) The component statements are p: 0 is less than every positive integer. q: 0 is less than every negative integer. The second statement is false. Therefore, the compound statement is false. (iii) The two component statements are p: All living things have two legs. q: All living things have two eyes. Both these statements are false. Therefore, the compound statement is false. Now, consider the following statement. p: A mixture of alcohol and water can be separated by chemical methods. This sentence cannot be considered as a compound statement with And. Here the word And refers to two things alcohol and water. This leads us to an important note. Note Do not think that a statement with And is always a compound statement as shown in the above example. Therefore, the word And is not used as a conjunction. 14.4.2 The word Or Let us look at the following statement. p: Two lines in a plane either intersect at one point or they are parallel. We know that this is a true statement. What does this mean? This means that if two lines in a plane intersect, then they are not parallel. Alternatively, if the two lines are not parallel, then they intersect at a point. That is this statement is true in both the situations. In order to understand statements with Or we first notice that the word Or is used in two ways in English language. Let us first look at the following statement. p: An ice cream or pepsi is available with a Thali in a restaurant. This means that a person who does not want ice cream can have a pepsi along with Thali or one does not want pepsi can have an ice cream along with Thali. That is, who do not want a pepsi can have an ice cream. A person cannot have both ice cream and pepsi. This is called an exclusive Or. Here is another statement. A student who has taken biology or chemistry can apply for M.Sc. microbiology programme. Here we mean that the students who have taken both biology and chemistry can apply for the microbiology programme, as well as the students who have taken only one of these subjects. In this case, we are using inclusive Or. It is important to note the difference between these two ways because we require this when we check whether the statement is true or not.
332
MATHEMATICS
Let us look at an example. Example 7 For each of the following statements, determine whether an inclusive Or or exclusive Or is used. Give reasons for your answer. (i) To enter a country, you need a passport or a voter registration card. (ii) The school is closed if it is a holiday or a Sunday. (iii) Two lines intersect at a point or are parallel. (iv) Students can take French or Sanskrit as their third language. Solution (i) Here Or is inclusive since a person can have both a passport and a voter registration card to enter a country. (ii) Here also Or is inclusive since school is closed on holiday as well as on Sunday. (iii) Here Or is exclusive because it is not possible for two lines to intersect and parallel together. (iv) Here also Or is exclusive because a student cannot take both French and Sanskrit. Rule for the compound statement with Or 1. 2. A compound statement with an Or is true when one component statement is true or both the component statements are true.
A compound statement with an Or is false when both the component statements are false. For example, consider the following statement. p: Two lines intersect at a point or they are parallel The component statements are q: Two lines intersect at a point. r: Two lines are parallel. Then, when q is true r is false and when r is true q is false. Therefore, the compound statement p is true. Consider another statement. p: 125 is a multiple of 7 or 8. Its component statements are q: 125 is a multiple of 7. r: 125 is a multiple of 8. Both q and r are false. Therefore, the compound statement p is false.
MATHEMATICAL REASONING
333
Again, consider the following statement: p: The school is closed, if there is a holiday or Sunday. The component statements are q: School is closed if there is a holiday. r: School is closed if there is a Sunday. Both q and r are true, therefore, the compound statement is true. Consider another statement. p: Mumbai is the capital of Kolkata or Karnataka. The component statements are q: Mumbai is the capital of Kolkata. r: Mumbai is the capital of Karnataka. Both these statements are false. Therefore, the compound statement is false. Let us consider some examples. Example 8 Identify the type of Or used in the following statements and check whether the statements are true or false: (i)
2 is a rational number or an irrational number.
(ii) To enter into a public library children need an identity card from the school or a letter from the school authorities. (iii) A rectangle is a quadrilateral or a 5-sided polygon. Solution (i) The component statements are p: 2 is a rational number. q: 2 is an irrational number. Here, we know that the first statement is false and the second is true and Or is exclusive. Therefore, the compound statement is true. (ii) The component statements are p: To get into a public library children need an identity card. q: To get into a public library children need a letter from the school authorities. Children can enter the library if they have either of the two, an identity card or the letter, as well as when they have both. Therefore, it is inclusive Or the compound statement is also true when children have both the card and the letter. (iii) Here Or is exclusive. When we look at the component statements, we get that the statement is true.
334
MATHEMATICS
14.4.3 Quantifiers Quantifiers are phrases like, There exists and For all. Another phrase which appears in mathematical statements is there exists. For example, consider the statement. p: There exists a rectangle whose all sides are equal. This means that there is atleast one rectangle whose all sides are equal. A word closely connected with there exists is for every (or for all). Consider a statement. p: For every prime number p,
p is an irrational number.
This means that if S denotes the set of all prime numbers, then for all the members p of the set S,
p is an irrational number.
In general, a mathematical statement that says for every can be interpreted as saying that all the members of the given set S where the property applies must satisfy that property. We should also observe that it is important to know precisely where in the sentence a given connecting word is introduced. For example, compare the following two sentences: 1. For every positive number x there exists a positive number y such that y < x. 2. There exists a positive number y such that for every positive number x, we have y < x. Although these statements may look similar, they do not say the same thing. As a matter of fact, (1) is true and (2) is false. Thus, in order for a piece of mathematical writing to make sense, all of the symbols must be carefully introduced and each symbol must be introduced at precisely the right place not too early and not too late. The words And and Or are called connectives and There exists and For all are called quantifiers. Thus, we have seen that many mathematical statements contain some special words and it is important to know the meaning attached to them, especially when we have to check the validity of different statements.
EXERCISE 14.3
1. For each of the following compound statements first identify the connecting words and then break it into component statements. (i) All rational numbers are real and all real numbers are not complex. (ii) Square of an integer is positive or negative. (iii) The sand heats up quickly in the Sun and does not cool down fast at night. (iv) x = 2 and x = 3 are the roots of the equation 3x2 x 10 = 0.
MATHEMATICAL REASONING
335
2. Identify the quantifier in the following statements and write the negation of the statements. (i) There exists a number which is equal to its square. (ii) For every real number x, x is less than x + 1. (iii) There exists a capital for every state in India. 3. Check whether the following pair of statements are negation of each other. Give reasons for your answer. (i) x + y = y + x is true for every real numbers x and y. (ii) There exists real numbers x and y for which x + y = y + x. 4. State whether the Or used in the following statements is exclusive or inclusive. Give reasons for your answer. (i) Sun rises or Moon sets. (ii) (iii) To apply for a driving licence, you should have a ration card or a passport. All integers are positive or negative.
14.5 Implications
In this Section, we shall discuss the implications of if-then, only if and if and only if . The statements with if-then are very common in mathematics. For example, consider the statement. r: If you are born in some country, then you are a citizen of that country. When we look at this statement, we observe that it corresponds to two statements p and q given by p : you are born in some country. q : you are citizen of that country. Then the sentence if p then q says that in the event if p is true, then q must be true. One of the most important facts about the sentence if p then q is that it does not say any thing (or places no demand) on q when p is false. For example, if you are not born in the country, then you cannot say anything about q. To put it in other words not happening of p has no effect on happening of q. Another point to be noted for the statement if p then q is that the statement does not imply that p happens. There are several ways of understanding if p then q statements. We shall illustrate these ways in the context of the following statement. r: If a number is a multiple of 9, then it is a multiple of 3. Let p and q denote the statements p : a number is a multiple of 9. q: a number is a multiple of 3.
336
MATHEMATICS
Then, if p then q is the same as the following: 1. p implies q is denoted by p q. The symbol stands for implies. This says that a number is a multiple of 9 implies that it is a multiple of 3. 2. p is a sufficient condition for q. This says that knowing that a number as a multiple of 9 is sufficient to conclude that it is a multiple of 3. 3. p only if q. This says that a number is a multiple of 9 only if it is a multiple of 3. 4. q is a necessary condition for p. This says that when a number is a multiple of 9, it is necessarily a multiple of 3. 5. q implies p. This says that if a number is not a multiple of 3, then it is not a multiple of 9.
14.5.1 Contrapositive and converse Contrapositive and converse are certain other statements which can be formed from a given statement with if-then. For example, let us consider the following if-then statement. If the physical environment changes, then the biological environment changes. Then the contrapositive of this statement is If the biological environment does not change, then the physical environment does not change. Note that both these statements convey the same meaning. To understand this, let us consider more examples.
Example 9 Write the contrapositive of the following statement: (i) If a number is divisible by 9, then it is divisible by 3. (ii) If you are born in India, then you are a citizen of India. (iii) If a triangle is equilateral, it is isosceles. Solution The contrapositive of the these statements are (i) If a number is not divisible by 3, it is not divisible by 9. (ii) If you are not a citizen of India, then you were not born in India. (iii) If a triangle is not isosceles, then it is not equilateral. The above examples show the contrapositive of the statement if p, then q is if q, then p. Next, we shall consider another term called converse. The converse of a given statement if p, then q is if q, then p.
MATHEMATICAL REASONING
337
For example, the converse of the statement p: If a number is divisible by 10, it is divisible by 5 is q: If a number is divisible by 5, then it is divisible by 10. Example 10 Write the converse of the following statements. (i) If a number n is even, then n2 is even. (ii) If you do all the exercises in the book, you get an A grade in the class. (iii) If two integers a and b are such that a > b, then a b is always a positive integer. Solution The converse of these statements are (i) If a number n2 is even, then n is even. (ii) If you get an A grade in the class, then you have done all the exercises of the book. (iii) If two integers a and b are such that a b is always a positive integer, then a > b. Let us consider some more examples. Example 11 For each of the following compound statements, first identify the corresponding component statements. Then check whether the statements are true or not. (i) If a triangle ABC is equilateral, then it is isosceles. (ii) If a and b are integers, then ab is a rational number. Solution (i) The component statements are given by p : Triangle ABC is equilateral. q : Triangle ABC is Isosceles. Since an equilateral triangle is isosceles, we infer that the given compound statement is true. (ii) The component statements are given by p : a and b are integers. q : ab is a rational number. since the product of two integers is an integer and therefore a rational number, the compound statement is true. If and only if, represented by the symbol means the following equivalent forms for the given statements p and q. (i) p if and only if q (ii) q if and only if p
338
MATHEMATICS
(iii) p is necessary and sufficient condition for q and vice-versa (iv) p q Consider an example. Example 12 Given below are two pairs of statements. Combine these two statements using if and only if . (i) p: If a rectangle is a square, then all its four sides are equal. q: If all the four sides of a rectangle are equal, then the rectangle is a square. (ii) p: If the sum of digits of a number is divisible by 3, then the number is divisible by 3. q: If a number is divisible by 3, then the sum of its digits is divisible by 3. Solution (i) A rectangle is a square if and only if all its four sides are equal. (ii) A number is divisible by 3 if and only if the sum of its digits is divisible by 3.
EXERCISE 14.4
1. Rewrite the following statement with if-then in five different ways conveying the same meaning. If a natural number is odd, then its square is also odd. 2. Write the contrapositive and converse of the following statements. (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) If x is a prime number, then x is odd. If the two lines are parallel, then they do not intersect in the same plane. Something is cold implies that it has low temperature. You cannot comprehend geometry if you do not know how to reason deductively. x is an even number implies that x is divisible by 4.
3. Write each of the following statements in the form if-then (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) You get a job implies that your credentials are good. The Bannana trees will bloom if it stays warm for a month. A quadrilateral is a parallelogram if its diagonals bisect each other. To get an A+ in the class, it is necessary that you do all the exercises of the book.
MATHEMATICAL REASONING
339
4. Given statements in (a) and (b). Identify the statements given below as contrapositive or converse of each other. (a) (i) (ii) (b) (i) (ii) If you live in Delhi, then you have winter clothes. If you do not have winter clothes, then you do not live in Delhi. If you have winter clothes, then you live in Delhi. If a quadrilateral is a parallelogram, then its diagonals bisect each other. If the diagonals of a quadrilateral do not bisect each other, then the quadrilateral is not a parallelogram. If the diagonals of a quadrilateral bisect each other, then it is a parallelogram.
340
MATHEMATICS
In order to prove the statement if p then q we need to show that any one of the following case is true. Case 1 By assuming that p is true, prove that q must be true.(Direct method) Case 2 By assuming that q is false, prove that p must be false.(Contrapositive method) Rule 4 Statements with if and only if In order to prove the statement p if and only if q, we need to show. (i) If p is true, then q is true and (ii) If q is true, then p is true Now we consider some examples. Example 13 Check whether the following statement is true or not. If x, y Z are such that x and y are odd, then xy is odd. Solution Let p : x, y Z such that x and y are odd q : xy is odd To check the validity of the given statement, we apply Case 1 of Rule 3. That is assume that if p is true, then q is true. p is true means that x and y are odd integers. Then x = 2m + 1, for some integer m. y = 2n + 1, for some integer n. Thus xy = (2m + 1) (2n + 1) = 2(2mn + m + n) + 1 This shows that xy is odd. Therefore, the given statement is true. Suppose we want to check this by using Case 2 of Rule 3, then we will proceed as follows. We assume that q is not true. This implies that we need to consider the negation of the statement q. This gives the statement q : Product xy is even. This is possible only if either x or y is even. This shows that p is not true. Thus we have shown that q p Note The above example illustrates that to prove p q, it is enough to show q p which is the contrapositive of the statement p q. Example 14 Check whether the following statement is true or false by proving its contrapositive. If x, y such that xy is odd, then both x and y are odd. Solution Let us name the statements as below
MATHEMATICAL REASONING
341
p : xy is odd. q : both x and y are odd. We have to check whether the statement p q is true or not, that is, by checking its contrapositive statement i.e., q p Now q : It is false that both x and y are odd. This implies that x (or y) is even. Then x = 2n for some integer n. Therefore, xy = 2ny for some integer n. This shows that xy is even. That is p is true. Thus, we have shown that q p and hence the given statement is true. Now what happens when we combine an implication and its converse? Next, we shall discuss this. Let us consider the following statements. p : A tumbler is half empty. q : A tumbler is half full. We know that if the first statement happens, then the second happens and also if the second happens, then the first happens. We can express this fact as If a tumbler is half empty, then it is half full. If a tumbler is half full, then it is half empty. We combine these two statements and get the following: A tumbler is half empty if and only if it is half full. Now, we discuss another method. 14.5.1 By Contradiction Here to check whether a statement p is true, we assume that p is not true i.e. p is true. Then, we arrive at some result which contradicts our assumption. Therefore, we conclude that p is true. Example 15 Verify by the method of contradiction. p:
7 is irrational
Solution In this method, we assume that the given statement is false. That is we assume that such that
342
MATHEMATICS
a2 a2 = 7b2 7 divides a. Therefore, there exists an integer c such b2 that a = 7c. Then a2 = 49c2 and a2 = 7b2 Hence, 7b2 = 49c2 b2 = 7c2 7 divides b. But we have already shown that 7 divides a. This implies that 7 is a common factor of both of a and b which contradicts our earlier assumption that a and b have no common factors. This shows that the
we get 7 = assumption 7 is rational is wrong. Hence, the statement 7 is irrational is true. Next, we shall discuss a method by which we may show that a statement is false. The method involves giving an example of a situation where the statement is not valid. Such an example is called a counter example. The name itself suggests that this is an example to counter the given statement. Example 16 By giving a counter example, show that the following statement is false. If n is an odd integer, then n is prime. Solution The given statement is in the form if p then q we have to show that this is false. For this purpose we need to show that if p then q. To show this we look for an odd integer n which is not a prime number. 9 is one such number. So n = 9 is a counter example. Thus, we conclude that the given statement is false. In the above, we have discussed some techniques for checking whether a statement is true or not. Note In mathematics, counter examples are used to disprove the statement. However, generating examples in favour of a statement do not provide validity of the statement.
EXERCISE 14.5
1. Show that the statement p: If x is a real number such that x3 + 4x = 0, then x is 0 is true by (i) direct method, (ii) method of contradiction, (iii) method of contrapositive 2. Show that the statement For any real numbers a and b, a2 = b2 implies that a = b is not true by giving a counter-example. 3. Show that the following statement is true by the method of contrapositive. p: If x is an integer and x2 is even, then x is also even. 4. By giving a counter example, show that the following statements are not true. (i) p: If all the angles of a triangle are equal, then the triangle is an obtuse angled triangle. (ii) q: The equation x2 1 = 0 does not have a root lying between 0 and 2.
MATHEMATICAL REASONING
343
5.
Which of the following statements are true and which are false? In each case give a valid reason for saying so. (i) p: Each radius of a circle is a chord of the circle. (ii) q: The centre of a circle bisects each chord of the circle. (iii) r: Circle is a particular case of an ellipse. (iv) s: If x and y are integers such that x > y, then x < y. (v) t : 11 is a rational number.
Miscellaneous Examples
Example 17 Check whether Or used in the following compound statement is exclusive or inclusive? Write the component statements of the compound statements and use them to check whether the compound statement is true or not. Justify your answer. t: you are wet when it rains or you are in a river. Solution Or used in the given statement is inclusive because it is possible that it rains and you are in the river. The component statements of the given statement are p : you are wet when it rains. q : You are wet when you are in a river. Here both the component statements are true and therefore, the compound statement is true. Example 18 Write the negation of the following statements: (i) p: For every real number x, x2 > x. (ii) q: There exists a rational number x such that x2 = 2. (iii) r: All birds have wings. (iv) s: All students study mathematics at the elementary level. Solution (i) The negation of p is It is false that p is which means that the condition x2 > x does not hold for all real numbers. This can be expressed as
p: There exists a real number x such that x2 < x. (ii) Negation of q is it is false that q, Thus q is the statement. q: There does not exist a rational number x such that x2 = 2.
This statement can be rewritten as q: For all real numbers x, x2 2
(iii) The negation of the statement is r: There exists a bird which have no wings.
344
MATHEMATICS
(iv) The negation of the given statement is s: There exists a student who does not study mathematics at the elementary level. Example 19 Using the words necessary and sufficient rewrite the statement The integer n is odd if and only if n2 is odd. Also check whether the statement is true. Solution The necessary and sufficient condition that the integer n be odd is n2 must be odd. Let p and q denote the statements p : the integer n is odd. q : n2 is odd. To check the validity of p if q, we have to check whether if p then q and if q then p is true. Case 1 If p, then q If p, then q is the statement: If the integer n is odd, then n2 is odd. We have to check whether this statement is true. Let us assume that n is odd. Then n = 2k + 1 when k is an integer. Thus n2 = (2k + 1)2 = 4k2 + 4k + 1 Therefore, n2 is one more than an even number and hence is odd. Case 2 If q, then p If q, then p is the statement If n is an integer and n2 is odd, then n is odd. We have to check whether this statement is true. We check this by contrapositive method. The contrapositive of the given statement is: If n is an even integer, then n2 is an even integer n is even implies that n = 2k for some k. Then n2 = 4k2. Therefore, n2 is even. Example 20 For the given statements identify the necessary and sufficient conditions. t: If you drive over 80 km per hour, then you will get a fine. Solution Let p and q denote the statements: p : you drive over 80 km per hour. q : you will get a fine. The implication if p, then q indicates that p is sufficient for q. That is driving over 80 km per hour is sufficient to get a fine. Here the sufficient condition is driving over 80 km per hour: Similarly, if p, then q also indicates that q is necessary for p. That is
MATHEMATICAL REASONING
345
When you drive over 80 km per hour, you will necessarily get a fine. Here the necessary condition is getting a fine.
7.
346
MATHEMATICS
Summary
A mathematically acceptable statement is a sentence which is either true or false. Explained the terms: Negation of a statement p: If p denote a statement, then the negation of p is denoted by p. Compound statements and their related component statements: A statement is a compound statement if it is made up of two or more smaller statements. The smaller statements are called component statements of the compound statement. The role of And, Or, There exists and For every in compound statements. The meaning of implications If , only if , if and only if . A sentence with if p, then q can be written in the following ways. p implies q (denoted by p q) p is a sufficient condition for q q is a necessary condition for p p only if q q implies p The contrapositive of a statement p q is the statement q p . The converse of a statement p q is the statement q p. p q together with its converse, gives p if and only if q. The following methods are used to check the validity of statements: (i) direct method (ii) contrapositive method (iii) method of contradiction (iv) using a counter example.
Historical Note
The first treatise on logic was written by Aristotle (384 B.C.-322 B.C.). It was a collection of rules for deductive reasoning which would serve as a basis for the study of every branch of knowledge. Later, in the seventeenth century, German mathematician G. W. Leibnitz (1646 1716 A.D.) conceived the idea of using symbols in logic to mechanise the process of deductive reasoning. His idea was realised in the nineteenth century by the English mathematician George Boole (18151864 A.D.) and Augustus De Morgan (18061871 A.D.) , who founded the modern subject of symbolic logic.
Chapter
15
STATISTICS
Statistics may be rightly called the science of averages and their estimates. A.L.BOWLEY & A.L. BODDINGTON
15.1 Introduction
We know that statistics deals with data collected for specific purposes. We can make decisions about the data by analysing and interpreting it. In earlier classes, we have studied methods of representing data graphically and in tabular form. This representation reveals certain salient features or characteristics of the data. We have also studied the methods of finding a representative value for the given data. This value is called the measure of central tendency. Recall mean (arithmetic mean), median and mode are three measures of central tendency. A measure of central Karl Pearson tendency gives us a rough idea where data points are (1857-1936) centred. But, in order to make better interpretation from the data, we should also have an idea how the data are scattered or how much they are bunched around a measure of central tendency. Consider now the runs scored by two batsmen in their last ten matches as follows: Batsman A : 30, 91, 0, 64, 42, 80, 30, 5, 117, 71 Batsman B : 53, 46, 48, 50, 53, 53, 58, 60, 57, 52 Clearly, the mean and median of the data are Batsman A Batsman B Mean 53 53 Median 53 53 Recall that, we calculate the mean of a data (denoted by x ) by dividing the sum of the observations by the number of observations, i.e.,
348
MATHEMATICS
x=
1 n
i =1
xi
Also, the median is obtained by first arranging the data in ascending or descending order and applying the following rule.
n + 1 If the number of observations is odd, then the median is 2
th
observation.
th
and
n + 1 observations. 2 We find that the mean and median of the runs scored by both the batsmen A and B are same i.e., 53. Can we say that the performance of two players is same? Clearly No, because the variability in the scores of batsman A is from 0 (minimum) to 117 (maximum). Whereas, the range of the runs scored by batsman B is from 46 to 60. Let us now plot the above scores as dots on a number line. We find the following diagrams:
For batsman A
For batsman B
Fig 15.1
Fig 15.2
We can see that the dots corresponding to batsman B are close to each other and are clustering around the measure of central tendency (mean and median), while those corresponding to batsman A are scattered or more spread out. Thus, the measures of central tendency are not sufficient to give complete information about a given data. Variability is another factor which is required to be studied under statistics. Like measures of central tendency we want to have a single number to describe variability. This single number is called a measure of dispersion. In this Chapter, we shall learn some of the important measures of dispersion and their methods of calculation for ungrouped and grouped data.
STATISTICS
349
15.3 Range
Recall that, in the example of runs scored by two batsmen A and B, we had some idea of variability in the scores on the basis of minimum and maximum runs in each series. To obtain a single number for this, we find the difference of maximum and minimum values of each series. This difference is called the Range of the data. In case of batsman A, Range = 117 0 = 117 and for batsman B, Range = 60 46 = 14. Clearly, Range of A > Range of B. Therefore, the scores are scattered or dispersed in case of A while for B these are close to each other. Thus, Range of a series = Maximum value Minimum value. The range of data gives us a rough idea of variability or scatter but does not tell about the dispersion of the data from a measure of central tendency. For this purpose, we need some other measure of variability. Clearly, such measure must depend upon the difference (or deviation) of the values from the central tendency. The important measures of dispersion, which depend upon the deviations of the observations from a central tendency are mean deviation and standard deviation. Let us discuss them in detail.
Thus, finding the mean of deviations about mean is not of any use for us, as far as the measure of dispersion is concerned.
350
MATHEMATICS
Remember that, in finding a suitable measure of dispersion, we require the distance of each value from a central tendency or a fixed number a. Recall, that the absolute value of the difference of two numbers gives the distance between the numbers when represented on a number line. Thus, to find the measure of dispersion from a fixed number a we may take the mean of the absolute values of the deviations from the central value. This mean is called the mean deviation. Thus mean deviation about a central value a is the mean of the absolute values of the deviations of the observations from a. The mean deviation from a is denoted as M.D. (a). Therefore, M.D.(a) =
Remark Mean deviation may be obtained from any measure of central tendency. However, mean deviation from mean and median are commonly used in statistical studies. Let us now learn how to calculate mean deviation about mean and mean deviation about median for various types of data 15.4.1 Mean deviation for ungrouped data Let n observations be x1, x2, x3, ...., xn. The following steps are involved in the calculation of mean deviation about mean or median: Step 1 Calculate the measure of central tendency about which we are to find the mean deviation. Let it be a. Step 2 Find the deviation of each xi from a, i.e., x1 a, x2 a, x3 a,. . . , xn a Step 3 Find the absolute values of the deviations, i.e., drop the minus sign (), if it is there, i.e., x1 a , x2 a , x3 a , ...., xn a Step 4 Find the mean of the absolute values of the deviations. This mean is the mean deviation about a, i.e.,
M.D.(a) =
Thus and
xi a
i =1
1 n
xi x
i =1 n i =1
, where x = Mean
1 n
xi M , where M = Median
STATISTICS
351
Note In this Chapter, we shall use the symbol M to denote median unless stated otherwise.Let us now illustrate the steps of the above method in following examples. Example 1 Find the mean deviation about the mean for the following data: 6, 7, 10, 12, 13, 4, 8, 12 Solution We proceed step-wise and get the following: Step 1 Mean of the given data is
x=
6 + 7 + 10 + 12 + 13 + 4 + 8 + 12 72 = = 9 8 8
Step 2 The deviations of the respective observations from the mean x , i.e., xi x are 6 9, 7 9, 10 9, 12 9, 13 9, 4 9, 8 9, 12 9, or 3, 2, 1, 3, 4, 5, 1, 3 Step 3 The absolute values of the deviations, i.e., xi x are 3, 2, 1, 3, 4, 5, 1, 3 Step 4 The required mean deviation about the mean is
M.D. ( x ) = =
xi x
i =1
3 + 2 + 1 + 3 + 4 + 5 + 1 + 3 22 = = 2.75 8 8
Note Instead of carrying out the steps every time, we can carry on calculation, step-wise without referring to steps. Example 2 Find the mean deviation about the mean for the following data : 12, 3, 18, 17, 4, 9, 17, 19, 20, 15, 8, 17, 2, 3, 16, 11, 3, 1, 0, 5 Solution We have to first find the mean ( x ) of the given data
x =
1 20 200 xi = 20 = 10 20 i =1
The respective absolute values of the deviations from mean, i.e., xi x are 2, 7, 8, 7, 6, 1, 7, 9, 10, 5, 2, 7, 8, 7, 6, 1, 7, 9, 10, 5
352
MATHEMATICS
Therefore and
xi x
i =1
20
= 124
M.D. ( x ) =
124 = 6.2 20
Example 3 Find the mean deviation about the median for the following data: 3, 9, 5, 3, 12, 10, 18, 4, 7, 19, 21. Solution Here the number of observations is 11 which is odd. Arranging the data into ascending order, we have 3, 3, 4, 5, 7, 9, 10, 12, 18, 19, 21 Now
11 + 1 Median = 2
th
or 6th observation = 9
The absolute values of the respective deviations from the median, i.e., xi M are 6, 6, 5, 4, 2, 0, 1, 3, 9, 10, 12 Therefore and
xi M = 58
i =1
11
M.D. ( M ) =
1 11 1 xi M = 11 58 = 5.27 11 i =1
15.4.2 Mean deviation for grouped data We know that data can be grouped into two ways : (a) Discrete frequency distribution, (b) Continuous frequency distribution. Let us discuss the method of finding mean deviation for both types of the data. (a) Discrete frequency distribution Let the given data consist of n distinct values x1, x2, ..., xn occurring with frequencies f1, f2 , ..., fn respectively. This data can be represented in the tabular form as given below, and is called discrete frequency distribution: x : x1 x2 x3 ... xn f : f1 f2 f3 ... fn (i) Mean deviation about mean First of all we find the mean x of the given data by using the formula
STATISTICS
353
x=
xi fi
i =1 n
fi
i =1
1 N
xi fi ,
i =1
where
x f
i =1 i
frequencies fi and N =
f
i =1
Then, we find the deviations of observations xi from the mean x and take their absolute values, i.e., xi x for all i =1, 2,..., n. After this, find the mean of the absolute values of the deviations, which is the required mean deviation about the mean. Thus
M.D. ( x ) =
f
i =1
xi x
f
i =1
1 n = f i xi x N i =1
(ii) Mean deviation about median To find mean deviation about median, we find the median of the given discrete frequency distribution. For this the observations are arranged in ascending order. After this the cumulative frequencies are obtained. Then, we identify , where 2 N is the sum of frequencies. This value of the observation lies in the middle of the data, therefore, it is the required median. After finding median, we obtain the mean of the absolute values of the deviations from median.Thus, the observation whose cumulative frequency is equal to or just greater than
M.D.(M) =
1 N
f
i =1
xi M
Example 4 Find mean deviation about the mean for the following data : xi 2 5 6 8 10 12 fi 2 8 10 7 8 5 Solution Let us make a Table 15.1 of the given data and append other columns after calculations.
354
MATHEMATICS
Table 15.1
xi 2 5 6 8 10 12
fi 2 8 10 7 8 5 40
fixi 4 40 60 56 80 60 300
xi x
5.5 2.5 1.5 0.5 2.5 4.5
f i xi x 11 20 15 3.5 20 22.5 92
N = f i = 40 ,
i =1
i =1
f i xi = 300 ,
f
i =1
xi x = 92
Therefore and
x=
1 N
i =1
fi xi = 1 N
1 300 = 7.5 40
M. D. ( x ) =
fi
i =1
xi x =
1 92 = 2.3 40
Example 5 Find the mean deviation about the median for the following data: xi fi 3 3 6 4 9 5 12 2 13 4 15 5 21 4 22 3
Solution The given observations are already in ascending order. Adding a row corresponding to cumulative frequencies to the given data, we get (Table 15.2).
Table 15.2
xi fi c.f.
3 3 3
6 4 7
9 5 12
12 2 14
13 4 18
15 5 23
21 4 27
22 3 30
STATISTICS
355
Median is the mean of the 15th and 16th observations. Both of these observations lie in the cummulative freqeuncy 18, for which the corresponding observation is 13.
Therefore, Median M = 15th observation + 16th observation 2 = 13 + 13 2 = 13
Now, absolute values of the deviations from median, i.e., xi M are shown in Table 15.3.
Table 15.3
xi M
10 3 30
8
7 4 28
8
4 5 20
1 2 2
0 4 0
2 5 10
8 4 32
9 3 27
fi f i xi M
f
i =1
= 30 and
1 N
f
i =1
xi M = 149
Therefore
M. D. (M) =
fi
i =1
xi M
1 149 = 4.97. 30
(b) Continuous frequency distribution A continuous frequency distribution is a series in which the data are classified into different class-intervals without gaps alongwith their respective frequencies. For example, marks obtained by 100 students are presented in a continuous frequency distribution as follows : Marks obtained 0-10 10-20 20-30 30-40 Number of Students 12 18 27 20 40-50 17 50-60 6
(i) Mean deviation about mean While calculating the mean of a continuous frequency distribution, we had made the assumption that the frequency in each class is centred at its mid-point. Here also, we write the mid-point of each given class and proceed further as for a discrete frequency distribution to find the mean deviation. Let us take the following example.
356
MATHEMATICS
Example 6 Find the mean deviation about the mean for the following data. Marks obtained Number of students 10-20 20-30 30-40 40-50 50-60 60-70 70-80 2 3 8 14 8 3 2
Solution We make the following Table 15.4 from the given data :
Table 15.4
Number of students fi 2 3 8 14 8 3 2 40
N =
Mid-points xi 15 25 35 45 55 65 75
f ix i
xi x
fi xi x
30 20 10 0 10 20 30
60 60 80 0 80 60 60 400
Here
i =1
fi = 40, fi xi = 1800,
i =1
fi
i =1
xi x = 400
Therefore
x=
1 7 1800 fi xi = 40 = 45 N i =1
and
M.D. ( x ) =
1 7 1 fi xi x = 40 400 = 10 N i =1
Shortcut method for calculating mean deviation about mean We can avoid the tedious calculations of computing x by following step-deviation method. Recall that in this method, we take an assumed mean which is in the middle or just close to it in the data. Then deviations of the observations (or mid-points of classes) are taken from the
STATISTICS
357
assumed mean. This is nothing but the shifting of origin from zero to the assumed mean on the number line, as shown in Fig 15.3
Fig 15.3
If there is a common factor of all the deviations, we divide them by this common factor to further simplify the deviations. These are known as step-deviations. The process of taking step-deviations is the change of scale on the number line as shown in Fig 15.4
Fig 15.4
The deviations and step-deviations reduce the size of the observations, so that the computations viz. multiplication, etc., become simpler. Let, the new variable be denoted by d i =
xi a , where a is the assumed mean and h is the common factor. Then, the h
n
Let us take the data of Example 6 and find the mean deviation by using stepdeviation method.
358
MATHEMATICS
Take the assumed mean a = 45 and h = 10, and form the following Table 15.5.
Table 15.5
xi 45 10
fi d i
xi x
f i xi x
3 2 1 0 1 2 3
6 6 8 0 8 6 6 0
30 20 10 0 10 20 30
60 60 80 0 80 60 60 400
Therefore
7 fi d i x = a + i=1 h N
= 45 +
0 10 = 45 40
and
M .D. (x ) =
1 N
fi
i =1
xi x =
400 = 10 40
Note The step deviation method is applied to compute x . Rest of the procedure is same. (ii) Mean deviation about median The process of finding the mean deviation about median for a continuous frequency distribution is similar as we did for mean deviation about the mean. The only difference lies in the replacement of the mean by median while taking deviations. Let us recall the process of finding median for a continuous frequency distribution. The data is first arranged in ascending order. Then, the median of continuous frequency distribution is obtained by first identifying the class in which median lies (median class) and then applying the formula
STATISTICS
359
N C 2 Median = l + h f
where median class is the class interval whose cumulative frequency is just greater than or equal to
N , N is the sum of frequencies, l, f, h and C are, respectively the lower 2 limit , the frequency, the width of the median class and C the cumulative frequency of the class just preceding the median class. After finding the median, the absolute values
of the deviations of mid-point xi of each class from the median i.e., xi M are obtained.
Then
M.D. (M) =
Example 7 Calculate the mean deviation about median for the following data : Class Frequency 0-10 10-20 20-30 30-40 40-50 50-60 6 7 15 16 4 2
Solution Form the following Table 15.6 from the given data :
Table 15.6
Class
Frequency fi
Mid-points xi 5 15 25 35 45 55
xi Med.
f i xi Med.
6 7 15 16 4 2 50
23 13 3 7 17 27
360
MATHEMATICS
th
N C h Median = l + 2 f
Here l = 20, C = 13, f = 15, h = 10 and N = 50 Therefore,
1 1 6 fi xi M = 50 508 = 10.16 N i =1
EXERCISE 15.1
Find the mean deviation about the mean for the data in Exercises 1 and 2. 1. 4, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 17 2. 38, 70, 48, 40, 42, 55, 63, 46, 54, 44 Find the mean deviation about the median for the data in Exercises 3 and 4. 3. 13, 17, 16, 14, 11, 13, 10, 16, 11, 18, 12, 17 4. 36, 72, 46, 42, 60, 45, 53, 46, 51, 49 Find the mean deviation about the mean for the data in Exercises 5 and 6. 5. x i 5 10 15 20 25 fi 6. x i fi 7. x i fi 8. x i fi 7 10 4 5 8 15 3 4 30 24 7 6 21 5 6 50 28 9 2 27 6 3 70 16 10 2 30 7 5 90 8 12 2 35 8 15 6
Find the mean deviation about the median for the data in Exercises 7 and 8.
STATISTICS
361
Find the mean deviation about the mean for the data in Exercises 9 and 10. 9. Income 0-100 100-200 200-300 300-400 400-500 500-600 600-700 700-800 per day Number 4 8 9 10 7 5 4 3 of persons 10. Height 95-105 105-115 115-125 125-135 135-145 145-155 in cms Number of 9 13 26 30 12 10 boys 11. Find the mean deviation about median for the following data : Marks 0-10 10-20 20-30 30-40 40-50 50-60 Number of 6 8 14 16 4 2 Girls 12. Calculate the mean deviation about median age for the age distribution of 100 persons given below: Age 16-20 21-25 26-30 31-35 36-40 41-45 46-50 51-55 Number 5 6 12 14 26 12 16 9 [Hint Convert the given data into continuous frequency distribution by subtracting 0.5 from the lower limit and adding 0.5 to the upper limit of each class interval] 15.4.3 Limitations of mean deviation In a series, where the degree of variability is very high, the median is not a representative central tendency. Thus, the mean deviation about median calculated for such series can not be fully relied. The sum of the deviations from the mean (minus signs ignored) is more than the sum of the deviations from median. Therefore, the mean deviation about the mean is not very scientific.Thus, in many cases, mean deviation may give unsatisfactory results. Also mean deviation is calculated on the basis of absolute values of the deviations and therefore, cannot be subjected to further algebraic treatment. This implies that we must have some other measure of dispersion. Standard deviation is such a measure of dispersion.
362
MATHEMATICS
non-negative. Let x1, x2, x3, ..., xn be n observations and x be their mean. Then
(x x)
i =1 i
If this sum is zero, then each ( xi x ) has to be zero. This implies that there is no dispersion at all as all observations are equal to the mean x . If
(x x)
i i =1
is small , this indicates that the observations x1, x2, x3,...,xn are
close to the mean x and therefore, there is a lower degree of dispersion. On the contrary, if this sum is large, there is a higher degree of dispersion of the observations from the mean x . Can we thus say that the sum
(x x)
i i =1
is a reasonable indicator
of the degree of dispersion or scatter? Let us take the set A of six observations 5, 15, 25, 35, 45, 55. The mean of the observations is x = 30. The sum of squares of deviations from x for this set is
(x x)
i =1 i
= 625 + 225 + 25 + 25 + 225 + 625 = 1750 Let us now take another set B of 31 observations 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45. The mean of these observations is y = 30 Note that both the sets A and B of observations have a mean of 30. Now, the sum of squares of deviations of observations for set B from the mean y is given by
(y
i =1
31
STATISTICS
363
If
(x x)
i i =1
will tend to say that the set A of six observations has a lesser dispersion about the mean than the set B of 31 observations, even though the observations in set A are more scattered from the mean (the range of deviations being from 25 to 25) than in the set B (where the range of deviations is from 15 to 15). This is also clear from the following diagrams. For the set A, we have
Fig 15.5
Fig 15.6
Thus, we can say that the sum of squares of deviations from the mean is not a proper measure of dispersion. To overcome this difficulty we take the mean of the squares of
of dispersion. This number, i.e., mean of the squares of the deviations from mean is called the variance and is denoted by 2 (read as sigma square). Therefore, the variance of n observations x1, x2,..., xn is given by
364
MATHEMATICS
2=
1 n ( xi x ) 2 n i =1
15.5.1 Standard Deviation In the calculation of variance, we find that the units of individual observations xi and the unit of their mean x are different from that of variance, since variance involves the sum of squares of (xi x ). For this reason, the proper measure of dispersion about the mean of a set of observations is expressed as positive square-root of the variance and is called standard deviation. Therefore, the standard deviation, usually denoted by , is given by
1 n ( xi x ) 2 n i =1
... (1)
Let us take the following example to illustrate the calculation of variance and hence, standard deviation of ungrouped data. Example 8 Find the Variance of the following data: 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 18, 20, 22, 24 Solution From the given data we can form the following Table 15.7. The mean is calculated by step-deviation method taking 14 as assumed mean. The number of observations is n = 10
Table 15.7
xi 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24
di =
xi 14 2
(x i x ) 81 49 25 9 1 1 9 25 49 81 330
4 3 2 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 5
STATISTICS
365
d
Therefore Mean x = assumed mean +
1 Variance ( ) = n
2
i =1
h = 14 +
5 2 = 15 10
and
1 ( xi x )2 = 10 330 = 33
i =1
10
Thus Standard deviation ( ) = 33 = 5.74 15.5.2 Standard deviation of a discrete frequency distribution Let the given discrete frequency distribution be x: x1, x2, x3 ,. . . , xn f: f1, f2, f3 ,. . . , fn
1 n fi (xi x )2 N i =1
... (2)
Let us take up following example. Example 9 Find the variance and standard deviation for the following data: xi fi 4 3 8 5 11 9 17 5 20 4 24 3 32 1
xi 4 8 11 17 20 24 32
fi 3 5 9 5 4 3 1 30
fi x i 12 40 99 85 80 72 32 420
xi x 10 6 3 3 6 10 18
( xi x ) 2
100 36 9 9 36 100 324
366
MATHEMATICS
N = 30,
7
fi xi = 420, fi ( xi x )
i =1 i =1
= 1374
Therefore
x=
fi xi
i =1
N
2
1 420 = 14 30
Hence
1 variance ( ) = N
=
fi (xi
i =1
x )2
1 1374 = 45.8 30
and
15.5.3 Standard deviation of a continuous frequency distribution The given continuous frequency distribution can be represented as a discrete frequency distribution by replacing each class by its mid-point. Then, the standard deviation is calculated by the technique adopted in the case of a discrete frequency distribution. If there is a frequency distribution of n classes each class defined by its mid-point xi with frequency fi, the standard deviation will be obtained by the formula
1 N
fi ( xi
i =1
x)2 ,
n
1 Variance ( ) = N
2
i =1
fi ( xi x ) 2 =
n n
1 N
fi ( xi 2 +
i =1
x 2 2 x xi )
1 = N 1 = N
fi xi 2 +
i =1 n
x 2 fi
i =1
2x
i =1
fi xi
fi xi 2 +
i =1
n n x 2 fi 2 x xi fi i =1 i =1
STATISTICS
367
n 1 n 1 n fi xi + x 2 N 2 x . N x Here xi fi = x or xi fi = Nx N i =1 N i =1 i =1
1 N
i =1
2 fi xi + x 2 2 x 2 =
1 N
fi xi 2
i =1
or
n fi xi 1 n 2 i =1 2 = fi xi N N i 1
1 N
2 n n = 1 N fi xi 2 fi xi N 2 i =1 i =1
n N f i xi f i xi i =1 i =1
n 2 2
... (3)
Example 10 Calculate the mean, variance and standard deviation for the following distribution : Class Frequency 30-40 40-50 50-60 60-70 70-80 80-90 90-100 3 7 12 15 8 3 2
Solution From the given data, we construct the following Table 15.9.
Table 15.9
Frequency Mid-point (f i ) (x i) 3 7 12 15 8 3 2 50 35 45 55 65 75 85 95
368
MATHEMATICS
Thus
Mean x =
1 N
fx
i =1
i i
3100 = 62 50
2 Variance = N
( )
f i (xi x )2
i =1
= and
1 10050 = 201 50
fi 7 10 15 10 6 614
=
= =
1 N 1 48
N fi xi ( fi xi )
2
48 9652 (614) 2
1 463296 376996 48
STATISTICS
369
width of class-intervals). Let the step-deviations or the new values be yi. i.e.
yi = xi A h
or xi = A + hyi
fx
i
We know that
x =
i =1
... (2)
f ( A + hy )
i i i =1
n n n 1 n f i A + h f i yi = A f i + h f i yi N i =1 N i =1 i =1 i =1
fi yi
i =1
n because fi = N i =1
x=A+h y
Variance of the variable x, x = =
1 N
2
... (3)
1 N
fi ( xi x )2
i =1
fi (A + hyi A h y )2
i =1
370
MATHEMATICS
1 N
h2 N
fi h2 (yi y )2
i =1
n
= i.e. or
i =1
2 2 x2 = h y
... (4)
... (5)
Let us solve Example 11 by the short-cut method and using formula (5) Examples 12 Calculate mean, Variance and Standard Deviation for the following distribution. Classes Frequency 30-40 40-50 50-60 60-70 70-80 80-90 90-100 3 7 12 15 8 3 2
Solution Let the assumed mean A = 65. Here h = 10 We obtain the following Table 15.11 from the given data :
Table 15.11
Class
Frequency fi
Mid-point yi= xi 35 45 55 65 75 85 95
xi 65 10
3 2 1 0 1 2 3
y i2 9 4 1 0 1 4 9
fi yi 9 14 12 0 8 6 6 15
f i y i2 27 28 12 0 8 12 18 105
3 7 12 15 8 3 2 N=50
STATISTICS
371
Therefore
x= A+
fi yi h = 65 15 10 = 62
50 50
Variance
2 =
h2 N2
2 N fi yi ( fi yi
2
(10 )
EXERCISE 15.2
Find the mean and variance for each of the data in Exercies 1 to 5. 1. 6, 7, 10, 12, 13, 4, 8, 12 2. First n natural numbers 3. First 10 multiples of 3 4. xi fi 5. xi fi 6 2 92 3 10 4 93 2 14 7 97 3 18 12 98 2 24 8 102 6 28 4 104 3 30 3 109 3
Find the mean and variance for the following frequency distributions in Exercises 7 and 8. 7. Classes Frequencies 0-30 30-60 60-90 90-120 120-150 150-180 180-210 2 3 5 10 3 5 2
372
MATHEMATICS
8.
Classes Frequencies
0-10 5
10-20 8
20-30 15
30-40 16
40-50 6
9. Find the mean, variance and standard deviation using short-cut method Height in cms No. of children 70-75 75-80 80-85 85-90 90-95 95-100 100-105 105-110 110-115 3 4 7 7 15 9 6 6 3
10. The diameters of circles (in mm) drawn in a design are given below: Diameters No. of circles 33-36 15 37-40 17 41-44 21 45-48 22 49-52 25
Calculate the standard deviation and mean diameter of the circles. [ Hint First make the data continuous by making the classes as 32.5-36.5, 36.5-40.5, 40.5-44.5, 44.5 - 48.5, 48.5 - 52.5 and then proceed.]
C.V. =
100 , x 0 ,
where and x are the standard deviation and mean of the data. For comparing the variability or dispersion of two series, we calculate the coefficient of variance for each series. The series having greater C.V. is said to be more variable than the other. The series having lesser C.V. is said to be more consistent than the other.
STATISTICS
373
15.6.1 Comparison of two frequency distributions with same mean Let x1 and 1 be the mean and standard deviation of the first distribution, and x2 and 2 be the mean and standard deviation of the second distribution. Then and
1 C.V. (1st distribution) = x 100 1
2
x2
100
Given x1 = x2 = x (say) Therefore and C.V. (1st distribution) = C.V. (2nd distribution) =
1
x
100
... (1)
100 ... (2) x It is clear from (1) and (2) that the two C.Vs. can be compared on the basis of values
of 1 and 2 only. Thus, we say that for two series with equal means, the series with greater standard deviation (or variance) is called more variable or dispersed than the other. Also, the series with lesser value of standard deviation (or variance) is said to be more consistent than the other. Let us now take following examples: Example 13 Two plants A and B of a factory show following results about the number of workers and the wages paid to them. A B No. of workers Average monthly wages Variance of distribution of wages 5000 Rs 2500 81 6000 Rs 2500 100
In which plant, A or B is there greater variability in individual wages? Solution The variance of the distribution of wages in plant A ( 12 ) = 81 Therefore, standard deviation of the distribution of wages in plant A ( 1 ) = 9
374
MATHEMATICS
Also, the variance of the distribution of wages in plant B ( 2 2 ) = 100 Therefore, standard deviation of the distribution of wages in plant B ( 2 ) = 10 Since the average monthly wages in both the plants is same, i.e., Rs.2500, therefore, the plant with greater standard deviation will have more variability. Thus, the plant B has greater variability in the individual wages. Example 14 Coefficient of variation of two distributions are 60 and 70, and their standard deviations are 21 and 16, respectively. What are their arithmetic means. Solution Given C.V. (1st distribution) = 60, 1 = 21 C.V. (2nd distribution) = 70, 2 = 16 Let x1 and x2 be the means of 1st and 2nd distribution, respectively. Then C.V. (1st distribution) = Therefore 60 =
x1 100
21 21 100 or x1 = 100 = 35 x1 60
and i.e.
x2 100
Example 15 The following values are calculated in respect of heights and weights of the students of a section of Class XI : Height Weight Mean Variance 162.6 cm 127.69 cm2 52.36 kg 23.1361 kg2
Can we say that the weights show greater variation than the heights? Solution To compare the variability, we have to calculate their coefficients of variation. Given Therefore Also Variance of height = 127.69cm2 Standard deviation of height = Variance of weight = 23.1361 kg
2
127.69cm = 11.3 cm
STATISTICS
375
Therefore Standard deviation of weight = 23.1361 kg = 4.81 kg Now, the coefficient of variations (C.V.) are given by (C.V.) in heights = = and (C.V.) in weights =
Standard Deviation Mean 100
Clearly C.V. in weights is greater than the C.V. in heights Therefore, we can say that weights show more variability than heights.
EXERCISE 15.3
1. From the data given below state which group is more variable, A or B? Marks Group A Group B 2. 10-20 20-30 30-40 9 10 17 20 32 30 40-50 50-60 60-70 33 25 40 43 10 15 70-80 9 7
From the prices of shares X and Y below, find out which is more stable in value: X 35 54 107 52 105 53 105 56 106 58 107 52 104 50 103 51 104 49 101
Y 108 3.
An analysis of monthly wages paid to workers in two firms A and B, belonging to the same industry, gives the following results: Firm A No. of wage earners Mean of monthly wages Variance of the distribution of wages (i) Which firm A or B pays larger amount as monthly wages? (ii) Which firm, A or B, shows greater variability in individual wages? 586 Rs 5253 100 Firm B 648 Rs 5253 121
376
MATHEMATICS
4.
The following is the record of goals scored by team A in a football session: No. of goals scored No. of matches 0 1 1 9 2 7 3 5 4 3
5.
For the team B, mean number of goals scored per match was 2 with a standard deviation 1.25 goals. Find which team may be considered more consistent? The sum and sum of squares corresponding to length x (in cm) and weight y (in gm) of 50 plant products are given below:
xi = 212 ,
i =1
50
xi2 = 902.8 ,
i =1
50
yi = 261 ,
i =1
50
yi2 = 1457.6
i =1
50
Miscellaneous Examples
Example 16 The variance of 20 observations is 5. If each observation is multiplied by 2, find the new variance of the resulting observations. Solution Let the observations be x1, x2, ..., x20 and x be their mean. Given that variance = 5 and n = 20. We know that Variance
20
( )
2
1 = n
(xi x ) , i.e., 5 =
2 i =1
20
1 20 (xi x )2 20 i =1
... (1)
or
(xi x )2 = 100
i =1
If each observation is multiplied by 2, and the new resulting observations are yi , then yi = 2xi i.e., xi = Therefore i.e.
y=
1 yi 2
1 20 1 20 1 20 yi = 2 xi = 2 . 20 xi n i =1 20 i =1 i =1
y=2x
or
x=
1 y 2
STATISTICS
377
1 1 2 yi 2 y = 100 , i.e., i =1
Thus the variance of new observations =
20
(y
i =1
20
y ) 2 = 400
1 400 = 20 = 22 5 20
Note The reader may note that if each observation is multiplied by a constant k, the variance of the resulting observations becomes k2 times the original variance. Example17 The mean of 5 observations is 4.4 and their variance is 8.24. If three of the observations are 1, 2 and 6, find the other two observations. Solution Let the other two observations be x and y. Therefore, the series is 1, 2, 6, x, y. Now or Therefore Also i.e. 8.24 = Mean x = 4.4 =
1+ 2 + 6 + x + y 5 22 = 9 + x + y x + y = 13
... (1)
1 5 2 variance = 8.24 = ( xi x ) n i =1
1 2 2 2 2 3.4 + 2.4 + 1.6 + x 2 + y 2 2 4.4 (x + y ) + 2 ( 4.4 ) ( ) ( ) ( ) 5 2 2 or 41.20 = 11.56 + 5.76 + 2.56 + x + y 8.8 13 + 38.72 Therefore x2 + y2 = 97 ... (2) But from (1), we have x2 + y2 + 2xy = 169 ... (3) From (2) and (3), we have 2xy = 72 ... (4) Subtracting (4) from (2), we get x2 + y2 2xy = 97 72 i.e. (x y)2 = 25 or xy= 5 ... (5) So, from (1) and (5), we get x = 9, y = 4 when x y = 5 or x = 4, y = 9 when x y = 5 Thus, the remaining observations are 4 and 9. Example 18 If each of the observation x1, x2, ...,xn is increased by a, where a is a negative or positive number, show that the variance remains unchanged.
378
MATHEMATICS
Solution Let x be the mean of x1, x2, ...,xn . Then the variance is given by
12 =
1 n
(xi x )
i =1
If a is added to each observation, the new observations will be yi = xi + a Let the mean of the new observations be y . Then
y=
... (1)
1 n
yi = n (xi + a)
i =1 i =1
n 1n 1 xi + a = = n n i =1 i =1
x +
i i =1
na =x+a n
... (2)
1 = n
1 = n
(yi y ) 2 =
i =1
n i =1
1 n ( xi + a x a) 2 n i =1
(xi x )2 = 12
Thus, the variance of the new observations is same as that of the original observations. Note We may note that adding (or subtracting) a positive number to (or from) each observation of a group does not affect the variance. Example 19 The mean and standard deviation of 100 observations were calculated as 40 and 5.1, respectively by a student who took by mistake 50 instead of 40 for one observation. What are the correct mean and standard deviation? Solution Given that number of observations (n) = 100 Incorrect mean ( x ) = 40, Incorrect standard deviation () = 5.1 We know that
x=
1 n xi n i =1
1 100 xi or 100 i =1
i.e.
40 =
xi = 4000
i =1
100
STATISTICS
379
i.e. Thus
Incorrect sum of observations = 4000 the correct sum of observations = Incorrect sum 50 + 40 = 4000 50 + 40 = 3990
Hence
Correct mean =
Also
Standard deviation =
xi
i =1
n
1 n 2 xi n i =1
2 2
=
1 100
1 100
n
n
1 n
2
x (x )
i =1 i
i.e. or Therefore
5.1 = 26.01 =
Incorrect xi (40) 2
i =1
Incorrect
x
i =1
1600
Now
Correct xi = Incorrect
2 i =1
x
i =1
2 i
(50)2 + (40)2
(Correct mean)
= =
161701 100
(39.9)
1617.01 1592.01
25
=5
380
MATHEMATICS
4.
5.
6.
7.
which of the three subjects shows the highest variability in marks and which shows the lowest? The mean and standard deviation of a group of 100 observations were found to be 20 and 3, respectively. Later on it was found that three observations were incorrect, which were recorded as 21, 21 and 18. Find the mean and standard deviation if the incorrect observations are omitted.
Summary
Measures of dispersion Range, Quartile deviation, mean deviation, variance, standard deviation are measures of dispersion. Range = Maximum Value Minimum Value Mean deviation for ungrouped data
M.D. (x ) =
( xi x ) ,
n
M.D. (M) =
( xi M )
n
STATISTICS
381
fi ( xi x ) ,
M.D. (M) =
fi ( xi M ) , where N = f
2 =
2 =
2 =
2 =
2 h2 N f y 2 ( fi yi ) , 2 i i N
h N
N fi yi2 ( fi yi ) ,
2
where yi =
xi A h
100, x 0. x For series with equal means, the series with lesser standard deviation is more consistent or less scattered.
Historical Note
Statistics is derived from the Latin word status which means a political state. This suggests that statistics is as old as human civilisation. In the year 3050 B.C., perhaps the first census was held in Egypt. In India also, about 2000 years ago, we had an efficient system of collecting administrative statistics, particularly, during the regime of Chandra Gupta Maurya (324-300 B.C.). The system of collecting data related to births and deaths is mentioned in Kautilyas Arthshastra (around 300 B.C.) A detailed account of administrative surveys conducted during Akbars regime is given in Ain-I-Akbari written by Abul Fazl.
382
MATHEMATICS
Captain John Graunt of London (1620-1674) is known as father of vital statistics due to his studies on statistics of births and deaths. Jacob Bernoulli (1654-1705) stated the Law of Large numbers in his book Ars Conjectandi, published in 1713. The theoretical development of statistics came during the mid seventeenth century and continued after that with the introduction of theory of games and chance (i.e., probability). Francis Galton (1822-1921), an Englishman, pioneered the use of statistical methods, in the field of Biometry. Karl Pearson (1857-1936) contributed a lot to the development of statistical studies with his discovery of Chi square test and foundation of statistical laboratory in England (1911). Sir Ronald A. Fisher (1890-1962), known as the Father of modern statistics, applied it to various diversified fields such as Genetics, Biometry, Education, Agriculture, etc.
Chapter
16
PROBABILITY
Where a mathematical reasoning can be had, it is as great a folly to make use of any other, as to grope for a thing in the dark, when you have a candle in your hand. JOHN ARBUTHNOT
16.1 Introduction
In earlier classes, we studied about the concept of probability as a measure of uncertainty of various phenomenon. We have obtained the probability of getting an even number in throwing a die as
3 1 i.e., . Here the 6 2
total possible outcomes are 1,2,3,4,5 and 6 (six in number). The outcomes in favour of the event of getting an even number are 2,4,6 (i.e., three in number). In general, to obtain the probability of an event, we find the ratio of the number of outcomes favourable to the event, to the total Kolmogorove number of equally likely outcomes. This theory of probability (1903-1987) is known as classical theory of probability. In Class IX, we learnt to find the probability on the basis of observations and collected data. This is called statistical approach of probability. Both the theories have some serious difficulties. For instance, these theories can not be applied to the activities/experiments which have infinite number of outcomes. In classical theory we assume all the outcomes to be equally likely. Recall that the outcomes are called equally likely when we have no reason to believe that one is more likely to occur than the other. In other words, we assume that all outcomes have equal chance (probability) to occur. Thus, to define probability, we used equally likely or equally probable outcomes. This is logically not a correct definition. Thus, another theory of probability was developed by A.N. Kolmogorov, a Russian mathematician, in 1933. He
384
MATHEMATICS
laid down some axioms to interpret probability, in his book Foundation of Probability published in 1933. In this Chapter, we will study about this approach called axiomatic approach of probability. To understand this approach we must know about few basic terms viz. random experiment, sample space, events, etc. Let us learn about these all, in what follows next.
PROBABILITY
385
Heads on both coins = (H,H) = HH Head on first coin and Tail on the other = (H,T) = HT Tail on first coin and Head on the other = (T,H) = TH Tail on both coins = (T,T) = TT Thus, the sample space is S = {HH, HT, TH, TT} Note The outcomes of this experiment are ordered pairs of H and T. For the sake of simplicity the commas are omitted from the ordered pairs. Example 2 Find the sample space associated with the experiment of rolling a pair of dice (one is blue and the other red) once. Also, find the number of elements of this sample space. Solution Suppose 1 appears on blue die and 2 on the red die. We denote this outcome by an ordered pair (1,2). Simlarly, if 3 appears on blue die and 5 on red, the outcome is denoted by the ordered pair (3,5). In general each outcome can be denoted by the ordered pair (x, y), where x is the number appeared on the blue die and y is the number appeared on the red die. Therefore, this sample space is given by S = {(x, y): x is the number on the blue die and y is the number on the red die}. The number of elements of this sample space is 6 6 = 36 and the sample space is given below: {(1,1), (1,2), (1,3), (1,4), (1,5), (1,6), (2,1), (2,2), (2,3), (2,4), (2,5), (2,6) (3,1), (3,2), (3,3), (3,4), (3,5), (3,6), (4,1), (4,2), (4,3), (4,4), (4,5), (4,6) (5,1), (5,2), (5,3), (5,4), (5,5), (5,6), (6,1), (6,2), (6,3), (6,4), (6,5), (6,6)} Example 3 In each of the following experiments specify appropriate sample space (i) (ii) A boy has a 1 rupee coin, a 2 rupee coin and a 5 rupee coin in his pocket. He takes out two coins out of his pocket, one after the other. A person is noting down the number of accidents along a busy highway during a year.
Solution (i) Let Q denote a 1 rupee coin, H denotes a 2 rupee coin and R denotes a 5 rupee coin. The first coin he takes out of his pocket may be any one of the three coins Q, H or R. Corresponding to Q, the second draw may be H or R. So the result of two draws may be QH or QR. Similarly, corresponding to H, the second draw may be Q or R. Therefore, the outcomes may be HQ or HR. Lastly, corresponding to R, the second draw may be H or Q. So, the outcomes may be RH or RQ.
386
MATHEMATICS
Thus, the sample space is S={QH, QR, HQ, HR, RH, RQ} (ii) The number of accidents along a busy highway during the year of observation can be either 0 (for no accident ) or 1 or 2, or some other positive integer. Thus, a sample space associated with this experiment is S= {0,1,2,...} Example 4 A coin is tossed. If it shows head, we draw a ball from a bag consisting of 3 blue and 4 white balls; if it shows tail we throw a die. Describe the sample space of this experiment. Solution Let us denote blue balls by B1, B2, B3 and the white balls by W1, W2, W3, W4. Then a sample space of the experiment is S = { HB1, HB2, HB3, HW1, HW2, HW3, HW4, T1, T2, T3, T4, T5, T6}. Here HBi means head on the coin and ball Bi is drawn, HWi means head on the coin and ball Wi is drawn. Similarly, Ti means tail on the coin and the number i on the die. Example 5 Consider the experiment in which a coin is tossed repeatedly until a head comes up. Describe the sample space. Solution In the experiment head may come up on the first toss, or the 2nd toss, or the 3rd toss and so on till head is obtained. Hence, the desired sample space is S= {H, TH, TTH, TTTH, TTTTH,...}
EXERCISE 16.1
In each of the following Exercises 1 to 7, describe the sample space for the indicated experiment. 1. A coin is tossed three times. 2. A die is thrown two times. 3. A coin is tossed four times. 4. A coin is tossed and a die is thrown. 5. A coin is tossed and then a die is rolled only in case a head is shown on the coin. 6. 2 boys and 2 girls are in Room X, and 1 boy and 3 girls in Room Y. Specify the sample space for the experiment in which a room is selected and then a person. 7. One die of red colour, one of white colour and one of blue colour are placed in a bag. One die is selected at random and rolled, its colour and the number on its uppermost face is noted. Describe the sample space. 8. An experiment consists of recording boygirl composition of families with 2 children. (i) What is the sample space if we are interested in knowing whether it is a boy or girl in the order of their births?
PROBABILITY
387
(ii) 9. 10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
What is the sample space if we are interested in the number of girls in the family? A box contains 1 red and 3 identical white balls. Two balls are drawn at random in succession without replacement. Write the sample space for this experiment. An experiment consists of tossing a coin and then throwing it second time if a head occurs. If a tail occurs on the first toss, then a die is rolled once. Find the sample space. Suppose 3 bulbs are selected at random from a lot. Each bulb is tested and classified as defective (D) or non defective(N). Write the sample space of this experiment. A coin is tossed. If the out come is a head, a die is thrown. If the die shows up an even number, the die is thrown again. What is the sample space for the experiment? The numbers 1, 2, 3 and 4 are written separatly on four slips of paper. The slips are put in a box and mixed thoroughly. A person draws two slips from the box, one after the other, without replacement. Describe the sample space for the experiment. An experiment consists of rolling a die and then tossing a coin once if the number on the die is even. If the number on the die is odd, the coin is tossed twice. Write the sample space for this experiment. A coin is tossed. If it shows a tail, we draw a ball from a box which contains 2 red and 3 black balls. If it shows head, we throw a die. Find the sample space for this experiment. A die is thrown repeatedly untill a six comes up. What is the sample space for this experiment?
16.3 Event We have studied about random experiment and sample space associated with an experiment. The sample space serves as an universal set for all questions concerned with the experiment. Consider the experiment of tossing a coin two times. An associated sample space is S = {HH, HT, TH, TT}. Now suppose that we are interested in those outcomes which correspond to the occurrence of exactly one head. We find that HT and TH are the only elements of S corresponding to the occurrence of this happening (event). These two elements form the set E = { HT, TH} We know that the set E is a subset of the sample space S . Similarly, we find the following correspondence between events and subsets of S.
388
MATHEMATICS
Description of events Number of tails is exactly 2 Number of tails is atleast one Number of heads is atmost one Second toss is not head Number of tails is atmost two Number of tails is more than two
Corresponding subset of S A = {TT} B = {HT, TH, TT} C = {HT, TH, TT} D = { HT, TT} S = {HH, HT, TH, TT}
The above discussion suggests that a subset of sample space is associated with an event and an event is associated with a subset of sample space. In the light of this we define an event as follows. Definition Any subset E of a sample space S is called an event. 16.3.1 Occurrence of an event Consider the experiment of throwing a die. Let E denotes the event a number less than 4 appears. If actually 1 had appeared on the die then we say that event E has occurred. As a matter of fact if outcomes are 2 or 3, we say that event E has occurred Thus, the event E of a sample space S is said to have occurred if the outcome of the experiment is such that E. If the outcome is such that E, we say that the event E has not occurred. 16.3.2 Types of events Events can be classified into various types on the basis of the elements they have. 1. Impossible and Sure Events The empty set and the sample space S describe events. In fact is called an impossible event and S, i.e., the whole sample space is
PROBABILITY
389
F = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,} = S, i.e., all outcomes of the experiment ensure the occurrence of the event F. Thus, the event F = S is a sure event. 2. Simple Event If an event E has only one sample point of a sample space, it is called a simple (or elementary) event. In a sample space containing n distinct elements, there are exactly n simple events. For example in the experiment of tossing two coins, a sample space is S={HH, HT, TH, TT} There are four simple events corresponding to this sample space. These are E1= {HH}, E2={HT}, E3= { TH} and E4={TT}. 3. Compound Event If an event has more than one sample point, it is called a Compound event. For example, in the experiment of tossing a coin thrice the events E: Exactly one head appeared F: Atleast one head appeared G: Atmost one head appeared etc. are all compound events. The subsets of S associated with these events are E={HTT,THT,TTH} F={HTT,THT, TTH, HHT, HTH, THH, HHH} G= {TTT, THT, HTT, TTH} Each of the above subsets contain more than one sample point, hence they are all compound events. 16.3.3 Algebra of events In the Chapter on Sets, we have studied about different ways of combining two or more sets, viz, union, intersection, difference, complement of a set etc. Like-wise we can combine two or more events by using the analogous set notations. Let A, B, C be events associated with an experiment whose sample space is S. 1. Complementary Event For every event A, there corresponds another event A called the complementary event to A. It is also called the event not A. For example, take the experiment of tossing three coins. An associated sample space is S = {HHH, HHT, HTH, THH, HTT, THT, TTH, TTT} Let A={HTH, HHT, THH} be the event only one tail appears Clearly for the outcome HTT, the event A has not occurred. But we may say that the event not A has occurred. Thus, with every outcome which is not in A, we say that not A occurs.
390
MATHEMATICS
Thus the complementary event not A to the event A is A = {HHH, HTT, THT, TTH, TTT} or A = { : S and A} = S A.
2. The Event A or B Recall that union of two sets A and B denoted by A B contains all those elements which are either in A or in B or in both. When the sets A and B are two events associated with a sample space, then A B is the event either A or B or both. This event A B is also called A or B. Therefore Event A or B = A B = { : A or B} 3. The Event A and B We know that intersection of two sets A B is the set of those elements which are common to both A and B. i.e., which belong to both A and B. If A and B are two events, then the set A B denotes the event A and B. A B = { : A and B} Thus, For example, in the experiment of throwing a die twice Let A be the event score on the first throw is six and B is the event sum of two scores is atleast 11 then A = {(6,1), (6,2}, (6,3), (6,4), (6,5), (6,6)}, and B = {(5,6), (6,5), (6,6)} so A B = {(6,5), (6,6)} Note that the set A B = {(6,5), (6,6)} may represent the event the score on the first throw is six and the sum of the scores is atleast 11.
4. The Event A but not B We know that AB is the set of all those elements which are in A but not in B. Therefore, the set AB may denote the event A but not B.We know that A B = A B Example 6 Consider the experiment of rolling a die. Let A be the event getting a prime number, B be the event getting an odd number. Write the sets representing the events (i) Aor B (ii) A and B (iii) A but not B (iv) not A. Solution Here S = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}, A = {2, 3, 5} and B = {1, 3, 5} Obviously (i) A or B = A B = {1, 2, 3, 5} (ii) A and B = A B = {3,5} (iii) A but not B = A B = {2} (iv) not A = A = {1,4,6}
PROBABILITY
391
16.3.4 Mutually exclusive events In the experiment of rolling a die, a sample space is S = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}. Consider events, A an odd number appears and B an even number appears Clearly the event A excludes the event B and vice versa. In other words, there is no outcome which ensures the occurrence of events A and B simultaneously. Here A = {1, 3, 5} and B = {2, 4, 6} Clearly A B = , i.e., A and B are disjoint sets. In general, two events A and B are called mutually exclusive events if the occurrence of any one of them excludes the occurrence of the other event, i.e., if they can not occur simultaneously. In this case the sets A and B are disjoint. Again in the experiment of rolling a die, consider the events A an odd number appears and event B a number less than 4 appears Obviously A = {1, 3, 5} and B = {1, 2, 3} Now 3 A as well as 3 B Therefore, A and B are not mutually exclusive events. Remark Simple events of a sample space are always mutually exclusive. 16.3.5 Exhaustive events Consider the experiment of throwing a die. We have S = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}. Let us define the following events A: a number less than 4 appears, B: a number greater than 2 but less than 5 appears and C: a number greater than 4 appears. Then A = {1, 2, 3}, B = {3,4} and C = {5, 6}. We observe that A B C = {1, 2, 3} {3, 4} {5, 6} = S. Such events A, B and C are called exhaustive events. In general, if E1, E2, ..., En are n events of a sample space S and if
E1 E 2 E 3 ... E n = E i = S
i =1 n
then E1, E2, ...., En are called exhaustive events.In other words, events E1, E2, ..., En are said to be exhaustive if atleast one of them necessarily occurs whenever the experiment is performed. Further, if Ei Ej = for i j i.e., events Ei and Ej are pairwise disjoint and
i =1
E i = S , then events E1, E2, ..., En are called mutually exclusive and exhaustive
events.
392
MATHEMATICS
We now consider some examples. Example 7 Two dice are thrown and the sum of the numbers which come up on the dice is noted. Let us consider the following events associated with this experiment A: the sum is even. B: the sum is a multiple of 3. C: the sum is less than 4. D: the sum is greater than 11. Which pairs of these events are mutually exclusive? Solution There are 36 elements in the sample space S = {(x, y): x, y = 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}. Then A = {(1, 1), (1, 3), (1, 5), (2, 2), (2, 4), (2, 6), (3, 1), (3, 3), (3, 5), (4, 2), (4, 4), (4, 6), (5, 1), (5, 3), (5, 5), (6, 2), (6, 4), (6, 6)} B = {(1, 2), (2, 1), (1, 5), (5, 1), (3, 3), (2, 4), (4, 2), (3, 6), (6, 3), (4, 5), (5, 4), (6, 6)} C = {(1, 1), (2, 1), (1, 2)} and D = {(6, 6)} We find that A B = {(1, 5), (2, 4), (3, 3), (4, 2), (5, 1), (6, 6)} Therefore, A and B are not mutually exclusive events. Similarly A C , A D , B C and B D . Thus, the pairs, (A, C), (A, D), (B, C), (B, D) are not mutually exclusive events. Also C D = and so C and D are mutually exclusive events. Example 8 A coin is tossed three times, consider the following events. A: No head appears, B: Exactly one head appears and C: Atleast two heads appear. Do they form a set of mutually exclusive and exhaustive events? Solution The sample space of the experiment is S = {HHH, HHT, HTH, THH, HTT, THT, TTH, TTT} and A = {TTT}, B = {HTT, THT, TTH}, C = {HHT, HTH, THH, HHH} Now A B C = {TTT, HTT, THT, TTH, HHT, HTH, THH, HHH} = S Therefore, A, B and C are exhaustive events. Also, A B = , A C = and B C = Therefore, the events are pair-wise disjoint, i.e., they are mutually exclusive. Hence, A, B and C form a set of mutually exclusive and exhaustive events.
PROBABILITY
393
EXERCISE 16.2
1. A die is rolled. Let E be the event die shows 4 and F be the event die shows even number. Are E and F mutually exclusive? 2. A die is thrown. Describe the following events: (i) A: a number less than 7 (iii) C: a multiple of 3 (v) E: an even number greater than 4 (ii) (iv) (vi) B: a number greater than 7 D: a number less than 4 F: a number not less than 3
Also find A B, A B, E F, D E, A C, D E, F, E F, 3. An experiment involves rolling a pair of dice and recording the numbers that come up. Describe the following events: A: the sum is greater than 8, B: 2 occurs on either die C: the sum is at least 7 and a multiple of 3. Which pairs of these events are mutually exclusive? 4. Three coins are tossed once. Let A denote the event three heads show, B denote the event two heads and one tail show, C denote the event three tails show and D denote the event a head shows on the first coin. Which events are (i) mutually exclusive? (ii) simple? (iii) Compound? 5. Three coins are tossed. Describe (i) Two events which are mutually exclusive. (ii) Three events which are mutually exclusive and exhaustive. (iii) Two events, which are not mutually exclusive. (iv) Two events which are mutually exclusive but not exhaustive. (v) Three events which are mutually exclusive but not exhaustive. 6. Two dice are thrown. The events A, B and C are as follows: A: getting an even number on the first die. B: getting an odd number on the first die. C: getting the sum of the numbers on the dice 5. Describe the events (i) A (ii) not B (iii) A or B (iv) A and B (v) A but not C (vi) B or C (vii) B and C (viii) A B C 7. Refer to question 6 above, state true or false: (give reason for your answer) (i) A and B are mutually exclusive (ii) A and B are mutually exclusive and exhaustive (iii) A = B
394
MATHEMATICS
(iv) A and C are mutually exclusive (v) A and B are mutually exclusive. (vi) A, B, C are mutually exclusive and exhaustive.
Clearly this assignment satisfies both the conditions i.e., each number is neither less than zero nor greater than 1 and
PROBABILITY
395
P(H) + P(T) =
1 1 + =1 2 2 1 1 , and probability of T = 2 2
1 3 and P(T) = ... (2) 4 4 Does this assignment satisfy the conditions of axiomatic approach?
Yes, in this case, probability of H = and probability of T =
3 . 4 We find that both the assignments (1) and (2) are valid for probability of H and T. In fact, we can assign the numbers p and (1 p) to both the outcomes such that 0 p 1 and P(H) + P(T) = p + (1 p) = 1 This assignment, too, satisfies both conditions of the axiomatic approach of probability. Hence, we can say that there are many ways (rather infinite) to assign probabilities to outcomes of an experiment. We now consider some examples. Example 9 Let a sample space be S = {1, 2,..., 6}.Which of the following assignments of probabilities to each outcome are valid? Outcomes 1 2 3 4 5 6
(a) (b) (c) (d) (e)
1 6
1
1 6
0
1 6
0
1 6
0
1 6
0
1 6
0
1 8
1 12
2 3
1 3
1 3
1 4
1 3
1 12
0.2
1 6
0.3
1 6
0.4
1 6
0.5
3 2
0.6
0.1
Solution (a) Condition (i): Each of the number p(i) is positive and less than one. Condition (ii): Sum of probabilities =
1 1 1 1 1 1 + + + + + =1 6 6 6 6 6 6
396
MATHEMATICS
Therefore, the assignment is valid (b) Condition (i): Each of the number p(i) is either 0 or 1. Condition (ii) Sum of the probabilities = 1 + 0 + 0 + 0 + 0 + 0 = 1 Therefore, the assignment is valid (c) Condition (i) Two of the probabilities p(5) and p(6) are negative, the assignment is not valid (d) (e)
3 > 1, the assignment is not valid 2 Since, sum of probabilities = 0.1 + 0.2 + 0.3 + 0.4 + 0.5 + 0.6 = 2.1, the assignment is not valid.
Since p(6) =
16.4.1 Probability of an event Let S be a sample space associated with the experiment examining three consecutive pens produced by a machine and classified as Good (non-defective) and bad (defective). We may get 0, 1, 2 or 3 defective pens as result of this examination. A sample space associated with this experiment is S = {BBB, BBG, BGB, GBB, BGG, GBG, GGB, GGG}, where B stands for a defective or bad pen and G for a non defective or good pen. Let the probabilities assigned to the outcomes be as follows Sample point: Probability: BBB BBG BGB GBB BGG GBG GGB GGG
1 8
1 8
1 8
1 8
1 8
1 8
1 8
1 8
Let event A: there is exactly one defective pen and event B: there are atleast two defective pens. Hence Now A = {BGG, GBG, GGB} and B = {BBG, BGB, GBB, BBB} P(A) = P(i ),i A = P(BGG) + P(GBG) + P(GGB) = and P(B) = P(i ), i B
1 1 1 3 + + = 8 8 8 8
PROBABILITY
397
P(HH) =
Clearly this assignment satisfies the conditions of axiomatic approach. Now, let us find the probability of the event E: Both the tosses yield the same result. Here E = {HH, TT} Now P(E) = P(wi), for all wi E
16.4.2 Probabilities of equally likely outcomes Let a sample space of an experiment be S = {1, 2,..., n}. Let all the outcomes are equally likely to occur, i.e., the chance of occurrence of each simple event must be same. i.e. P(i) = p, for all i S where 0 p 1 Since
or
np = 1 i.e., p =
1 n
Let S be a sample space and E be an event, such that n(S) = n and n(E) = m. If each out come is equally likely, then it follows that
P(E) =
m n
16.4.3 Probability of the event A or B Let us now find the probability of event A or B, i.e., P (A B) Let A = {HHT, HTH, THH} and B = {HTH, THH, HHH} be two events associated with tossing of a coin thrice Clearly A B = {HHT, HTH, THH, HHH} Now P (A B) = P(HHT) + P(HTH) + P(THH) + P(HHH)
398
MATHEMATICS
1 1 1 1 4 1 P ( A B) = + + + = = 8 8 8 8 8 2
Also and Therefore P(A) = P(HHT) + P(HTH) + P(THH) = P(B) = P(HTH) + P(THH) + P(HHH) = P(A) + P(B) =
3 3 6 + = 8 8 8
3 8 3 8
It is clear that
The points HTH and THH are common to both A and B . In the computation of P(A) + P(B) the probabilities of points HTH and THH, i.e., the elements of A B are included twice. Thus to get the probability P(A B) we have to subtract the probabilities of the sample points in A B from P(A) + P(B) i.e.
Thus we observe that, P( A B) = P( A) + P( B) P (A B) In general, if A and B are any two events associated with a random experiment, then by the definition of probability of an event, we have
P ( A B ) = p ( i ) , i A B .
Since we have
A B = (AB) (A B) (BA) ,
P(A B) = [ P(i ) i (AB) ] + [ P(i ) i A B] + [ P(i ) i B A ] (because AB, A B and B A are mutually exclusive) Also P(A) + P(B) = [ p(i ) i A ] + [ p(i ) i B] = [ P(i )i (AB) (A B) ] + [ P(i )i (B A) (A B) ] = [ P(i )i (A B) ] + [ P(i )i (A B) ] + [ P(i )i (BA) ] + ... (1)
[using (1)]
PROBABILITY
399
Hence P(A B) = P (A) +P(B) P(A B) . Alternatively, it can also be proved as follows: A B = A (B A), where A and B A are mutually exclusive, and B = (A B) (B A), where A B and B A are mutually exclsuive. Using Axiom (iii) of probability, we get P (A B) = P (A) + P (B A) ... (2) and P(B) = P ( A B) + P (B A) ... (3) Subtracting (3) from (2) gives P (A B) P(B) = P(A) P (A B) or P(A B) = P(A) + P (B) P (A B) The above result can further be verified by observing the Venn Diagram (Fig 16.1)
Fig 16.1
If A and B are disjoint sets, i.e., they are mutually exclusive events, then A B = Therefore
P(A B) = P () = 0
Thus, for mutually exclusive events A and B, we have P( A B) = P ( A) + P (B) , which is Axiom (iii) of probability. 16.4.4 Probability of event not A Consider the event A = {2, 4, 6, 8} associated with the experiment of drawing a card from a deck of ten cards numbered from 1 to 10. Clearly the sample space is S = {1, 2, 3, ...,10} If all the outcomes 1, 2, ...,10 are considered to be equally likely, then the probability of each outcome is
1 10
400
MATHEMATICS
Now
1 1 1 1 4 2 + + + = = 10 10 10 10 10 5
Also event not A = A = {1, 3, 5, 7, 9, 10} Now P(A) = P(1) + P(3) + P(5) + P(7) + P(9) + P(10) = Thus, P(A) =
6 3 = 10 5
3 2 = 1 = 1 P ( A) 5 5 Also, we know that A and A are mutually exclusive and exhaustive events i.e., A A = and A A = S or P(A A) = P(S) Now P(A) + P(A) = 1, by using axioms (ii) and (iii). or P( A ) = P(not A) = 1 P(A) We now consider some examples and exercises having equally likely outcomes unless stated otherwise.
Example 10 One card is drawn from a well shuffled deck of 52 cards. If each outcome is equally likely, calculate the probability that the card will be (i) a diamond (ii) not an ace (iii) a black card (i.e., a club or, a spade) (iv) not a diamond (v) not a black card. Solution When a card is drawn from a well shuffled deck of 52 cards, the number of possible outcomes is 52. (i) Let A be the event 'the card drawn is a diamond' Clearly the number of elements in set A is 13. Therefore, P(A) =
13 1 = 52 4
i.e. Probability of a diamond card = (ii) We assume that the event Card drawn is an ace is B Therefore Card drawn is not an ace should be B. We know that P(B) = 1 P(B) = 1
4 1 12 =1 = 52 13 13
PROBABILITY
401
(iii) Let C denote the event card drawn is black card Therefore, number of elements in the set C = 26 i.e. P(C) =
26 1 = 52 2
1 . 2
(iv) We assumed in (i) above that A is the event card drawn is a diamond, so the event card drawn is not a diamond may be denoted as A' or not A Now P(not A) = 1 P(A) = 1 (v)
1 3 = 4 4 The event card drawn is not a black card may be denoted as C or not C.
1 1 = 2 2 1 2
Example 11 A bag contains 9 discs of which 4 are red, 3 are blue and 2 are yellow. The discs are similar in shape and size. A disc is drawn at random from the bag. Calculate the probability that it will be (i) red, (ii) yellow, (iii) blue, (iv) not blue, (v) either red or yellow. Solution There are 9 discs in all so the total number of possible outcomes is 9. Let the events A, B, C be defined as A: the disc drawn is red B: the disc drawn is yellow C: the disc drawn is blue. (i) The number of red discs = 4, i.e., n (A) = 4 Hence
Therefore, P(B) =
402
MATHEMATICS
3 1 = 9 3 (iv) Clearly the event not blue is not C. We know that P(not C) = 1 P(C)
Therefore, P(C) =
1 2 = 3 3 (v) The event either red or yellow may be described by the set A or C Since, A and C are mutually exclusive events, we have
Therefore P(not C) = 1 P(A or C) = P (A C) = P(A) + P(C) =
4 1 7 + = 9 3 9
Example 12 Two students Anil and Ashima appeared in an examination. The probability that Anil will qualify the examination is 0.05 and that Ashima will qualify the examination is 0.10. The probability that both will qualify the examination is 0.02. Find the probability that (a) Both Anil and Ashima will not qualify the examination. (b) (c) Atleast one of them will not qualify the examination and Only one of them will qualify the examination.
Solution Let E and F denote the events that Anil and Ashima will qualify the examination, respectively. Given that P(E) = 0.05, P(F) = 0.10 and P(E F) = 0.02. Then (a) The event both Anil and Ashima will not qualify the examination may be expressed as E F.
Since, E is not E, i.e., Anil will not qualify the examination and F is not F, i.e., Ashima will not qualify the examination. Also Now or E F = (E F) (by Demorgan's Law) P(E F) = P(E) + P(F) P(E F) P(E F) = 0.05 + 0.10 0.02 = 0.13 P (atleast one of them will not qualify) = 1 P(both of them will qualify) = 1 0.02 = 0.98
PROBABILITY
403
(c) The event only one of them will qualify the examination is same as the event either (Anil will qualify, and Ashima will not qualify) or (Anil will not qualify and Ashima will qualify) i.e., E F or E F, where E F and E F are mutually exclusive. Therefore, P(only one of them will qualify) = P(E F or E F) = P(E F) + P(E F) = P (E) P(E F) + P(F) P (E F) = 0.05 0.02 + 0.10 0.02 = 0.11 Example 13 A committee of two persons is selected from two men and two women. What is the probability that the committee will have (a) no man? (b) one man? (c) two men? Solution The total number of persons = 2 + 2 = 4. Out of these four person, two can be selected in 4 C 2 ways. (a) No men in the committee of two means there will be two women in the committee. Out of two women, two can be selected in 2 C 2 = 1 way. Therefore (b)
P ( no man ) =
2 4
C 2 1 2 1 1 = = 43 6 C2
One man in the committee means that there is one woman. One man out of 2
can be selected in 2 C1 ways and one woman out of 2 can be selected in 2 C1 ways. Together they can be selected in 2 C1 2 C1 ways. Therefore (c)
P ( One man ) =
2
C1 2 C1 2 2 2 = = 4 23 3 C2
Hence
C2 1 1 = 4 = C2 C2 6
EXERCISE 16.3
1. Which of the following can not be valid assignment of probabilities for outcomes of sample Space S = {1 , 2 , 3 , 4 , 5 , 6 , 7 }
404
MATHEMATICS
0.1
0.01
0.05
0.03
0.01
0.2
0.6
1 7 0.1 0.1
1 7 0.2 0.2
1 7 0.3 0.3
1 7 0.4 0.4
1 7 0.5 0.2
1 7 0.6 0.1
1 7 0.7 0.3
1 2 3 4 5 6 15 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 2. A coin is tossed twice, what is the probability that atleast one tail occurs? 3. A die is thrown, find the probability of following events: (i) A prime number will appear, (ii) A number greater than or equal to 3 will appear, (iii) A number less than or equal to one will appear, (iv) A number more than 6 will appear, (v) A number less than 6 will appear. 4. A card is selected from a pack of 52 cards. (a) How many points are there in the sample space? (b) Calculate the probability that the card is an ace of spades. (c) Calculate the probability that the card is (i) an ace (ii) black card.
5. A fair coin with 1 marked on one face and 6 on the other and a fair die are both tossed. find the probability that the sum of numbers that turn up is (i) 3 (ii) 12 6. There are four men and six women on the city council. If one council member is selected for a committee at random, how likely is it that it is a woman? 7. A fair coin is tossed four times, and a person win Re 1 for each head and lose Rs 1.50 for each tail that turns up. From the sample space calculate how many different amounts of money you can have after four tosses and the probability of having each of these amounts. 8. Three coins are tossed once. Find the probability of getting (i) 3 heads (ii) 2 heads (iii) atleast 2 heads (iv) atmost 2 heads (v) no head (vi) 3 tails (vii) exactly two tails (viii) no tail (ix) atmost two tails
2 is the probability of an event, what is the probability of the event not A. 11 10. A letter is chosen at random from the word ASSASSINATION. Find the probability that letter is (i) a vowel (ii) a consonant
9. If
PROBABILITY
405
11. In a lottery, a person choses six different natural numbers at random from 1 to 20, and if these six numbers match with the six numbers already fixed by the lottery committee, he wins the prize. What is the probability of Winning the prize in the game. [Hint order of the numbers is not important.] 12. Check whether the following probabilities P(A) and P(B) are consistently defined (i) P(A) = 0.5, P(B) = 0.7, P(A B) = 0.6 (ii) P(A) = 0.5, P(B) = 0.4, P(A B) = 0.8 13. Fill in the blanks in following table: P(A) P(B) P(A B) P(A B) (i) (ii) (iii)
1 3 1 5 1 15
0.35 0.5
... 0.35
0.25 ...
3 1 and P(B) = . Find P(A or B), if A and B are mutually exclusive 5 5 1 1 1 , P(F) = and P(E and F) = , find 4 2 8
19.
20.
(i) P(E or F), (ii) P(not E and not F). Events E and F are such that P(not E or not F) = 0.25, State whether E and F are mutually exclusive. A and B are events such that P(A) = 0.42, P(B) = 0.48 and P(A and B) = 0.16. Determine (i) P(not A), (ii) P(not B) and (iii) P(A or B) In Class XI of a school 40% of the students study Mathematics and 30% study Biology. 10% of the class study both Mathematics and Biology. If a student is selected at random from the class, find the probability that he will be studying Mathematics or Biology. In an entrance test that is graded on the basis of two examinations, the probability of a randomly chosen student passing the first examination is 0.8 and the probability of passing the second examination is 0.7. The probability of passing atleast one of them is 0.95. What is the probability of passing both? The probability that a student will pass the final examination in both English and Hindi is 0.5 and the probability of passing neither is 0.1. If the probability of passing the English examination is 0.75, what is the probability of passing the Hindi examination?
406
MATHEMATICS
21. In a class of 60 students, 30 opted for NCC, 32 opted for NSS and 24 opted for both NCC and NSS. If one of these students is selected at random, find the probability that (i) (ii) (iii) The student opted for NCC or NSS. The student has opted neither NCC nor NSS. The student has opted NSS but not NCC.
Miscellaneous Examples
Example 14 On her vacations Veena visits four cities (A, B, C and D) in a random order. What is the probability that she visits (i) (iii) (v) A before B? A first and B last? A just before B? (ii) (iv) A before B and B before C? A either first or second?
Solution The number of arrangements (orders) in which Veena can visit four cities A, B, C, or D is 4! i.e., 24.Therefore, n (S) = 24. Since the number of elements in the sample space of the experiment is 24 all of these outcomes are considered to be equally likely. A sample space for the experiment is S = {ABCD, ABDC, ACBD, ACDB, ADBC, ADCB BACD, BADC, BDAC, BDCA, BCAD, BCDA CABD, CADB, CBDA, CBAD, CDAB, CDBA DABC, DACB, DBCA, DBAC, DCAB, DCBA} (i) Let the event she visits A before B be denoted by E Therefore, E = {ABCD, CABD, DABC, ABDC, CADB, DACB ACBD, ACDB, ADBC, CDAB, DCAB, ADCB} Thus (ii)
P(E) =
n(E) n ( S)
12 1 = 24 2
Let the event Veena visits A before B and B before C be denoted by F. Here F = {ABCD, DABC, ABDC, ADBC}
n ( F) 4 1 Therefore, P ( F) = n S = 24 = 6 ( )
Students are advised to find the probability in case of (iii), (iv) and (v).
PROBABILITY
407
Example 15 Find the probability that when a hand of 7 cards is drawn from a well shuffled deck of 52 cards, it contains (i) all Kings (ii) 3 Kings (iii) atleast 3 Kings. Solution Total number of possible hands =
52
C7
48
Hence
C 4 48 C3 1 = 52 7735 C7
Therefore
P (3 Kings) =
C3 48 C 4 9 = 52 1547 C7
(iii) P(atleast 3 King) = P(3 Kings or 4 Kings) = P(3 Kings) + P(4 Kings) =
Example 16 If A, B, C are three events associated with a random experiment, prove that
P ( A B C ) = P ( A ) + P ( B ) +P ( C ) P ( A B ) P ( A C )
... (1)
... (2)
Also A E = A ( B C ) = ( A B ) ( A C ) [using distribution property of intersection of sets over the union]. Thus
P ( A E ) = P ( A B ) + P ( A C ) P ( A B) ( A C )
408
MATHEMATICS
... (3)
P ( A B) P ( A C ) + P ( A B C ) Example 17 In a relay race there are five teams A, B, C, D and E. (a) (b) What is the probability that A, B and C finish first, second and third, respectively. What is the probability that A, B and C are first three to finish (in any order) (Assume that all finishing orders are equally likely)
Solution If we consider the sample space consisting of all finishing orders in the first three places, we will have 5 P3 , i.e., a probability of (a)
5! = 5 4 3 = 60 sample points, each with ( 5 3 )!
1 . 60 A, B and C finish first, second and third, respectively. There is only one finishing order for this, i.e., ABC. 1 . 60 A, B and C are the first three finishers. There will be 3! arrangements for A, B and C. Therefore, the sample points corresponding to this event will be 3! in number. 3! 6 1 = = 60 60 10
Thus P(A, B and C finish first, second and third respectively) = (b)
So
PROBABILITY
409
3. A die has two faces each with number 1, three faces each with number 2 and one face with number 3. If die is rolled once, determine (i) P(2) (ii) P(1 or 3) (iii) P(not 3) 4. In a certain lottery 10,000 tickets are sold and ten equal prizes are awarded. What is the probability of not getting a prize if you buy (a) one ticket (b) two tickets (c) 10 tickets. 5. Out of 100 students, two sections of 40 and 60 are formed. If you and your friend are among the 100 students, what is the probability that (a) you both enter the same section? (b) you both enter the different sections? 6. Three letters are dictated to three persons and an evelope is addressed to each of them, the letters are inserted into the envelopes at random so that each envelope contains exactly one letter. Find the probability that at least one letter is in its proper envelope. 7. A and B are two events such that P(A) = 0.54, P(B) = 0.69 and P(A B) = 0.35. Find (i) P(A B) (ii) P(A B) (iii) P(A B) (iv) P(B A) 8. From the employees of a company, 5 persons are selected to represent them in the managing committee of the company. Particulars of five persons are as follows: S. No. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Name Harish Rohan Sheetal Alis Salim Sex M M F F M Age in years 30 33 46 28 41
A person is selected at random from this group to act as a spokesperson. What is the probability that the spokesperson will be either male or over 35 years? 9. If 4-digit numbers greater than 5,000 are randomly formed from the digits 0, 1, 3, 5, and 7, what is the probability of forming a number divisible by 5 when, (i) the digits are repeated? (ii) the repetition of digits is not allowed? 10. The number lock of a suitcase has 4 wheels, each labelled with ten digits i.e., from 0 to 9. The lock opens with a sequence of four digits with no repeats. What is the probability of a person getting the right sequence to open the suitcase?
410
MATHEMATICS
Summary
In this Chapter, we studied about the axiomatic approach of probability. The main features of this Chapter are as follows: Sample space: The set of all possible outcomes Sample points: Elements of sample space Event: A subset of the sample space Impossible event : The empty set Sure event: The whole sample space Complementary event or not event : The set A or S A Event A or B: The set A B Event A and B: The set A B Event A and not B: The set A B Mutually exclusive event: A and B are mutually exclusive if A B = Exhaustive and mutually exclusive events: Events E1, E2,..., En are mutually exclusive and exhaustive if E1 E2 ... En = S and Ei Ej = V i j Probability: Number P (i) associated with sample point i such that (i) 0 P (i) 1 (iii) P(A) =
i
i
(ii)
P ( ) for all S = 1
i
i i
of the outcome i. Equally likely outcomes: All outcomes with equal probability Probability of an event: For a finite sample space with equally likely outcomes Probability of an event P(A) =
the set A, n(S) = number of elements in the set S. If A and B are any two events, then P(A or B) = P(A) + P(B) P(A and B) equivalently, P(A B) = P(A) + P(B) P(A B) If A and B are mutually exclusive, then P(A or B) = P(A) + P(B) If A is any event, then P(not A) = 1 P(A)
PROBABILITY
411
Historical Note
Probability theory like many other branches of mathematics, evolved out of practical consideration. It had its origin in the 16th century when an Italian physician and mathematician Jerome Cardan (15011576) wrote the first book on the subject Book on Games of Chance (Biber de Ludo Aleae). It was published in 1663 after his death. In 1654, a gambler Chevalier de Metre approached the well known French Philosoher and Mathematician Blaise Pascal (16231662) for certain dice problem. Pascal became interested in these problems and discussed with famous French Mathematician Pierre de Fermat (16011665). Both Pascal and Fermat solved the problem independently. Besides, Pascal and Fermat, outstanding contributions to probability theory were also made by Christian Huygenes (16291665), a Dutchman, J. Bernoulli (16541705), De Moivre (16671754), a Frenchman Pierre Laplace (17491827), A Frenchman and the Russian P.L Chebyshev (18211897), A. A Markov (18561922) and A. N Kolmogorove (19031987). Kolmogorove is credited with the axiomatic theory of probability. His book Foundations of Probability published in 1933, introduces probability as a set function and is considered a classic.
Appendix
INFINITE SERIES
A.1.1 Introduction
As discussed in the Chapter 9 on Sequences and Series, a sequence a1, a2, ..., an, ... having infinite number of terms is called infinite sequence and its indicated sum, i.e., a1 + a2 + a3 + ... + an + ... is called an infinte series associated with infinite sequence. This series can also be expressed in abbreviated form using the sigma notation, i.e., a1 + a2 + a3 + . . . + an + . . . =
a
k =1
In this Chapter, we shall study about some special types of series which may be required in different problem situations.
(1 + x )
= 1 + mx +
INFINITE SERIES
413
Remark 1. Note carefully the condition | x | < 1, i.e., 1< x < 1 is necessary when m is negative integer or a fraction. For example, if we take x = 2 and m = 2, we obtain
(1 2 )2 = 1 + ( 2 )( 2 ) +
or 1= 1 + 4 + 12 + . . . This is not possible
( 2 )( 3)
1.2
( 2 )2 + ...
2. Note that there are infinite number of terms in the expansion of (1+ x)m, when m is a negative integer or a fraction Consider
( a + b)
b b m = a 1 + = a 1 + a a
b m ( m 1) m = a 1 + m a + 1.2
m m 1 = a + ma b +
2 b + ... a
m ( m 1) 1.2
a m 2b 2 + ...
m ( m 1)( m 2 ) ... ( m r + 1) a m r b r 1.2.3...r We give below certain particular cases of Binomial Theorem, when we assume
x < 1 , these are left to students as exercises:
, when | x | < 2.
414
MATHEMATICS
Solution We have
x 1 2
1 2
1 1 3 2 x = 1 + 2 + 2 2 x + ... 1 2 1. 2 2
= 1+
x 3x 2 + + ... 4 32
resulting sequence a, ar, ar2, . . ., arn1 is taken as the standard form of G.P., where a is first term and r, the common ratio of G.P. Earlier, we have discussed the formula to find the sum of finite series a + ar + ar2 + ... + arn 1 which is given by
Sn =
a 1 rn 1 r
).
In this section, we state the formula to find the sum of infinite geometric series a + ar + ar2 + .. . . .+ arn 1 +. . . . and illustrate the same by examples. Let us consider the G.P. 1,
2 4 , ,... 3 9
Here a = 1, r =
2 . We have 3
n
2 1 n 3 = 3 1 2 Sn = 2 3 1 3
n
... (1)
INFINITE SERIES
415
n
2 3
n
1 0.6667
5 0.1316872428
10 0.01734152992
n
20 0.00030072866
2 We observe that as n becomes larger and larger, becomes closer and closer to 3
the sum of infinitely many terms is given by S = 3. Thus, for infinite geometric progression a, ar, ar2, ..., if numerical value of common ratio r is less than 1, then
a 1 rn
Sn =
1 r
a ar n = 1 r 1 r
(ii) 1
416
MATHEMATICS
5 5 5 , , ,.... 4 16 64
Solution Here a =
1 1 1 1 + + + + ... ... (1) 1! 2! 3! 4! The sum of the series given in (1) is denoted by the number e Let us estimate the value of the number e. Since every term of the series (1) is positive, it is clear that its sum is also positive. Consider the two sums 1+
1 1 1 1 + + + ... + + ... 3! 4! 5! n!
and Observe that
1 1 1 1 1 1 = and 2 = , which gives < 2 4 3! 2 2 3! 6 1 1 1 1 1 1 < = and 3 = , which gives 8 4! 23 2 4! 24 1 1 1 1 1 1 = and 4 = , which gives < 4 . 16 5! 2 2 5! 120 1 1 1 1 + 3 + 4 + .... + n1 + ... 2 2 2 2 2
... (2)
... (3)
INFINITE SERIES
417
Therefore
... (4)
Adding
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 + + + + + + ... + + ... n! 1! 2! 3! 4! 5!
1 1 1 1 1 1 < 1 + + + 2 + 3 + 4 + ... + n1 + ... 2 2 2 1! 2! 2
... (5)
1 1 1 1 1 = 1 + 1 + + 2 + 3 + 4 + ... + n1 + ... 2 2 2 2 2
= 1+
1 1 1 2
=1+ 2 = 3
Left hand side of (5) represents the series (1). Therefore e < 3 and also e > 2 and hence 2 < e < 3. Remark The exponential series involving variable x can be expressed as
ex = 1 + x x 2 x3 xn + + + ... + + ... 1! 2! 3! n!
Example 3 Find the coefficient of x2 in the expansion of e2x+3 as a series in powers of x. Solution In the exponential series
e = 1+
x
x x 2 x3 + + + ... 1! 2! 3!
418
MATHEMATICS
2 x+ 3
( 2 x + 3) + ( 2 x + 3) 2 + ... 1+
1! 2!
( 2 x + 3) n
n!
1 n n 2 n 3 + C1 3n 1 ( 2 x ) + n C2 3n 2 ( 2 x ) + ... + ( 2 x ) . n!
n
n =2
n ( n 1) 3 C 2 3n 2 22 2 = n! n! n= 2
= 2
3n 2 [using n! = n (n 1) (n 2)!] n = 2 ( n 2 )!
3 32 33 2 1 + + + + ... = 1! 2! 3!
= 2e3 . Thus 2e is the coefficient of x2 in the expansion of e2x+3. Alternatively e2x+3 = e3 . e2x
3
2 x (2 x ) 2 (2 x)3 + + + ... e3 1 + = 1! 2! 3!
22 e 3 . = 2e 3 Thus, the coefficient of x2 in the expansion of e2x+3 is 2!
Example 4 Find the value of e2, rounded off to one decimal place. Solution Using the formula of exponential series involving x, we have
ex = 1 + x x 2 x3 xn + + + ... + + ... 1! 2! 3! n!
INFINITE SERIES
419
Putting x = 2, we get
e2 = 1 + 2 2 2 23 2 4 25 2 6 + + + + + + ... 1! 2! 3! 4! 5! 6!
= 1+ 2 + 2 +
4 2 4 4 + + + + ... 3 3 15 45
Thus, e2 lies between 7.355 and 7.4. Therefore, the value of e2, rounded off to one decimal place, is 7.4.
Note The expansion of loge (1+x) is valid for x = 1. Substituting x = 1 in the expansion of loge (1+x), we get
1 1 1 log e 2 = 1 + + ... 2 3 4
420
MATHEMATICS
2 + 2 2 3 + 3 3 x + x ... 2 3
= log e (1 + x ) + log (1 + x )
2 = log e 1 + ( + ) x + x
= log e
( (1 + px + qx )
2
Here, we have used the facts + = p and = q . We know this from the given roots of the quadratic equation. We have also assumed that both | x | < 1 and
| x | < 1.
Appendix
MATHEMATICAL MODELLING
A.2.1 Introduction
Much of our progress in the last few centuries has made it necessary to apply mathematical methods to real-life problems arising from different fields be it Science, Finance, Management etc. The use of Mathematics in solving real-world problems has become widespread especially due to the increasing computational power of digital computers and computing methods, both of which have facilitated the handling of lengthy and complicated problems. The process of translation of a real-life problem into a mathematical form can give a better representation and solution of certain problems. The process of translation is called Mathematical Modelling. Here we shall familiaries you with the steps involved in this process through examples. We shall first talk about what a mathematical model is, then we discuss the steps involved in the process of modelling.
A.2.2 Preliminaries
Mathematical modelling is an essential tool for understanding the world. In olden days the Chinese, Egyptians, Indians, Babylonians and Greeks indulged in understanding and predicting the natural phenomena through their knowledge of mathematics. The architects, artisans and craftsmen based many of their works of art on geometric prinicples. Suppose a surveyor wants to measure the height of a tower. It is physically very difficult to measure the height using the measuring tape. So, the other option is to find out the factors that are useful to find the height. From his knowledge of trigonometry, he knows that if he has an angle of elevation and the distance of the foot of the tower to the point where he is standing, then he can calculate the height of the tower. So, his job is now simplified to find the angle of elevation to the top of the tower and the distance from the foot of the tower to the point where he is standing. Both of which are easily measurable. Thus, if he measures the angle of elevation as 40 and the distance as 450m, then the problem can be solved as given in Example 1.
422
MATHEMATICS
Example 1 The angle of elevation of the top of a tower from a point O on the ground, which is 450 m away from the foot of the tower, is 40. Find the height of the tower. Solution We shall solve this in different steps. Step 1 We first try to understand the real problem. In the problem a tower is given and its height is to be measured. Let h denote the height. It is given that the horizontal distance of the foot of the tower from a particular point O on the ground is 450 m. Let d denotes this distance. Then d = 450m. We also know that the angle of elevation, denoted by , is 40. The real problem is to find the height h of the tower using the known distance d and the angle of elevation . Step 2 The three quantities mentioned in the problem are height, distance and angle of elevation. So we look for a relation connecting these three quantities. This is obtained by expressing it geometrically in the following way (Fig 1). AB denotes the tower. OA gives the horizontal distance from the point O to foot of the tower. AOB is the angle of elevation. Then we have tan =
h or h = d tan d
... (1)
Fig 1
Step 3 We use Equation (1) to solve h. We have = 40. and d = 450m. Then we get h = tan 40 450 = 450 0.839 = 377.6m Step 4 Thus we got that the height of the tower approximately 378m. Let us now look at the different steps used in solving the problem. In step 1, we have studied the real problem and found that the problem involves three parameters height, distance and angle of elevation. That means in this step we have studied the real-life problem and identified the parameters. In the Step 2, we used some geometry and found that the problem can be represented geometrically as given in Fig 1. Then we used the trigonometric ratio for the tangent function and found the relation as h = d tan So, in this step we formulated the problem mathematically. That means we found an equation representing the real problem.
MATHEMATICAL MODELLING
423
In Step 3, we solved the mathematical problem and got that h = 377.6m. That is we found Solution of the problem. In the last step, we interpreted the solution of the problem and stated that the height of the tower is approximately 378m. We call this as Interpreting the mathematical solution to the real situation In fact these are the steps mathematicians and others use to study various reallife situations. We shall consider the question, why is it necessary to use mathematics to solve different situations. Here are some of the examples where mathematics is used effectively to study various situations. 1. Proper flow of blood is essential to transmit oxygen and other nutrients to various parts of the body in humanbeings as well as in all other animals. Any constriction in the blood vessel or any change in the characteristics of blood vessels can change the flow and cause damages ranging from minor discomfort to sudden death. The problem is to find the relationship between blood flow and physiological characteristics of blood vessel. 2. In cricket a third umpire takes decision of a LBW by looking at the trajectory of a ball, simulated, assuming that the batsman is not there. Mathematical equations are arrived at, based on the known paths of balls before it hits the batsmans leg. This simulated model is used to take decision of LBW. 3. Meteorology department makes weather predictions based on mathematical models. Some of the parameters which affect change in weather conditions are temperature, air pressure, humidity, wind speed, etc. The instruments are used to measure these parameters which include thermometers to measure temperature, barometers to measure airpressure, hygrometers to measure humidity, anemometers to measure wind speed. Once data are received from many stations around the country and feed into computers for further analysis and interpretation. 4. Department of Agriculture wants to estimate the yield of rice in India from the standing crops. Scientists identify areas of rice cultivation and find the average yield per acre by cutting and weighing crops from some representative fields. Based on some statistical techniques decisions are made on the average yield of rice. How do mathematicians help in solving such problems? They sit with experts in the area, for example, a physiologist in the first problem and work out a mathematical equivalent of the problem. This equivalent consists of one or more equations or inequalities etc. which are called the mathematical models. Then
424
MATHEMATICS
solve the model and interpret the solution in terms of the original problem. Before we explain the process, we shall discuss what a mathematical model is. A mathematical model is a representation which comprehends a situation. An interesting geometric model is illustrated in the following example. Example 2 (Bridge Problem) Konigsberg is a town on the Pregel River, which in the 18th century was a German town, but now is Russian. Within the town are two river islands that are connected to the banks with seven bridges as shown in (Fig 2). People tried to walk around the town in a way that only crossed each bridge once, but it proved to be difficult problem. Leonhard Euler, a Swiss Fig 2 mathematician in the service of the Russian empire Catherine the Great, heard about the problem. In 1736 Euler proved that the walk was not possible to do. He proved this by inventing a kind of diagram called a network, that is made up of vertices (dots where lines meet) and arcs (lines) (Fig3). He used four dots (vertices) for the two river banks and the two islands. These have been marked A, B and C, D. The seven lines (arcs) are the seven bridges. You can see that 3 bridges (arcs) join to riverbank, A, and 3 join to riverbank B. 5 bridges (arcs) join to island C, and 3 join to island D. This means that all the vertices have an odd number of arcs, so Fig 3 they are called odd vertices (An even vertex would have to have an even number of arcs joining to it). Remember that the problem was to travel around town crossing each bridge only once. On Eulers network this meant tracing over each arc only once, visiting all the vertices. Euler proved it could not be done because he worked out that, to have an odd vertex you would have to begin or end the trip at that vertex. (Think about it). Since there can only be one beginning and one end, there can only be two odd vertices if you are to trace over each arc only once. Since the bridge problem has 4 odd vertices, it just not possible to do!
MATHEMATICAL MODELLING
425
After Euler proved his Theorem, much water has flown under the bridges in Konigsberg. In 1875, an extra bridge was built in Konigsberg, joining the land areas A and D (Fig 4). Is it possible now for the Konigsbergians to go round the city, using each bridge only once? Here the situation will be as in Fig 4. After the addition of the new edge, both the vertices A and D have become even degree vertices. Fig 4 However, B and C still have odd degree. So, it is possible for the Konigsbergians to go around the city using each bridge exactly once. The invention of networks began a new theory called graph theory which is now used in many ways, including planning and mapping railway networks (Fig 4).
426
MATHEMATICS
parameters involved in the problem. For example, in the case of pendulum, the factors are period of oscillation (T), the mass of the bob (m), effective length (l ) of the pendulum which is the distance between the point of suspension to the centre of mass of the bob. Here, we consider the length of string as effective length of the pendulum and acceleration due to gravity (g), which is assumed to be constant at a place. So, we have identified four parameters for studying the problem. Now, our purpose is to find T. For this we need to understand what are the parameters that affect the period which can be done by performing a simple experiment. We take two metal balls of two different masses and conduct experiment with each of them attached to two strings of equal lengths. We measure the period of oscillation. We make the observation that there is no appreciable change of the period with mass. Now, we perform the same experiment on equal mass of balls but take strings of different lengths and observe that there is clear dependence of the period on the length of the pendulum. This indicates that the mass m is not an essential parameter for finding period whereas the length l is an essential parameter. This process of searching the essential parameters is necessary before we go to the next step. 2. Mathematical description This involves finding an equation, inequality or a geometric figure using the parameters already identified. In the case of simple pendulum, experiments were conducted in which the values of period T were measured for different values of l. These values were plotted on a graph which resulted in a curve that resembled a parabola. It implies that the relation between T and l could be expressed T2 = kl It was found that k =
4 2 . This gives the equation g
... (1)
T = 2
l g
... (2)
Finding the solution The mathematical formulation rarely gives the answer directly.
Usually we have to do some operation which involves solving an equation, calculation or applying a theorem etc. In the case of simple pendulums the solution involves applying the formula given in Equation (2).
MATHEMATICAL MODELLING
427
The period of oscillation calculated for two different pendulums having different lengths is given in Table 1
Table 1
l T
The table shows that for l = 225 cm, T = 3.04 sec and for l = 275 cm, T = 3.36 sec.
Interpretation/Validation
A mathematical model is an attempt to study, the essential characteristic of a real life problem. Many times model equations are obtained by assuming the situation in an idealised context. The model will be useful only if it explains all the facts that we would like it to explain. Otherwise, we will reject it, or else, improve it, then test it again. In other words, we measure the effectiveness of the model by comparing the results obtained from the mathematical model, with the known facts about the real problem. This process is called validation of the model. In the case of simple pendulum, we conduct some experiments on the pendulum and find out period of oscillation. The results of the experiment are given in Table 2.
Table 2
Periods obtained experimentally for four different pendulums Mass (gms) 385 230 Length (cms) 275 225 275 225 Time (secs) 3.371 3.056 3.352 3.042
Now, we compare the measured values in Table 2 with the calculated values given in Table 1. The difference in the observed values and calculated values gives the error. For example, for l = 275 cm, and mass m = 385 gm, error = 3.371 3.36 = 0.011 which is small and the model is accepted. Once we accept the model, we have to interpret the model. The process of describing the solution in the context of the real situation is called interpretation of the model. In this case, we can interpret the solution in the following way: (a) The period is directly proportional to the square root of the length of the pendulum.
428
MATHEMATICS
(b) It is inversely proportional to the square root of the acceleration due to gravity. Our validation and interpretation of this model shows that the mathematical model is in good agreement with the practical (or observed) values. But we found that there is some error in the calculated result and measured result. This is because we have neglected the mass of the string and resistance of the medium. So, in such situation we look for a better model and this process continues. This leads us to an important observation. The real world is far too complex to understand and describe completely. We just pick one or two main factors to be completely accurate that may influence the situation. Then try to obtain a simplified model which gives some information about the situation. We study the simple situation with this model expecting that we can obtain a better model of the situation. Now, we summarise the main process involved in the modelling as (a) Formulation (b) Solution (c) Interpretation/Validation The next example shows how modelling can be done using the techniques of finding graphical solution of inequality. Example 3 A farm house uses atleast 800 kg of special food daily. The special food is a mixture of corn and soyabean with the following compositions
Table 3
Cost per Kg Rs 10 Rs 20
The dietary requirements of the special food stipulate atleast 30% protein and at most 5% fibre. Determine the daily minimum cost of the food mix. Solution Step 1 Here the objective is to minimise the total daily cost of the food which is made up of corn and soyabean. So the variables (factors) that are to be considered are x = the amount of corn y = the amount of soyabean z = the cost Step 2 The last column in Table 3 indicates that z, x, y are related by the equation z = 10x + 20y ... (1) The problem is to minimise z with the following constraints:
MATHEMATICAL MODELLING
429
The farm used atleast 800 kg food consisting of corn and soyabean i.e., x + y 800 ... (2) (b) The food should have atleast 30% protein dietary requirement in the proportion as given in the first column of Table 3. This gives 0.09x + 0.6y 0.3 (x + y) ... (3) (c) Similarly the food should have atmost 5% fibre in the proportion given in 2nd column of Table 3. This gives 0.02x + 0.06 y 0.05 (x + y) ... (4) We simplify the constraints given in (2), (3) and (4) by grouping all the coefficients of x, y. Then the problem can be restated in the following mathematical form. Statement Minimise z subject to x + y 800 0.21x .30y 0 0.03x .01y 0 This gives the formulation of the model. Step 3 This can be solved graphically. The shaded region in Fig 5 gives the possible solution of the equations. From the graph it is clear that the minimum value is got at the point (470.6,329.4) i.e., x = 470.6 and y = 329.4.
(a)
Fig 5
This gives the value of z as z = 10 470.6 + 20 329.4 = 11294 This is the mathematical solution.
430
MATHEMATICS
Step 4 The solution can be interpreted as saying that, The minimum cost of the special food with corn and soyabean having the required portion of nutrient contents, protein and fibre is Rs 11294 and we obtain this minimum cost if we use 470.6 kg of corn and 329.4 kg of soyabean. In the next example, we shall discuss how modelling is used to study the population of a country at a particular time. Example 4 Suppose a population control unit wants to find out how many people will be there in a certain country after 10 years Step 1 Formulation We first observe that the population changes with time and it increases with birth and decreases with deaths. We want to find the population at a particular time. Let t denote the time in years. Then t takes values 0, 1, 2, ..., t = 0 stands for the present time, t = 1 stands for the next year etc. For any time t, let p (t) denote the population in that particular year. Suppose we want to find the population in a particular year, say t0 = 2006. How will we do that. We find the population by Jan. 1st, 2005. Add the number of births in that year and subtract the number of deaths in that year. Let B(t) denote the number of births in the one year between t and t + 1 and D(t) denote the number of deaths between t and t + 1. Then we get the relation P (t + 1) = P (t) + B (t) D (t) Now we make some assumptions and definitions 1. 2.
B (t ) P (t ) is called the birth rate for the time interval t to t + 1. D (t) P (t) is called the death rate for the time interval t to t + 1.
Assumptions 1. The birth rate is the same for all intervals. Likewise, the death rate is the same for all intervals. This means that there is a constant b, called the birth rate, and a constant d, called the death rate so that, for all t 0,
b=
B (t ) P (t )
and
d=
D (t ) P (t )
... (1)
2. There is no migration into or out of the population; i.e., the only source of population change is birth and death. As a result of assumptions 1 and 2, we deduce that, for t 0,
MATHEMATICAL MODELLING
431
P (t + 1) = P(t) + B(t) D(t) = P(t) + bP(t) dP(t) = (1 + b d) P(t) Setting t = 0 in (2) gives P(1) = (1 + b d)P (0) Setting t = 1 in Equation (2) gives P(2) = (1 + b d) P (1) = (1 + b d) (1 + b d) P (0) = (1 + b d)2 P(0) Continuing this way, we get P(t) = (1 + b d)t P (0)
(Using equation 3)
... (4)
for t = 0, 1, 2, ... The constant 1 + b d is often abbreviated by r and called the growth rate or, in more high-flown language, the Malthusian parameter, in honor of Robert Malthus who first brought this model to popular attention. In terms of r, Equation (4) becomes , t = 0, 1, 2, ... ... (5) P(t) = P(0)r t P(t) is an example of an exponential function. Any function of the form cr t, where c and r are constants, is an exponential function. Equation (5) gives the mathematical formulation of the problem. Step 2 Solution Suppose the current population is 250,000,000 and the rates are b = 0.02 and d = 0.01. What will the population be in 10 years? Using the formula, we calculate P(10). P(10) = (1.01)10 (250,000,000) = (1.104622125) (250,000,000) = 276,155,531.25 Step 3 Interpretation and Validation Naturally, this result is absurd, since one cant have 0.25 of a person. So, we do some approximation and conclude that the population is 276,155,531 (approximately). Here, we are not getting the exact answer because of the assumptions that we have made in our mathematical model. The above examples show how modelling is done in variety of situations using different mathematical techniques. Since a mathematical model is a simplified representation of a real problem, by its very nature, has built-in assumptions and approximations. Obviously, the most important
432
MATHEMATICS
question is to decide whether our model is a good one or not i.e., when the obtained results are interpreted physically whether or not the model gives reasonable answers. If a model is not accurate enough, we try to identify the sources of the shortcomings. It may happen that we need a new formulation, new mathematical manipulation and hence a new evaluation. Thus mathematical modelling can be a cycle of the modelling process as shown in the flowchart given below:
START
<
ASSUMPTIONS/AXIOMS
FORMULATION
SOLUTION
INTERPRETATION
<
VALIDATION
NO
YES SATISFIED
<
<
STOP
ANSWERS
EXERCISE 1.1
1. (i), (iv), (v), (vi), (vii) and (viii) are sets. 2. (i) (ii) (iii) (vi) (v) (vi) 3. (i) A = {3, 2, 1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 } (ii) B = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5} (iii) C = {17, 26, 35, 44, 53, 62, 71, 80} (iv) D = {2, 3, 5} (v) E = {T, R, I, G, O, N, M, E, Y} (vi) F = {B, E, T, R,} 4. (i) { x : x = 3n and 1 n 4 } (ii) { x : x = 2n and 1 n 5 } (iii) { x : x = 5n and 1 n 4 } (iv) { x : x is an even natural number} (v) { x : x = n2 and 1 n 10 } 5. (i) A = {1, 3, , 5, . . . } (ii) B = {0, 1, 2, 3, 4 } (iii) C = { 2, 1, 0, 1, 2 } (iv) D = { L, O, Y, A } (v) E = { February, April, June, September, November } (vi) F = {b, c, d, f, g, h, j } 6. (i) (c) (ii) (a) (iii) (d) (iv) (b)
EXERCISE 1.2
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. (i), (i) (i) (i) (i) (iii), (iv) Finite (ii) Infinite (ii) Yes (ii) No (ii) Infinite (iii) Finite (iv) Infinite Finite (iii) Infinite (iv) Finite No (iii) Yes (iv) No Yes 6. B= D, E = G (v) Finite (v) Infinite
EXERCISE 1.3
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. (i) (vii) (i) (i), (i) (iii) 1 (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) False (ii) True (iii) False (iv) True (v) False (v), (vii), (viii), (ix), (xi) { a }, (ii) , { a }, { b } { a, b } , { 1 }, { 2 }, { 3 }, { 1, 2 }, { 1, 3 }, { 2, 3 } { 1, 2, 3 } (vi) (vi) True (iv)
( 4, 6] (ii) ( 12, 10) (iii) [ 0, 7 ) (iv) [ 3, 4 ] 7. (i) { x : x R, 3 < x < 0 } (ii) { x : x R, 6 x 12 } (iii) { x : x R, 6 < x 12 } (iv) { x R : 23 x < 5 } 9. (iii)
434
MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 1.4
1. (i) X Y = {1, 2, 3, 5 } (iii) (ii) A B = { a, b, c, e, i, o, u } A B = {x : x = 1, 2, 4, 5 or a multiple of 3 } 3. B
(iv) A B = {x : 1 < x < 10, x N} (v) A B = {1, 2, 3 } 2. Yes, A B = { a, b, c } 4. (i) { 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 } (ii) {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7,8 } (iii) {3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8 } (iv) {3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10) (v) {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8 } (vi) (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10} 5. 6. (i) X Y = { 1, 3 } (ii) A B = { a } (i) { 7, 9, 11 } (v) (viii) { 7, 9, 11 } 7. 9. (i) B (v) (iv) {4, 8, 16, 20 ) (vii) {20 ) (x) { 5, 10, 15 } (ii) { 11, 13 } (vi) { 7, 9, 11 } (ix) {7, 9, 11 } (vii) { 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10 ) (iii) { 3 } (iii) (vii) (x) { 7, 9, 11, 15 } (iv) 8. (iii) (iv) { 11 }
(ii) C (iii) D { 2 } {vi){ x : x is an odd prime number } (ii) {3, 9, 15, 18, 21 } (viii) { 4, 8, 12, 16 }
(v) { 2, 4, 8, 10, 14, 16 } (vi) { 5, 10, 20 } (xi) {2, 4, 6, 8, 12, 14, 16} (xii) {5, 15, 20} (ii) F (iii) { b , d } (iii) T (iv) T
10. (i) { a, c } (ii) {f, g } 11. Set of irrational numbers 12. (i) F
EXERCISE 1.5
(i) (iv) 2. (i) (iv) 3. (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) 1. { 5, 6, 7, 8, 9} (ii) {1, 3, 5, 7, 9 } (iii) {7, 8, 9 } { 5, 7, 9 ) (v) { 1, 2, 3, 4 } (vi) { 1, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 9 } { d, e, f, g, h} (ii) { a, b, c, h } (iii) { b, d , f, h } { b, c, d, e ) { x : x is an odd natural number } { x : x is an even natural number } { x : x N and x is not a multiple of 3 } { x : x is a positive composit number and x = 1 ]
ANSWERS
435
{ x : x is a positive integer which is not divisible by 3 or not divisible by 5} { x : x N and x is not a perfect square } { x : x N and x is not a perfect cube } { x : x N and x = 3 } (ix) { x : x N and x = 2 } (xi) { x : x N and x > (iii) (iv)
(x) { x : x N and x < 7 } 6. is the set of all equilateral triangles. 7. (i) U (ii) A
9 } 2
EXERCISE 1.6
1. 2 5. 30 2. 5 6. 19 3. 50 7. 25, 35 4. 42 8. 60
EXERCISE 2.1
1. x = 2 and y = 1 2. The number of elements in A B is 9. 3. G H = {(7, 5), (7, 4), (7, 2), (8, 5), (8, 4), (8, 2)} H G = {(5, 7), (5, 8), (4, 7), (4, 8), (2, 7), (2, 8)} 4. (i) False P Q = {(m, n) (m, m) (n, n), (n, m)} (ii) False A B is a non empty set of ordered pairs (x, y) such that x A and y B (iii) True 5. A A = {( 1, 1), ( 1, 1), (1, 1), (1, 1)} A A A = {(1, 1, 1), (1, 1, 1), (1, 1, 1), (1, 1, 1), (1, 1, 1), (1, 1, 1), (1, 1, 1), (1, 1, 1)} 6. A = {a, b}, B = {x, y} 8. A B = {(1, 3), (1, 4), (2, 3), (2, 4)} A B will have 24 = 16 subsets. 9. A = {x, y, z} and B = {1,2}
436
MATHEMATICS
10. A = {1, 0, 1}, remaining elements of A A are (1, 1), (1, 1), (0, 1), (0, 0), (1, 1), (1, 0), (1, 1)
EXERCISE 2.2
1. R = {(1, 3), (2, 6), (3, 9), (4, 12)} Domain of R = {1, 2, 3, 4} Range of R = {3, 6, 9, 12} Co domain of R = {1, 2, ..., 14} 2. R = {(1, 6), (2, 7), (3, 8)} Domain of R = {1, 2, 3} Range of R = {6, 7, 8} 3. R = {(1, 4), (1, 6), (2, 9), (3, 4), (3, 6), (5, 4), (5, 6)} 4. 5. (i) R = {(x, y) : y = x 2 for x = 5, 6, 7} (ii) R = {(5,3), (6,4), (7,5)}. Domain of R = {5, 6, 7}, Range of R = {3, 4, 5} (i) R = {(1, 1), (1,2), (1, 3), (1, 4), (1, 6), (2 4), (2, 6), (2, 2), (4, 4), (6, 6), (3, 3), (3, 6)} (ii) Domain of R = {1, 2, 3, 4, 6} (iii) Range of R = {1, 2, 3, 4, 6} 7. R = {(2, 8), (3, 27), (5, 125), (7, 343)} 9. Domain of R = Z Range of R = Z
6. Domian of R = {0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5,} Range of R = {5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10} 8. No. of relations from A into B = 26
EXERCISE 2.3
1. (i) yes, Domain = {2, 5, 8, 11, 14, 17}, Range = {1} (ii) yes, Domain = (2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14}, Range = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7} (iii) No. (i) Domain = R, Range = ( , 0] (ii) Domain of Function = {x : 3 x 3} (iii) Range of Function = {x : 0 x 3} (i) f (0) = 5 (i) t (0) = 32 (ii) f (7) = 9 (ii) t (28) = (iii) f (3) = 11 t (10) = 14 (iii) Range = R (iv) 100
2.
3. 4. 5.
(i) Range = ( , 2)
ANSWERS
437
10.
11. No
12.
EXERCISE 3.1
1. 2.
5 36 (i) 39 22 30
(i)
19 72 (ii) 229 5 29
(ii) 5.
4 3 (iii) 300
(iii)
26 9 (iv) 210
(iv) 6. 5 : 4
3. 12 7. (i)
4. 12 36
20 3
(iii)
2 15
(ii)
1 5
7 25
EXERCISE 3.2
3 2 1 , cosec x = , sec x = 2, tan x = 3 , cot x = 2 3 3
1. sin x =
5 4 5 3 4 2. cosec x = , cos x = , sec x = , tan x = , cot x = 3 5 4 4 3 4 5 3 5 4 3. sin x = , cosec x = , cos x = , sec x = , tan x = 5 4 5 3 3
4. sin x =
438
MATHEMATICS
5. sin x = 6.
1 2
9.
3 2
10. 1
EXERCISE 3.3
5. (i)
3 +1 2 2
(ii) 2
EXERCISE 3.4
1. 3. 5. 7. 8.
4 , , n + , n Z 3 3 3 5 11 5 , , n ,nZ 6 6 6 x= n or x = n, n Z 3 7 or (2n + 1) , n Z 6 2
2. 4. 6.
x = n + ( 1) n x=
n n 3 , or + ,nZ 2 2 8
9.
x=
n , or n ,n Z 3 3
8.
9.
10.
ANSWERS
439
EXERCISE 5.1
1. 3 5. 2 7 i 2. 0 6. 3. i 4. 14 + 28 i 8. 4
5 3 i 14 14
19 21i 5 10
7.
17 5 =i 3 3 4 3 +i 25 25
9.
22 107 i 3 27
7 2 i 2
11.
12.
13. i
EXERCISE 5.2
1 . 2,
2 3
2 . 2,
5 6
3.
2 cos + i sin 4 4
4.
3 3 2 cos + i sin 4 4
5.
3 3 + i sin 2 cos 4 4
6. 3 (cos + i sin )
EXERCISE 5.3
1.
3i
3 11 i 2
2.
1 7 i 4 1 7 i 2
3.
3 3 3 i 2
4.
1 7i 2
2 34 i 2 3
5.
6.
7.
1 7 i 2 2 1 7 i 2 2
8.
9.
(4 2 ) i
2
10.
440
MATHEMATICS
5.
(i)
3 3 2 cos + i sin 4 4
8.
5 2 i 27 27
1 3 , 2 4
6.
2 4 i 3 3
9.
14 14 i 21 21
4 5 5 15. 2
10.
2 , (ii) 0 5
13. 18. 0
14. x = 3, y = 3 20. 4
EXERCISE 6.1
1. 2. 3. 4. (i) {1, 2, 3, 4} (i) No Solution (i) {... 2, 1, 0, 1} (i) {1, 0, 1, 2, 3, ...} 6. ( , 3) 10. (, 6) 14. (, 2] (ii) {... 3, 2, 1, 0, 1,2,3,4,} (ii) {... 4, 3} (ii) (, 2) (ii) (2, ) 7. (, 3] 11. (, 2] 15. (4, ) 18. x 1, 8. (, 4] 12. ( , 120] 16. (, 2]
20. x <
2 , 7
ANSWERS
441
EXERCISE 6.2
1. 2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
442
MATHEMATICS
7.
8.
9.
10.
EXERCISE 6.3
1. 2.
ANSWERS
443
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
444
MATHEMATICS
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
ANSWERS
445
15.
80 10 , 5. 3 3
11 1, 3
11. Between 20C and 25C 12. More than 320 litres but less than 1280 litres. 13. More than 562.5 litres but less than 900 litres. 14. Atleast 9.6 but more than 16.8.
EXERCISE 7.1
1. (i) 125, (ii) 60. 5. 8 2. 108 6. 20 3. 5040 4. 336
446
MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 7.2
1. (i) 40320, (ii) 18 5. (i) 30, (ii) 15120 2. 30, No 3. 28 4. 64
EXERCISE 7.3
1. 5. 9. 11. 504 2. 4536 3. 60 56 6. 9 7. (i) 3, (ii) 4 (i) 360, (ii) 720, (iii) 240 10. 33810 (i) 1814400, (ii) 2419200, (iii) 25401600 4. 120, 48 8. 40320
EXERCISE 7.4
1. 45 5. 2000 9. 35 2. (i) 5, (ii) 6 6. 778320 3. 210 7. 3960 4. 40 8. 200
EXERCISE 8.1
1. 110x + 40x2 80x3 + 80x4 32x5
x 5 5 x 2 10 10 5 1 + + + 3+ 5 x+ 243 81 27 9 x 3x x
x 6 + 6 x 4 + 15 x 2 + 20 + 15 6 1 + 4+ 6 2 x x x 7. 11040808032
6. 884736 9. 9509900499
10. (1.1)
10000
> 1000
ANSWERS
447
EXERCISE 8.2
1. 1512 4. 7. 2. 101376 3.
( 1)
r 6
Cr .x12 2 r .y r
( 1)r 12 Cr .x24r .y r
6. 18564 10. n = 7; r = 3
105 9 35 12 x ; x 8 48 12. m = 4
9 7
EXERCISE 9.1
1. 3, 8, 15, 24, 35 2.
1 2 3 4 5 , , , , 2 3 4 5 6
3. 2, 4, 8, 16 and 32
4.
1 1 1 5 7 , , , and 6 6 2 6 6 3 9 21 75 , , , 21 and 2 2 2 2
6.
8.
49 128
10.
360 23
1,
448
MATHEMATICS
13. 2, 2, 1, 0, 1;
2 + 2 + 1 + 0 + (1) + ...
3 5 8 14. 1, 2, , and 2 3 5
EXERCISE 9.2
1. 1002001 2. 98450 8. 2q 4. 5 or 20 9. 6. 4 10. 0 15. 1
n ( 5n + 7 ) 2 13. 27 16. 14
7.
179 321 14. 11, 14, 17, 20 and 23 17. Rs 245 18. 9
EXERCISE 9.3
1.
5 5 , 2 20 2n
2. 3072
4. 2187 6. 1 7.
1 20 1 ( 0.1) 6
x 3 1 x 2n
8.
7 2
n 3 + 1 3 2 1
9.
1 ( a )n 1+ a
10.
1 x
11.
22 +
3 11 3 1 2
) (
13. 4 16.
14.
15. 2059
80 8 4 8 16 10n 1 n , , ,...or 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, .. 18. 3 3 3 81 9 19. 496 20. rR 21. 3, 6, 12, 24 26. 9 and 27
n=
EXERCISE 9.4
1.
n ( n + 1) ( n + 2 ) 3
2.
n ( n + 1) ( n + 2 ) ( n + 3) 4
ANSWERS
449
3.
n ( n + 1) 3n 2 + 5n + 1 6
4.
n n +1
5. 2840
2
6. 3n (n + 1) (n + 3)
n ( n + 1) 3n 2 + 23n + 34 12
7.
n ( n + 1) ( n + 2 ) 12
8. 9.
n ( n + 1) ( 2n + 1) + 2 2n 1 6
10.
n ( 2n + 1) ( 2n 1) 3
50 n 5n 2n 2 10 1 1 10 n , (ii) 81 9 3 27
22. 1680
23.
n 2 n + 3n + 5 3
25.
n 2n2 + 9n + 13 24
29. Rs 43690
EXERCISE 10.1
1.
2. (0, a), (0, a) and 3a,0 or (0, a), (0, a), and 3. (i) y2 y1 , (ii) x2 x1 7.
3
3a,0
5.
)
1 2
15 4. , 0 2
10. 135
8. x = 1
11. 1 and 2, or
14.
1 , 104.5 Crores 2
450
MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 10.2
1. y = 0 and x = 0 4. 6. 8. 2. x 2y + 10 = 0 3. y = mx 5. 2x + y + 6 = 0 7. 5x + 3y + 2 = 0
3 +1 x
) (
3 1 y = 4
3 1
x 3y + 2 3 = 0
L=
.192 ( C 20 ) + 124.942 90
EXERCISE 10.3
1. (i)
1 1 5 5 y = x + 0, , 0; (ii) y = 2 x + , 2 , ; (iii) y = 0x + 0, 0, 0 7 7 3 3
x y 3 + =1, , 2; x y 3 2 2 + = 1, 4,6; (ii) 4 6 2
2.
(i) (iii)
3.
(i) x cos 120 + y sin 120 = 4, 4, 120 (ii) x cos 90 + y sin 90 = 2, 2, 90; (iii) x cos 315 + y sin 315 = 2 2 , 2 2 , 315
6. (i)
8. y + 7x = 21
9. 30 and 150
22 9
3 + 2 x + 2 3 1 y = 8 3 + 1 or
) (
3 2 x + 1 + 2 3 y = 1 + 8 3
) (
ANSWERS
451
13. 2x + y = 5 17. y x = 1,
2
68 49 14. , 25 25
15.
m=
1 5 ,c = 2 2
7 ,1 6
3.
2 x 3 y = 6 , 3x + 2 y = 6
sin ( ) 2 sin 2
8 32 4. 0 , , 0, 3 3
6.
5.
x=
5 22
7. 2x 3y + 18 = 0 11. 3x y = 7, x + 3y = 9 15.
23 5 units 18
9. 5 14. 1 : 2
16. Slope of the line is zero i.e. line is parallel to x - axis 17. x = 1, y = 1. 21. 18x + 12y + 11 = 0 18. (1, 4). 19.
1 5 2 7
13 22. , 0 5
65
8. c(4, 5), r =
53 9. c (
1 1 , 0) ; r = 4 4
10. x2 + y2 6x 8y + 15 = 0
11. x2 + y2 7x + 5y 14 = 0
452
MATHEMATICS
13. x2 + y2 ax by = 0 14. x2 + y2 4x 4y = 5 15. Inside the circle; since the distance of the point to the centre of the circle is less than the radius of the circle.
EXERCISE 11.2 1. F (3, 0), axis - x - axis, directrix x = 3, length of the Latus rectum = 12 2. F (0,
3 3 ), axis - y - axis, directrix y = , length of the Latus rectum = 6 2 2
3. F (2, 0), axis - x - axis, directrix x = 2, length of the Latus rectum = 8 4. F (0, 4), axis - y - axis, directrix y = 4, length of the Latus rectum = 16 5. F ( , 0) axis - x - axis, directrix x = 6. F (0,
5 2
5 , length of the Latus rectum = 10 2
7. y2 = 24x 10. y2 = 8x
20 , 6
16 3
21 ; 5
2. F (0, 21 ); V (0, 5); Major axis = 10; Minor axis = 4 , e = Latus rectum =
8 5
7 ; 4
9 2
ANSWERS
453
4. F (0, 75 ); V (0, 10); Major axis = 20; Minor axis = 10 , e = Latus rectum = 5 5. F ( 13 ,0); V ( 7, 0); Major axis =14 ; Minor axis = 12 , e = Latus rectum =
3 ; 2 13 ; 7
72 7
3 ; 2 2 2 ; 3
6. F (0, 10 3 ); V (0, 20); Major axis =40 ; Minor axis = 20 , e = Latus rectum = 10 7. F (0, 4 2 ); V (0, 6); Major axis =12 ; Minor axis = 4 , e = Latus rectum = 8.
4 3
15 ; 4
1 2
5 ; 3
9. F ( 5 ,0); V ( 3, 0); Major axis = 6 ; Minor axis = 4 , e = Latus rectum = 10. 13. 16.
x2 y 2 + =1 25 9 x2 y 2 + =1 9 4 x2 y 2 + =1 64 100
8 3
11. 14. 17.
x2 y2 + =1 144 169 x2 y 2 + =1 1 5 x2 y 2 + =1 16 7
x2 y 2 + =1 36 20 x2 y2 + =1 169 144 x2 y 2 + =1 25 9
454
MATHEMATICS
19.
x2 y 2 + =1 10 40
20. x + 4y = 52 or
x2 y 2 + =1 52 13
EXERCISE 11.4
9 5 ; Latus rectum = 4 2 2. Foci (0 6), Vertices (0, 3); e = 2; Latus rectum = 18
1. Foci ( 5, 0), Vertices ( 4, 0); e = 3. Foci (0, 13 ), Vertices (0, 2); e = 4. Foci ( 10, 0), Vertices ( 6, 0); e = 5. Foci (0,
2 14 5
13 ; Latus rectum = 9 2
5 64 ; Latus rectum = 3 3
), Vertices (0,
6 14 4 5 ); e = ; Latus rectum = 5 3 3
49 65 ; Latus rectum = 2 4
9. 12. 15.
y 2 x2 =1 9 16
x2 y 2 =1 25 20 x2 y2 =1 5 5
8. 11. 14.
y 2 x2 =1 25 39
y 2 x2 =1 25 144 x2 9 y2 =1 49 343
4. 1.56m (approx.) 7.
x2 y 2 + =1 25 9
6. 18 sq units
8. 8 3a
ANSWERS
455
EXERCISE 12.1
1. y and z - coordinate are zero 3. I, IV, VIII, V, VI, II, III, VII 4. (i) XY - plane (ii) (x, y, 0) 2. y - coordinate is zero (iii) Eight regions
EXERCISE 12.2
1. (i) 2 5 (ii) 43 (iii) 2 26 (iv) 2 5 4. x 2z = 05. 9x2 + 25y2 + 25z2 225 = 0
EXERCISE 12.3
4 1 27 1. (i) , , , (ii) ( 8,17 ,3) 2. 1 : 2 5 5 5 3. 2 : 3 5. (6, 4, 2), (8, 10, 2)
2. 7 34 , 7
3. a = 2, b =
16 , c=2 3
EXERCISE 13.1
1. 6 5.
22 2. 7
3. 7.
4. 8. 12. 16.
19 2 108 7
1
1 2
6. 5 10. 2 14.
11 4
9. b 13.
11. 1 15.
1 4
a b
a b
456
MATHEMATICS
a +1 b 0 22. 2 Limit does not exist at x = 1 Limit does not exist at x = 0 0 28. a = 0, b = 4
18.
x a1
19. 0 23. 3, 6
20. 1
31. 2
32. For lim f (x) to exists, we need m = n; lim f (x) exists for any integral value x0 x1 of m and n.
EXERCISE 13.2
1. 20 4. (i) 3x2 6. 2. 99 (ii) 2x 3 3. 1 (iii)
2 x3
2
(iv)
( x 1)2
7. (i) 2x a b
(ii) 4ax ax 2 + b
a b
(iii)
( x b )2
8.
nx n anx n1 x n + a n
( x a)
(iii)
3 ( 5 + 2x ) x4
(iv) 15x4 +
24 x5
10. sin x
ANSWERS
457
2. 1
3.
ad bc
5.
2
6.
( cx + d )
( x 1)
, x 0,1
7.
( ax
( 2ax + b )
2
+ bx + c
8.
apx 2 2bpx + ar bq
( px
+ 2x + r
9.
apx 2 + 2bpx + bq ar
( ax + b )
na ( ax + b )
n1
10.
4a 2b + 3 sin x x5 x
11. 13.
2 x
12.
( ax + b )n 1 ( cx + d )m1 mc ( ax + b ) + na ( cx + d )
14. 16.
cos (x+a)
1 1 + sin x
n1
( sin x cos x )
18.
2sec x tan x
( sec x + 1)
cos cos2 x
19. n sin x
cos x
bc cos x + ad sin x + bd
( c + d cos x )
21.
( 3x + 7 cos x )2
458
MATHEMATICS
x cos
1 + tanx x sec 2 x
28.
(1 + tanx )
EXERCISE 14.1
(i) This sentence is always false because the maximum number of days in a month is 31. Therefore, it is a statement. (ii) This is not a statement because for some people mathematics can be easy and for some others it can be difficult. (iii) This sentence is always true because the sum is 12 and it is greater than 10. Therefore, it is a statement. (iv) This sentence is sometimes true and sometimes not true. For example the square of 2 is even number and the square of 3 is an odd number. Therefore, it is not a statement. (v) This sentence is sometimes true and sometimes false. For example, squares and rhombus have equal length whereas rectangles and trapezium have unequal length. Therefore, it is not a statement. (vi) It is an order and therefore, is not a statement. (vii) This sentence is false as the product is (8). Therefore, it is a statement. (viii) This sentence is always true and therefore, it is a statement. (ix) It is not clear from the context which day is referred and therefore, it is not a statement. (x) This is a true statement because all real numbers can be written in the form a + i 0. 2. The three examples can be: (i) Everyone in this room is bold. This is not a statement because from the context it is not clear which room is reffered here and the term bold is not precisely defined. (ii) She is an engineering student. This is also not a statement because who she is. (iii) cos2 is always greater than 1/2. Unless, we know what is, we cannot say whether the sentence is true or not. 1.
ANSWERS
459
EXERCISES 14.2
1. (i) Chennai is not the capital of Tamil Nadu.
2 is a complex number. All triangles are equilateral tringles. The number 2 is not greater than 7. Every natural number is not an integer. The negation of the first statement is the number x is a rational number. which is the same as the second statement This is because when a number is not irrational, it is a rational. Therefore, the given pairs are negations of each other. The negation of the first statement is x is an irrational number which is the same as the second statement. Therefore, the pairs are negations of each other. Number 3 is prime; number 3 is odd (True). All integers are positive; all integers are negative (False). 100 is divisible by 3,100 is divisible by 11 and 100 is divisible by 5 (False).
(ii)
3.
EXERCISE 14.3
(i) And. The component statements are: All rational numbers are real. All real numbers are not complex. (ii) Or. The component statements are: Square of an integer is positive. Square of an integer is negative. (iii) And. the component statements are: The sand heats up quickily in the sun. The sand does not cool down fast at night. (iv) And. The component statements are: 2 x = 2 is a root of the equation 3x x 10 = 0 2 x = 3 is a root of the equation 3x x 10 = 0 2. (i) There exists. The negation is There does not exist a number which is equal to its square. (ii) For every. The negation is There exists a real number x such that x is not less than x + 1. (iii) There exists. The negation is There exists a state in India which does not have a capital. 1.
460
MATHEMATICS
No. The negation of the statement in (i) is There exists real number x and y for which x + y y + x, instead of the statement given in (ii). 4. (i) Exclusive (ii) Inclusive (iii) Exclusive 3.
EXERCISE 14.4
1. (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) 2. (i) A natural number is odd implies that its square is odd. A natural number is odd only if its square is odd. For a natural number to be odd it is necessary that its square is odd. For the square of a natural number to be odd, it is sufficient that the number is odd If the square of a natural number is not odd, then the natural number is not odd. The contrapositive is If a number x is not odd, then x is not a prime number. The converse is If a number x in odd, then it is a prime number. The contrapositive is If two lines intersect in the same plane, then they are not parallel The converse is If two lines do not interesect in the same plane, then they are parallel The contrapositive is If something is not at low temperature, then it is not cold The converse is If something is at low temperature, then it is cold The contrapositive is If you know how to reason deductively, then you can comprehend geometry. The converse is If you do not know how to reason deductively, then you can not comprehend geometry. This statement can be written as If x is an even number, then x is divisible by 4. The contrapositive is, If x is not divisible by 4, then x is not an even number. The converse is, If x is divisible by 4, then x is an even number. If you get a job, then your credentials are good. If the banana tree stays warm for a month, then it will bloom.
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)
(v)
3.
(i) (ii)
ANSWERS
461
If diagonals of a quadrilateral bisect each other, then it is a parallelogram. If you get A+ in the class, then you do all the exercises in the book. Contrapositive Converse Contrapositive Converse
EXERCISE 14.5
5. (i) False. By definition of the chord, it should intersect the circle in two points. (ii) False. This can be shown by giving a counter example. A chord which is not a dimaeter gives the counter example. (iii) True. In the equation of an ellipse if we put a = b, then it is a circle (Direct Method) (iv) True, by the rule of inequality (v) False. Since 11 is a prime number, therefore 11 is irrational.
462
MATHEMATICS
(i) If there is log on to the server, then you have a password. (ii) If it rains, then there is traffic jam. (iii) If you can access the website, then you pay a subscription fee. 4. (i) You watch television if and only if your mind in free. (ii) You get an A grade if and only you do all the homework regularly. (iii) A quadrilateral is equiangular if and only if it is a rectangle. 5. The compound statement with And is 25 is a multiple of 5 and 8 This is a false statement. The compound statement with Or is 25 is a multiple of 5 or 8 This is true statement. 7. Same as Q1 in Exercise 14.4 3.
EXERCISE 15.1
1. 3 5. 6.32 9. 157.92 2. 8.4 6. 16 10. 11.28 3. 2.33 7. 3.23 11. 10.34 4. 7 8. 5.1 12. 7.35
EXERCISE 15.2
1. 9, 9.25
n + 1 n2 1 , 2. 2 12
EXERCISE 15.3
1. B 4. A 2. Y 5. Weight 3. (i) B, (ii) B
7. 20, 3.036
ANSWERS
463
EXERCISE 16.1
1. 2. or 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. {HHH, HHT, HTH, THH, TTH, HTT, THT, TTT} {(x, y) : x, y = 1,2,3,4,5,6} {(1,1), (1,2), (1,3), ..., (1,6), (2,1), (2,2), ..., (2,6), ..., (6, 1), (6, 2), ..., (6,6)} {HHHH, HHHT, HHTH, HTHH, THHH, HHTT, HTHT, HTTH, THHT, THTH, TTHH, HTTT, THTT, TTHT, TTTH, TTTT} {H1, H2, H3, H4, H5, H6, T1, T2, T3, T4, T5, T6} {H1, H2, H3, H4, H5, H6, T} {XB1, XB2, XG1, XG2, YB3, YG3, YG4, YG5} {R1, R2, R3, R4, R5, R6, W1, W2, W3, W4, W5, W6, B1, B2, B3, B4, B5, B6} (i) {BB, BG, GB, GG} (ii) {0, 1, 2} {RW, WR, WW} [HH, HT, T1, T2, T3, T4, T5, T6} {DDD, DDN, DND, NDD, DNN, NDN, NND, NNN} {T, H1, H3, H5, H21, H22, H23, H24, H25, H26, H41, H42, H43, H44, H45, H46, H61, H62, H63, H64, H65, H66} {(1,2), (1,3), (1,4), (2,1), (2,3), (2,4), (3,1), (3,2), (3,4), (4,1), (4,2), (4,3)} {1HH, 1HT, 1TH, 1TT, 2H, 2T, 3HH, 3HT, 3TH, 3TT, 4H, 4T, 5HH, 5HT, 5TH, 5TT, 6H, 6T} {TR1, TR2, TB1, TB2, TB3, H1, H2, H3, H4, H5, H6} {6, (1,6), (2,6), (3,6), (4,6), (5,6), (1,1,6), (1,2,6), ..., (1,5,6), (2,1,6). (2,2,6), ..., (2,5,6), ..., (5,1,6), (5,2,6), ... }
EXERCISE 16.2
1. No. 2. (i) {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6} (ii) (iii) {3, 6} (iv) {1, 2, 3} (v) {6} (vi) {3, 4, 5, 6}, AB = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}, AB = , BC = {3, 6}, EF = {6}, DE = , A C = {1, 2,4,5}, D E = {1,2,3}, E F = , F = {1, 2} 3. A = {(3,6), (4,5), (5, 4), (6,3), (4,6), (5,5), (6,4), (5,6), (6,5), (6,6)} B = {(1,2), (2,2), (3, 2), (4,2), (5,2), (6,2), (2,1), (2,3), (2,4), (2,5), (2,6)} C ={(3,6), (6,3), (5, 4), (4,5), (6,6)} A and B, B and C are mutually exclusive. 4. 5. (i) A and B; A and C; B and C; C and D (ii) A and C (iii) B and D (i) Getting at least two heads, and getting at least two tails (ii) Getting no heads, getting exactly one head and getting at least two heads
464
MATHEMATICS
(iii) Getting at most two tails, and getting exactly two tails (iv) Getting exactly one head and getting exactly two heads (v) Getting exactly one tail, getting exactly two tails, and getting exactly three tails Note There may be other events also as answer to the above question. 6. A = {(2, 1), (2,2), (2,3), (2,4), (2,5), (2,6), (4,1), (4,2), (4,3), (4,4), (4,5), (4,6), (6,1), (6,2), (6,3), (6,4), (6,5), (6,6)} B = {(1, 1), (1,2), (1,3), (1,4), (1,5), (1,6), (3,1), (3,2), (3,3), (3,4), (3,5), (3,6), (5,1), (5,2), (5,3), (5,4), (5,5), (5,6)} C = {(1, 1), (1,2), (1,3), (1,4), (2,1), (2,2), (2,3), (3,1), (3,2), (4,1)} (i) A = {(1,1), (1,2), (1,3), (1,4), (1,5), (1,6), (3,1), (3,2), (3,3), (3,4), (3,5), (3,6), (5,1), (5,2), (5,3), (5,4), (5,5), (5,6)} = B (ii) B = {(2,1), (2,2), (2,3), (2,4), (2,5), (2,6), (4,1), (4,2), (4,3), (4,4), (4,5), (4,6), (6,1), (6,2), (6,3), (6,4), (6,5), (6,6)} = A (iii) AB = {(1,1), (1,2), (1,3), (1,4), (1,5), (1,6), (3,1), (3,2), (3,3), (3,4), (3,5), (3,6), (5,1), (5,2), (5,3), (5,4), (5,5), (5,6), (2,1), (2,2), (2,3), (2,5), (2,6), (4,1), (4,2), (4,3), (4,4), (4,5), (4,6), (6,1), (6,2), (6,3), (6,4), (6,5), (6,6)} = S (iv) A B = (v) A C = {(2,4), (2,5), (2,6), (4,2), (4,3), (4,4), (4,5), (4,6), (6,1), (6,2), (6,3), (6,4), (6,5), (6,6)} (vi) B C = {(1,1), (1,2), (1,3), (1,4), (1,5), (1,6), (2,1), (2,2), (2,3), (3,1), (3,2), (3,3), (3,4), (3,5), (3,6), (4,1), (5,1), (5,2), (5,3), (5,4), (5,5), (5,6)} (vii) B C = {(1,1), (1,2), (1,3), (1,4), (3,1), (3,2)} (viii) A B C = {(2,4), (2,5), (2,6), (4,2), (4,3), (4,4), (4,5), (4,6), (6,1), (6,2), (6,3), (6,4), (6,5), (6,6)} 7. (i) True (ii) True (iii) True (iv) False (v) False (vi) False
EXERCISE 16.3
1. (a) Yes 3. (i) 5. (i) (b) Yes (c) No (d) No (e) No 2.
4. (a) 52 (b)
3 5
ANSWERS
465
7. Rs 4.00 gain, Rs 1.50 gain, Re 1.00 loss, Rs 3.50 loss, Rs 6.00 loss. P ( Winning Rs 4.00) = P (Losing Rs 3.50) = 8. (i) 9.
1 1 , P (Losing Rs 6.00) = . 4 16
9 11
6 13
(ii)
7 13
11.
1 38760
12. (i) No, because P(AB) must be less than or equal to P(A) and P(B), (ii) Yes 13. (i) 15. (i) 18. 0.6 21. (i)
7 15 5 8 19 30
14.
4 5
(ii)
2 15
C5 60 C5
(ii) 1
30
C5 2. 60 C5
13
4. (a) 6.
(c)
10000
C10 C10
2 3
8.
4 5
2 5
(ii)
3 8
10.
1 5040